845ref Ac 270 PDF
845ref Ac 270 PDF
845ref Ac 270 PDF
Grid Solutions
845
Transformer Protection System
Transformer Protection, Control and Management
Instruction manual
Product version: 2.7x
GE publication code: 1601-0651-AC (GEK-119651L)
RoHS Compliant
*1601-0450-AC*
Copyright © 2020 GE Multilin. All rights reserved.
GE Multilin 845 Transformer Protection System instruction manual for revision 2.7x.
845 Transformer Protection System, EnerVista, EnerVista Launchpad, and
EnerVista 8Series Setup software are registered trademarks of GE Multilin.
The contents of this manual are the property of GE Multilin. This documentation is
furnished on license and may not be reproduced in whole or in part without the permission
of GE Multilin. The content of this manual is for informational use only and is subject to
change without notice.
Part number: 1601-0651-AC (August 2020)
7.MONITORING Transformer........................................................................................................................................ 7 - 2
Harmonic Derating...................................................................................................................................7 - 2
Thermal Elements .....................................................................................................................................7 - 5
Winding Hottest..........................................................................................................................................7 - 6
Aging Factor.................................................................................................................................................7 - 7
Loss of Xfmr Life .........................................................................................................................................7 - 9
Tap Changer Failure.............................................................................................................................. 7 - 10
Trip and Close Circuit Monitoring ...........................................................................................7 - 13
Breaker Arcing Current................................................................................................................7 - 20
Breaker Health ................................................................................................................................7 - 23
Functions............................................................................................................................................7 - 27
Power Factor (55).................................................................................................................................... 7 - 27
Demand ...................................................................................................................................................... 7 - 33
Current Demand......................................................................................................................................7 - 33
Real Power Demand..............................................................................................................................7 - 36
Reactive Power ........................................................................................................................................7 - 38
Apparent Power Demand ...................................................................................................................7 - 41
Pulsed Outputs ........................................................................................................................................ 7 - 43
Digital Counters....................................................................................................................................... 7 - 46
Harmonic Detection......................................................................................................................7 - 49
RTD Temperature ...........................................................................................................................7 - 52
RTD Trouble.......................................................................................................................................7 - 57
Loss of Communications ............................................................................................................7 - 58
Chapter 1: Introduction
Introduction
The Multilin 845 relay is a microprocessor-based unit intended for the management and
primary protection of the medium to large size medium voltage (MV) and high voltage (HV)
power transformers. Both 2-winding and 3-winding transformers are supported. The 845
relay provides a number of primary and backup current and voltage based protection
functions. This system allows for control of the circuit breakers at each winding plus a
number of monitoring and control functions are also provided.
Overview
Each relay provides protection, control, and monitoring functions with both local and
remote human interfaces. They also display the present trip/alarm conditions, and most of
the more than 35 measured system parameters. Recording of past trip, alarm or control
events, maximum demand levels, and energy consumption is also performed.
These relays contain many innovative features. To meet diverse utility standards and
industry requirements, these features have the flexibility to be programmed to meet
specific user needs. This flexibility will naturally make a piece of equipment difficult to
learn. To aid new users in getting basic protection operating quickly, setpoints are set to
typical default values and advanced features are disabled. These settings can be
reprogrammed at any time.
Programming can be accomplished with the front panel keys and display. Due to the
numerous settings, this manual method can be somewhat laborious. To simplify
programming and provide a more intuitive interface, setpoints can be entered with a PC
running the EnerVista 8 Setup software provided with the relay. Even with minimal
computer knowledge, this menu-driven software provides easy access to all front panel
functions. Actual values and setpoints can be displayed, altered, stored, and printed. If
settings are stored in a setpoint file, they can be downloaded at any time to the front panel
program port of the relay via a computer cable connected to the USB port of any personal
computer.
A summary of the available functions and a single-line diagram of protection and control
features is shown below. For a complete understanding of each feature operation, refer to
Chapter 4: About Setpoints, and to the detailed feature descriptions in the Chapters that
follow. The logic diagrams include a reference to every setpoint related to a feature and
show all logic signals passed between individual features. Information related to the
selection of settings for each setpoint is also provided.
Winding 3
Winding 1 3
Winding 2
3 3
LIGHT
3VTs T.C.
AFP OLTC
Failure
50_2 67G-1 67G-2 50BF-2 50BF-3
55 50N-1 50N-2
67P
3V_0
67N
32 Amps Amps
Amps
Harmonics Calculate
3I_0
Calculate
3I_0
Amps Amps
Harmonic
50/87 Restraint
Block
87T
Metering
Transient Recorder
Event Recorder
Fault Report
Data Logger
RTD input
59_2 59N 59P 24 27P 81U 81O 81R 27X 59X VTFF 25
Description
Fault Report
FlexElements
FlexLogic Equations
Flex States
IEC 61850 Communications
Metering: current, voltage, power, PF, energy, frequency, harmonics, THD
Modbus User Map
Non-volatile Latches
OPC-UA Communications
Output Relays
Setpoint Groups (6)
Transformer Dissolved Gas Analysis
Transformer Energization Reports
Transformer Integrated Fault Report
Transformer Overload
Transformer Loss of Life
Trip Bus (6)
Transient Recorder (Oscillography)
Trip and Close Coil Monitoring
User-programmable LEDs
User-programmable Pushbuttons
Virtual Inputs (32)
Virtual Outputs (32)
Targets
Status Summary
Breakers
Switches Setpoints Device
Last Trip Data
System
Arc Flash
Contact Inputs Inputs
Output Relays
Outputs
Virtual Inputs
Protection
Virtual Outputs
Flex States Monitoring
Communications
Control
Information
Device Status FlexLogic
Clock Testing
PTP Status
Metering Summary
Transformer
Currents Records Events
Voltages Transients
Frequency
Fault Reports
Volts per Hertz
Data Logger
Harmonic Magnitude
Harmonics Breakers
Arc Flash
RTDs
RTD Maximums
Analog Inputs
FlexElements
Security Overview
The following security features are available:
BASIC SECURITY
The basic security feature is present in the default offering of the 845 relay. The
845 introduces the notion of roles for different levels of authority. Roles are used as login
names with associated passwords stored on the device. The following roles are available
at present: Administrator, Operator, Factory and Observer, with a fixed permission
structure for each one. Note that the Factory role is not available for users, but strictly used
in the manufacturing process.
The 845 can still use the Setpoint access switch feature, but enabling the feature can be
done only by an Administrator. Setpoint access is controlled by a keyed switch to offer
some minimal notion of security.
CYBERSENTRY
The CyberSentry Embedded Security feature is a software option that provides advanced
security services. When the software option is purchased, the Basic Security is
automatically disabled.
CyberSentry provides security through the following features:
• An Authentication, Authorization, Accounting (AAA) Remote Authentication Dial-In
User Service (RADIUS) client that is centrally managed, enables user attribution, and
uses secure standards based strong cryptography for authentication and credential
protection.
• A Role-Based Access Control (RBAC) system that provides a permission model that
allows access to 845 device operations and configurations based on specific roles
and individual user accounts configured on the AAA server. At present the defined
roles are: Administrator, Operator and Observer.
• Strong encryption of all access and configuration network messages between the
EnerVista software and 845 devices using the Secure Shell (SSH) protocol, the
Advanced Encryption Standard (AES), and 128-bit keys in Galois Counter Mode (GCM)
as specified in the U.S. National Security Agency Suite B extension for SSH and
approved by the National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) FIPS-140-2
standards for cryptographic systems.
• Security event reporting through the Syslog protocol for supporting Security
Information Event Management (SIEM) systems for centralized cyber security
monitoring.
There are two types of authentication supported by CyberSentry that can be used to
access the 845 device:
• Device Authentication – in which case the authentication is performed on the
845 device itself, using the predefined roles as users (No RADIUS involvement).
– 845 authentication using local roles may be done either from the front panel or
through EnerVista.
• Server Authentication - in which case the authentication is done on a RADIUS server,
using individual user accounts defined on the server. When the user accounts are
created, they are assigned to one of the predefined roles recognized by the 845
– 845 authentication using RADIUS server may be done only through EnerVista.
WiFi and USB do not currently support CyberSentry security. For this reason WiFi is
FASTPATH:
disabled by default if the CyberSentry option is purchased. WiFi can be enabled, but be
aware that doing so violates the security and compliance model that CyberSentry is
supposed to provide.
With the CyberSentry security option, many communication settings cannot be changed
FASTPATH:
remotely. All communication settings can still be changed through the relay front panel.
When both 845 device and server authentication are enabled, the 845 automatically
directs authentication requests to the 845 device or the respective RADIUS server, based
on user names. If the user ID credential does not match one of the device local accounts,
the 845 automatically forwards the request to a RADIUS server when one is provided. If a
RADIUS server is provided, but is unreachable over the network, server authentication
requests are denied. In this situation, use local 845 device accounts to gain access to the
845 system.
USER ROLES
User Access Levels are used to grant varying permissions to specific user roles. User roles
are used by both Basic Security and CyberSentry.
The following user roles are supported:
• Administrator: The Administrator role has complete read and write access to all
settings and commands. The role does not allow concurrent access. The Administrator
role also has an operand to indicate when it is logged on.
• Operator: The Operator role is present to facilitate operational actions that may be
programmed and assigned to buttons on the front panel. The Operator has read/write
access to all settings under the command menu/section. The Operator can also use
the Virtual Input command under the control menu/section. The Operator can view
settings from EnerVista or the front panel but does not have the ability to change any
settings. This role is not a concurrent role.
• Observer: The Observer role has read-only access to all 845 settings. This role allows
concurrent access. The Observer is the default role if no authentication has been done
to the device. This role can download settings files and records from the device.
• Factory: This is an internal non-user accessible role used for manufacturing
diagnostics. The ability to enable or disable this role is a security setting that the
Administrator controls.
GENERAL RULES FOR USER ROLES WITH CYBERSENTRY
1. The only concurrent role is Observer. If the user is logged in through serial, front panel,
or over the network, that counts as the role being logged in for concurrency reasons.
2. Both EnerVista and the front panel provide a one-step logoff. For the front panel, the
root menu has a logoff command. From EnerVista right-clicking on a device and
providing a logoff function from the context menu is sufficient.
3. The EnerVista Login Screen has “User Name:” and “Password:” fields for the default
remote (Radius) authentication, but when a “Local Authentication” checkbox is
selected the “User Name:” field changes to a drop down menu where the user can
select one of the predefined roles on the 845.
dependent. Each 8 Series unit is ordered with a number of required and optional modules.
NOTE Each of these modules can be supplied in a number of configurations specified at the time
of ordering.
² (
1 7UDQVIRUPHU3URWHFWLRQ6\VWHP
$SSOLFDWLRQ ( _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG
3 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHFXUUHQWLQSXWV-YROWDJH-
3KDVH&XUUHQWV³6ORW-
3 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHFXUUHQWLQSXWV-YROWDJH-
+ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.WZRZLQGLQJVZLWKYROWDJH
3KDVH&XUUHQWV³6ORW.
+ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.WZRZLQGLQJVZLWKYROWDJH
5 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.$WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.WKUHHZLQGLQJVZLWKYROWDJH
5 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.$WKUHHSKDVHLQSXWV.WKUHHZLQGLQJVZLWKYROWDJH
*URXQG&XUUHQWV * _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $JURXQGLQSXWSHUSKDVHFXUUHQWEDQN
* _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $JURXQGLQSXWVSHUSKDVHFXUUHQWEDQN
4 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $JURXQGLQSXW-$JURXQGLQSXW.
3RZHU6XSSO\ + _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ WR9'&WR9$&
5 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ WR9'&WR9$&([WHQGHG5LGHWKURXJK
/ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ WR9'&
1 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 1RQH
6ORW%
5 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ;57'63W1L1L
6 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ;57'63W1L1L&X
1 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 1RQH
6ORW& 5 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ;57'63W1L1L
6 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ;57'63W1L1L&X
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ )RUP$9PRQ5HOD\V)RUP&5HOD\V&ULWLFDO)DLOXUH5HOD\
6ORW) $ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([W6XSSO\
0 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 665+LJK6SHHG+LJK%UHDN&ULWLFDO)DLOXUH5HOD\'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([WVXSSO\
1 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 1RQH
6ORW*
$ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ )RUP$9PRQ5HOD\V)RUP&5HOD\V'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([W6XSSO\
/ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 'FP$23'FP$,357'2KPV,QSXW
0 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 665+LJK6SHHG+LJK%UHDN)RUP&5HOD\'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([WVXSSO\
1 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 1RQH
6ORW+
$ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ )RUP$5HOD\V)RUP&5HOD\V'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([WVXSSO\
) _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 'LJLWDO,QSXWV$UF)ODVK,QSXWV
0 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 665+LJK6SHHG+LJK%UHDN)RUP&5HOD\'LJLWDO,QSXWV,QW([WVXSSO\
)DFHSODWH 0 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ %DVLF0HPEUDQH.H\SDGZLWK3XVKEXWWRQV
* _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG5XJJHG.H\SDGZLWK3XVKEXWWRQV
$ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG0HPEUDQH.H\SDGZLWK3XVKEXWWRQV
6 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ %DVLF731*31*7UDQVIRUPHU2YHUORDG
&XUUHQW3URWHFWLRQ
0 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG%DVLFBB5*)
$ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG6WDQGDUG3*1
9ROWDJH0RQLWRULQJDQG3URWHFWLRQ 6 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG3;31;28
3 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG6WDQGDUGB5
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG6HWSRLQW*URXS&RQWURO9LUWXDO,QSXWV7ULS%XV3VHXGR9ROWDJH%UHDNHU&RQWURO
&RQWURO ) _ _ _ _ _ _ _ )OH[/RJLF%)97))
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG+0,6WDQGDUG7DE3XVKEXWWRQV$QQXQFLDWRU3DQHO&RQILJXUDEOH6/'VZLWK
7 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ %D\&RQWURO
0RQLWRULQJ % _ _ _ _ _ _ %DVLF%UHDNHUV&RLO0RQLWRULQJ%UHDNHU$UFLQJ+DUPRQLFV7+''HPDQG7ULS&RXQWHUV
_ _ _ _ _ _ +DUPRQLF'HUDWLQJ)DFWRU
_ _ _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG%DVLF%UHDNHU+HDOWK+HDOWK5HSRUW7KHUPDO(OHPHQWV7DS&KDQJHU/HDUQHG
& _ _ _ _ _ _ 'DWD(QHUJL]DWLRQDQG+LVWRULFDO0D[5HFRUG
$ _ _ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG6WDQGDUG+DUPRQLF'HWHFWLRQ
0 _ _ _ _ _ _ 0 '6WDQGDUG'LVVROYHG*DV$QDO\VLV,QWHJUDWHG)DXOW5HSRUW
&RPPXQLFDWLRQV _ _ _ _ 6WDQGDUG)URQW86%[5HDU560RGEXV578'13,(&[(WKHUQHW
6 ( _ _ _ _ 0RGEXV7&3'13
_ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG)URQW86%[5HDU56[(WKHUQHW)LEHU0RGEXV5787&3'13
( _ _ _ _ ,(& 617323&8$
3 _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG353
$ _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG([WHQGHG,(&
( _ _ _ _ $GYDQFHG353([WHQGHG,(&
$GYDQFHG&RPPXQLFDWLRQV&RQQHFWRU 1 _ _ _ 1RQH
6 _ _ _ 670XOWLPRGHQP
& _ _ _ 5-&RSSHU0
:LUHOHVV&RPPXQLFDWLRQ 1 _ _ 1RQH
: _ _ :L)L
6HFXULW\ % _ %DVLF
$ _ $GYDQFHG&\EHU6HQWU\/HYHO
)XWXUH2SWLRQ 1 1RW$YDLODEOH
&RPPXQLFDWLRQVRSWLRQV$DQG(KDYHEHHQGLVFRQWLQXHG
&$3')
Advanced security is only available with advanced communications (1E, 1P, 3A, 3E). When
the advanced communications option is selected, the Ethernet port on the main CPU is
disabled.
RMIO1 – * G G * *
Power Supply L | | | | 24 - 48 V DC
H | | | | 110 - 250 V DC / 110 - 230 V AC
I/O Module 1 G | | | Remote Module I/O (3 - 100 Ohm Platinum RTDs)
I/O Module 2 G | | Remote Module I/O (3 - 100 Ohm Platinum RTDs)
I/O Module 32 G | Remote Module I/O (3 - 100 Ohm Platinum RTDs)
X | None
I/O Module 4 G Remote Module I/O (3 - 100 Ohm Platinum RTDs)
X None
1. RMIO requires firmware version 2.00 and later and hardware version B. Check the hardware
version under Status > Information > Main CPU. If RMIO support is required for relays with earlier
hardware versions, contact the factory.
2. RMIO comes standard with 6 RTDs (Modules 1 and 2).
892800RMIO-A1.fm
Other Accessories
• 18J0-0030 8 Series Depth Reducing Collar - 1 3/8"
• 18J0-0029 8 Series Depth Reducing Collar - 3"
Specifications
To obtain the total operating time, i.e. from the presence of a trip condition to initiation of a
trip, add 8 ms output relay time to the operate times listed below.
Device
ANNUNCIATOR PANEL
Number of Elements: ........................................1 (36 indicators)
Layout: .....................................................................Grid of 2x2 or 3x3
Data Storage:........................................................Non-volatile memory
Mode:........................................................................Self-reset, latched, acknowledgeable
Display Text: ..........................................................3 lines of 15 characters maximum
Visual Indication:.................................................Flashing: 2Hz @ 50% duty cycle
CUSTOM CONFIGURATIONS
Config Mode: .........................................................Simplified, Regular
Protection
ARC FLASH HS PHASE/GROUND INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT HS 50P/50G
Current:....................................................................Phasor Magnitude (special high speed algorithm)
Pickup Level:..........................................................0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Dropout Level: ......................................................97 to 98% of Pickup
Level Accuracy:....................................................For 0.1 to 0.2 x CT: ± 0.2% of reading or 1.5% of rated,
whichever is greaterFor > 0.2 x CT: ± 1.5% of reading
Operate Time: .......................................................4 ms at >6 x Pickup at 60 Hz5 ms at >6 x Pickup at 50 Hz4-8
ms at > (3-6) x Pickup at 60 Hz4-10 ms at > (3-6) x Pickup at
50 Hz
TRANSFOMER PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL PROTECTION
Differential/Restraint Characteristic:.........Dual Slope, Dual Breakpoint
Minimum Pickup level:......................................0.05 to 1.00 x CT in steps of 0.01
Slope 1 range:.......................................................1 to 100% in steps of 1%
Slope 2 range:.......................................................1 to 100% in steps of 1%
Breakpoint 1:.........................................................0.50 to 2.00 x CT in steps of 0.01
Breakpoint 2:.........................................................2.00 to 30.00 x CT in steps of 0.01
2nd harmonic inhibit level: ..............................0.1 to 40.0% in steps of 0.1%
2nd harmonic inhibit mode:............................Per-phase, Average, 2-out-of-3, 1-out-of-3
5th harmonic inhibit level: ...............................1.0 to 40.0% in steps of 0.1%
Dropout level:........................................................97 to 98% of Pickup
Operate time:........................................................< 16/22 ms at >3 x Pickup @60Hz (harmonic inhibits
disabled/enabled)< 18/26 ms at >3 x Pickup @50Hz
(harmonic inhibits disabled/enabled)
Level accuracy: ....................................................± 0.5% of reading current, or ±1% of rated
TRANSFORMER OVERLOAD
Operating Parameter:.......................................Winding 1, 2, 3 loads
Pickup level:...........................................................50 to 300% in steps of 1%
Dropout level:........................................................97 to 98% of Pickup
Level Accuracy:....................................................Per current input
Operate time:........................................................<25 ms at >3 x Pickup at 60 Hz,<30 ms at >3 x Pickup at 50
Hz
Timer Accuracy:...................................................±3% of delay setting or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
Add 1.5 cycles to the curve time to obtain the TOC operating time, i.e., from fault inception
FASTPATH:
until operation.
Add 1.5 cycles to the curve time to obtain the TOC operating time, i.e., from fault inception
NOTE:
until operation.
NOTE
PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50P/N/G)
Current (for Phase IOC only): ......................... Phasor or RMS
Current (for Neutral/Ground IOC only):..... Fundamental Phasor Magnitude
Pickup Level: ......................................................... 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Dropout Level:...................................................... 97 to 98% of Pickup
Level Accuracy:.................................................... For 0.1 to 2.0 x CT: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated,
whichever is greater, for > 2.0 x CT: ±1.5% of reading. (For
Neutral IOC, Iop = 3 * (|I_0| - K * |I_1|)where K = 1/16 and |I_0|
= 1/3 * |In|))
Operate Time:....................................................... <12 ms typical at 3 × Pickup at 60 Hz (Phase/Ground IOC) <16
ms typical at 3 × Pickup at 60 Hz (Neutral IOC)<15 ms typical
at 3 × Pickup at 50 Hz (Phase/Ground IOC)<20 ms typical at 3
× Pickup at 50 Hz (Neutral IOC)
Operating time specifications given above are applicable when RMS inputs are used.
NOTE:
Typical times are average operate times over multiple test cases.
NOTE
Timer Accuracy:...................................................±3% of delay setting or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
NEGATIVE SEQUENCE INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT (50_2)
Current:....................................................................I_2 Fundamental Phasor Magnitude
Pickup Level:..........................................................0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Dropout Level: ......................................................97 to 98% of Pickup
Level Accuracy:....................................................For 0.1 to 2.0 x CT: ±0.5% of reading or ± 0.4% of rated,
whichever is greater, for > 2.0 x CT: ± 1.5% of reading. (For lop
= |I_2| - K * |I_1| where K = 1/8 and|I_1| = 1/
3*|Ia+Ib*(1?120º)+Ic*(1?240 º)|)
Pickup Time Delay: .............................................0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Dropout Time Delay:..........................................0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Overreach:..............................................................< 2%
Operate Time: .......................................................< 12 ms typical at 3 x Pickup at 60 Hz< 15 ms typical at 3 x
Pickup at 50 Hz
Timer Accuracy:...................................................±3% of delay setting or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
PHASE DIRECTIONALOVERCURRENT (67P)
Relay Connection:...............................................90º(Quadrature)
Quadrature Voltage:..........................................ABC phase seq.: phase A (Vbc), phase B (Vca), phase C (Vab);
ACB phase seq.: phase A (Vcb), phase B (Vac), phase C (Vba)
Polarizing Voltage Threshold:........................0.050 to 3.000 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Current Sensitivity Threshold: .......................0.05 x CT
Characteristic Angle: .........................................0º to 359º in steps of 1°
Angle Accuracy:...................................................± 2º
Operation Time (FlexLogic™ operands):...Reverse to Forward transition: < 12 ms, typically;Forward to
Reverse transition:<8 ms, typically
NEUTRAL DIRECTIONALOVERCURRENT (67N)
Directionality:........................................................Co-existing forward and reverse
Polarizing: ...............................................................Voltage, Current, Dual
Polarizing Voltage:..............................................V_0 or VX
Polarizing Current:..............................................Ig
Operating Current: .............................................I_0
Level Sensing: .......................................................3 x (|I_0| – K x |I_1|), Ig
Restraint, K:............................................................0.000 to 0.500 in steps of 0.001
Characteristic Angle: .........................................-90º to 90º in steps of 1°
Limit Angle: ............................................................40º to 90º in steps of 1°, independent for forward and
reverse
Angle Accuracy:...................................................±2º (both voltage and current (1A/5A only)
polarizing signals)
Pickup Level:..........................................................0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Dropout Level: ......................................................97 to 98% of Pickup
Operate Time (no direction transition): .....< 16 ms at 3 x Pickup at 60 Hz< 20 ms at 3 x Pickup at 50 Hz
Typical times are average Operate Times including variables such as frequency change
FASTPATH:
OVERFREQUENCY (81O)
Pickup Level: ......................................................... 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Dropout Level:...................................................... Pickup - 0.03 Hz
Pickup Time Delay:............................................. 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Dropout Time Delay: ......................................... 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Minimum Operating Voltage:........................ 0.000 to 1.250 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Level Accuracy:.................................................... ± 0.01 Hz
Timer Accuracy:................................................... ± 3% of delay setting or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
Operate Time:....................................................... typically 7.5 cycles at 0.1 Hz/s changetypically 7 cycles at 0.3
Hz/s changetypically 6.5 cycles at 0.5 Hz/s change
Typical times are average Operate Times including variables such as frequency change
FASTPATH:
Control
BREAKER CONTROL
Operation:...............................................................Asserted FlexLogic Operands
Function: .................................................................Opens/closes, blocks, bypasses blocks to the feeder breaker
BREAKER FAILURE
Mode:........................................................................ 3-pole
Current Supervision:.......................................... phase and neutral current (fundamental phasor magnitude)
Current Supervision Pickup:........................... 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Current Supervision Dropout: ....................... 97 to 98% of pickup
Current Supervision Accuracy:..................... For 0.1 to 2.0 x CT: ± 0.5% of reading or ± 0.4% of rated
(whichever is greater)
For > 2.0 x CT: ± 1.5% of reading
Time Delay: ............................................................ 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Timer Accuracy:................................................... ± 3% of delay setting or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
Reset Time: ............................................................ 19 to 30 ms at 1.5 to 20 x Pickup
LOCAL CONTROL MODE
Number of Elements: ........................................ 1
Select Before Operate Mode: ........................ Disabled, Enabled
Mode:........................................................................ Local Mode ON, Local Mode OFF
Display Status: .....................................................LM (local mode) displayed in banner
Tagging: .................................................................. Disabled, Enabled
SWITCH CONTROL
Operation: .............................................................. Local (PB control and SLD) and Remote (asserted FlexLogic
operands)
Function:................................................................. Opens/Closes the disconnect switch
Timers: ..................................................................... 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
SYNCHROCHECK (25)
Maximum Frequency Difference:................ 0.01 to 5.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz for frequency window of
fnom ± 5 Hz
Maximum Angle Difference: .......................... 1° to 100° in steps of 1°
Maximum Voltage Difference:...................... 10 to 600000 V in steps of 1 V
Hysteresis for Maximum Frequency
Difference: ........................................................ 0.01 to 0.10 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Breaker Closing Time:....................................... 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Dead Source Function:..................................... None, LB & DL, DB & LL, DB & DL, DB OR DL, DB XOR DL
Dead/Live Levels for Bus and Line: ............ 0.00 to 1.50 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
TRIP BUS
Number of Elements: ........................................ 6
Number of Inputs: .............................................. 16
Pickup Time Delay:............................................. 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Dropout Time Delay: ......................................... 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Operate Time:....................................................... < 2 ms at 60 Hz
Timer Accuracy:................................................... ± 3% of delay time or ± ¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
Monitoring
HARMONIC DERATING
Timer Accuracy:................................................... ±3% of delay setting or ±3 cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR (TCM)
Applicable Voltage: ............................................ 20 to 250 VDC
Trickle Current:.....................................................1 to 2.5 mA
Timing Accuracy: ................................................ ± 3 % or ± 4 ms, whichever is greater
HARMONIC DETECTION
Operating Parameter: ...................................... Current 2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th harmonic or THD per phase
Timer Accuracy:................................................... Harmonics: ±3% of delay setting or ±1/4 cycle (whichever is
greater) from pickup to operateTHD: ±3% of delay setting or
±3 cycles (whichever is greater) from pickup to operate
Recording
TRANSIENT RECORDER
Default AC Channels: ........................................ 12 currents + 4 voltages
Configurable Channels: ................................... 16 analog and 64 digital channels
Sampling Rate:.....................................................128/c, 64/c, 32/c, 16/c, 8/c
Trigger Source:.....................................................Any element pickup, dropout or operate, digital input or
output change of state, FlexLogic operand
Trigger Position:................................................... 0 to 100%
Storage Capability:............................................. Non-volatile memory
EVENT DATA
Number of Records: .......................................... 1024 (matches the existing Event Recorder)
Data Storage: ....................................................... Non-volatile memory
Time-tag Accuracy: ........................................... One microsecond
Settings: .................................................................. 64 Configurable FlexAnalog parameters,Event Selector
Actuals:.................................................................... Selected Event Number,Timestamp of Selected Event,Cause
of Selected Event,64 Configurable FlexAnalog values
Commands:........................................................... None (using existing Clear Event Recorder)
DATA LOGGER
Data Logger channels:..................................... 16
Data Logger Rate: .............................................. 1 cycle, 1 sec., 30 sec., 1 min., 15 min., 30 min., 1 hour,
6 hours, 8 hours, 12 hours, 24 hours
Inputs: ...................................................................... Any analog parameter from the list of available analog
parameters
Data Collection Mode: ...................................... Continuous, Triggered
Trigger Source:.....................................................Any digital flag from the list of digital flags
Trigger Position:................................................... 0 to 50% in steps of 1%
Channel 1(16) Mode:.......................................... Sample, Min, Max, Mean
EVENT RECORDER
Number of events:.............................................. 1024
Header:.................................................................... relay name, order code, firmware revision
Content:................................................................... any element pickup, any element operate, digital input
change of state, digital output change of state, self-test
events
Data Storage: ....................................................... non-volatile memory
Time-tag Accuracy: ........................................... to one microsecond
LAST TRIP DATA
Number of Records: .......................................... 1
Data Storage: ....................................................... Non-volatile memory
Time-tag Accuracy: ........................................... One microsecond
Actuals:.................................................................... Event Number of Last Trip,Timestamp of Last Trip,Cause of
Last Trip,64 Configurable FlexAnalog values
Commands:........................................................... Clear Last Trip Data
User-Programmable Elements
FLEXLOGIC
Lines of code:........................................................1024
Supported operations:......................................NOT, XOR, OR (2 to 16 inputs), AND (2 to 16 inputs), NOR (2 to
16 inputs), NAND (2 to 16 inputs), latch (reset-dominant),
edge detectors, timers
Inputs:.......................................................................any logical variable, contact, or virtual input
Number of timers:...............................................32
Pickup delay: .........................................................0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1
Dropout delay:......................................................0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1
Timer accuracy: ................................................... ±3% of delay setting or ±¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
FLEXELEMENTS
Number of elements: ........................................8
Operating signal:.................................................Any analog actual value, or two values in a differential mode
Operating signal mode: ...................................Signed, or Absolute value
Operating mode: .................................................Level, Delta
Comparison direction: ......................................Over, Under
Operate time:........................................................FlexElements are processed once per cycle(16 ms at 60 Hz,
20 ms at 50 Hz)
Pickup Level:..........................................................-30.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 pu
Hysteresis:..............................................................0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1%
Delta dt: ...................................................................40 msec to 45 days
Pickup and dropout delays: ...........................0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
FLEXSTATES
Number of States:...............................................256 logical variables grouped under 16 Modbus addresses
Programmability: ................................................Any FlexLogic operand, any digital input, any virtual input,
any remote input
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Type:..........................................................................Set-dominant or Reset-dominant
Range: ......................................................................16 individually programmed
Output: .....................................................................Stored in non-volatile memory
Execution sequence: .........................................As input prior to protection, control and FlexLogic
FLEXCURVES
Number: ..................................................................4 (A, B, C, D)
Reset points:..........................................................40 (0.00 to 0.98 x pickup)
Operate points: ....................................................80 (1.03 to 20.0 x pickup)
Time delay:.............................................................0 to 200,000,000 ms in steps of 1 ms
Saturation level:...................................................20 times the pickup level
TAB PUSHBUTTONS
Number of elements: ........................................1 (20 Tab Pushbuttons)
Data Storage:........................................................Non-volatile memory
Mode:........................................................................Self-reset, latched
Display Message: ................................................2 lines; 15 characters per line
Dropout Timer: .....................................................0.000 to 60.000 s in steps of 0.005
Auto-reset Timer: ................................................0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1
Hold Timer:.............................................................0.1 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1
Timer Accuracy:...................................................±3% of delay setting or ±¼ cycle (whichever is greater) from
pickup to operate
USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
Number: ..................................................................17 (14 + 3 PB LEDS) for Membrane and Rugged Front Panels
Programmability: ................................................any logic variable, contact, or virtual input
Reset mode:...........................................................self-reset or latched
USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS
Number of pushbuttons:................................. 3 (Membrane and Rugged Front Panels)
Mode:........................................................................ Self-reset, latched
Display message:................................................ 2 lines of 13 characters on each line
Dropout timer:...................................................... 0.000 to 60.000 s in steps of 0.005
Auto-reset timer:................................................. 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1
Hold timer: ............................................................. 0.0 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1
Metering
RMS PARAMETERS
Currents
Parameters:........................................................... Phase A, B, C, Neutral, Ground
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 0.25% of reading or ± 0.2% of rated (whichever is greater)
from 0.1 to 2.0 x CT± 1% of reading > 2.0 x CT
Voltages
Parameters:........................................................... Wye VTs: A-n, B-n, C-n, A-B, B-C, C-A, Average Phase, Neutral
and ResidualDelta VTs: A-B, B-C, C-A, Neutral and Residual
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 0.5% of reading from 15 to 208 V± 2% for open Delta
connections
Real Power (Watts)
Range:...................................................................... -214748364.8 kW to 214748364.7 kW
Parameters:........................................................... Wye VTs: 3-phase and per phaseDelta VTs: 3-phase only
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 1.0% of reading or 0.2 kW (whichever is greater) at -0.8 <
PF ≤ -1.0 and 0.8 < PF < 1.0
Reactive Power (Vars)
Range:...................................................................... -214748364.8 kvar to 214748364.7 kvar
Parameters:........................................................... Wye VTs: 3-phase and per phaseDelta VTs: 3-phase only
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 1.0% of reading or 0.2 kvar (whichever is greater) at -0.2 <
PF ≤ 0.2
Apparent Power (VA)
Range:...................................................................... 0 kVA to 214748364.7 kVA
Parameters:........................................................... Wye VTs: 3-phase and per phaseDelta VTs: 3-phase only
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 1.0% of reading or 0.2 kVA (whichever is greater)
Power Factor
Parameters:........................................................... 3-phase; per phase if VT is Wye
Range:...................................................................... 0.01 Lag to 1.00 to 0.01 Lead
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 0.02 for 50 Hz and 60 Hz; ± 0.05 for 25 Hz
Watt-hours (positive and negative)
Range:...................................................................... 0.000 MWh to 4294967.295 MWh
Parameters:........................................................... 3-phase only
Update Rate:......................................................... 50 ms
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 2.0% of reading
Var-hours (positive and negative)
Range:...................................................................... 0.000 Mvarh to 4294967.295 Mvarh
Parameters:........................................................... 3-phase only
Update Rate:......................................................... 50 ms
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 2.0% of reading
PHASORS
Current
Parameters:........................................................... Phase A, B, C, Neutral and Ground
Magnitude Accuracy:........................................ ± 0.5% of reading or ± 0.2% of rated (whichever is greater)
from 0.1 to 2.0 x CT± 1.0% of reading > 2.0 x CT
Angle Accuracy:................................................... 2° (3° for 25 Hz)
Voltages
Parameters: ...........................................................Wye VTs: A-n, B-n, C-n, A-B, B-C, C-A, Average Phase, Neutral
and Residual;Delta VTs: A-B, B-C, C-A, Neutral and Residual
Magnitude Accuracy: ........................................± 0.5% of reading from 15 to 208 V;± 1% for open Delta
connections;± 10% for 25 Hz with 150 V <V < 208V
Angle Accuracy:...................................................0.5° (15 V <V < 208 V)
FREQUENCY
Range: ......................................................................2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Accuracy at:...........................................................V = 15 to 208 V: ± 0.01 Hz (input frequency 15 to 70 Hz);I = 0.1
to 0.4 x CT: ± 0.020 Hz (input frequency 15 to 70 Hz);I > 0.4 x
CT: ± 0.01 Hz (input frequency 15 to 70 Hz)
CURRENT AND VOLTAGE HARMONICS
Parameters: ...........................................................Magnitude of each harmonic and THD
Range: ......................................................................2nd to 25th harmonic: per-phase displayed as % of f1
fundamental frequency THD: per-phase displayed as % of f1
DEMAND
Measured Values: ...............................................Phase A/B/C present and maximum current, three-phase
present, maximum real/reactive/apparent power, minimum
real/reactive/apparent power
Measurement Type:...........................................Thermal Exponential, 90% response time (programmed): 5,
10, 15, 20, 30 minutesBlock Interval / Rolling Demand, time
interval (programmed): 5, 10, 15, 20, 30 minutes
Current Pickup Level: ........................................10 to 10000 in steps of 1 A
Dropout Level: ......................................................96-98% of Pickup level
Level Accuracy:....................................................± 2%
NOTE:
Inputs
AC CURRENTS
CT Rated Primary: ...............................................1 to 12000 A
CT Rated Secondary: .........................................1 A or 5 A based on relay ordering
Burden: ....................................................................< 0.2 VA at rated secondary
Short Term CT Withstand:...............................1 second at 100 x rated current 2 seconds at 40 x rated
currentcontinuous at 3 x rated current
AC VOLTAGE
VT Range:................................................................10 to 260 V
Nominal Frequency: ..........................................20 to 65 Hz
Burden: ....................................................................<0.25 VA at 120 V
Conversion Range: .............................................1 to 275 V
Voltage Withstand: ............................................continuous at 260 V to neutral1 min/hr at 420 V to neutral
ANALOG INPUTS
Current Input (mA DC): ..................................... 0 to 1mA, 0 to 5mA, 0 to 10mA, 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA
(configurable)
Input Impedance: ............................................... 375 Ω ± 10%
Conversion range: .............................................. 0 to +21 mA DC
Accuracy:................................................................ ± 1% of full scale,
Type: ......................................................................... Passive
Sampling Interval: .............................................. Typically 500 ms
Cable: ....................................................................... Twisted-pair shielded cable
FREQUENCY
Nominal frequency setting: ........................... 50 Hz, 60 Hz
Sampling frequency:......................................... 64 samples per power cycle128 samples per power cycle
(available for transient recorder
Tracking frequency range:............................. 3 to 72 Hz
ARC FLASH SENSOR/FIBER
Number of Point Sensors:............................... 4
Detection Radius:................................................ 180 degree
Maximum Fiber Length (Point Sensor):..... 18 ft
Fiber Size: ............................................................... 1000 um
Mode:........................................................................ Multi-mode
Connector: ............................................................. Small Media Interface (SMI)
Fiber Type:.............................................................. Plastic Optical Fiber
Bend Radius: ......................................................... >25 mm
CONTACT INPUTS
Number of Inputs: .............................................. Based on relay order code
Type: ......................................................................... Wet or Dry
Wet Contacts:....................................................... 300 V DC maximum
Selectable thresholds: ...................................... Programmable: 17 VDC (For 24 VDC Operating Voltage) 33
VDC (For 48 VDC and 60VDC Operating Voltage) 84 VDC (For
110 VDC and 125 VDC Operating Voltage)166 VDC (For 220
VDC and 250 VDC Operating Voltage)
Tolerance:............................................................... 17VDC: Vlow(off)<10V, Vhigh(on)>19V 33VDC: Vlow(off)<23V,
Vhigh(on)>38V 84VDC: Vlow(off)<70V, Vhigh(on)>88V166VDC:
Vlow(off)<140V, Vhigh(on)>176V
Recognition time:................................................ 1 ms (typical)
Debounce time: ................................................... 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5 ms
Continuous current draw (burden):............ 2 mA
CLOCK
Setup: ....................................................................... Date and Time, Daylight Saving Time, UTC (Coordinated
Universal Time)
Backup Retention: .............................................. 31 days
For relays with Hardware Revision A, Clock Backup Retention is 1 hour. Check the Hardware
FASTPATH:
IRIG-B INPUT
Auto-detect: .......................................................... DC and AM
Amplitude Modulation:..................................... 1 V to 10 V pk-to-pk
DC Shift:................................................................... TTL
Input Impedance: ............................................... 40 kΩ
Isolation: ................................................................. 2 kV
IRIG-B Format:...................................................... IEEE 1344-1995 (with control bits extension)
RTD INPUTS
Types (3-wire):.......................................................100 Ω Platinum, 120 Ω Nickel, 100 Ω Nickel, 10 Ω
Copper(RMIO only supports 100Ω Platinum)
Sensing current: ..................................................5 mA
Range: ......................................................................–40 to +250°C (-40 to +482°F)
Accuracy: ................................................................±2°C (±4°F)
Isolation:..................................................................36 V pk-pk (a group of RTDs to ground)2 kV from base unit
(RMIO only)
Lead Resistance: .................................................25 Ohms max. per lead for platinum or nickel and 3 Ohms
max. per lead for copper RTDs
RTD Inputs Available: ........................................6 RTD inputs with one module or 12 inputs with 2 modules
(IO cards R or S). 1 RTD input with IO card L.6 to 12 RTD inputs
with RMIO modules 1 through 4
Cable:........................................................................Three-wire shielded cable
OHMS INPUT
Type:..........................................................................Resistance (ohms)
Range: ......................................................................0 to 500 Ω or 0.5 to 5.1 kΩ
Bias current: ..........................................................1.9 mA through the full range
Accuracy: ................................................................± 1% (of full scale based on input range)
TAP CHANGER
Operating Parameter:.......................................BCD, ohms In 1, Analog Ip 1
Tap Changer Range:..........................................-19 to +39
Accuracy: ................................................................Per Input accuracy
Outputs
ANALOG OUTPUTS
Range (configurable): ........................................0 to 1mA, 0 to 5mA, 0 to 10mA, 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA
Max. load resistance: ........................................10 kΩ @ 1 mA,600Ω @ 20 mA
Accuracy: ................................................................± 1% of full scale
Isolation:..................................................................500V DC for one minute (functional isolation between analog
inputs and output group; and each group of chassis)
Driving Signal:.......................................................any Analog quantity
Sampling Interval:...............................................Typically 500 ms
Upper and lower limit
(for the driving signal):................................-90 to 90 pu in steps of 0.001
Cable:........................................................................Twisted-pair shielded cable
For order codes with a combined total of 2 or 3 type A and M I/O cards, the following
FASTPATH:
ratings are applied to meet UL508 requirements: 1 second on / 10 seconds off, 9% duty
cycle.
Power Supply
POWER SUPPLY (FOR H OPTION ONLY)
Nominal DC Voltage: .........................................125 to 250 V
Minimum DC Voltage: .......................................88 V
Maximum DC Voltage:......................................300 V
Nominal AC Voltage:..........................................100 to 240 V at 50/60 Hz
Minimum AC Voltage: .......................................88 V at 50 to 60 Hz
Maximum AC Voltage: ......................................265 V at 50 to 60 Hz
Typical Voltage loss ride through:...............50 ms duration
POWER SUPPLY (FOR L DC OPTION ONLY)
Nominal DC Voltage: .........................................24 V to 48 V
Minimum DC Voltage: .......................................20 V
Maximum DC Voltage:......................................60 V
POWER CONSUMPTION
Typical:..................................................................... 20 W / 40 VA
Maximum: .............................................................. 34 W / 70 VA
Communications
ETHERNET – BASE OFFERING (“SE” OPTION)
Modes: ..................................................................... 10/100 Mbps
One Port:................................................................. RJ45
Protocol:.................................................................. Modbus TCP, DNP
ETHERNET – CARD OPTION “C” - 2X COPPER (RJ45) PORTS
Modes: ..................................................................... 10/100 MB
Two Ports:............................................................... RJ45 (with this option both enabled ports are on the
communications card; the Ethernet port located on the base
CPU is disabled)
Protocols:................................................................ Modbus TCP, DNP3.0, IEC60870-5-104, IEC 61850 Ed.2,
IEC 61850 Ed.2 GOOSE, IEEE 1588 (PTP version 2), SNTP,
IEC 62439-3 clause 4 (PRP)
ETHERNET – CARD OPTION “S” - 2X ST FIBER PORTS
Fiber type: .............................................................. 100 MB Multi-mode
Two Ports:............................................................... ST (with this option both enabled ports are on the
communications card; the Ethernet port located on the base
CPU is disabled)
Protocols:................................................................ Modbus TCP, DNP3.0, IEC60870-5-104, IEC 61850 Ed.2,
IEC 61850 Ed.2 GOOSE, IEEE 1588 (PTP version 2), SNTP,
IEC 62439-3 clause 4 (PRP), OPC-UA
Wavelength:.......................................................... 1300nm
Typical link distance:......................................... 4 km
USB
Standard specification:.................................... Compliant with USB 2.0
Protocols:................................................................ Modbus TCP, TFTP
SERIAL
RS485 port: ............................................................ Isolated
Baud rates: ............................................................ Supports 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, and 115200 kbps
Response time: .................................................... 10 ms typical
Parity: ....................................................................... None, Odd, Even
Protocol:.................................................................. Modbus RTU, DNP 3.0, IEC 60870-5-103
Maximum distance:........................................... 1200 m (4000 feet)
Isolation: ................................................................. 2 kV
Cable: ....................................................................... Belden 9841 or similar 24 AWG stranded, shielded twisted-
pair
WIFI
Standard specification:.................................... IEEE802.11bgn
Range:...................................................................... 30 ft (direct line of sight)
REMOTE MODBUS DEVICE PROFILE
Device Name: ....................................................... BSG3 (13 alphanumeric characters maximum)
IP Address: ............................................................. 0.0.0.0 – standard Ethernet address
Slave Address:...................................................... 254 (1 to 254)
Modbus Port:......................................................... 502 (0 to 10000, default 502)
Poll Rate: ................................................................. 3 minute (OFF, 3 to 120 minutes), the continuous mode poll
interval is defined as the poll rate interval
Trigger:..................................................................... Off (any FlexLogic Operand), the trigger mode is based on
the FlexLogic operand designed to trigger the poll
CAN (RMIO)
Maximum Distance:...........................................250 m (820 ft)
Cable Type: ............................................................Shielded or unshielded twisted pair
Cable Gauge:.........................................................Belden 9841 or similar 24 AWG for distances up to 100m;22
AWG for distances up to 250 m.
APPROVALS
Physical
DIMENSIONS
Size: ........................................................................... Refer to Chapter 2
Weight: .................................................................... 9 kg [20.0 lbs]
Environmental
Ambient temperatures:
Storage/Shipping: -40°C to 85°C
Operating: -40°C to 60°C
Humidity: Operating up to 95% (non condensing) @ 55°C (As per
IEC60068-2-30 Variant 2, 6 days)
Altitude: 2000m (standard base reference evaluated altitude)
5000m (maximum achievable altitude)
Pollution Degree: II
Overvoltage Category: II
Ingress Protection: IP54 Front
Insulation Class: 1
Noise: 0 dB
injury.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious
IMPORTANT:
injury.
moderate injury.
Failure to shut equipment off prior to removing the power connections could expose
you to dangerous voltages causing injury or death.
Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of
shock and/or fire, for example from high voltage connected to low voltage terminals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type,
terminal torque settings, voltage, current magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/
clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are un-compromised for safety purposes during device
operation and service.
All recommended equipment that should be grounded and must have a reliable and
un-compromised grounding path for safety purposes, protection against
electromagnetic interference and proper device operation.
Equipment grounds should be bonded together and connected to the facility’s main
ground system for primary power.
In addition to the safety precautions mentioned all electrical connections made must
respect the applicable local jurisdiction electrical code.
It is recommended that a field external switch, circuit breaker be connected near the
equipment as a means of power disconnect. The external switch or circuit breaker is
selected in accordance with the power rating.
This product itself is not Personal Protective Equipment (PPE). However, it can be used
in the computation of site specific Arc Flash analysis when the arc flash option is
ordered. If a new appropriate Hazard Reduction Category code for the installation is
determined, user should follow the cautions mentioned in the arc flash installation
section.
The critical fail relay must be connected to annunciate the status of the device when
CAUTION:
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the AC current, and voltage input
match the ratings specified on the relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in
excess of the specified limits.
Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly
familiar with all safety cautions and warnings in this manual and with applicable
country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to
current transformers, voltage transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make
sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to attempting work on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current
transformers. Make sure that current transformer secondary circuits are shorted out
before making or removing any connection to the current transformer (CT) input
terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or
currents are connected to such equipment and that trip and close commands to the
circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are isolated, unless this is required by
the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers,
isolators, and other switching apparatus, all control circuits from the device to the
primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are working on or around this
primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class
CAUTION:
1M. Class 1M devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with
optical instruments.
To ensure the settings file inside the relay is updated, wait 30 seconds after a setpoint
FASTPATH:
This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation
FASTPATH:
Industrial environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.
Must-read Information
The following general statements apply and are repeated in the relevant sections of the
manual.
• WiFi and USB do not currently support CyberSentry security. For this reason WiFi is
FASTPATH:
disabled by default if the CyberSentry option is purchased. WiFi can be enabled, but be
aware that doing so violates the security and compliance model that CyberSentry is
supposed to provide.
• Before upgrading firmware, it is very important to save the current 845 settings to a
file on your PC. After the firmware has been upgraded, it is necessary to load this file
back into the 845.
• The SNTP, IRIG-B and PTP settings take effect after rebooting the relay.
• Commands may be issued freely through other protocols than Modbus (i.e., DNP, IEC
104, and, IEC 61850) without user authentication or encryption of data taking place,
even if the relay has the advanced security feature enabled.
• Note that the factory role password may not be changed.
• In 845 both DNP and IEC104 protocol can work at the same time, but consider that
there is only one point map. So, both protocols use the same configured points.
• The 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is
closed.
• The Phase Directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a
following reverse fault, the element needs some time – in the order of 8 ms – to
change the directional signal. Some protection elements such as Instantaneous
Overcurrent may respond to reverse faults before the directional signal has changed.
A coordination time of at least 10 ms must therefore be added to all the instantaneous
protection elements under the supervision of the Phase Directional element. If current
reversal is a concern, a longer delay – in the order of 20 ms – is needed.
• The same curves used for the time overcurrent elements are used for Neutral
Displacement. When using the curve to determine the operating time of the Neutral
Displacement element, substitute the ratio of neutral voltage to Pickup level for the
current ratio shown on the horizontal axis of the curve plot.
• If the 3-phase VT uses a delta connection and FREQUENCY INPUT is set to J2-3VT, the
positive sequence voltage is used as the supervision voltage. In such conditions, the
true supervision level is internally changed to 1/sqrt(3) of the user setting since the
base of VT here is the phase-phase voltage.
• To monitor the trip coil circuit integrity, use the relay terminals “FA_1 NO” and “FA_1
COM” to connect the Trip coil, and provide a jumper between terminals “FA_1 COM”
and “FA_1 OPT/V” voltage monitor).
• In Power factor monitoring, SWITCH-IN and SWITCH-OUT are mutually exclusive
settings.
• The relay is not approved as, or intended to be, a revenue metering instrument. If used
in a peak load control system, consider the accuracy rating and method of
measurement employed, and the source VTs and CTs, in comparison with the
electrical utility revenue metering system.
• In bulk oil circuit breakers, the interrupting time for currents is less than 25% of the
interrupting rating and can be significantly longer than the normal interrupting time.
• For future reference, make a printout of the conversion report immediately after the
conversion in case conversion reports are removed or settings modified from the 8
Series Setup Software.
Storage
Store the unit indoors in a cool, dry place. If possible, store in the original packaging. Follow
the storage temperature range outlined in the Specifications.
Use the factory-provided dust caps on all Arc Flash sensor fiber and connectors when not
in use, to avoid dust contamination in the transceiver and sensor plugs.
Repairs
The firmware and software can be upgraded without return of the device to the factory.
For issues not solved by troubleshooting, the process to return the device to the factory for
repair is as follows:
• Contact a GE Grid Solutions Technical Support Center. Contact information is found in
the first chapter.
• Obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) number from the Technical Support
Center.
• Verify that the RMA and Commercial Invoice received have the correct information.
• Tightly pack the unit in a box with bubble wrap, foam material, or styrofoam inserts or
packaging peanuts to cushion the item(s). You may also use double boxing whereby
you place the box in a larger box that contains at least 5 cm of cushioning material.
• Ship the unit by courier or freight forwarder, along with the Commercial Invoice and
RMA, to the factory.
• Customers are responsible for shipping costs to the factory, regardless of whether the
unit is under warranty.
• Fax a copy of the shipping information to the GE Grid Solutions service department.
Use the detailed return procedure outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/support/ret_proc.htm
The current warranty and return information are outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
Chapter 2: Installation
Installation
Mechanical Installation
This section describes the mechanical installation of the 845 system, including dimensions
for mounting and information on module withdrawal and insertion.
Product Identification
The product identification label is located on the side panel of the 845. This label indicates
the product model, serial number, and date of manufacture.
Figure 2-1: Product Label
g Multilin 85
7UDQVIRUPer Protection System
Model: 85-EP5NNG5HNNANNGSSBSNNNB
Serial Number: MJAXXXXXXX
Technical Support:
Worldwide: +1 905 927 7070
North America: 1 800 547 8629
www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/
650 Markland Street, Markham
ON, Canada L6C 0M1
!&%% MFG. Date: Mar. 11, 2016
E57838
POWER SUPPLY RATINGS:
~
Nominal: 100 to 240V 125 to 250V UL
~
Range: 88 to 265V (50/60Hz) 88 to 300V
Power Consumption: 20W Typ, 34W/70VA Max MADE IN
C R
LISTED
US
Dimensions
The dimensions (in inches [millimeters]) of the 845 are shown below. Additional dimensions
for mounting, and panel cutouts, are shown in the following sections.
>@ >@
02817,1*685)$&(
)52179,(:
Mounting
The 845 unit can be mounted two ways: standard panel mount or optional tab mounting, if
required.
• Standard panel mounting:
From the front of the panel, slide the empty case into the cutout. From the rear of the
panel, screw the case into the panel at the 8 screw positions (see figures in Standard
panel mount section).
• Optional tab mounting:
The “V” tabs are located on the sides of the case and appear as shown in the following
figure. Use needle nose pliers to bend the retaining "V" tabs outward to about 90°. Use
caution and do not bend and distort the wall of the enclosure adjacent to the tabs. The
relay can now be inserted and can be panel wired.
Figure 2-3: “V” Tabs Located on Case Side
Standard Panel Mount The standard panel mount and cutout dimensions are illustrated below.
To avoid the potential for personal injury due to fire hazards, ensure the unit is
CAUTION:
>@
>@ >@
>@
3$1(/&87287
Depth Reducing Collar Two different sizes of optional depth reducing collar are available for mounting relays in
narrow-depth service panels, or wherever space is an issue.
The drill hole locations are different when a depth reducing collar is used. See Depth
NOTE:
7.25
9.00
10.40
Dimensions in inches
GE PN 'A' DEPTH
1009-0310 1 3/8"
1009-0311 3"
892703A1.dwg
4.74
3.85
9.00
3.85
4.74
7.25
Dimensions in inches
892703A1.dwg
8 SERIES UNIT
892703A1.dwg
To mount an 8 Series relay with a depth reducing collar, follow these steps:
1. Drill mounting holes as shown on the panel cutout drawing (Depth reducing collar
panel cutout).
2. Mount the required collar (depth 1.375" or 3") on the captive unit using eight screws as
shown.
3. Mount the combined unit and collar on the panel using eight screws as shown.
operation.
Follow the steps outlined in the diagrams below to insert and withdraw the Draw-out unit.
67(3
6&$/(
+$1'/(72%(/,)7('72
326,7,21:+,/(6/,',1*
'5$:28781,7,172
&$37,9(81,7
67(3
67(3
386++$1'/('2:1
$1'7,*+7(17+(6&5(:
0$,17$,1+$1'/(/,)7('326,7,21
:,7+,1/%72548(
817,/'5$:28781,7
+$1'/(6+28/'%()/86+
,6)8//<,16(57('
:,7+)52173$1(/685)$&(
'29(7$,/*8,'(
32:(56833/<02'8/(
&$37,9(6&5(:
72,16(577+(32:(56833/<02'8/(
6/,'(7+(02'8/(,172'29(7$,/*8,'(
386+817,/7+(&211(&725,6/$7&+('
7,*+7(1&$37,9(6&5(:86,1*/%,172548(
725(029(32:(56833/<
816&5(:7+(&$37,9(6&5(:
6/,'($)/$7%/$'(6&5(:'5,9(5,172
$60$//23(1,1*217+(7232)7+(02'8/(
0$5.('%<$552:
3,9276&5(:'5,9(57281/$7&+7+(02'8/(
6/,'(7+(02'8/(287
All current and voltage sources connected to the 8 Series relay must be identified
before starting the removal process.
Removal of the magnetic module from a relay installed in a power system shall only be
performed by suitably-qualified personnel.
LOTO (Lockout Tag Out) of the system is required prior to module removal/
CAUTION:
replacement.
Follow the procedures outlined below to remove or replace the CT/VT magnetic module.
PREPARATION
1. Shut down and de-energize all systems connected to the 8 Series relay
2. Review all points in the section Cautions and Warnings.
An 8 Series relay, with the magnetic module removed, does NOT have an internal
IMPORTANT:
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current
CAUTION:
transformers. Make sure that in-field current transformer secondary circuits are
shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current transformer (CT)
input terminals of the device (i.e disconnection/connection of 8 Series CT Input
terminals or the internal CT /VT magnetic module).
02817,1*6&5(:
(;75$&7,21722/
REMOVAL
LOTO (Lockout Tag Out) of the system is required prior to module removal/
CAUTION:
replacement.
1. Remove the 8 Series draw-out unit from the chassis (see the section Draw-out Unit
Withdrawal and Insertion). Carefully set aside.
2. Within the captive chassis, unscrew the mounting screw (as indicated in the following
figure).
3. Insert the magnetic module extractor tool as shown in the following figure, without
engaging the pins.
4. Slide the tool to the left, engaging the pins fully (see arrow in figure).
5. Pull the tool handle towards the operator to disengage the module, and carefully
remove the module from the chassis..
6. Remove the tool from the module, and save for future use
REPLACEMENT
LOTO (Lockout Tag Out) of the system is required prior to module removal/
CAUTION:
replacement.
Ensure the replacement CT /VT module is the same type as the removed module.
Alternate models and configurations may be unsafe for use.
1. Insert the extractor tool into the front of the module, then slide the tool to the left to
engage the tool pins.
2. Place the module/tool at the front of the chassis so that it is flush with the left and
bottom sides.
3. Slide the module/tool into the back of the chassis as far as it will go, making sure the
connectors mate while keeping the module flush to the left and bottom sides of the
chassis.
4. Tighten the captive mounting screw using a torque of 6 in-lbs.
5. Remove the tool from the magnetics module and save for future use.
6. Insert the 8 Series draw-out unit (see the section Draw-out Unit Withdrawal and
Insertion).
7. Re-energize the 8 series relay system.
8. Remove the external shorting equipment from the CT inputs.
9. Ensure the In Service LED on the relay front panel is green.
10. Navigate to the Target message screen (press Home and then Targets) and check
that the Target screen does not show any Self-Test errors.
(Self-Test errors may indicate that the module has not been mounted properly.)
11. Verify through the 8 Series relay that CTs and VTs, digital inputs and other circuits are
all metering correctly.
Figure 2-13: RMIO - DIN rail mounting - Base & Expansion units
SNAP-IN THE DIN CLIPS (QTY: 4)
FOR DIN RAIL MOUNTING
0.30”
(7,6 mm)
1.38”
(35,1 mm)
DIN 3 RAIL
853726A1.CDR
2.250”
(57,15 mm)
4.100”
(104,14 mm)
853727A1.CDR
0.356”
[9.03 mm]
0.672”
2.285” [17.06 mm]
[58.04 mm]
EXPANSION UNIT
OUTLINE
code, operands for sensor failures must be assigned to an auxiliary output relay which
must be connected into the control logic of the breaker equipment to ensure safe
operations when the output relay is asserted. In the event of this assertion, the Hazard
Reduction Category code cannot be maintained unless backup protection is continuing
to maintain it.
Care must be taken when handling the Arc Flash sensor fiber, which can be damaged if
twisted, bent, or clamped tightly during installation.
• Do not bend sensor fiber sharply, or with a radius of less than 25 mm (1 inch). Sharp
bends can damage the fiber. Do not pull or tug loops of sensor fiber, as sharp bends
may result.
• Do not clamp sensor fiber tightly during installation. Sensor fiber should be held in
place loosely for the best long-term performance. Avoid over-tightening ties which
may deform or break the sensor fiber.
• Do not pull or tug sensor fiber with force, as this may cause internal damage or
separate the fiber from the cable connector.
• Do not twist the sensor fiber, as twisting can damage the fiber resulting in
substandard performance.
• Do not attach sensor fiber directly to the bus.
• Avoid surface temperatures above 70 °C or 158 °F to prolong the life of the fiber.
• Secure all sensor fibers (loosely but securely) away from any moving parts.
• Use the factory-provided dust caps on all Arc Flash sensor fiber and connectors when
not in use, to avoid dust contamination in the transceiver and sensor plugs.
Sensor Installation Figure 2-17: AF Sensor - front, side and top view
1RWWR6FDOH
'LPHQVLRQVLQPP
Sensor fiber should be held in place loosely for the best long-term performance. Avoid
over-tightening ties which may deform or break the sensor fiber.
Before installing the AF sensor unit, ensure that all other drilling and installation is
complete to minimize possible damage to the sensitive unit.
To install the AF sensor and route the sensor fiber, follow these steps:
1. Choose a location for the sensor clear of any obstructions that could shield the sensor
from arc flash light.
2. Mount the sensor securely, using the mounting screw holes.
3. Once the sensor is securely mounted, carefully route the sensor fiber from the AFS
sensor to the base unit, minimizing loops and curves for the strongest possible signal.
4. Secure all sensor fibers (loosely but securely) away from any moving parts.
Both the AF sensor connections (CH 1 through CH 4) and the sensor cables are shipped
FASTPATH:
with dust caps in place to avoid dust contamination. The small rubber dust caps must
be removed before operation.
Electrical Installation
Figure 2-19: Typical Wiring for a 2-Winding Transformer with VTs on HV Side
(892841A4)
75$16)250(5
3KDVH%
:LQGLQJ
:LQGLQJ
3KDVH&
6((97
:,5,1*,1
,16758&7,21
:<(97 0$18$/
&211(&7,21 :,1',1*
:,1',1* *5281'('
*5281'(' 1(875$/
& 1(875$/
$ &21752/
6((*5281' 32:(5
,1387:,5,1*,1
% ,16758&7,21
0$18$/
6/27$
,$ 1 ,% 1 ,%
*5281'
1 (875$/
/ ,1 (
*5281'
%86
3+$6($3+$6(%3+$6(& *5281' 3+$6($3+$6(%3+$6(& *5281'
92/7$*(,13876 &855(17,13876 &855(17,13876 3:56833/<
D D
) ',*,7$/,1387 9 )
:%5($.(5 E
) ',*,7$/,1387 ) 75,3:%.5
75,3
) ',*,7$/,1387 $8;,/,$5< ) &2,/ &,5&8,7
) ',*,7$/,1387 D
9 )
2 8 7 3 8 7 5 ( / $< 6
) ',*,7$/,1387
)
) &20021 127($8;5(/$<6$1'
$8;,/,$5< ) 3529,'(&2,/021,725,1*
) 9
/7&WDSSRVLWLRQLI ) %<92/7$*(6((,16758&7,21
%&'LQSXWVHOHFWHG ) 0$18$/)25'(7$,/621
%&'287387 *+ ',*,7$/,1387 :,5,1*
$8;,/,$5< )
%&'287387 *+ ',*,7$/,1387
)
', *, 7$/ ,138 76
2 8 7 3 8 7 5 ( / $< 6
',*,7$/,1387
', *, 7$/ ,138 76
+ ',*,7$/,1387 *+
+ ',*,7$/,1387 *+
$8;,/,$5<
+ ',*,7$/,1387 *+
+ ',*,7$/,1387
*+
+ ',*,7$/,1387
$8;,/,$5< *+
+ ',*,7$/,1387
+
*+
&20021
+ 9
6/27*25+,2B$
237,21$/ *+
$8;,/,$5< *+
&+ ),%(5,1387
6/27+,2B$,6$9$,/$%/(:+(16/27*,6:,7+,2B/
*+
&+ ),%(5,1387 6/27+,2B)237,21$/
$5&)/$6+
&+ ),%(5,1387
&+ ),%(5,1387
+27 %
57'
&203 % 57'
& +27 57' 5(7851 %
57'
& &203 +27 %
57' 57'
& 5(7851 57' &203 %
& +27 +27 %
57' 57'
& &203 &203 %
& +27 57' 5(7851 %
57'
& &203 6+,(/' %
& 5(7851 57' +27 %
57'
& 6+,(/' &203 %
& +27 +27 %
57' 57'
& &203 &203 %
& +27
57'
6/27%25&,2B525,2B6
237,21$/ 57' 5(7851 %
& &203 +27 %
683325762+0&233(557'$6:(// 57'
& 5(7851 57' &203 %
& +27 6+,(/' %
3(5621$/ 57'
&20387(5 & &203 5(6(59(' %
& 6+,(/'
(7+(51(7 & 5(6(59('
>%$&.3$1(/(7+(51(732575-2567@
86%
>)52173$1(//2&$/
5HDU3DQHO 6/27(
7UDQVIRUPHU3URWHFWLRQ6\VWHP
352*5$00,1*3257@ $33/,&$%/()25
&20081,&$7,21
237,21$/ &20081,&$7,216
237,21µ6(¶21/< (7+(51(7
),%(5&233(5
(7+(51(7
&233(5 675-
6/27*,2B/237,21$/
5-
675-
3(5621$/ 6/27'
&20387(5 '&P , 2
)URQW3DQHO &20081,&$7,216 5(6(59(' &$1
+ 57
86%
$1$/2*287387 $1$/2*,1387
7<3(% ,5,*% 56
5(6( 9(
5(785
5(6( 9(
5(785
5(785
6+,(/
6+,(/
6+,(/
6+,(/
&20
&20
&20
+2
' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' ' * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 23(1'(/7$97&211(&7,21
$&&(6632,17
/7&7$3
$0%,(17
326,7,21
7(03(5$785(
,)2+06
,1387
&$%/(6+,(/'72%(*5281'('
$73/&&20387(5(1'21/<
------
$1<0($685('
250(7(5(' $1<0($685('25
$1$/2*3$5$0(7(5 0(7(5('$1$/2*3$5$0(7(5
2873876 ,13876
Figure 2-20: Typical Wiring for a 2-Winding Transformer without VTs (892843A3)
6/27. 6/27.
&20
&20
$FGU
ysLjuZosfVs¯
̾Ϟ 8æñ %8Ϟ q f(Ϟ :lϞ
Þ
Dž
ʗf(Ϟ :PlϞ tzϞ ~8(/ (̄Ϟ ͗Ϟ ȓ
ͬ ŪƄŗķĠǢ ͈ĎĎϞϞ
͆ Ϟ
ėĒ lº Ϟ[[[Ϟĸ121211111ƁɒěΣő11121Ɠ
͉Ϟ
džϞ
ƜǂϞ
u
ŻũƮ
ͣ͒lºϞ 4Ϟ ū ŀϞ ɜϞ
Ĺ Ŗ ŁLJÆϞ
Ŷ Ŭ Ϟ 8 / %! q f( : P l
ơ͊ł Ń
͍ėĒ·lº·ĔϞ
+++Ϟ
ĺ
ŷ
Řř**** ĻļŹŰŦƠϞ ʘě
ż
źƀȖϞ ĭϞ
Þ
Ȕ â ŭ
Ç Ό Ů
ű ͥ Ĥ ů Ρ ͋ ͌ ʼ Ɨ ƝϞ
v v
ăçϞ ̹Ϟ ǣ ½ \ +++++++++++Ϟ+Ϟ
ȕ ʢϞ ʣϞ įϞ
ċ !6eϞ 6eϞ
t9ϞF Ϟ 6ˢϞ Æ ʥϞ ÇLjϞ
$V̕ $Ϟ i¯
̿$˰eϞ
ċeü¥eϞ
!E$üɸϞ
ʔ$ˮϞ
X_
$ɺϞ
ŏƅɂǸƒIJϞ
ĥʤϞ
ʩʪϞ ăçϞ ʓE$ɪϞ ƞ¾ ¾ƂɐͭƋ
̓ ®
ǏϞ Y¶±Ϟ
W_
6 $=̴Ϟ eϞ
6ˣϞ
i¯
ʦϞ ʧϞ Ǎ ǎ
ʿȏϞ Llj^Ϟ D
NJD
* ðΤD "Ϟ L
* L _Ϟ
L Ϟ ʨϞL H Ϟ L S NjϞðǽϞ
D̏Ϟ D_Ϟ DnnjϞ DāϞ)Ϟ )Ϟ /Ϟ /ǰϞ /DzǑϞ/"Ϟ /̐Ϟʮ/_Ϟ /nϞ /āϞ /ȐϞ Ϟ ˅Ϟ /ͨϞ /
SΩħϞ ñϞ ˆ_Ϟ Ϟ)Ϟ Ϟ ɚϞ SϞ
)Ϟ
F@Ϟ F@Ϟ ̻̺ͦϞ FĕͧFĕϞ FΒϞ FΓϞ u Ϟ 7Ϟ Ϟ 7Ϟ )Ϟ
@Ϟ 7Ϟ u»Ϟ Ϟ ͜ ØϞ (_ Ϟ Ϟ 7Ϟ
@Ϟ 7Ϟ u»Ϟ d@Ϟ 7Ϟ u»Ϟ 7Ϟ Ϟ 7Ϟ ÙϞ ØϞ ɁϞ ŒϞƢϞ
Y_ Z_ Z
WϞ@Ϟ ˿ϞßϞ ˾ ϞɝϞ þ˵ùɩϞ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
)Ϟ
Ϟ
)_RϞ*_ )_RϞ+_ )_RϞ+_ )_RϞ*_
˻ʡWϞ@Ϟ ˽ĂWϞȋϞ WϞáϞ ʕøϞ
)_RϞ,_ )_RϞ+_ -_RϞ*_ ._RϞ*_
WϞ@Ϟ WϞßϞ ̀ϞáϞ ʒ¬̳øϞ
Ęͫ͡
)̃Ϟ ȩϞ
Ϟ Ϟ ƤϞ ƩϞ ΪϞ ɦϞ
?Ϟ Ϟ ɨϞ ̂8΅ǒϞ
;9Ϟ
ʯ5Ok.Ϟ
4k>Ϟ
FϞ 0 ͛Ϟ7Ϟ ΄Ϟ Ϟ $
Ϟ Ϟ $Ϟ $
Ϟ Ϟ
)Ϟ )Ϟ ˇ
ƹϞ Ǩ22 ƐĪƃϞ ɯϞ X̑Ϟ
êaϞ K0Ϟ
jȊϞ
˩õ Ϟ ] kp~B¯ Ú̬̀xϞ
GKò¤89SϞ ΘϞ
vQ v ɘϞ ǖƺϞ ˶̆˥̸pϞ ɞú
¨Ϟ
ά ] ] ] ]ń
ʹ˗ Ή͓ͲϞ $ ] ]Ņ έ
ǓϞήșί\Ιΰśα Ŝ ŝ \\βϞ
ϞŲϞ ˘û#µ˦²ʰ#ʊϞ ̵û¨ĄÚʋpƙϞ ppϞ
akxRpk¯
ʃú²Ϟ
ˬĔγȚδεͻ ŞζȶțϞηθ ȷ0 ι̗ϞκϞ ƈϞ ÙϞ
Ϟ Ϟ
GK0ʺ9"Ϟ
čϞ
ɻɔ
¨Ϟ pk¯ ̼²
#ʌϞ
4:BϞ ϞÎ; Ƹ"Ϟ -îϞ
ϞϞ XÍHϞ
ʻϞ ?Ϟ ?Ϟ
SλϞ ï,Ϟ îAϞ
ϞMϞ
4:BϞ Ϟ
4 B ȇϞ ïTϞ -Û
"Ϟ ỌC òϞ ̈́ϞμϞ ˖= Ϟ $ >Ϟ
>J t$ϞtCʝϞ$ Ϟ
H5?L_ _ X rkNVϞ νϞ
4:BϞ ϞΆÏ Ϳ ǪǔϞ d0Ϟ
ϞĜϞ ?Ϟ ?Ϟ
͎ëĘώ& Đ ϏĐ
*
ϐϞ H5?M&_ T"_?AM/?;6_
Ǥ QJďM ͏é &
QQ Q
M ΐϞ
& *
ʠϞ ê b Ϟ
Ϟ"Ϟ ϑϞ
Ϟ
ϒϞ Ϟ
ϞưϞ
Ϟ
oϞ
Ϟ
à Ϟ
Ϟ &Ϟ
Ϟ &Ϟ š
jϞ &|Ϟ ƊϞ
±ąϞ
`Ϟ
Ϟ
Ϟ Ϟ & " Ţ Ϟ
ÿϞ œϙ̇ɮϞ
MϞ Ϟ nÂȌϞ
Ϟ & , Ϟ
̛Ϟ Ϟ &TϞ
UϞ MϞ
͘ĜϞ
Ϟ
Ϟ &`Ϟ
TϞ Ϟ ˄ǹϞ Ϟ bUϞ
aϞ
`Ϟ
Ϟ h äːoϞ &aϞţ
Ϟ aÂ^Ϟ Ϟ &^Ϟ
ΞϞ
hJ ˎϞ
Ϟ &Ϟ
ƼϞ Ϟ Ϟ &Ϟ
ƽϞ ´Ϟ
3Ϟ
Ϟ
Ϟ &|Ϟ
3Ϟ Ϟ
MϞ
Ϟ
Ϟ
G7>N__>D_ _ UD_>C_ UF_>BN0>;7_
ΝϞfĉ®Y³PgϞzÅϞYì˙Ϟ ɟY(³Ϟ³ϞfϞ (ˋˌϞ
ϞȂϞ
ÿTϞ
äϞ & "Ϟ
J Ϟ b,Ϟ
"Ϟ Ϟ -ǗÈÀϞ
Ϟ &_Ϟ
3,Ϟ ̜Ϟ h 0-Ϟ b`Ϟ
ĦϗɄϘO>;Ϟ
ϖϞ Ϟ
kɲOϞ ȅϞ
Ϟ h ĊϞ bUϞ
3`Ϟ hJˏϞ
ʛ±˝ɳąϞ
UϞ h ̷Ϟ
İɛϞ˸ɖˠ ˍϞW̨ɷ̋ù ̤Ϟ́̚Ϟ̍̒Ϟ˴ϞḀ͇̆Ϟ
ĉgàϞ
ϓþ¬öϞ˹@0Ϟ ˭Ϟ ĖēͷϞ
ēͰĖęϞ Ϟ H8@O_ ɴϞ Ϟ
˯ʳöϞ
¬¥Ϟ ģϞ ɗϞ * ı˲Ϟ * @9:R<0P/@<I_
* *
ɏ́ ̝ͮɑϞ
ϔ
Ϟ
Ϟ
Ϟ
͠DŽΏ˱˚Ϟ
ňʼnƱϚϞ
Ϟ
Ϟ
Ϟ
G4>N_$_
V4_>BN0>;4_
˕ ̞ ĬϞ Ĩ ̟ ϞŧϞ
ƪϞ
I8@O__
VO>óϞ
P(OϞ Ϟ $C K >Ϟ .ͯ'Ϟ ǡƶǀϞ
ʅĚΊϞ¯͔Ě͝ęϞ ͤ̔̎˧Ϟ :÷Ϟ £˛fϞ
½ \ \
˞kPϞ
÷r5Ϟk̠̯PϞ 7 5Ϟ7̰Ϟ
̈ ʎ ɵƟ
ǥ ¿ ̉̓ǺȍǿϞ ľ Ÿ īƇ
ÊǭǵÐȀȆȉǚÖÊǮǶÐϜϝϞ
ŋǛÖȸȹϞ
¼Ϟ
ĶϞ
ϛϞ ¼Ϟ
Ϟ
Έ
Ûɠ> >Ϟ
CϞ ƲϞ ŨϞ
Ϟ yÉǙyǬϞ yǴϞ ƿǻϞ ɬȈϞ yȎϞ ȒͳÉÅϞ Ϟ IϞ Ϟ ʑϞ ÑϞ ÒϞ ÓϞ ÔϞ ×Ϟ ʵ˨Ϟ ËϞ 3IϞ Ϟ "Ϟ 3ÑϞ 3ÒϞʶÓϞ 3ÔϞ ×Ϟ IǁϞ IËϞ IIϞ IϞIǼϞ ˺Ϟ.V;̡ϞFĈϞ V Ĉ ˟Ϟ
{C¯
D¯ (¯
>*
˔ťŐƕƔͽŵˁ
?Ϟ r '=Ϟ Ϟ
˂Ϟ Ϟ =Z¥ µ6#ϞϞ
?Ϟ ʆ£<ZϞ ǜϞ
'<~%#ĆϞ
%<=%!'ćE!%Ϟ
?Ϟ #°EϞ ?Ϟ
[[Ϟ ·Ϟ
ɡ Ύ***********ƣϞ
'~ˑϞZ£ V˒BϞ Ϟ ~Ϟ¢!E#.VBϞ
͐Ϟ
͑Ϟ
ͼϞ
Ϟ°s Ƴɢ<=EPå!Ϟå#BϞ #s ČϞ
Ϟ
ͪϞ ōϞ Ŏ Ɩ
ʷa
L ʸ
Ϟ DͱL
* DÌǩ
SϞÌ " Ϟ
'#͂Ϟ<ɶ'ZE!.Ϟ
!Ϟ <%%!%.Ϟ
'#'s¢Ϟ='!'<%!Ϟ '#ČϞ <%'ZE!%.Ϟ!Ϟ
<%ć%!%.Ϟ #'s¢Ϟ='!'<%Ć%!Ϟ
EP=̮ZϞ
#°̱µZϞ
$GZJ
Terminal Identification
All the terminal strips are labeled with a slot letter to identify the module slot position and
numbers to identify the terminals within the module.
Make sure that the first letter on the terminal strip corresponds to the slot location
CAUTION:
Terminal Connections
When installing two lugs on one terminal, both lugs must be “right side up” as shown in the
NOTE:
picture below. This is to ensure the adjacent lower terminal block does not interfere with
NOTE the lug body.
SCREW
1 2 3
WASHER
TERMINAL LOWER
BLOCK TERMINAL
DIVIDER
A broad range of applications are available for the 845 relays. As such, it is not possible to
present typical connections for all possible schemes. The information in this section covers
the important aspects of interconnections, in the general areas of instrument transformer
inputs, other inputs, outputs, communications and grounding. The figure below shows the
rear terminal layout of the 845 Platform.
1
1
1
1
2
3 2
2
2
3
3
3
PORT 4
4
4
4
Tx4
5
5
5
PORT 4
6
6
6
7
7
7
Rx4
8
8
8
10 9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
PORT 5
F G H Tx5
PORT 5
1
1
1
Rx5
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
5
5
5
PORT 1
6
6
6
7
7
7
J K
8
8
8
12 11 10 9
12 11 10 9
12 11 10 9
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
BANK - J1 BANK - K1
5
5
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10
10
11
11
12
12
BANK - J2 BANK - K2
13
13
14
14
15
15
16
16
$1$/2*2873876
)*+ 2379 9 )*+ 5(6(59(' * $1$/2*287387
)*+ 12 )*+ &20021 +6+% * $1$/2*287387
&/26( ZLWK9PRQ 9
)*+ &20021 $8; )*+ 12 * $1$/2*287387
9
2873875(/$<6
2873875(/$<6
)*+ 2379 )*+ 5(6(59(' * $1$/2*287387
)*+ 1& )*+ &20021 +6+% * $1$/2*287387
$8; ZR9PRQ
)*+ &20021 )*+ 12 * 5(7851
)*+ 12 )*+ 5(6(59(' * 6+,(/'
)*+ 1& )*+ &20021 +6+% * $1$/2*,1387
$1$/2*,13876
)*+ &20021 $8; )*+ 12 ZR9PRQ * $1$/2*,1387
)*+ 12 )*+ 5(6(59(' * $1$/2*,1387
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * $1$/2*,1387
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * 5(7851
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * 6+,(/'
7+5(6+2/' 7+5(6+2/'
',*,7$/,13876
',*,7$/,13876
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * 2+06,1387
2+06
,1387
6(77,1* 6(77,1*
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 *5283 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 *5283 * 2+06,1387
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * 6+,(/'
)*+ ',*,7$/,1387 )*+ ',*,7$/,1387 * +27
)*+ &20021 )*+ &20021 * &203
57'
)*+ '&9 )*+ '&9 * 5(7851
)*+ 1& )*+ 1& * 6+,(/'
)250&
)*+ &20021 $8;
)*+ &20 &)5
* 5(6(59('
)*+ 12 )*+ 12 * 5(6(59('
+ ',*,7$/,1387
%& +27 ZKHQXVHGLQ6ORW)RQO\
57' + ',*,7$/,1387
%& &203
&DUG6DOVRVXSSRUWV2KP&RSSHU57'
+ ',*,7$/,1387
%& 5(7851 57'
+ ',*,7$/,1387
%& 6+,(/'
+ ',*,7$/,1387
%& +27
57' + ',*,7$/,1387
%& &203
+ &20021
%& +27
57' + 9
%& &203
%& 5(7851 57'
$5&)/$6+
&+ ),%(5,1387
%& +27
57' &+ ),%(5,1387
%& &203
&+ ),%(5,1387
%& 6+,(/'
&+ ),%(5,1387
%& 5(6(59('
$&'5
Terminal Strip Types There are two types of removable terminal strips as shown: right-angle plugs with side
screw connections, and straight plugs with front screw connections.
Wire Size Use the following guideline for wiring to terminal strips A, B, C, D, F, G, H:
• 12 AWG to 24 AWG
P S U
N 12 12 12 12
G 11 11 11 11
10 10 10 10
Tx 9 9 9 9
Rx 8 8 8 8
7 7 7 7
6 6 6 6
5 5 5 5
Com Port
+ B1
- B2 4 4 4 4
Common B3 3 3 3 3
2 2 2 2
1 1 1 1
896750.cdr
To switchgear
ground bus
– +
D8, D9, and D10 refer to terminals shown on the 8 Series Terminal Identification diagrams.
NOTE:
NOTE
Verify that the relay’s nominal input current of 1 A or 5 A matches the secondary rating
CAUTION:
of the connected CTs. Unmatched CTs may result in equipment damage or inadequate
protection.
IMPORTANT: The phase and ground current inputs correctly measure up to 46 times the
CAUTION:
current input’s nominal rating. Time overcurrent curves become horizontal lines for
currents above 20 × PKP.
Ground CT Inputs
Before making ground connections, be aware that the relay automatically calculates the
neutral (residual) current from the sum of the three phase current phasors. The following
figures show three possible ground connections using the ground current input (Terminals
J7 and J8).
The ground input (Terminals J7 and J8) is used in conjunction with a Zero Sequence CT as
source, or in the neutral of wye-connected source CTs. The ground current input can be
used to polarize the neutral. When using the residual connection, set the
GROUND CT PRIMARY setpoint to a value equal to the PHASE CT PRIMARY setpoint.
Figure 2-33: Ground Inputs
J1 J3 J5
8 Series
J2 J4 J6
J8 J7 J7 J8 J7 J8
892773A2.cdr
Voltage Inputs
The 845 relays have four channels for AC voltage inputs, each with an isolating
transformer in each J and K slot. Voltage transformers up to a maximum 5000:1 ratio may
be used. The nominal secondary voltage must be in the 10 to 240 V range. The Bus VT
connections most commonly used, wye and delta (or open delta), are shown in the typical
wiring diagram. The single Auxiliary voltage input is commonly used as the “line voltage”.
For LEA inputs, the “line voltage” connection is line to neutral voltages. The line VT input
channel, used for the synchrocheck feature, can be connected for phase-neutral voltages
Van, Vbn, or Vcn; or for phase-phase voltages Vab, Vbc, or Vca as shown.
TO BUS VTs TO BUS VTs TO BUS VTs TO BUS VTs TO BUS VTs TO BUS VTs
A A A A A A
B 52 B 52 B 52 B 52 B 52 B 52
C C C C C C
If Delta VTs are used for three-phase voltages, the zero sequence voltage (V0) and
CAUTION:
neutral ground polarizing voltage (–V0) are zero. Also, with the Delta VT connection, the
phase-neutral voltage cannot be measured and is not displayed.
TRANSFORMER FEEDER
J1 J2 J3 J4 J5 J6 J7 J8
IA N IB N IC N IG N
892775A1.cdr
Zero-Sequence CT Installation
The figure below shows the various CT connections and the exact placement of a Zero
Sequence current CT, so that ground fault current can be detected. Twisted pair cabling on
the Zero Sequence CT is recommended.
Ground
outside CT
To ground;
LOAD must be on
load side
996630A5
LOAD
Control Power
Control power is supplied to the relay such that it matches the relay’s installed power
supply range.
Control power supplied to the relay must match the installed power supply range. If the
CAUTION:
applied voltage does not match, damage to the unit may occur. All grounds MUST be
connected for normal operation regardless of control power supply type.
For more details, please refer to the Power Supply subsection located in the Introduction
chapter.
The relay should be connected directly to the ground bus, using the shortest practical
CAUTION:
path. A tinned copper, braided, shielding and bonding cable should be used. As a
minimum, 96 strands of number 34 AWG should be used. Belden catalog number 8660
is suitable.
Contact Inputs
Depending on the order code, the 845 relay has a different number of contact inputs which
can be used to operate a variety of logic functions for circuit switching device control,
external trips, blocking of protection elements, etc. The relay has ‘contact inputs’ and
‘virtual inputs’ that are combined in a form of programmable logic to facilitate the
implementation of various schemes.
The voltage threshold at which the contact inputs detect a closed contact input is
programmable as 17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to
125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
Wet or Dry input signal types can be connected to contact input terminals as shown in the
figure: Wet and Dry Contact Input Wiring Examples.
Dry inputs use an internal +24V that is supplied by the 845. The voltage threshold must be
set to 17V for the inputs to be recognized using the internal +24V.
The same type of input signal must be connected to all contact inputs on the same contact
FASTPATH:
input card.
INPUT
SIGNAL
SWITCH
(WET)
INPUT
SIGNAL
SWITCH
(DRY)
EXTERNAL
DC POWER
SUPPLY
Output Relays
The locations of the output relays have a fixed assignment for the platform called the
master identifier. I/O options that include inputs occupy the fixed assigned output
locations so in these cases the relay assignment maps to the master identifier.
The output relays for the 845 relay are fully programmable, and can be assigned in the
transformer breakers menu for breaker tripping or closing. The output relays assigned for
breaker closing, are automatically excluded from the menus for output selection for the
rest of the elements.
The critical failure output relay is reserved as Relay_8 and it is omitted and is not
programmable.
Table 2-6: Slots F,G,H Terminal Master Identifier (left) and I/O options A, A, A (right)
Slots F, G, H Terminal Master Identifier Slots F,G,H with I/O options A, A, A
Terminal # SLOT F SLOT G SLOT H Terminal # SLOT F SLOT G SLOT H
1 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17 1 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17
2 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17 2 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17
3 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17 3 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 RELAY_17
4 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18 4 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18
5 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18 5 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18
6 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18 6 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 RELAY_18
7 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19 7 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19
8 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19 8 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19
9 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19 9 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 RELAY_19
10 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20 10 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20
11 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20 11 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20
12 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20 12 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 RELAY_20
13 RELAY_5 RELAY_13 RELAY_21 13 Digital In_1 Digital In_8 Digital In_15
14 RELAY_5 RELAY_13 RELAY_21 14 Digital In_2 Digital In_9 Digital In_16
15 RELAY_5 RELAY_13 RELAY_21 15 Digital In_3 Digital In_10 Digital In_17
16 RELAY_6 RELAY_14 RELAY_22 16 Digital In_4 Digital In_11 Digital In_18
17 RELAY_6 RELAY_14 RELAY_22 17 Digital In_5 Digital In_12 Digital In_19
18 RELAY_6 RELAY_14 RELAY_22 18 Digital In_6 Digital In_13 Digital In_20
19 RELAY_7 RELAY_15 RELAY_23 19 Digital In_7 Digital In_14 Digital In_21
20 RELAY_7 RELAY_15 RELAY_23 20 Common Common Common
21 RELAY_7 RELAY_15 RELAY_23 21 +24V +24V +24V
22 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24 22 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24
23 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24 23 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24
24 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24 24 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 RELAY_24
Table 2-7: Slots F, G, H with I/O options M, L, F (left) and I/O options A, L, A (right)
Slots F, G, H with I/O options M, L, F Slots F,G,H with I/O options A, L, A
Terminal # SLOT F SLOT G SLOT H Terminal # SLOT F SLOT G SLOT H
1 RELAY_1 Analog Out_1 Digital In_8 1 RELAY_1 Analog RELAY_9
Out_1
2 RELAY_1 Analog Out_2 Digital In_9 2 RELAY_1 Analog RELAY_9
Out_2
3 Reserved Analog Out_3 Digital In_10 3 RELAY_1 Analog RELAY_9
Out_3
4 RELAY_2 Analog Out_4 Digital In_11 4 RELAY_2 Analog RELAY_10
Out_4
5 RELAY_2 Analog Out_5 Digital In_12 5 RELAY_2 Analog RELAY_10
Out_5
6 Reserved Analog Out_6 Digital In_13 6 RELAY_2 Analog RELAY_10
Out_6
7 RELAY_3 Analog Out_7 Digital In_14 7 RELAY_3 Analog RELAY_11
Out_7
Table 2-8: Slots F,G,H with I/O options A, A, F (left) and I/O options A, N, F (right)
Slots F,G,H with I/O options A, A, F Slots F, G, H with I/O options A, N, F
Terminal # SLOT F SLOT G SLOT H Terminal # SLOT F SLOT H
1 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 Digital In_15 1 RELAY_1 Digital In_8
2 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 Digital In_16 2 RELAY_1 Digital In_9
3 RELAY_1 RELAY_9 Digital In_17 3 RELAY_1 Digital In_10
4 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 Digital In_18 4 RELAY_2 Digital In_11
5 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 Digital In_19 5 RELAY_2 Digital In_12
6 RELAY_2 RELAY_10 Digital In_20 6 RELAY_2 Digital In_13
7 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 Digital In_21 7 RELAY_3 Digital In_14
8 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 Digital In_22 8 RELAY_3 Digital In_15
9 RELAY_3 RELAY_11 Digital In_23 9 RELAY_3 Digital In_16
10 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 Digital In_24 10 RELAY_4 Digital In_17
11 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 Common 11 RELAY_4 Common
12 RELAY_4 RELAY_12 +24V 12 RELAY_4 +24V
13 Digital In_1 Digital In_8 ARC FLASH 13 Digital In_1 ARC FLASH
Sensor 1 Sensor 1
14 Digital In_2 Digital In_9 Sensor 2 14 Digital In_2 Sensor 2
15 Digital In_3 Digital In_10 Sensor 3 15 Digital In_3 Sensor 3
Sensor 4 Sensor 4
16 Digital In_4 Digital In_11 16 Digital In_4
17 Digital In_5 Digital In_12 17 Digital In_5
18 Digital In_6 Digital In_13 18 Digital In_6
19 Digital In_7 Digital In_14 19 Digital In_7
20 Common Common 20 Common
21 +24V +24V 21 +24V
22 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 22 RELAY_8
23 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 23 RELAY_8
24 RELAY_8 RELAY_16 24 RELAY_8
Serial Communications
One two-wire RS485 port is provided. Up to thirty-two 8 Series IEDs can be daisy-chained
together on a communication channel without exceeding the driver capability. For larger
systems, additional serial channels must be added. Commercially available repeaters can
also be used to add more than 32 relays on a single channel. Suitable cable should have a
characteristic impedance of 120 ohms and total wire length should not exceed 1200
meters (4000 ft).
Voltage differences between remote ends of the communication link are not uncommon.
For this reason, surge protection devices are internally installed across all RS485
terminals.Internally, an isolated power supply with an opto-coupled data interface is used
to prevent noise coupling.
Figure 2-39: RS485 wiring diagram
TWISTED PAIR
8-Series IED
Z T (*) SHIELD
D3 RS485 +
ISOLATION ISOLATION
D4 RS485 -
DATA
DATA COM
COMMON
UP TO 32, 8-Series
OR OTHER IEDs, IED
MAXIMUM CABLE
LENGTH OF
1200 m (4000 ft.) Z T (*)
RS485 +
RS485 -
LAST
COMMON DEVICE
892780A4.CDR
To ensure that all devices in a daisy-chain are at the same potential, it is imperative
CAUTION:
that the common terminals of each RS485 port are tied together and grounded only
once, at the master or at the 845. Failure to do so may result in intermittent or failed
communications.
The source computer/PLC/SCADA system should have similar transient protection devices
installed, either internally or externally. Ground the shield at one point only, as shown in the
figure above, to avoid ground loops. Correct polarity is also essential. The 845 IEDs must be
wired with all the positive (+) terminals connected together and all the negative (–)
terminals connected together. Each relay must be daisy-chained to the next one. Avoid
star or stub connected configurations. The last device at each end of the daisy-chain
should be terminated with a 120 ohm ¼ watt resistor in series with a 1 nF capacitor across
the positive and negative terminals. Some systems allow the shield (drain wire) to be used
as a common wire and to connect directly to the COM terminal; others function correctly
only if the common wire is connected to the COM terminal, but insulated from the shield.
Observing these guidelines ensure a reliable communication system immune to system
transients.
IRIG-B
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows time stamping of events to be
synchronized among connected devices within 1 millisecond. The IRIG-B time code
formats are serial, width-modulated codes which can be either DC level shift or amplitude
modulated (AM) form. The type of form is auto-detected by the 845 relay. Third party
equipment is available for generating the IRIG-B signal; this equipment may use a GPS
satellite system to obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic
locations can also be synchronized.
Figure 2-40: IRIG-B connection
IRIG-B GE MULTILIN
TIME CODE SHIELDED CABLE 8-SERIES
GENERATOR
+ D1 IRIG-B(+)
892781A3.CDR
TO OTHER DEVICES
Chapter 3: Interfaces
Interfaces
Display
“Home”:return to
default screen
LED labels TARGETS STATUS METERING SETPOINTS RECORDS
“ESCAPE”: return to
previous menu
ENTER HELP
LOAD-LIMIT REDUCED
LED#2,LED#3,
MESSAGE
and LEDs 5 to 14
(programmable) OPEN CLOSE F1
RESET
“ENTER”:enter selected
setting
USB port
Targets
Status Summary
Breakers
Switches Setpoints Device
Last Trip Data
System
Arc Flash
Contact Inputs Inputs
Output Relays
Outputs
Virtual Inputs
Protection
Virtual Outputs
Flex States Monitoring
Communications
Control
Information
Device Status FlexLogic
Clock Testing
PTP Status
Metering Summary
Transformer
Currents Records Events
Voltages Transients
Frequency
Fault Reports
Volts per Hertz
Data Logger
Harmonic Magnitude
Harmonics Breakers
Arc Flash
RTDs
RTD Maximums
Analog Inputs
FlexElements
Working with The 845 display contains five main menu items labeled Targets, Status, Metering,
Graphical Display Setpoints, and Records located at the bottom of the screen. Choosing each main menu
Pages item displays the corresponding sub-menu.
There are two ways to navigate throughout the 845 menu: using the pushbuttons
corresponding to the soft tabs from the screen, or by selecting the item from the list of
items on the screen using the “Up” and “Down” pushbuttons to move the yellow
highlighted line, and pressing the pushbutton “Enter”.
Figure 3-4: Tab Pushbuttons
TARGETS STATUS METERING SETPOINTS RECORDS
The tab pushbuttons are used to enter the menu corresponding to the label on the tabs. If
more than 5 tabs exist, the first and the last tab are labelled with arrows to allow you to
scroll to the other tabs.
The Home pushbutton is used to display the home screen, and all screens defined under
the Front Panel/Screens menu as default screens.
HELP
The Help pushbutton is used to provide the Modbus address corresponding to the present
location when in the Actual Values menu.
ENTER
The Enter pushbutton has a dual function. It is used to display a sub-menu when an item is
highlighted. It is also used to save the desired value for any selected setpoint.
The Up, and Down pushbuttons are used to select/highlight an item from a menu, as well
as select a value from the list of values for a chosen item.
The Up, Down, Left, and Right pushbuttons on the membrane faceplate are used to move
the yellow highlight. These pushbuttons are also used on special screens to navigate to
multiple objects.
ESCAPE
The Escape pushbutton is used to display the previous menu. This pushbutton can also be
used to cancel a setpoint change.
RESET
The Reset pushbutton clears all latched LED indications, target messages, and latched
output relays, providing the conditions causing these events are not present.
To change (or view) an item on (or from) the 845 menus:
1. Use the pushbuttons that correspond to the tabs (Targets, Status, Metering, Setpoints,
Records) on the screen to select a menu.
2. Use the Up and Down pushbuttons to highlight an item.
3. Press Enter to view a list of values for the chosen item. (Some items are view-only.)
4. Use the Up and Down pushbuttons to highlight a value.
5. Press Enter to assign the highlighted value to the item.
Single Line Diagram BKR1 LED setting for Breaker symbol color configuration
In all 8 Series devices the Breaker symbol color is configurable as per the color scheme
setting in Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Display Properties > Color Scheme.
The breaker status icon changes state according to the breaker status input and the color
scheme setting (Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Display Properties > Color Scheme) to
show Breaker status.
The winding voltage setting for each breaker is displayed on the associated branch. The
winding configuration icon will display either a 2-winding or 3-winding transformer based
on the order code.
The transformer status is indicated in the top right of the display.
Connected/Disconnected
Breaker State Symbol
Detection
Configured Connected
Configured Disconnected
*845 considers the breaker state Connected when detection of the Connected/
Disconnected state of the breaker is not configured. Connected/Disconnected detection is
not configured when setpoint Connected (under Setpoints > System > Breaker) is set to
OFF.
The parameters displayed in the Front panel screen example are as follows for a 2-
Winding Transformer with VT:
The parameters displayed in the Front panel screen example are as follows for a 2-
Winding Transformer without VT:
The parameters displayed in the Front panel screen example are as follows for 3-Winding
Transformer:
The 845 front panel provides two columns of 7 LED indicators each, and 3 LED pushbutton
indicators. The “IN-SERVICE” (LED 1) and the “PICKUP” (LED 4) indicators from the first LED
column are non-programmable LEDs. The bottom 3 LED indicators from the first column,
and the 7 LED indicators from the second LED column are fully programmable. The
indicators “TRIP” (LED 2), and “ALARM” (LED 3), are also programmable, and can be
triggered by either a selection of FlexLogic operand assigned in their own menu, or by the
operation of any protection, control or monitoring element with function selected as Trip,
Alarm, or Latched Alarm.
The RESET key is used to reset any latched LED indicator or Target Message once the
condition has been cleared (latched conditions can also be reset via the RESETTING menu).
Figure 3-7: LED numbering
/(' /('
/(' /('
/(' /('
/(' /('
/(' /('
/(' /('
/(' /('
ALARM
Some status indicators are common while some are feature specific which depend on the
availability in the order code. The common status indicators in the first column are
described below.
• IN SERVICE
– Green color = Relay powered up, passed self-test has been programmed, and
ready to serve. This LED indicates that control power is applied, all monitored
inputs, outputs, and internal systems are OK, and that the device has been
programmed.
– Red color = Relay failed self test, has not been programmed, or out of service
• TRIP
This LED indicates that the element selected to produce a trip has operated. This
indicator always latches; as such, a Reset command must be initiated to allow the
latch to be reset.
• ALARM
This LED indicates that the FlexLogic™ operand serving as an Alarm switch has
operated. Latching of the indicator depends on the selected protection function. A
Reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
• PICKUP
This LED indicates that at least one element is picked up. This indicator is never
latched.
• TEST MODE
This LED indicates that the relay has been set into Test Mode.
• MESSAGE
This LED indicates the presence of Target Messages detected by the relay.
• LOCAL MODE
This LED indicates that the relay is operating in local mode.
Breaker status indication is based on the breaker’s 52a and 52b contacts. With both
contacts wired to the relay and configured, closed breaker status is determined by closed
52a contact and opened 52b contact. Vice-versa the open breaker status is determined by
opened 52a contact and closed 52b contact. If both 52a and 52b contacts are open, due
to a breaker being racked out from the switchgear, both the Breaker Open and Breaker
Closed LED Indicators will be off.
The Event Cause indicators in the first column are described as follows:
Events Cause LEDs are turned ON or OFF by protection elements that have their respective
target settings selected as either “Self-Reset” or “Latched”. If a protection element target
setting is “Self-Reset”, then the corresponding Event Cause LEDs remain ON as long as the
operate operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element
target setting is “Latched”, then the corresponding Event Cause LEDs turn ON when the
operate operand associated with the element is asserted and will remain ON until the
RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
Default labels are shipped in the package of every 845, together with custom templates. A
custom LED template is available for editing and printing, refer to publication GET-20035
from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin. The default labels can be replaced by user-
printed labels. Customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations
where languages other than English are used to communicate with operators.
For LED and Pushbutton programming details, please refer to Front Panel.
FASTPATH:
LED 5
LED 6 LED 19 LED 20
PB5 PB6
LED 7
LED 8
LED 21 LED 22
LED 9 PB7 PB8
LED 10
LED 11 LED 23 LED 24
PB9 PB10
LED 12
Some status indicators are common while some are feature specific which is dependent
upon the order code. The common status indicators in the first column are described
below.
• IN SERVICE
This LED indicates that control power is present, all monitored inputs, outputs, and
internal systems are OK, and that the device is programmed.
• TRIP
This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as a trip switch has operated.
This indicator always latches so a reset command must be initiated to allow the latch
to be reset.
• ALARM
This LED indicates that the FlexLogic operand serving as an alarm switch has
operated. Latching of the indicator depends on the selected protection function. The
Reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
• PICKUP
This LED indicates that at least one element is picked up. This indicator is never
latched.
• TEST MODE
This LED indicates that the relay is in test mode.
• MESSAGE
This LED indicates the presence of target messages detected by the relay.
• PHASE A FAULT
This LED indicates that phase A of the Phase Time Overcurrent 1 function has
operated.
• PHASE B FAULT
This LED indicates that phase B of the Phase Time Overcurrent 1 function has
operated.
• PHASE C FAULT
This LED indicates that phase C of the Phase Time Overcurrent 1 function has
operated.
• GROUND FAULT
This LED indicates that the Ground Time Overcurrent 1 function has operated.
• 50P INST OC
This LED indicates that the Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 function has operated.
• 27 PHASE UV (Order Code without Autoreclose)
This LED indicates that the Phase Undervoltage 1 function has operated.
• LOCKOUT (Order Code with Autoreclose)
This LED indicates that the Autoreclose function has reached the lockout stage.
ALARM
Some status indicators are common while some are feature specific which depend on the
availability in the order code. The common status indicators in the first column are
described below.
• IN SERVICE
– Green color = Relay powered up, passed self-test has been programmed, and
ready to serve. This LED indicates that control power is applied, all monitored
inputs, outputs, and internal systems are OK, and that the device has been
programmed.
– Red color = Relay failed self test, has not been programmed, or out of service
• TRIP
This LED indicates that the element selected to produce a trip has operated. This
indicator always latches; as such, a Reset command must be initiated to allow the
latch to be reset.
• ALARM
This LED indicates that the FlexLogic™ operand serving as an Alarm switch has
operated. Latching of the indicator depends on the selected protection function. A
Reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
• PICKUP
This LED indicates that at least one element is picked up. This indicator is never
latched.
• TEST MODE
This LED indicates that the relay has been set into Test Mode.
• MESSAGE
This LED indicates the presence of Target Messages detected by the relay.
• LOCAL MODE
This LED indicates that the relay is operating in local mode.
Breaker status indication is based on the breaker’s 52a and 52b contacts. With both
contacts wired to the relay and configured, closed breaker status is determined by closed
52a contact and opened 52b contact. Vice-versa the open breaker status is determined by
opened 52a contact and closed 52b contact. If both 52a and 52b contacts are open, due
to a breaker being racked out from the switchgear, both the Breaker Open and Breaker
Closed LED Indicators will be off.
The Event Cause indicators in the first column are described as follows:
Events Cause LEDs are turned ON or OFF by protection elements that have their respective
target settings selected as either “Self-Reset” or “Latched”. If a protection element target
setting is “Self-Reset”, then the corresponding Event Cause LEDs remain ON as long as the
operate operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element
target setting is “Latched”, then the corresponding Event Cause LEDs turn ON when the
operate operand associated with the element is asserted and will remain ON until the
RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
Default labels are shipped in the package of every 845, together with custom templates. A
custom LED template is available for editing and printing, refer to publication GET-20035
from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin. The default labels can be replaced by user-
printed labels. Customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations
where languages other than English are used to communicate with operators.
For LED and Pushbutton programming details, please refer to Front Panel.
FASTPATH:
The security icon only represents the security access level through the front panel.
NOTE:
Do not remove power from the relay whenever the Settings Save icon is ON. When power is
NOTE:
Relay Messages
Target Messages Target Messages are displayed in order of their activation, whereas in cases of
simultaneous activation, they are displayed in the order outlined below (from highest to
lowest priority):
1. Targets generated by pressing programmable pushbutton
2. Targets generated by Contact inputs
3. Targets generated by Protection, Control and Monitoring elements
4. Targets generated by communications.
In cases where the Pickup and Operate flags from an element are detected at the same
time, the Pickup flag is not displayed. The Operate flag is displayed instead.
LED #6, from the first column of LEDs, is factory configured to be triggered by the FlexLogic
operand ANY TARGET, to indicate the presence of at least one target message. This LED is
labeled as “MESSAGE”. The LED can be programmed to any other FlexLogic operand by
choice.
MESSAGE TIMEOUT:
The timeout applies to each screen other than the default screen. Examples include
viewing, metering, or navigating to a screen with setting, etc. If no further navigation is
performed, no pushbutton is touched, and/or no target is initiated for the time specified in
the message timeout setpoint, the display goes back to the default screen (the metering
summary screen).
The target message interrupts the message timeout. It overrides it. The message timeout
starts timing after each target message, and if no more activity is recorded for the
specified time, the display goes back to the default screen.
Pressing a programmable pushbutton activates a new screen with a Target Message
corresponding to the programmed PB action. The PB Target Message is displayed for 10
seconds then defaults to the screen that was displayed before pressing the pushbutton.
The PB Target Message is recorded in the list with other generated Target Messages.
Target Messages can be cleared either by pressing the PB corresponding to the tab
“CLEAR”, or by initiating a RESET command. The “CLEAR” command clears only the Target
Messages, while initiating a RESET clears not only the Target Messages, but also any
latched LEDs and output relays.
Self-Test Errors The relay performs self-diagnostics at initialization (after power up), and continuously as a
background task to ensure that the hardware and software are functioning correctly.
There are two types of self-test warnings indicating either a minor or major problem. Minor
errors indicate a problem with the relay that does not compromise protection and control
functionality of the relay. Major errors indicate a problem with the relay which takes it out
of service.
Self-Test Warnings may indicate a serious problem with the relay hardware!
CAUTION:
When a total loss of power is present, the Critical Failure Relay (Output Relay 8) is de-
NOTE:
energized.
NOTE
Out of Service When the relay is shipped from the factory, the DEVICE IN SERVICE is set to “Not Ready”.
The IN SERVICE LED will be orange and the critical fail relay will be de-energized but this will
not be classified as a major self-test. An out of service event will be generated in the event
recorder.
Flash Messages Flash messages are warning, error, or general information messages displayed in response
to pressing certain keys. The factory default flash message time is 2 seconds.
Label Removal
The 3 Pushbutton (Rugged and Membrane) front panels come with a label removal tool for
removing the LED label and user-programmable pushbutton label.
Templates for printing custom LED labels are available online at:
NOTE:
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/app/ViewFiles.aspx?prod=845&type=9.
NOTE
The following procedures describes how to use the label removal tool.
1. Bend the tabs of the tool upwards as shown in the image.
2. Slide the label removal tool under the LED label as shown in the next image. Make sure
the bent tabs are pointing away from the relay. Move the tool inside until the tabs
enter the pocket.
Software Interface
EnerVista 8 Series Setup Software
Although settings can be entered manually using the control panel keys, a PC can be used
to download setpoints through the communications port. The EnerVista 8 Series
Setup software is available from GE Multilin to make this as convenient as possible. With
EnerVista 8 Series Setup software running, it is possible to:
• Program and modify settings
• Load and save setting files to and from a disk
• Read actual values
• Monitor status
• Read pre-trip data and event records
• Get help on any topic
• Upgrade the 845 firmware
The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software allows immediate access to all 845 features with
easy to use pull down menus in the familiar Windows environment. This section provides
the necessary information to install EnerVista 8 Series Setup software, upgrade the relay
firmware, and write and edit setting files.
The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software can run without a 845 connected to the computer.
In this case, settings may be saved to a file for future use. If a 845 is connected to a PC and
communications are enabled, the 845 can be programmed from the setting screens. In
addition, measured values, status and trip messages can be displayed with the actual
value screens.
Hardware & Software The following requirements must be met for the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software.
Requirements • Dual-core processor
• Microsoft Windows™ 7 or 8.1; 32-bit or 64-bit is installed and running properly.
• At least 1 GB of free hard disk space is available.
• At least 2 GB of RAM is installed.
• 1280 x 800 display screen
The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software can be installed from the GE Multilin website at
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/.
Installing the After ensuring the minimum requirements indicated earlier, use the following procedure to
EnerVista 8 Series install the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software using the EnerVista Launchpad application
Setup Software (found on the GE Multilin website).
1. Double-click the installation package and follow the instructions to install the no-
charge EnerVista software on the local PC.
2. When installation is complete, start the EnerVista Launchpad application.
3. Click the IED Setup section of the LaunchPad toolbar.
4. In the EnerVista Launchpad window, click the Add Product button and select the
845 Protection System as shown below. Select the Web option to ensure the most
recent software release, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the
845.
5. EnerVista Launchpad obtains the latest installation software from the Web and
automatically starts the installation process. A status window with a progress bar is
shown during the downloading process.
6. Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software is being installed.
7. Click on Next to begin the installation. The files are installed in the directory indicated,
the USB driver is loaded into the computer, and the installation program automatically
creates icons and adds the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software to the Windows start
menu.
8. The 845 device is added to the list of installed IEDs in the EnerVista Launchpad
window, as shown below.
If you are going to communicate from your computer to the 845 Relay using the USB
port:
9. Plug the USB cable into the USB port on the 845 Relay then into the USB port on your
computer.
10. Launch EnerVista 8 Series Setup software from LaunchPad.
11. In EnerVista > Device Setup:
Upgrading the The latest EnerVista software and firmware can be downloaded from:
Software https://www.gegridsolutions.com/
After upgrading, check the version number under Help > About. If the new version does
not display, try uninstalling the software and reinstalling the new versions.
Using the Quick The Quick Connect button can be used to establish a fast connection through the front
Connect Feature panel USB port of a 845 relay, or through the Ethernet port. The following window appears
when the QuickConnect button is pressed:
As indicated by the window, the "Quick Connect" feature can quickly connect the EnerVista
8 Series Setup software to a 845 front port if the USB is selected in the interface drop-down
list. Select “USB” and press the Connect button. Ethernet or WiFi can also be used as the
interface for Quick Connect as shown next.
When connected, a new Site called “Quick Connect” appears in the Site List window.
The 845 Site Device has now been configured via the Quick Connect feature for either USB
or Ethernet communications. Proceed to Connecting to the Relay next, to begin
communications.
Configuring Ethernet Before starting, verify that the Ethernet cable is properly connected to the RJ-45 Ethernet
Communications port.
1. Install and start the latest version of the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software (available
from the GE Multilin Website). See the previous section for the installation procedure.
2. Click on the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window and click the Add
Site button to define a new site.
3. Enter the desired site name in the "Site Name" field. If desired, a short description of
the site can also be entered. In this example, we will use “Substation 1” as the site
name.
4. The new site appears in the upper-left list.
5. Click the Add Device button to define the new device.
6. Enter the desired name in the "Device Name" field, and a description (optional).
7. Select “Ethernet” from the Interface drop-down list. This displays a number of
interface parameters that must be entered for proper Ethernet functionality.
8. Enter the IP address, slave address, and Modbus port values assigned to the 845 relay
(from the Setpoints > Device > Communications menu).
9. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the 845 and upload the order code. If
a communications error occurs, ensure that the Ethernet communication values
correspond to the relay setting values.
10. Click OK when the relay order code has been received. The new device will be added
to the Site List window (or Online window) located in the top left corner of the main
EnerVista 8 Series Setup software window.
The 845 Site Device has now been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to
the following section to begin communications.
Configuring USB By default, the relay USB port uses the network address 172.16.0.2. In some cases this IP is
Address part of the corporate network for the computer and conflicts with existing computers or
other devices on that network. To resolve this conflict, change the USB address to be in a
different network. This change must be made to the computer settings, the relay settings,
and the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software settings in order to connect to the relay through
the USB port.
1. Open the Windows Control Panel and select Network and Internet > Network
Sharing.
The exact path may vary depending on the version of Windows.
NOTE:
NOTE
3. Find the GE RNDIS Device (or GE RNDIS Device #2) and right-click the network it is on
to open the Properties window.
4. Select Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4)and click Properties.
5. In the Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4) Properties window, ensure that Use the
following IP Address is selected, and enter an appropriate IP address.
6. Click OK to save the new settings.
7. In the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software, navigate to File > Preferences > USB and
change the IP address to match. This address will now be used by the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software when the interface selected is USB.
10. Change both the USB IP Address and USB GWY IP Address setpoints to match the
IP address the computer is now using.
The relay should now communicate with the computer through the USB port.
Connecting to the Now that the communications parameters have been properly configured,
Relay communications with the relay can be initiated.
1. Expand the Site list by double clicking on the site name or clicking on the «+» box to
list the available devices for the given site.
2. Desired device trees can be expanded by clicking the «+» box. The following list of
headers is shown for each device:
Device Definition
Status
Metering
Quick Setup
Setpoints
Records
Maintenance.
3. Expand the Setpoints > Device > Front Panel list item and double click on Display
Properties or Default Screens to open the settings window as shown:
4. The settings window opens with a corresponding status indicator on the lower left of
the EnerVista 8 Series Setup window.
5. If the status indicator is red, verify that the serial, USB, or Ethernet cable is properly
connected to the relay, and that the relay has been properly configured for
communications (steps described earlier).
The settings can now be edited, printed, or changed. Other setpoint and command
windows can be displayed and edited in a similar manner. "Actual Values" windows are
also available for display. These windows can be arranged, and resized, if desired.
Device > Installation) switches to "Not Ready" for the duration of the upload. This ensures
that all new settings are applied before the device is operational. Settings file upload
operations include the following:
• Enervista 8 Series Setup software menu option Write Settings File to Device
• Logic Designer changes saved online
• SLD configuration saved online
• IEC 61850 configuration saved online
• FlexLogic configuration saved online
• CID file uploaded to device
Individual setting changes from the device front panel or Enervista 8 Series Setup software
Online Window do not change the DEVICE IN SERVICE state.
Engaging a Device The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software may be used in on-line mode (relay connected) to
directly communicate with a relay. Communicating relays are organized and grouped by
communication interfaces and into sites. Sites may contain any number of relays selected
from the product series.
Entering Setpoints The System Setup page is used as an example to illustrate entering setpoints. In this
example, we are changing the voltage sensing setpoints.
1. Establish communications with the relay.
2. Select the Setpoint > System > Voltage Sensing menu item.
3. Select the Aux. VT Secondary setpoint by clicking anywhere in the parameter box. This
displays three arrows: two to increment/decrement the value and another to launch
the numerical keypad.
4. Clicking the arrow at the end of the box displays a numerical keypad interface used to
enter values within the setpoint range displayed near the top of the keypad: Click = to
exit from the keypad and keep the new value. Click on Xto exit from the keypad and
retain the old value.
6. In the Setpoints > System Setup > Voltage Sensing dialog box, click on Save to save
the values into the 845. Click YES to accept any changes and exit the window. Click
Restore to retain previous values. Click Default to restore Default values.
7. For setpoints requiring an alphanumeric text string (e.g. "relay name"), the value may
be entered directly within the setpoint value box.
When using Setpoint Groups, an element from one group can be dragged and dropped on
NOTE:
File Support Opening any EnerVista 8 Series Setup file automatically launches the application or
provides focus to the already opened application.
Using Setpoints Files The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software interface supports three ways of handling changes
to relay settings:
• In off-line mode (relay disconnected) to create or edit relay settings files for later
download to communicating relays.
• Directly modifying relay settings while connected to a communicating relay, then
saving the settings when complete.
• Creating/editing settings files while connected to a communicating relay, then saving
them to the relay when complete.
Settings files are organized on the basis of file names assigned by the user. A settings file
contains data pertaining to the following types of relay settings:
• Device Definition
• Relay Setup
• System Setup
• Protection
• Control
• Inputs/Outputs
• Monitoring
• FlexLogic
• Quick setup
• Protection summary
• IEC 61850 configurator
• Modbus user map
Factory default values are supplied and can be restored after any changes.
The 845 displays relay setpoints with the same hierarchy as the front panel display.
Downloading & Saving Back up a copy of the in-service settings for each commissioned unit, so as to revert to the
Setpoints Files commissioned settings after inadvertent, unauthorized, or temporary setting changes are
made, after the settings default due to firmware upgrade, or when the unit has to be
replaced. This section describes how to backup settings to a file and how to use that file to
restore settings to the original relay or to a replacement relay.
Setpoints must be saved to a file on the local PC before performing any firmware
upgrades. Saving setpoints is also highly recommended before making any setpoint
changes or creating new setpoint files.
The setpoint files in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup window are accessed in the Files Window.
Use the following procedure to download and save setpoint files to a local PC.
1. Ensure that the site and corresponding device(s) have been properly defined and
configured as shown in Connecting EnerVista 8 Series Setup to the Relay, above.
2. Select the desired device from the site list.
3. Select the Read Device Settingsfrom the online menu item, or right-click on the device
and select Read Device Settings to obtain settings information from the device.
4. After a few seconds of data retrieval, the software requests the name and destination
path of the setpoint file. The corresponding file extension is automatically assigned.
Press Receive to complete the process. A new entry is added to the tree, in the File
pane, showing path and file name for the setpoint file.
Adding Setpoints Files The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software provides the capability to review and manage a
to the Environment large group of setpoint files. Use the following procedure to add an existing file to the list.
1. In the offline pane, right-click on Files and select the Add Existing Settings File item
as shown:
2. The Open dialog box is displayed, prompting to select a previously saved setpoint file.
As for any other MS Windows® application, browse for the file to be added then click
Open. The new file and complete path will be added to the file list.
Creating a New The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software allows the creation of new setpoint files
Setpoints File independent of a connected device. These can be uploaded to a relay at a later date. The
following procedure illustrates how to create new setpoint files.
1. In the Offline pane, right click and select the New Settings File item. The following box
appears, allowing for the configuration of the setpoint file for the correct firmware
version. It is important to define the correct firmware version to ensure that setpoints
not available in a particular version are not downloaded into the relay.
2. Select the Firmware Version, and Order Code options for the new setpoint file.
3. For future reference, enter some useful information in the Description box to facilitate
the identification of the device and the purpose of the file.
4. To select a file name and path for the new file, click the button beside the File Name
box.
5. Select the file name and path to store the file, or select any displayed file name to
replace an existing file. All 845 setpoint files should have the extension ‘.cid’ (for
example, ‘845 1.cid’).
6. Click OK to complete the process. Once this step is completed, the new file, with a
complete path, is added to the 845 software environment.
Offline settings files can be created for invalid order codes in order to support file
NOTE:
conversion from different products, upgrades, and special orders. To validate an order
NOTE code, visit the GE Multilin online store.
File names for setting files cannot have a decimal point other than the one that is added in
NOTE:
front of CID.
NOTE
Upgrading Setpoints It is often necessary to upgrade the revision for a previously saved setpoint file after the
Files to a New 845 firmware has been upgraded. This is illustrated in the following procedure:
Revision 1. Establish communications with the 845 relay.
2. Select the Status > Information > Main CPU menu item and record the Firmware
Version.
3. Load the setpoint file to be upgraded into the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software
environment as described in the section, Adding Setpoints Files to the Environment.
4. In the File pane, select the saved setpoint file.
5. From the main window menu bar, select the Offline > Edit Settings File Properties
menu item and note the File Version of the setpoint file. If this version is different from
the Firmware Revision noted in step 2, select a New File Version that matches the
Firmware Revision from the pull-down menu.
6. For example, if the firmware revision is J0J08AA150.SFD (Firmware Revision 1.50) and
the current setpoint file revision is 1.10, change the New File Version to “1.5x”.
7. Enter any special comments about the setpoint file in the "Description" field.
8. Select the desired firmware version from the "New File Version" field.
9. When complete, click OKto convert the setpoint file to the desired revision. See
Loading Setpoints from a File below, for instructions on loading this setpoint file into
the 845.
Printing Setpoints The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software allows printing of partial or complete lists of
setpoints. Use the following procedure to print a list of setpoints:
1. Select a previously saved setpoints file in the File pane or establish communications
with a 845 device.
2. If printing from an online device, select the Online > Print Device Informationmenu
item. If printing from a previously saved setpoints file, select the Offline > Print
Settings File menu item.
3. The Print/Export Options dialog box appears. Select Setpoints in the upper section
and select either Include All Features (for a complete list) or Include Only Enabled
Features (for a list of only those features which are currently used) in the filtering
section and click OK.
4. Setpoint lists can be printed in the same manner by right clicking on the desired file (in
the file list) or device (in the device list) and selecting the Print Device Information or
Print Settings File options.
Printing Values from a A complete list of actual values can also be printed from a connected device with the
Connected Device following procedure:
1. Establish communications with the desired 845 device.
2. From the main window, select the Online > Print Device Information menu item
3. The Print/Export Options dialog box will appear. Select Actual Values in the upper
section and select either Include All Features (for a complete list) or Include Only
Enabled Features (for a list of only those features which are currently used) in the
filtering section and click OK.
Actual values lists can be printed in the same manner by right clicking on the desired
device (in the device list) and selecting the Print Device Information option.
Loading Setpoints
from a File
An error message occurs when attempting to upload a setpoint file with a revision
CAUTION:
number that does not match the relay firmware. If the firmware has been upgraded
since saving the setpoint file, see Upgrading Setpoints Files to a New Revision for
instructions on changing the revision number of a setpoint file.
The following procedure illustrates how to load setpoints from a file. Before loading a
setpoints file, it must first be added to the 845 environment as described in the section,
Adding Setpoints Files to the Environment.
1. Select the previously saved setpoints file from the File pane of the 845 software main
window.
2. Select the Offline > Edit Settings File Properties menu item and verify that the
corresponding file is fully compatible with the hardware and firmware version of the
target relay. If the versions are not identical, see Upgrading Setpoint Files to a New
Revision for details on changing the setpoints file version.
3. Right-click on the selected file and select the Write Settings File to Device item.
4. Select the target relay from the list of devices shown and click Send. If there is an
incompatibility, an error of the following type occurs:
If there are no incompatibilities between the target device and the settings file, the data is
transferred to the relay. An indication of the percentage completed is shown in the bottom
of the main window.
Uninstalling Files and The unit can be decommissioned by turning off the power to the unit and disconnecting
Clearing Data the wires to it. Files can be cleared after uninstalling the EnerVista software or the relay, for
example to comply with data security regulations. On the computer, settings files can be
identified by the .cid extension.
To clear the current settings file do the following:
1. Create a default settings file.
2. Write the default settings file to the relay.
3. Delete all other files with the .cid extension.
4. Delete any other data files, which can be in standard formats, such as COMTRADE or
.csv.
You cannot directly erase the flash memory, but all records and settings in that memory
can be deleted. Do this from the front panel or EnerVista software using:
RECORDS > CLEAR RECORDS
Quick Setup
The Quick Setup item is accessed from the EnerVista software from different screens.
Online and offline settings changes are made from the corresponding Quick Setup screen.
Quick Setup is designed for quick and easy user programming. Power system parameters,
and settings for some simple overcurrent elements are easily set. The Quick Setup screen
is shown as follows:
• Settings names and units can be viewed at this screen. To view the range of the
settings, hover the cursor over the setpoint value field.
• Configure and save the settings as required.
• The Save, Restore and Default buttons function the same as in the individual setting
setup screens.
• Attempting to enter and save a setting value which exceeds the range gives a
warning dialog box. (note the value is not replaced with the maximum value of the
setting). Correct the setting value and save to proceed.
Example:The Phase CT Primary value has a setting range of 1 to 12000, but the user
enters 12001 and tries to save it. Quick Setup displays a warning dialog. Pressing OK
leaves the setting value at 12001, but not 12000 (max. value) as is the case with other
views.
an 845 relay.
Before upgrading firmware, it is very important to save the current 845 settings to a file on
FASTPATH:
your PC. After the firmware has been upgraded, it will be necessary to load this file back
into the 845. Refer to Downloading and Saving Setpoints Files for details on saving relay
setpoints to a file.
Loading New Relay Loading new firmware into the 845 flash memory is accomplished as follows:
Firmware 1. Connect the relay to the local PC and save the setpoints to a file as shown in
Downloading and Saving Setpoints Files.
2. Select the Maintenance > Update Firmware menu item. The following screen
appears. Select OK to proceed.
3. The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software requests the new firmware file. Locate the
folder that contains the firmware file to load into the 845.
4. EnerVista 8 Series Setup software now prepares the 845 to receive the new firmware
file. The 845 front panel momentarily displays “Upload Mode”, indicating that it is in
upload mode.
5. The following screen appears, click YES to proceed with the firmware loading process.
6. After the Boot 2 upload is completed, the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software requests
that the user reboot the relay. After the Boot 1 upload is completed, the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software again requests that the user to reboot the relay.
Make sure to reboot the relay first and then press the OK. Not the other way around.
CAUTION:
After successfully updating the 845 firmware, the relay is not in service and requires
setpoint programming. To communicate with the relay, the communication settings may
have to be manually reprogrammed.
When communications is established, the saved setpoints must be reloaded back into the
relay. See Loading Setpoints from a File for details.
Modbus addresses assigned to features, settings, and corresponding data items (i.e.
default values, min/max values, data type, and item size) may change slightly from version
to version of firmware.
The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are
enhanced or modified.
SLD Configurator The SLD Configurator allows users to create customized single line diagrams (SLD) for the
front panel display. The SLDs must be configured from the SLD Configurator in the
EnerVista 8 Series Setup software, located under Setpoints > SLD Configurator. The SLD
Configurator allows breakers, switches, metering, and status items on the SLD.
Single line diagrams (SLD) are viewed from the relay front panel and individual SLD pages
can be selected for the default home screen pages. The 8 Series provides six (6) SLD pages.
Each page can have a combination of active and passive objects. Status, metering, and
control objects are active while the static images for bus, generator, motor, transformer,
ground, etc. are passive objects.
Figure 3-20: SLD Page
For optimum use, the first SLD page can be used for the overall single line diagram and the
subsequent pages can be used for breaker/switch specific CT/VT placement, metering and
status. Once the configurable SLDs are programmed, they are saved within the relay
settings file. The SLD pages can also be saved individually as local XML files. The locally
stored XML files can then be reloaded to generate another diagram. SLDs represent
objects using GE symbols (similar to ANSI).
The following figure shows the objects that are available for design in the SLD Configurator
and their maximum usage limits [X]. The maximum limit reflects the maximum possible
order code.
Control Objects
The control objects consist of selectable breakers and disconnect switches. The following
figure shows the different symbols in the GE Standard style and IEC style. If the switching
element is tagged, blocked, or bypassed, indicators with the letters “T”, “B”, and “By” appear
on the lower right corner of the element. Additionally, the breaker/switch name is
displayed on top of the object.
The displayed breaker name is configured in the setpoint Setpoints > System > Breakers >
NOTE:
Breaker[X] > Name. This setpoint has a 13-character limit. The name should be kept to a
NOTE minimum so that it appears properly on the SLD.
NOTE
The control objects status follows the color scheme from the Setpoints > Device > Front
Panel > Display Properties > Color Scheme setting. By default, this setting is set to “Green
(open)”. If set to “Red (open)”, the status colors are reversed.
If the setting is used, the breaker symbols automatically change to the Truck CB symbols.
The SLD assumes that if the Breaker Racked-In/Racked-Out input is used (any setting other
than “Off”), the appropriate Truck CB symbol will be used.
The following figure shows the orientation available for the control objects. The default
position for the control objects is 0 degrees. Orientation in multiple directions allows for
configuration of the single line diagram according to the existing drawings and ensure the
correct side for the fixed/moving contacts.
Status Objects
The status objects consist of digital operands. Up to 15 digital status elements can be
configured per SLD page. The status object acts as an LED on the screen. If the diagram
shows a circle with no color, it means the assigned input is low. If it shows a circle with red
color in it, the assigned input is high. The following figure shows an example of “Reclose
Blocked” signal in both On and Off state.
Figure 3-24: Reclose Blocked signal
In addition, Remote Breaker status objects are added for GE and IEC style. Remote breaker
status allows monitoring of three distant breakers. These objects are not controllable and
hence cannot be used for selection and operation.
Metering Objects
The metering objects consist of metering elements. Up to 15 metering elements can be
configured per SLD page. The metering object has an input for all the available FlexAnalog
values. The units for these values are dynamically scaled as per the defaults. The following
figure shows the metering element on a configured SLD.
and switches on the screen. Pressing up key rotates through in a reverse order. With the
membrane front panel, the up, down, left, and right keys can navigate to the closest
breaker/switch depending on the key press direction.
Rugged Membrane
Front Panel Front Panel
While browsing through switches/breakers the active element is shown with a blue
colored border around it. To select a breaker/switch, the browsing indicator border must
be around the desired breaker or switch. The breaker or switch can then be selected by
pressing the Enter key. As the breaker or switch is being selected, a flash message appears
indicating that the breaker or switch has been selected as shown in the following figure.
Once the element is selected for operation, the SLD control pushbuttons appear and the
color of the highlighter will change to maroon indicating that the breaker or switch is
selected. By default, the control pushbuttons are programmed for Tag, Block, and Bypass.
For each control action, a flash message is displayed. Refer to section Local Control Mode
(Recloser/breaker, Contactor and Switches).
Figure 3-26: Active element selection with flash message
Browsing and selection is allowed only when the relay is in Local Mode and the user has at
NOTE:
least an operator level of security access. To check if the relay is in local mode, look for an
NOTE “LM” symbol on the task pane at the top of the screen. Pressing navigation keys on SLD
pages while in remote mode does nothing.
Control pushbuttons appearing on the SLD page are only active while a control object is
NOTE:
selected.
NOTE
The control object is deselected if the user navigates to any screen other than SLD or by
NOTE:
pressing escape key. If no action is taken after selection, the object is automatically
NOTE deselected after the Bkr/Sw Select timeout setting (Setpoints > Control > Control Mode >
Bkr/Sw Select Timeout). Once deselected, the control pushbutton labels return to the SLD
page navigation labels and the color of the box around the object changes back to blue for
browsing. Pressing escape once more removes the browsing highlight around the objects.
If inactive during browsing for the timeout setting (Setpoints > Device > Front Panel >
Message Timeout), the browsing highlight around the object disappears. If an object is
selected, Home button operation will be prohibited. The object must be de-selected by
pressing escape in order for the home button to function.
Upgrading from firmware versions1.3x to 1.7x, the breaker operations from the front panel
NOTE:
Control Operations
The control operations carried out through the front panel of the relay are done only in
Local Mode (Setpoints > Control > Local Control Mode > Local Mode). Opening and closing
operations can be carried out by pressing the Open and Close pushbuttons on the relay
front panel. Other operations such as tagging, blocking and bypassing can be carried out
by pressing the control pushbuttons that appear after the control object selection.
Remote operations are allowed for opening, closing, blocking, and bypassing. Tagging
NOTE:
switch is tagged, it cannot be bypassed although the letters “By” may appear below the
NOTE element on SLD.
If breaker is selected and relay status is changed to Out-of-Service, the breaker control
NOTE:
actions, such as tag, blocked, bypass and open/close are blocked. The breaker may remain
NOTE in the selected state, but no action can be executed.
Once the selected breaker or switch is tagged, a letter “T” appears below the associated
element. Similarly, for blocking, letter “B” appears and for bypassing, letters “By” appear
below the associated breaker or switch as shown in the last column of the following figure.
The blocking and bypassing letters also appear if the breakers/switches are blocked or
bypassed remotely. These are linked to their respective breaker/switch in the SLD
Configurator window so that when that breaker/switch is deleted, the letters also get
deleted.
Permitted breaker/switch operations are described in the following figure below when
various letter indications are present under the control element.
Figure 3-27: Letter Indications for breaker/switch operations
For detailed tagging, blocking and bypassing operations, refer to the section Local Control
Mode (Recloser/breaker, Contactor and Switches).
FlexCurve Editor The FlexCurve Editor is designed to graphically view and edit the FlexCurve. The FlexCurve
Editor screen is shown as follows for FlexCurves A, B, C, and D:
• The Operate Curves are displayed, which can be edited by dragging the tips of the
curves
• A Base curve can be plotted for reference, to customize the operating curve. The Blue
colored curve in the picture is a reference curve. It can be Extremely Inverse, Definite
Time, etc.
• The Trip (Reset and Operate) Times in the tables and curves work interactively i.e.,
changing the table value affects the curve shape and vice versa.
• Save Configured Trip Times.
• Export Configured Trip Times to a CSV file
• Load Trip Times from a CSV File
• The screen above shows the model followed by 845 for viewing FlexCurves. Select
Initialize to copy the trip times from the selected curve to the FlexCurve.
Transient Recorder The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software can be used to capture waveforms (or view trace
(Waveform Capture) memory) from the relay at the instance of a pickup, trip, alarm, or other condition.
NOTE
Preference Button
The following window appears:
Change the color of each graph as desired, and select other options as required, by
checking the appropriate boxes. Click OK to store these graph attributes, and to close the
window. The Waveform Capture window reappears based on the selected graph
attributes.
To view a vector graph of the quantities contained in the waveform capture, press the View
Phasors button to display the following window:
Protection Summary Protection Summary is a single screen which holds the summarized information of
different settings from Grouped Elements and Monitoring Elements.
The Protection Summary Screen allows the user to:
• view the output relay (R3, R4) assignments for the elements
• modify the output relay assignments for the elements
• view the Function status for the elements
• navigate to the respective element screen on a button click.
With the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software running and communications established,
select the Setpoints > Protection Summary menu item to open the Protection Summary
window. The Protection Summary screen is as follows:
Convert SR 745 Files EnerVista 8 Series Setup software version 1.4x and abovesupports conversion of SR 745
files to 845 settings files.
The conversion can only be initialized with EnerVista from the Offline/New Settings File
commands located in the taskbar.
1. In the menu taskbar, click on Offline and select the New Settings File item. The
following Create New Setting s File dialog box appears, which allows for the setpoint
file conversion.
2. Select the Firmware Version and Order Code option for the new setpoint file.
3. For future reference, enter some useful information in the Description box to facilitate
the identification of the device and purpose for the file.
4. To select the file name and path for the new file, click the button beside the File Name
box.
5. To select the SR settings file used for initialization, click the Initialize Settings from SR
Settings File button.
6. To locate and select the file to convert, click the button beside the Initialize Settings
from SR Settings File box.
EnerVista 8 Series Setup version 1.4x and above supports conversion of 5.0, 5.1 and 5.2
CAUTION:
files. If the file version is less than 5.0 it must be converted to 5.2 using the latest 745
EnerVista Setup before doing the 845 conversion.
7. Click OK to begin the conversion and complete the process. Once this step is
completed, the new file, with a complete path, is added to the EnerVista 8 Series
Setup software environment.
Conversion Summary At the end of the conversion process, the results are summarized in a conversion report.
Report The report is found under Device Definition in the offline file window.
For future reference, make a printout of the conversion report immediately after the
CAUTION:
conversion in case conversion reports are removed or settings modified from the 8
Series Setup Software.
Results Window The following figure shows an example conversion summary results window.
Figure 3-29: Results Window
set to default and must be verified before putting the relay into service.
Status Icons
The status icon shows the conversion results:
Successful conversion
About Setpoints
The 845 has a considerable number of programmable setpoints, all of which make the
relay extremely flexible. These setpoints have been grouped into a variety of menus which
are available from the paths shown below. Each setpoints menu has sub-sections that
describe in detail the setpoints found on that menu.
Use the path provided to access the menus from the front panel and from the EnerVista 8
NOTE:
Certain named settings allow custom names. Do not create 13-character long names
NOTE:
using the largest width characters (i.e. WWWWWWWWWWWWW). Doing so can cause the
NOTE last 3 characters to overlap the setting name when viewed from the HMI or the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software.
Setpoints Device
System
Inputs
Outputs
Protection
Monitoring
Control
FlexLogic
Testing
Level 1 Level 2
the old output which is no longer used for closing, will automatically show up in the menu
NOTE of the elements with the default value “Do Not Operate”. The newly selected output is
automatically excluded from the list of outputs for selection under all element menus.
When excluded from the list of outputs for element menus, the output is inactive for any
element.
Programming Output Relays for breaker tripping and closing the breakers
The programming of the output relays for tripping individual breakers is performed once,
when selected under setpoint BKR 1(2,3) Trip Relay Select, and BKR 1(2,3) Close Relay
Select from the Setpoints/System/Breakers/Breaker 1(2,3) menu as shown:
PATH:SETPOINTS > SYSTEM > BREAKER 1 (2, 3)
From these screens, Relay 1, Relay 2, and Relay 9 are selected as default outputs for
tripping Breaker 1, Breaker 2, and Breaker 3 respectively. Output relays for closing the
breakers are not selected. The user can program any output relay from the list of output
relays for breaker tripping, or closing.
PROTECTION ELEMENT TRIP SELECTIONS
Selective tripping of the transformer breakers from the protection element can be
programmed from two places:
• From the Relay HMI: Protection Element Menu
• From the 845 PC program: Element’s Menu or Protection Summary
From the Relay HMI: Protection Element Menu
If Trip is selected as a “Function” for an element, and upon operation of that element, the
LED “TRIP” will turn on. Similarly when Alarm, or Latched Alarm is selected, upon element
operation, the LED “ALARM” will turn on. Selecting the “Configurable” setting is not
associated with an LED.
1. Select Trip from the list of selections available for the setpoint “Function”
2. Select the output relays for tripping the breakers, and any other aux relays if
necessary.
Selecting Trip as a function, does not automatically change the values of the breaker trip
NOTE:
selected output relays to “Operate” from the menus of the protection, control or
NOTE monitoring elements. Regardless of the selected element function, the values for all output
relays from the menu elements will show “Do Not Operate”. The user must select the
desired output relays to be energized upon element operation.
2. If necessary, select the output relays to operate as an Alarm upon IOC1 operation.
To distinguish the element functionality upon function selection, and to prevent the
user from making programming mistakes, a mechanism affecting the output relays
selected for breaker tripping is implemented and will activate upon changing the
function from Disabled to Alarm, Latched Alarm, or Configurable.
– The output relays selected for tripping of the breakers will be de-activated in the
IOC1 element menu. The rest of the outputs are fully programmable and
operational.
– The setting for these trip selected output relays can be changed, i.e. from "Do Not
Operate" to "Operate", but the physical relay will not be energized. This is to
prevent the user to operate the trip output relay by mistake, when the function is
used as Alarm, or Configurable.
Changing the function back to be fully “Trip”, will enable the breaker trip selected
output relays from the IOC1 menu to be programmable.
Element Menu - The element function can be set as Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, or
Configurable. Depending on the selected function, the relay applies the following rules:
Example 1: Programming an IOC1 element as a Trip function
1. Select Output Relays 1 and 2 to trip breaker 1 and 2 respectively.
Figure 4-2: Transformer Breakers setup
Protection Summary- The selections of Function, and the selection of output relays for
“Operate”/”Do Not Operate” for each element are reflected in the Protection Summary
window as shown.
Once the Protection Summary window is open, the user can change the setting “Operate”/
”Do Not Operate” for any output relay, except the ones selected for breaker close, by
checking/unchecking the appropriate box. The user can also access the individual menu
for any of the listed elements, and make changes.
Figure 4-4: Protection Summary screen
Use the protection summary window for programming all of the elements and output
NOTE:
relays needed for the application. Please note, that the output relays selected for breaker
NOTE closing are excluded from the menus of all elements, and they are made inactive (cannot
be selected) in the Protection Summary menu. The check boxes related to these outputs
automatically become inactive, and they cannot be checked/unchecked by the user.
The check boxes for the relay outputs assigned for breaker tripping will automatically
NOTE:
Common Setpoints
To make the application of this device as simple as possible, similar methods of operation
and similar types of setpoints are incorporated in various features. Rather than repeat
operation descriptions for this class of setpoint throughout the manual, a general
description is presented in this overview. Details that are specific to a particular feature are
included in the discussion of the feature. The form and nature of these setpoints is
described below.
• FUNCTION setpoint: The <ELEMENT_NAME> FUNCTION setpoint determines the
operational characteristic of each feature. The range for this setpoint is: “Disabled”,
“Trip”, “Alarm”, “Latched Alarm”, and “Configurable”.
If the FUNCTION setpoint is selected as “Disabled”, then the feature is not operational.
If the FUNCTION setpoint is selected as “Trip”, then the feature is operational. When
the “Trip” function is selected and the feature operates, the output relay #1 “Trip”
operates, and the LED “TRIP” is lit.
If the FUNCTION setpoint is selected as “Alarm” or “Latched Alarm”, then the feature is
operational. When this function is selected, and the feature operates, the LED “ALARM”
is lit, and any assigned auxiliary output relay operates. The “Trip” output relay does
not operate, and the LED “TRIP” is not lit.
When Alarm function is selected and the feature operates, the LED “ALARM” flashes,
and it self-resets when the operating conditions are cleared.
When Latched Alarm function is selected, and the feature operates, the LED “ALARM”
will flash during the operating condition, and will be steady lit after the conditions are
cleared. The LED “ALARM” can be reset by issuing reset command.
If the FUNCTION setpoint is selected as “Configurable”, the feature is fully operational
but outputs are not driving any action, such as output relay #1, Alarm LED or anything
else. Operands from this element must be programmed to a desirable action which
may be as simple as the auxiliary output relay from the list of available relays in the
element itself, FlexLogic, Trip Bus etc.
The FlexLogic operands generated by the operation of each feature are active, and
NOTE:
• PICKUP: The setpoint selects the threshold equal to or above (for over elements) or
equal to or below (for under elements) which the measured parameter causes an
output from the measuring element.
• PICKUP DELAY: The setpoint selects a fixed time interval to delay an input signal from
appearing as an output.
• DROPOUT DELAY: The setpoint selects a fixed time interval to delay dropping out the
output signal after being generated.
• TDM: The setting provides a selection for Time Dial Multiplier which modifies the
operating times per the selected inverse curve. For example, if an IEEE Extremely
Inverse curve is selected with TDM=2, and the fault current is 5 times bigger than the
PKP level, operation of the element can not occur before an elapsed time of 2.59 s
from Pickup.
• OUTPUT RELAYS: The <ELEMENT_NAME> RELAYSsetpoint selects the relays required to
operate when the feature generates an output. The range is “Operate” or “Do Not
Operate”, and can be applied to any combination of the auxiliary output relays. The
default setting is “Do Not Operate”.
The available auxiliary relays vary depending on the order code.
When IP addresses are changed and sent as a Settings file the unit reboots twice.
FASTPATH:
Logic Diagrams
Refer to the logic diagrams provided for a complete understanding of the operation of
each feature. These sequential logic diagrams illustrate how each setpoint, input
parameter, and internal logic is used in a feature to obtain an output. In addition to these
logic diagrams, the Setpoints chapter provides written descriptions for each feature.
• Setpoints: Shown as a block with a heading labeled ‘SETPOINT’. The exact wording of
the displayed setpoint message identifies the setpoint. Major functional setpoint
selections are listed below the name and are incorporated in the logic.
• Comparator Blocks: Shown as a block with an inset box labeled ‘RUN’ with the
associated pickup/dropout setpoint shown directly above. Element operation of the
detector is controlled by the signal entering the ‘RUN’ inset. The measurement/
comparison can only be performed if a logic ‘1’ is provided at the ‘RUN’ input.
The relationship between a setpoint and input parameter is indicated by the following
symbols: “<” (less than), “>” (greater than), etc.
• Pickup and Dropout Time Delays: Shown as a block with indication of two timers –
the tPKP (Pickup Delay), and tDPO(Dropout Delay).
• LED Indicators: Shown as the following schematic symbol (X).
• Logic: Described with basic logic gates (AND, OR, XOR, NAND, NOR). The inverter
(logical NOT), is shown as a circle: O
• FlexLogic operands: Shown as a block with a heading labeled ‘FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS’.
Each feature produces output flags (operands) which can be used further for creating
logic in the FlexLogic equation editor, or Trip Bus, or can be directly assigned to trigger
an output. The operands from all relay features constitute the list of FlexLogic
operands.
This chapter describes the Device, System, Input and Output setpoint menu settings in
detail.
Device
Figure 5-1: Device Display Hierarchy
Custom Configuration
Modbus Protocol
Real Time Clock
RS485
Security USB
Communications Wi-Fi
Setpoints Device
Ethernet
System Transient Recorder
Routing
Annunciator
Installation
Display Properties
Default Screens
Default Screens
Custom Configuration
The custom configuration features allow customization of the 8 Series configurations in
such a way that the user experience of the 8 Series platform is further enhanced.
Configuration Mode
Modern multifunctional Intelligent Electronic Devices (IEDs), such as the 8 Series platform,
support a multitude of functions and features which include: Protection and Control (P&C),
Asset Monitoring, Flexible Logic Engine (FlexLogic), Records and Reporting, Time
Synchronization, Testing/Simulation, etc. Taking into consideration user experience,
configuration mode controls how the “Setpoints” are presented by only displaying settings
that are typically used, or settings that are important to configure.
There are two configuration modes supported: Simplified, and Regular.
• In Simplified configuration mode, some of the advanced functions/features or a few
settings under a function are hidden or made read-only (greyed out).
• In Regular configuration mode, all function/features and setpoints of the device are
editable and nothing is hidden or greyed out.
Simplified configuration mode does not remove any functionality or setting from the
device. It only controls the view or display of the settings. All the settings made in Regular
configuration mode are still applied during simplified mode (they are either hidden or read-
only). Therefore, simplified configuration mode can also be viewed as locking advanced
setpoints.
Configuration mode is applicable to the “Setpoints” items only and does not control view/
presentation to other Main menu items, such as Device Definition, Status, Metering,
Records, Commands and Maintenance. The configuration mode setting is available to be
changed by the “Administrator” role. The configuration mode control is applicable to
device HMI and setup software, as well as online and offline setting files.
Configuration mode does not disable the device functionality or settings. It only controls
NOTE:
the view or presentation on the HMI and setup software screens. Therefore, settings which
NOTE are hidden or Read-only are preserved and applied within the device.
The homepage shows the home icon which changes color according to the configuration
mode. When in Simplified configuration mode, the home icon color changes to green.
“Input” is hidden but configured as “Phasor” during Regular mode, therefore Phase TOC 1
NOTE still applies “Phasor” as an input. Similarly, “Reset” is read-only, and Phase TOC 1 still
applies “Instantaneous” for resetting. The read-only settings are greyed out.
Figure 5-2: Comparing the setpoints for Regular and Simplified mode
5HJXODr Simplified
..\Current\Phase TOC 1 ..\Current\Phase TOC 1
Item Name Value Unit Item Name Value Unit
Function Disabled Function Disabled
Signal Input CT Bank 1 -J1 Signal Input CT Bank 1 -J1
Input Phasor
Pickup 1.000 x CT
Pickup 1.000 x CT
Curve IEEE Mod Inverse
Curve IEEE Mod Inverse
TDM 1.00
TDM 1.00
Reset Instantaneous
Reset Instantaneous
Direction Disabled Direction Disabled
Voltage Restraint Disabled Voltage Restraint Disabled
Volt Lower Limit 0.1 p.u. Relays Do Not Operate
Block Off PTOC 1
Relays Do Not Operate
Events Enabled
Targets Self-Reset
PTOC 1
5HJXODr Simplified
..\Setpoints\Inputs ..\Setpoints\Inputs
Item Name Item Name
Contact Inputs Contact Inputs
Virtual Inputs Analog Inputs
Analog Inputs
Remote Inputs
Inputs MA In
Real-time Clock
Path:Setpoints > Device > Real Time Clock
The 845 is capable of receiving a time reference from several time sources in addition to its
own internal clock for the purpose of time-stamping events, transient recorders and other
occurrences within the relay. The accuracy of the time stamp is based on the time
reference that is used. The 845 supports an internal clock, SNTP, IRIG-B, and PTP IEEE 1588
(version 2)as potential time references.
If two or more time sources are available, the time source with the higher priority shown in
Time Sources table is used where 1 is considered to be the highest priority. Please note
that the time source priority of PTP and IRIG-B can be swapped. If both PTP and IRIG-B are
available to the 845, by default the 845 clock syncs to PTP over IRIG-B. If PTP is not
available the 845 CPU syncs the internal clock to IRIG-B.
Table 5-1: Time Sources
Time Source Priority
PTP (IEEE1588) 1*
Clock Path:Setpoints > Device > Real Time Clock > Clock
DATE
Format: Month/Day/Year
Range: Month: 1 to 12; Day: 1 to 31; Year: 2008 to 2094
Default: 01/01/2008
TIME
Range: 0 to 23: 0 to 59:0 to 59
Default: 00:00:00
LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC
Range: –24.0 to 24.0 hrs in steps of 0.5 hrs
Default: 0.0 hrs
REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
IRIG-B
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
DST START MONTH
Range: January to December (all months)
Default: Not Set
DST START DAY
Range: SUN to SAT (all days of the week)
Default: Not Set
DST START WEEK
Range: 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, Last
Default: Not Set
DST START HOUR
Range: 0 to 23
Default: 2
DST END MONTH
Range: January to December (all months)
Default: Not Set
DST END WEEK
Range: 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, Last
Default: Not Set
IRIG-B
IRIG-B is available in all 8 Series relays. A failure on IRIG-B triggers an event and a target
message.
Note that IRIG-B is auto detected. The signal type is detected in the hardware, so there are
FASTPATH:
no configurable options.
PTP Configuration Path:Setpoints > Device > Real Time Clock > Precision Time
PORT 4(5) PTP FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
When the port setting is selected as “Disabled,” PTP is disabled on the port. The relay
does not generate, or listen to, PTP messages on the port.
PORT 4(5) PATH DELAY ADDER
Range: 0 to 60000 ns in steps of 1 ns
Default: 0 ns
The time delivered by PTP is advanced by the time value in the setting prior to the time
being used to synchronize the relay’s real time clock. This is to compensate for time
delivery delays not compensated for in the network. In a fully compliant Power Profile
(PP) network, the peer delay and the processing delay mechanisms compensate for all
the delays between the grandmaster and the relay. In such networks, the setting is zero.
In networks containing one or more switches and/or clocks that do not implement both
of these mechanisms, not all delays are compensated, so the time of message arrival at
the relay is later than the time indicated in the message. The setting can be used to
approximately compensate for the delay. Since the relay is not aware of network
switching that dynamically changes the amount of uncompensated delay, there is no
setting that always completely corrects for uncompensated delay. A setting can be
chosen that reduces worst-case error to half of the range between minimum and
maximum uncompensated delay if these values are known.
PORT 4(5) PATH DELAY ASYMMETRY
Range: -1000 to +1000 ns in steps of 1 ns
Default: 0 ns
The setting corresponds to “Delay Asymmetry” in PTP, which is used by the peer delay
mechanism to compensate for any difference in the propagation delay between the two
directions of a link. Except in unusual cases, the two fibers are of essentially identical
length and composition, so the setting is set to zero.
In unusual cases where the length of link is different in different directions, the setting is
to be set to the number of nanoseconds longer the Ethernet propagation delay is to the
relay compared with the mean of path propagation delays to and from the relay. For
instance, if it is known say from the physical length of the fibers and the propagation
speed in the fibers that the delay from the relay to the Ethernet switch it is connected to
is 9000 ns and that the delay from the switch to the relay is 11000 ns, then the mean
delay is 10000 ns, and the path delay asymmetry is +1000 ns.
SNTP Protocol 845 Transformer Protection System relays accept time synchronization from up to two
different SNTP servers. In order to define number of SNTP servers to be used, different
settings for each SNTP server must be configured.
• If one SNTP server is used to synchronize the relay, the SNTP Server and UDP port
settings must be configured with the corresponding settings.
• If two SNTP servers are used to synchronize the relay, the SNTP Server IP and UDP port
for the main server must be configured, along with the SNP Server 2 IP and UDP port
for the back-up server.
845 Transformer Protection System relays only support SNTP unicast.
NOTE:
It may take 2-3 minutes for the relay to synchronize with the SNTP server.
NOTE
Security
The following security features are available:
• Basic Security – The basic security feature present in the default offering of the
product.
• CyberSentry – The feature refers to the advanced security options available as a
software option. When this option is purchased, it is automatically enabled and Basic
Security is disabled.
GENERAL RULES FOR ROLES
• All the roles are password protected, except for the Observer role which is user-
defined on the device. A user with Observer capability defined on the Radius is
password protected.
• All the roles, except for the Observer role, support only one session at one time.
• The Observer role has read-only access to all values in the relay except for one service
command which is described in the Password Recovery Procedure section.
• All the roles, except for the Observer, have access to a “log out” setting, which has the
effect of switching to Observer role.
• A Setpoint access setting for bypassing security is available. If this feature is used, the
user gains total access to any operations / configuration changes executed either
from the front panel or from EnerVista.
• The setpoint access setting may be either switched directly on or assigned to a digital
input.
• If the setpoint access setting is assigned to a digital input, the digital input needs to be
activated through a physical key (jumper).
• The setpoint access setting may be set only by an Administrator.
PASSWORD COMPLEXITY
The password complexity is available on both Basic Security and CyberSentry.
If password complexity is enabled, a user account requires an alpha-numeric password
that meets the following requirements:
• Passwords cannot contain the user account name or parts of the user's full name that
exceed two consecutive characters
• Passwords must be 6 to 20 characters in length
• Passwords must contain characters from three of the following four categories:
- English uppercase characters (A through Z)
- English lowercase characters (a through z)
- Base 10 digits (0 through 9)
- Non-alphabetic characters (for example, ~, !, @, #, $,%,&)
PASSWORD RECOVERY PROCEDURE
In the event of losing all passwords, the 845 can be reset to factory defaults by following
the procedure below:
1. Send an email to the customer support department providing a valid serial number
and using a recognizable corporate email account. (Worldwide e-mail:
[email protected])
2. Customer support provides the code to reset the relay to factory defaults.
3. Enter the code provided from the front panel, under the menu Setpoints > Device >
Installation > Service Command to reset the relay to factory defaults.
Note that even an Observer may execute this operation.
NOTE:
NOTE
• The current limitation for the maximum number of Observer sessions from EnerVista
NOTE:
Basic Security The 8 Series Basic Security supports three roles: Administrator, Operator and Observer.
The Main Settings Structure is available from Path:Setpoints > Device > Security.
LOGIN
The setting allows a user to login with a specific role.
1. Whenever a new role is logged in, the user is prompted to enter a password.
2. If the wrong password is entered, an “Authentication Failed!” message is displayed
3. If the maximum failed authentications occur an “Account Blocked!” message is
displayed.
4. The Observer is the default choice and it does not require a password.
LOGOUT
This setting logs out the current user and logs in as Observer. If the user is already an
Observer, this setting does not apply. When logging out, a switch to Observer role is
performed.
CHANGE PASSWORDS
1. The Change local passwords menu is shown on the front panel and EnerVista on a
successful login of Administrator role.
2. If password complexity is enabled, the rules as defined in the Password Complexity
section must be obeyed. If password complexity is disabled this setting accepts 1 to
20 alphanumeric characters.
See Path:Setpoints > Device > Security > Change Local Passwords.
3. The default password is “0”, which is programmed from the factory.
4. The “login setting” in this menu is similar to that in the parent security settings.
5. The Observer does not have password associated with it. So there is no need to show
it in the list of password changing roles.
LOAD FACTORY DEFAULTS
The Administrator role can change this setting. This setting resets all the settings,
communication and Security passwords, and all records.
ACCESS LOCKOUT
Access lockout is the number of failed authentications (the default is 3 and the maximum is
99) before the device blocks subsequent authentication attempts for the lockout period. A
value of 0 shall mean Lockout is disabled.
ACCESS LOCKOUT PERIOD
Access lockout period is the period of time in minutes of a lockout (the default is 3 and the
maximum is 9999). A value of “0” means that there is no lockout period.
ACCESS TIMEOUT
Access timeout is the time of idleness before a logged in user is automatically logged out.
This timeout applies to all users, independent of the communication channel (serial,
Ethernet or direct access).
PASSWORD COMPLEXITY
This setting is available so that the option of selecting between simple passwords and
complex ones is provided.
• The setting is only available to Administrator.
• By default password complexity is disabled.
• When password complexity is enabled, it follows the rules defined in the Password
Complexity section.
OPERATOR PIN PASSWORD
This setting allows a numeric password for the Operator even when Password Complexity
is enabled. When the Operator PIN password is enabled, a virtual numeric keypad is shown
instead of a virtual keyboard. By default, Operator PIN password is disabled. Changing this
setting changes the Operator password to the default “0”.
SETPOINT ACCESS
This setting is only available to Administrator. The setpoint access is used for the purpose
of bypassing security. It can be either switched on or assigned to a digital input. If assigned
to a digital input, the digital input needs to be activated through a physical key.
If the maximum number of Observer roles already logged in on the relay has been reached,
NOTE:
you must log in on the Security screen within one minute of making the connection
NOTE otherwise your session is terminated.
Commands may be issued freely through protocols other than Modbus (e.g., DNP, IEC 104,
FASTPATH:
and, IEC 61850) without user-authentication or encryption of data taking place, even if the
relay has the advanced security feature enabled.
Login
Logout
Device Authentication
Access Lockout
Access Timeout
Real Time Clock
Security
Setpoints Device Password Complexity
Data
Security
Capture
Syslog IP Address
Setpoint Access
New Password
Change Administrator
Password
Confirm Password
New Password
Change Operator
Password
Confirm Password
Communications
SECURITY SETTINGS
LOGIN
Range: Administrator, Operator, Observer
Default: Observer
The setting allows a user to login with a specific role.
– Whenever a new role is logged in, the user is prompted to enter a password.
– If the wrong password is entered, an “Authentication Failed!” message is
displayed.
– If the maximum failed authentications occur, the “Account Blocked!” message is
displayed.
– The Observer is the default choice and it does not require a password.
LOGOUT
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
This setting logs out the current user. When logging out from the panel, a switch to the
Observer role is performed.
DEVICE AUTHENTICATION
Range: Yes, No
Default: Yes
Device authentication setting offers the option to disable or enable this type of
authentication. By default device authentication is on, but the option to turn it off is
provided and may be chosen when a RADIUS server is accessible and will be used
exclusively.
Only an administrator role may change this setting. If administrator disables it, the role
remains logged in, but it is not allowed to write any other settings. In EnerVista a popup
window warns that such changes are not going to be saved.
If device authentication is disabled, EnerVista still displays both radio buttons for
choosing between device and server authentication. See the EnerVista setup section.
However the drop down menu, when local is selected, has only the Administrator option.
Once logged in, this role is only able to switch on device authentication. After switching
on the device authentication, the Administrator gains write access to all the other
settings without the need to logout and login again.
LOAD FACTORY DEFAULTS
Range: Yes, No
Default: No
An Administrator role is able to change this setting. This resets all the settings,
communication and security passwords, and all records.
ACCESS LOCKOUT
Range: 0-99
Default: 3
The Access lockout is the set number of failed authentications (the default is 3 and the
maximum is 99) before the device blocks subsequent authentication attempts for the
lockout period. A value of “0” means Lockout is disabled.
ACCESS LOCKOUT PERIOD
Range: 0-9999 minutes
Default: 3 minutes
The Access lockout period is the set period of time in minutes of a lockout (the default is
3 and the maximum is 9999). A value of “0” means that there is no lockout period.
Note that the lockout period is measured from the moment the maximum number of failed
NOTE:
authentications has been reached. Additional attempts to login during the lockout period
NOTE do not extend this time.
ACCESS TIMEOUT
Range: 2-999 minutes
Default: 5 minutes
The Access timeout is the time of idleness before a logged in user is automatically
logged out. This timeout setting applies to all users, independent of the communication
channel (serial, Ethernet or direct access).
– Each password change menu has two settings: New Password and Confirm
Password.
– With password complexity enabled, each setting may take 6 to 20 alphanumeric
characters. With password complexity disabled, each setting takes 1 to 20
alphanumeric characters.
– If password complexity is enabled, its rules, as defined in the section Password
Complexity, must be obeyed.
– The default password is “0”.
– The Observer does not have a password associated with it. So there is no need to
show it in the list of password changing roles.
ENERVISTA SETUP
For the software setup the following applies:
• Some Security Settings (such as Radius configuration) are only accessible and
configurable through the EnerVista setup program.
• The EnerVista software only allows for changes that are permitted by the user’s
logged in role. For example, the Observer role cannot write to any settings, but can
only view.
• If the settings file is modified off line, EnerVista checks for the role of the user trying to
download it and allows the download only if the role is Administrator (see table below).
If the role is different, EnerVista notifies the user that this operation is allowed only for
Administrators (e.g., via a pop-up window).
• The EnerVista Login Screen has two radio buttons to choose between device and
server authentication.
– If server authentication is chosen, the screen provides “User Name:” and
“Password:” fields
– If device authentication is chosen the “User Name:” field changes to a drop down
menu.
If device authentication is enabled internally, the drop down menu contains all
predefined roles on the 8 Series.
If device authentication is disabled, the drop down menu has only the
Administrator option. This is to allow for switching on the device authentication.
Once logged in, the Administrator is only able to turn on the device
authentication, but once the device authentication is enabled, access to all the
other settings is granted.
• A file download may be performed only from EnerVista.
Table 5-2: Role and File Access Table
Role: Administrator Operator Observer
File access:
Read All files Yes Yes Yes
(Download from 845)
In special cases security settings, such as RADIUS IP address and port, if modified offline,
NOTE:
can result in interruption of service when applied online, if the user is not aware of the
NOTE change having been made. For this reason, if these settings have been modified, offline,
they will not be written during the file write operation.
RADIUS SETTINGS
The following are settings that need to be configured through EnerVista, in order to set up
communication with a Radius server on 845. For configuring the RADIUS server itself,
consult the RADIUS documentation. An example is provided, see Communications Guide.
Table 5-3: Radius Settings
Setting Description Min Max Default Unit Minimum
Name s Permission
s
Primary IP address of primary 0.0.0.0 223.255.255.2 0.0.0.0 - Administrat
Radius IP Radius server. 54 or
Address Default value
indicates no Primary
Radius server is
configured, and so
Radius is disabled.
Primary Radius 1 65535 1812 - Administrat
Authenticati authentication port or
on Port
Vendor ID An identifier that 1 65535 Value that - Administrat
specifies Radius represents or
vendor specific General Electric
attributes used with (2910)
the protocol.
Radius Authentication EAP-TTLS EAP-TTLS EAP-TTLS - Administrat
Authenticati method used by or
on Method Radius server.
Currently fixed to
EAP-TTLS.
Timeout Timeout in seconds in 0 9999 10 sec Administrat
between re- or
transmission
requests
Retries Number of retries 0 9999 3 - Administrat
before giving up or
Radius Shared Secret used in See 245 N/A - Administrat
Authenticati authentication. It is password characters or
on (Shared) only displayed as section
Secret asterisks. This setting for
must meet the requireme
CyberSentry nts
password
requirements.
Confirm Confirmation of the See 245 N/A - Administrat
Radius shared secret. Only password characters or
Authenticati display as asterisks. section
on (Shared) for
Secret requireme
nts
SECURITY EVENTS
• The event recorder records the events described in the table Security Events.
Table 5-4: Security Events
Event Record Level Description
FAILED_AUTH, ORIGIN, Warning (4) A failed authentication with time stamp in
TIMESTAMP UTC time when it occurred.
USER_LOCKOUT, ORIGIN, Error (3) The user lockout has occurred because of
TIMESTAMP: too many failed authentication attempts.
SETTING_CHG, ORIGIN, Notice (5) An event to indicate setting change(s).
TIMESTAMP:
LOGIN, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP: Warning (4) An event to indicate when a certain role
logged in.
LOGOUT, ORIGIN, TIMESTAMP: Warning (4) An event to indicate when a certain role
logged out or timed out.
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
The following operands are added for CyberSentry.
Communications
8 Series relays have a two-stage communications capability. The base CPU supports
Modbus protocol through the Ethernet, USB, serial and WiFi port. In addition, the base CPU
also supports IEC 103, DNP serial, DNP TCP/IP, and TFTP protocol. Once the
communications module option is added to the base, the base Ethernet port becomes
disabled but the two Ethernet ports on the communications module have enhanced
communications capabilities such as IEC61850 Ed.2, IEC62439 parallel redundancy
protocol (PRP) and IEEE 1588 Precision Time Protocol (PTP version 2). The communications
CPU also supports Modbus TCP, IEC 104, DNP TCP, TFTP, SFTP, and SNTP protocol.
Modbus Protocol All Ethernet ports and serial communication ports support the Modbus protocol. The only
exception is if the serial port has been configured for DNP or IEC 60870-5-103 operation
(see descriptions below). This allows the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software (which is a
Modbus master application) to communicate to the 845.
The 845 implements a subset of the Modicon Modbus RTU serial communication standard.
The Modbus protocol is hardware-independent. That is, the physical layer can be any of a
variety of standard hardware configurations. This includes USB, RS485, fiber optics, etc.
Modbus is a single master / multiple slave type of protocol suitable for a multi-drop
configuration.
The 845 is always a Modbus slave with a valid slave address range 1 to 254.
DATA FRAME FORMAT AND DATA RATE
One data frame of an asynchronous transmission to or from an 845 typically consists of 1
start bit, 8 data bits, and 1 stop bit. This produces a 10-bit data frame. This is important for
transmission through modems at high bit rates. Modbus protocol can be implemented at
any standard communication speed. The 845 supports operation at 9600, 19200, 38400,
57600, and 115200 bps baud rate. The USB interface supports ModBus TCP/IP.
NOTE
When this setting is changed to Function Code 03h, retrieving configuration settings
NOTE:
RS485 On the rear card 8 Series relays are equipped with one RS485 serial communication port
and one 10/100 Mbps Ethernet port. The RS485 port has settings for baud rate and parity.
It is important that these parameters agree with the settings used on the computer or
other equipment connected to this port. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained
and connected to a DCS, PLC or a PC using the RS485 port.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Communications > RS485
BAUD RATE
Range: 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200
Default: 115200
PARITY
Range: None, Odd, Even
Default: None
PORT PROTOCOL
Range: Modbus, DNP 3.0, IEC 60870-5-103
Default: Modbus
Wi-Fi Wi-Fi refers to Wireless Local Area Networks (WLANs) that are based on the 802.11 set of
standards. WLANs are essentially providing Local Area Network (LAN) type of connectivity
but without the need of cables, which makes them more convenient for use in limited
spaces. Wi-Fi works on top of the TCP/IP stack, the same as Ethernet. The signal strength
and its range is determined by the wireless device’s antenna technology and standard, the
best being IEEE 802.11n.
Wi-Fi defines two modes of operation, namely ad-hoc, used for small deployments, and
infrastructure mode, which supports more robust types of security and better capabilities
for centralized management. The infrastructure mode requires an access point (AP).
Devices operating in this mode pass all data through the AP.
The Wi-Fi module integrated on the 8 Series products conforms to IEEE 802.11b/g/n
standards. The 8 Series devices operate in infrastructure mode. Security is optional, but
enabled by default and it is advisable that it is left on, as wireless traffic is very susceptible
to cyber-attacks.
The security technology used is WPA2 (Wireless Protected Access version 2), based on the
IEEE 802.11i standard for data encryption. WPA2 is a second version of WPA technology,
designed to solve known security limitations found in one of the encryption algorithms
used by WPA, namely TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol). WPA2 uses CCMP (Counter
Mode with Cipher Block Chaining Message Authentication Code Protocol), which provides
an enhanced data cryptographic encapsulation mechanism based on AES (Advanced
Encryption Standard). CCMP makes WPA2 much stronger and secure than its predecessors,
WPA and WEP.
Several forms of WPA2 security keys exist. The 8 Series supports WPA2 PSK (Pre-Shared
Key), which utilizes 64 hexadecimal digits. The key may actually be entered as a string of 64
hexadecimal digits or as a passphrase of 8 to 32 printable ASCII characters. For user
convenience, the settings accept the key in the form of a passphrase. Internally the ASCII
passphrase is used for deriving a 256-bit key.
The following are the Wi-Fi network settings for the 8 Series product. Only an Administrator
has the rights to change them.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Communications > Wi-Fi
WiFi Enable
This setting switches Wi-Fi functionality on/off. By default Wi-Fi is enabled in the basic
offering, but it is disabled in software options that offer CyberSentry.
WiFi IP Address / Subnet Mask
The default IP address is 192.168.0.x, where x is calculated as:
X = (modulo 242 of the last 3 digits of the serial number) + 12
Example: A unit has a serial number of MJ3A16000405, the default IP address would be
192.168.0.175 (where 405 mod 242 = 163 + 12 = 175).
This is to ensure uniqueness of the default IP address for all 8 Series devices present on one
wireless network and it creates a usable address space from 192.168.0.12 to
192.168.0.253 for 8 Series devices.
From the remaining range of unicast addresses 192.168.0.1 to 192.168.0.253, at least two
NOTE:
are going to be used for the AP and a laptop installed with the EnerVista software, which
NOTE will be used to configure the 8 Series devices. The AP should be configured with the
address 192.168.0.1 and mask 255.255.255.0 and have DHCP enabled with a DHCP range
from 192.168.0.2 to 192.168.0.253. This allows laptops, iPads and any other devices to
connect to the local network without the need to statically configure their own IP address
and mask.
an SSID before connecting to the device and making it harder for casual outsiders looking
NOTE for wireless networks to find the device and attempt to connect.
Ideally the passphrase should be set through EnerVista and not directly from the Keypad,
NOTE:
where there are limitations in terms of space and types of characters supported. However,
NOTE for convenience, the passcode setting is available from the Keypad as well.
WiFi Status
A Wi-Fi symbol is displayed in the caption area of the 8 Series product front panel. The
following table lists all possibilities for this icon:
Wi-Fi Events
Event Description
Wi-Fi Connected This event is recorded to indicate a network connect.
Wi-Fi Disconnected This event is recorded to indicate a network
disconnect.
If the relay is in service mode and the settings are default a minor error is triggered.
NOTE:
NOTE
IP address: 192.168.0.1
Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0
SSID: same as entered on the PC (SSID provided with the 8 Series relay)
Broadcast disabled
Security type: WPA2-PSK (WPA2-Personal)
Encryption: AES
Passphrase: same as entered on the PC (Passphrase provided with the 8 Series relay)
DHCP enabled range of 192.168.0.12 to 192.168.0.253
3. Any 8 Series relays in range are automatically connect to the configured Access Point.
4. Start EnerVista on a PC and use the Discover function, all relays within range appear
and are populated in EnerVista for initial configuration and commissioning.
5. Once the relay is configured, change the 8 Series relay default Wi-Fi SSID and
Passphrase settings before the relay goes into service.
Connecting multiple 8 Series relays over USB to a single PC is not possible because in the
FASTPATH:
address you must press the “Back” key first to switch between softkey mode and the
NOTE Down/Up key mode.
NOTE The setting is valid on port 5 if port 4’s OPERATION is set to INDEPENDENT.
PRT4 OPERATION
Range: Independent, LLA, PRP
Default: Independent
This setting determines the mode of operation for ports 4 and 5: INDEPENDENT, LLA or
PRP.
INDEPENDENT operation: ports 4 and 5 operate independently with their own MAC and
IP address.
LLA operation: the operation of ports 4 and 5 are as follows:
Ports 4 and 5 use port 4’s MAC and IP address settings while port 5 is in standby mode in
that it does not actively communicate on the Ethernet network but monitors its link. If
Port 4 is active and the link loss problem is detected, communications is switched to Port
5 immediately. Port 5 is, in effect, acting as a redundant or backup link to the network for
port 4.
LLA (Link Loss Alert)is a proprietary feature supported by the 8 Series relay fiber optic
ports. When enabled on an 8 Series fiber optic port, this feature is able to detect a failure
of the fiber link. If port 4’s OPERATION is set to LLA, the detection of a link failure by this
feature triggers the transfer of communications from port 4 to port 5. If LLA is enabled
on a port with a non-fiber SFP, the target message “LLA not supported by Prt (4 or 5)” is
displayed on the keypad and an event is logged.
PRP (Parallel Redundancy Protocol) operation: ports 4 and 5 use the same MAC address
and combine information at the link layer. It is intended to only be used if the two ports
are connected to separate parallel LAN’s. In this mode of operation both ports cannot be
connected to the same LAN. The receiving devices (845 ) process the first frame received
and discard the duplicate through a link redundancy entity (LRE) or similar service that
operates below layer 2. Aside from LRE, PRP uses conventional Ethernet hardware but
both ports must know they are in PRP. Ports of PRP devices operating with the same
Internet Protocol (IP) addresses for traffic that uses IP Management protocols such as
Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) must operate correctly.
Duplicate Discard mode (only mode supported by the 8 Series). This is the normal
setting for PRP operation and once set it allows the sender LRE to append a six-octet
field that contains a sequence number, the Redundancy Control Trailer (RCT) to both
frames it sends. The receiver LRE uses the sequence number of the RCT and the source
MAC address to detect duplicates. It forwards only the first frame of a pair to its upper
layers.
Routing When the configuration card is present, a default route and a maximum number of 6 static
routes can be configured. The default route is used as the last choice, if no other route
towards a given destination is found.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Communications > Routing > Default Route
GATEWAY ADDRESS
Range: Standard IPV4 unicast address format (0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254)
Default: 127.0.0.1
This setting sets the gateway of the default route to be used by IP traffic sent from the
relay, if no other route towards a given IP destination is found.
This setting is available only if the communications card is present.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Communications > Routing > Static RT1 (2 to 6)
RT1 (2,3,4,5,6) DESTINATION
Range: Standard IPV4 network address format (0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254)
Default: 127.0.0.1
This setting sets the destination IPv4 route. This setting is available only if the
communications card is present.
TARGETS
WRONG ROUTE CONFIG
Description: A route with mismatched destination and mask has been configured.
Message: “Wrong route configuration.
”What to do: Rectify the IP address and mask of the mis-configured route.
TOPOLOGY EXAMPLE
Figure 5-7: Topology Example
In the above figure: Topology Example, the 8 Series device is connected through the two
Ethernet ports available on the communications card.
• Port 4 (IP address 10.1.1.2) connects to LAN 10.1.1.0/24 and to the Internet through
Router1. Router 1 has an interface on 10.1.1.0/24 and the IP address of this interface
is 10.1.1.1.
• Port 5 (IP address 10.1.2.2) connects to LAN 10.1.2.0/24 and to EnerVista setup
program through Router 2. Router 2 has an interface on 10.1.2.0/24 and the IP
address of this interface is 10.1.2.1.
Configuration
Network addresses:
PRT54IP ADDRESS = 10.1.1.2PRT4 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0PRT5 IP ADDRESS =
10.1.2.2PRT5 SUBNET IP MASK = 255.255.255.0
Routing Settings:
IPV4 DEFAULT ROUTE: GATEWAY ADDRESS = 10.1.1.1
STATIC NETWORK ROUTE 1:
– RT1 DESTINATION = 10.1.3.0/24RT1 NET MASK = 255.255.255.0RT1 GATEWAY =
10.1.2.1
Behavior: One static network route was added to the destination 10.1.3.0/24, where a
laptop running EnerVista is located. This static route uses a different gateway (10.1.2.1)
than the default route. This gateway is the address of Router 2, which is “aware” of
destination 10.1.3.0 and is able to route packets coming from the 8 Series device and
destined to EnerVista.
DNP Protocol Path:Setpoints > Device > Communications > DNP protocol
synchronization via other means such as IRIGB or 1588. Given network asymmetry, the
NOTE consistency of the network latency, clock drift, and additional delays due to routers
located between the client and the 845 all contribute error.
DNP / IEC104 Point The menu path for the DNP/IEC104 point lists is shown below.
Lists Path: Setpoints > Device > Communications > DNP/IEC104 Point Lists
Binary Input / MSP Points
Analog Input / MME Points
Binary Outp / CSC / CDC Pnts
Binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104)
The binary inputs points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP points for IEC 60870-5-104
protocol, can be configured to a maximum of 96 points. The data source for each point is
user-programmable and can be configured by assigning FlexLogic operands. For a
complete list, see Format Code FC142.
The menu path for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown
below.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Communications > DNP/IEC104 Point Lists > Binary Input/MSP
Points
Point 0 Entry
...
Point 255 Entry
Analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104)
Up to 255 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols.
The menu path for the analog input point (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown
below.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Communications > DNP/IEC104 Point Lists > Analog Input / MME
Points
Analog IP Point 0 Entry
Point 0 Scale Factor
Point 0 Deadband
DNP ANALOG INPUT POINT 0(255) SCALE FACTOR
Range: / 0.001, / 0.01, / 0.1, / 1, / 10, / 100, / 1000, / 10000, / 100000
Default: /1
These are numbers used to scale analog input point values. Each setting represents the
scale factor for the analog input point. For example, if the DNP PHASE A VOLTAGE SCALE
FACTOR setting is set to “/ 1000”, and the Phase A voltage is 72000 V, the Phase A voltage
sent on to the 845 is 72 V. The settings are useful when analog input values must be
adjusted to fit within certain ranges in DNP masters.
Note that a scale factor of ”/ 0.1” is equivalent to a multiplier of 10.
FASTPATH:
value. Since DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points
assigned after the first “Off” point are ignored.
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input with status),
Configurable
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 2 (Binary Input Change
with Time), Configurable
Change Event Scan Rate: 8 times per power system cycle
Change Event Buffer Size: 1024
Default Class for All Points: 1
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION COUNTERS
The following details lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21).
When a freeze function is performed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is
available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point. 845 Digital Counter values are
represented as 16 or 32-bit integers. The DNP 3.0 protocol defines counters to be unsigned
integers. Care should be taken when interpreting negative counter values.
BINARY COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: 22
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 7 (freeze), 8 (freeze noack), 9 (freeze and
clear), 10 (freeze and clear, noack), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Binary Counter with
Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter
Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
FROZEN COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: 23
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter with
Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter
Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
14 Digital Counter 15
15 Digital Counter 16
ANALOG INPUTS
It is important to note that 16-bit and 32-bit variations of analog inputs are transmitted
through DNP as signed numbers. Even for analog input points that are not valid as
negative values, the maximum positive representation is 32767 for 16-bit values and
2147483647 for 32-bit values. This is a DNP requirement. The deadbands for all Analog
Input points are in the same units as the Analog Input quantity. For example, an Analog
Input quantity measured in volts has a corresponding deadband in units of volts. Relay
settings are available to set default deadband values according to data type. Deadbands
for individual Analog Input Points can be set using DNP Object 34.
1. A default variation refers to the variation response when variation 0 is requested and/
FASTPATH:
or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default variations for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23,
30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
2. For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a
request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests
sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, are responded with qualifiers 00 or 01. For
change event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts – the 845 is not restarted, but
the DNP process is restarted.
IEC 60870-5-104 The IEC 60870-5-104 communications protocol is supported on Ethernet ports 4 and 5
only. Setting changes become active after rebooting.
In 845 both DNP and IEC104 protocol can work at the same time, but consider that there is
FASTPATH:
only one point map. So, the two protocols use the same data mapping, i.e., same point
index and same point source.
Each Measured value has a Parameter of measured value (P_ME_NB) associated to its
threshold.
The IEC 60870-5-104 Deadbands settings are used to determine when to trigger
spontaneous responses containing M_ME_NB_1 analog data. Each setting represents the
threshold value for each M_ME_NB_1 analog point.
For example, to trigger spontaneous responses from the 845 when a current value
changes by 15 A, the “Analog Point xx Deadband” setting should be set to 15. Note that
these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NB_1 (parameter of
measured value, scaled value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the
default, for each individual M_ME_NB_1 analog point. There are three ways to send the
measurands to the Master station. The measurands are part of the General Group and
Group 2, so when a general interrogation or group 2 interrogation takes place all the
measurands are included in the response. Also, there is a cyclic data period setting where it
is configured in the scan period to send the measurands to the Master. And the last way, is
by sending spontaneously when a deadband overflow takes place. The IEC104 Channels
sub-menu information is shown below.
Commands are executed over the Binary Outputs. The first 8 Binary Outputs are
configured to receive Select/Operate Commands and the next 8 Binary Outputs are
configured to receive Direct Execute Commands.
The IEC104 CHANNEL 1 PORT and IEC104 CHANNEL 2 PORT settings select the
communications port assigned to the IEC104 protocol for each channel. When this setting
is set to “Network - TCP”, the IEC104 protocol can be used over TCP/IP on channels 1 or 2.
The IEC104 NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS settings can force the 845 to respond to a
maximum of two specific IEC104 masters which own the configured IP Addresses. The
settings in this sub-menu are shown below.
“IEC104 Channel 1 Port” takes the “Port Number 1” and “Client Address 1” to allow or reject
FASTPATH:
GROUPS OF DATA
The data is organized into groups in order to provide values when the controlling station
requests them by a general or group interrogation.
Group 1 is set by the 96 Single Points (M_SP).
Group 2 is set by the 32 Measured values (M_ME).
Group 3 is set by the 32 Measured thresholds (P_ME).
These 96 Single Points and 32 Measured Values are also sent as a response to a General
Interrogation.
The Integrated Totals (M_IT) has its own Counter Group 1, and it is sent as a response to a
General Request Counter.
IEC 60870-5-103 The point map for the 103 is different from the one shared by the IEC104 and DNP
protocols. IEC 60870-5-103 serial communications protocol is supported on the rear RS485
port only.
The DNP, IEC 103 and Modbus cannot be enabled simultaneously. Only one instance of
DNP 3.0, IEC 103 or Modbus can run on the RS485 serial port.
PATH:SETPOINTS > DEVICE > COMMUNICATIONS > IEC 60870-5-103 PROTOCOL
IEC103 Common ASDU Addrs
Range: 0 to 254 in steps of 1
Default: 0
IEC103 Sync Timeout
Range: 0 to 1440 minutes in steps of 1 min
Default: 0 min
All binary inputs are configured from FlexLogic operands. For a complete list, see Format
Code FC142.
Pay attention when configuring the function type and information number of the different
FASTPATH:
points, because they must be unique. There is no mechanism in the EnerVista 8 Series
Setup software or the front panel HMI to detect duplication of the information index.
The IEC 60870-5-103 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first “Off” value.
FASTPATH:
Since IEC 60870-5-103 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned
after the first “Off” point are ignored.
IEC 61850 The optional communications processor supports both the IEC61850 GOOSE and IEC
61850 MMS Server service as per IEC 61850 standard Ed. 2. The GOOSE messaging service
provides the 845 unit the ability to Publish/Subscribe Digital Input and other element
statuses and its Quality and Timestamp to/from other IEDs with supporting GOOSE
messaging service. Server support allows remote control center, RTU/Gateway, local HMI
or other client role devices access to the relay for monitoring and control. The
configuration of IEC61850 services is accomplished using the 845 configuration software,
EnerVista 8 Series Setup software.
– Select any online relay and right click on the selected “tree” item. More options
become available for selection, as shown in the next examples.
Example of Additional Options
Generate ICD file:The menu option generates a default ICD file with the respective
order code option and saves the file to the path selected previously.
Read Device Settings: The menu option reads all the settings from the relay by TFTP
and creates an 845 file with extension *.CID. The created *.CID file consists of two
sections. A private section where all non IEC 61850 settings are available, and a public
section in which IEC 61850 related settings are implemented.
When creating a CID file using a 3rd party ICT/SCL tool, ensure the following:
FASTPATH:
– The order code in the CID file must match the device order code if writing the CID
file directly into the relay (without using the EnerVista software). The "Desc" value
in communication settings of the CID file must match the relay’s order code.
– The maximum allowed services must be equal or below the specified limits as in
ICD/CID.
– Configure Datasets only in "LLN0" logical node.
– Creating new LD, LN, and communication-AP settings is not recommended.
(Setpoints > Device > Installation) switches to Not Ready for the duration of the upload. This
ensures that all new settings are applied before the device is operational.
Remote Modbus The Remote Modbus Device describes a device within the same network as the
Device 8 Series device and the poll mode of operation for retrieving the data. The 8 Series device
acts as a Modbus Master and initiates Modbus requests to the Modbus slave at a defined
poll interval or per trigger.
Path: Device > Communications > Remote Modbus Device > Device 1
DEVICE NAME
Range: 13 Alphanumeric Characters
Default: BSG3
The Remote Modbus Device Name defaults to the Powell BriteSpot Thermal Monitoring
device (BSG3).
DEVICE PROFILE
Range: 13 Alphanumeric Characters
Default: BSG3
The Remote Modbus Device default profile is for the Powell BriteSpot Thermal Monitoring
device (BSG3). The 27 analog and 27 digital operands that are available in the device are
supported and are pre-configured in the default settings file. The data defined for BSG3
are described in the 8 Series Protection Relay Platform Communications guide.
Other device profiles can be configured as described in the following section.
IP ADDRESS
Range: Standard IPV4 network address format
Default: 0.0.0.0
SLAVE ADDRESS
Range: 1 to 254 in steps of 1
Default: 254
MODBUS PORT
Range: 0 to 10000 in steps of 1
Default: 502
POLL RATE
Range: OFF, 3 to 120 minutes in steps of 1
Default: 3 minutes
TRIGGER
Range: Any FlexLogic operand
fault: Off
3. If required, create a new profile and add it to the profile list by clicking New and
entering a name for the new profile when prompted.
The profile opens in the Remote Modbus Device Profile Editor window, with all
configured points listed.
5. To add a Digital Point enter a name in the Label column and an address in the
Modbus Address column. The remaining columns fill with default values that can be
edited as needed. Use the Delete Row button to delete entries.
– Mask: The specific position in a 32 bit value to pack the bit read from the source.
For example, if Mask is 8198, the source bit is placed in the 13th position. (Bits are
numbered from 0 to 31.)
6. To manage the enumerations used by Digital Points, click the Edit Enumeration
button. Enumerations are used to display user-friendly text for the true/false settings
of each point. A maximum of 10 enumerations are permitted.
Click each field to enter (or edit) the Name of the enumeration as shown in the list of
Digital Points, along with the text to display for a False Value or a True Value. Use the
Delete Row button to delete entries. All fields have a 13 character maximum.
When done, click OK to save changes.
7. To add an Analog Point enter a name in the Label column and an address in the
Modbus Addresscolumn. The remaining columns fill with default values that can be
edited as needed. Use the Delete Row button to delete entries.
When checked, the Check for unique Modbus Addressescheckbox does not allow
duplicate addresses.
The following fields are available for each Digital Point:
– Label: The name for the point, to a maximum of 13 characters
– Modbus Address (Hex): The Modbus Address for the point, in hexadecimal
– Read Function: The Modbus function to be used for reading the point (function 3
or function 4).
– Data Type: SINT16 - Signed Integer (16-bit), UINT16 - Unsigned Integer (16-bit),
SINT32 - Signed Long (32 -bit), UINT32 - Unsigned Long (32-bit), FLOAT - IEED
Floating Point Number (32-bit).
– Multiplier: The multiplier to apply to the read data.
– Decimals: The number of decimal places to add to the read data. For example, a
Decimal entry of 2 results in dividing the read data by 10*10=100.
– Unit: The units associated with this value, to a maximum of 6 characters.
8. To select a profile, navigate to Device > Communications > Remote Modbus Device >
Device 1. Under Device Profile, select a profile from the drop-down list.
Click Save to save your changes. If you are working online, a new CID file will be
created and sent to the relay.
When a new CID file is uploaded, the DEVICE IN SERVICE state (Setpoints > Device >
NOTE:
Transient Recorder
The Transient Recorder contains waveforms captured at the same sampling rate as the
other relay data at the point of trigger. By default, data is captured for all AC current and
voltage inputs available on the relay as ordered. Transient record is generated upon
change of state of at least one of the assigned triggers: “Trigger Source”, “Trigger on
Pickup”, “Trigger on Operate”, “Trigger on Alarm”, or “Trigger on Trip”.
The number of cycles captured in a single transient record varies based on the number of
records, sample rate, and the number of selected channels. There is a fixed amount of
data storage for the Transient Recorder: the more data captured, the less the number of
cycles captured per record.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Transient Recorder
NUMBER OF RECORDS
Range: 1 to 16 in steps of 1
Default: 5
The selection from the range defines the desired number of records.
SAMPLES PER CYCLE
Range: 8/c, 16/c, 32/c, 64/c, 128/c
Default: 32/c
This setpoint provides a selection of samples-per-cycle for representing the waveform.
The waveform records can be viewed using the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software.
TRIGGER MODE
Range: Overwrite, Protected
Default: Overwrite
When “Overwrite” setting is selected, the new records overwrite the old ones, meaning
the relay will always keep the newest records as per the selected number of records. In
“Protected” mode, the relay will keep the number of records corresponding to the
selected number of records, without saving further records that are beyond the selected
number of records.
TRIGGER POSITION
Range: 0 to 100% in steps of 1%
Default: 20%
This setting indicates the location of the trigger with respect to the selected length of
record. For example at 20% selected trigger position, the length of each record will be
split on 20% pre-trigger data, and 80% post-trigger data.
TRIGGER SOURCE:
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The trigger source can be any digital input: an operand from the list of FlexLogic
operands, a contact input, a contact output, a virtual input or output, or a remote input
or output.
TRIGGER ON ANY PICKUP
Range: On, Off
Default: Off
Selection of “On” setting enables triggering of the recorder upon pickup condition
detected by any of the protection or control elements.
TRIGGER ON ANY OPERATE
Range: On, Off
Default: Off
Selection of “On” setting enables triggering of the recorder upon operate state of any of
the enabled protection or control elements.
TRIGGER ON TRIP
Range: On, Off
Default: Off
Selecting the “On” setting enables triggering of the recorder when any of the protection
elements configured as a “Trip” function operates, or the state of the operand assigned
to operate the #1 Trip output relay changes to “high”.
TRIGGER ON ALARM
Range: On, Off
Default: Off
Selecting “On” setting enables triggering of the recorder when any of the protection
elements configured as “Alarm”, or “Latched Alarm” function operates, or the state of the
operand assigned to trigger the Alarm LED changes to “high”.
DIGITAL INPUT 1 to 64
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
ANALOG INPUT 1 to 16
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic analog parameter
Default: Off
Data Logger
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a configured rate. All
data is stored in non-volatile memory, where the information is retained upon a relay
control power loss.
The data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period of time, or with
larger number of channels for a shorter period of time. The relay automatically partitions
the available memory between the channels in use.
The selection of the rate for logging data also affects the duration of recorded data. The
data logger has longer duration for sampling rates at longer periods of time (i.e. “1 minute”,
“30 minutes”, “1 hour”), as compared to sampling rates at short periods (i.e. “per cycle”, or
“per second”).
The recorded data can be downloaded to 8 Series EnerVista program and displayed with
parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
If data is not available for the entire duration of pre-trigger, the trigger position will be
NOTE:
Fault Reports
The 845 relay supports up to 15 fault reports. The trigger conditions and the analog
quantities to be stored are entered in this menu.
When enabled, this function monitors the pre-fault trigger. The pre-fault data are stored in
the memory for prospective creation of the fault report on the rising edge of the pre-fault
trigger. The element waits for the fault trigger as long as the pre-fault trigger is asserted,
but not shorter than 1 second. When the fault trigger occurs, the fault data is stored and
the complete report is created. If the fault trigger does not occur within 1 second after the
pre-fault trigger drops out, the element resets and no record is created.
The user-programmable fault report contains a header with the following information:
• Relay model
• Device name
• Firmware revision
• Date and time of trigger
• Name of pre-fault trigger (FlexLogic operand)
• Name of Fault trigger (FlexLogic operand)
• Active setting group at the time of pre-fault trigger
• Active setting group at the time of fault trigger.
The fault report continues with the following information:
• All current and voltage phasors (one cycle after the fault trigger)
• Pre-fault values for all programmed analog channels (one cycle before pre-fault
trigger)
• Fault values of all programmed analog channels (one cycle after the fault trigger)
Each Fault Report created can be saved as a text file using the EnerVista 8 Series Setup
software. The file names are numbered sequentially to show which file is older than the
other.
The trigger can be any FlexLogic operand, but in most applications it is expected to be the
same operand, usually a virtual output, that is used to drive an output relay to trip a
breaker. A FAULT RPT TRIG event is automatically created when the report is triggered.
If a number of protection elements, such as overcurrent elements, are “OR’d” to create a
fault report trigger, the first operation of any element causing the OR gate output to
become high triggers the fault report. However, If other elements operate during the fault
and the first operated element has not been reset (the OR gate output is still high), the fault
report is not triggered again. Considering the reset time of protection elements, there is
very little chance that fault report can be triggered twice in this manner. As the fault report
must capture a usable amount of pre and post-fault data, it cannot be triggered faster
than every 20 ms.
The fault report stores data, in non-volatile memory, pertinent to an event when triggered.
Each fault report is stored as a file to a maximum capacity of fifteen (15) files. A sixteenth
(16th) trigger overwrites the oldest file.
The EnerVista 8 Series Setup software is required to view all captured data. The relay
faceplate display can be used to view the date and time of trigger, the fault type and the
distance location of the fault.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Fault Report
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
PRE-FAULT TRIGGER
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setpoint specifies the FlexLogic operand to capture the pre-fault data. The rising
edge of this operand stores one cycle-old data for subsequent reporting. The element
waits for the fault trigger to actually create a record as long as the operand selected as
PRE-FAULT TRIGGER is “On”. If the operand remains “Off” for 1 second, the element resets
and no record is created.
FAULT TRIGGER
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setpoint specifies the FlexLogic operand to capture the fault data. The rising edge of
this operand stores the data as fault data and results in a new report. The trigger (not
the pre-fault trigger) controls the date and time of the report. The distance to fault
calculations are initiated by this signal.
ANALOG CHANNELS 1 to 32
These settings specify an actual value such as voltage or current magnitude, true RMS,
phase angle, frequency, temperature, etc., to be stored should the report be created. Up
to 32 analog channels can be configured.
Event Data
The Event Data feature stores 64 FlexAnalog quantities each time an event occurs. The
relay is able to capture a maximum of 1024 records. The Event Data behaviour matches
that of the Event Recorder. This is a Platform feature and a ‘Basic’ option so it has no
dependencies.
There is no Enabling/Disabling of the feature. It is always ‘ON’.
When changes are made to the Event Data settings, the Event data is cleared and the
Snapshot.txt file is deleted. The Event Record remains as is and is not cleared.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Event Data
PARAMETER 1 to 64
Range: Off, any FlexAnalog Parameter
Default: Off
Flex States
Path: Setpoints > Device > Flex States
PARAMETER 1 (to 256)
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Front Panel
The 845 relay provides an easy to use faceplate for menu navigation using 5 navigation
pushbuttons and a high quality graphical display. Conveniently located on the panel is a
group of 7 pushbuttons for Up/Down value selection, Enter, Home, Escape, Help, and Reset
functions. The faceplate also includes 3 programmable function pushbuttons with LEDs.
Fourteen other status LEDs are available, 12 of which are programmable.
Please refer to Front Control Panel Interface.
The USB port on the Front Panel is intended for connection to a portable PC.
FASTPATH:
LED “PICKUP”
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Any Pickup
The setpoint requires assigning a FlexLogic operand to turn on the LED "PICKUP", when
triggered. The indicator is a self-rest indicator and will turn off if the condition evolves
into a fault or the measured parameter drops below the pickup level.
LED 5 (17) NA ME
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: LED 5
The setpoint is used to select the LED name by choosing up to 13 alphanumeric
characters.
LED 5 (17) COLOR
Range: Off, Red, Green, Orange
Default: Orange
The setpoint selects the color of the LED. Three colors are available for selection: Red,
Green, and Orange.
LED 5 (17) TRIGGER
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operands
Default: Testing On
This setpoint requires the assigning of a FlexLogic operand to trigger the selected LED
upon operation.
LED 5 (17) TYPE
Range: Self-reset, Latched
Default: Testing On
The setpoint defines the type of LED indication as either Self-Reset (the LED resets after
the FlexLogic operand drops out), or Latched (the LED stays latched upon dropping out
of the FlexLogic operand).
Note 1:
• LED 1: IN-SERVICE – non-programmable. The LED is hardcoded to show a green light
when the relay is fully functional and an orange light when the relay is not
programmed, or experiences a self-test error.
• LED 2: TRIP - see the default setpoint above and the description
• LED 3: ALARM - see the default setpoint above and the description
• LED 4: PICKUP – non-programmable. The LED is hardcoded to show a green light
when at least one element has picked up.
Programmable The user-programmable pushbuttons provide an easy and error-free method of entering
Pushbuttons digital state (on, off) information. Depending on the faceplate three to ten pushbuttons are
available for programming.
Figure 5-9: Programmable PBs on Front Panel
Each pushbutton asserts its own ON and OFF FlexLogic operands (for example,
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON and PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF). These operands are available for each
pushbutton and are used to program specific actions. Each pushbutton has an associated
LED indicator. By default, this indicator displays the present status of the corresponding
pushbutton (ON or OFF). This can be changed by programming the LED Trigger setting in
the Programmable LED settings menu.
The activation and deactivation of user-programmable pushbuttons is dependent on
whether latched or self-reset mode is programmed.
LATCHED MODE
In Latched Mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by directly pressing the associated
front panel pushbutton. The pushbutton maintains the set state until deactivated by a
Reset command or after a user-specified time delay. The state of each pushbutton is
stored in non-volatile memory and maintained through loss of control power.
The pushbutton is Reset (deactivated) in Latched Mode by directly pressing the associated
active front panel pushbutton. It can also be programmed to Reset automatically through
the PB 1 AUTORESET and PB 1 AUTORESET DELAY settings. These settings enable the auto-
reset timer and specify the associated time delay. The auto-reset timer can be used in
select-before-operate (SBO) switching device control applications, where the command
type (CLOSE/OPEN) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must
Reset automatically if control is not executed within a specified time period.
SELF-RESET MODE
In Self-reset mode, a pushbutton remains active for the time it is pressed (the pulse
duration) plus the Dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROPOUT TIME setting. The
pushbutton is Reset (deactivated) in Self-reset mode when the dropout delay specified in
the PUSHBTN 1 DROPOUT TIME setting expires.The pulse duration of the pushbutton must
be at least 50 ms to operate the pushbutton. This allows the user-programmable
pushbuttons to properly operate during power cycling events and various system
disturbances that may cause transient assertion of the operating signals.
The operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the
PUSHBTN 1 LOCK setting. If locking is applied, the pushbutton ignores the commands
executed through the front panel pushbuttons. The locking functions are not applied to the
auto-reset feature. In this case, the inhibit function can be used in SBO control operations
to prevent the pushbutton function from being activated and ensuring “one-at-a-time”
select operation.
The locking functions can also be used to prevent accidental pressing of the front panel
pushbuttons.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the Event Recorder and displayed as Target
Messages. In latched mode, user-defined messages can also be associated with each
pushbutton and displayed when the pushbutton is ON or changing to OFF.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Programmable PBs > Pushbutton 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
This setting selects the characteristic of the pushbutton. If set to “Disabled” the
pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both ON and OFF)
are de-asserted. If set to Self-reset the control logic is activated by the pulse (longer
than 100 ms) issued when the pushbutton is being physically pressed.
When in Self-reset mode and activated locally, the pushbutton control logic asserts the
ON corresponding FlexLogic operand as long as the pushbutton is being physically
pressed, and after being released the deactivation of the operand is delayed by the
PUSHBTN 1 DROPOUT TIME setting. The OFF operand is asserted when the pushbutton
element is deactivated.
If set to Latched the control logic alternates the state of the corresponding FlexLogic
operand between ON and OFF on each button press or by virtually activating the
pushbutton (assigning Set and Reset operands). When in Latched mode, the states of
the FlexLogic operands are stored in a non-volatile memory. Should the power supply be
lost, the correct state of the pushbutton is retained upon subsequent power-up of the
relay.
ID TEXT
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Open (PB1), Close (PB2), F1 (PB3), Gnd Trip Enabled (PB4), SCADA Enabled (PB5),
Hot Line Tag (PB6), Demand Reset (PB7), Alt Settings (PB8), Target Reset (PB9), PB Block
(PB10)
This setting specifies the 13-character line of the user-programmable message and is
intended to provide the ID information of the pushbutton.
ON TEXT
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: PB1 On (or PB[X] On)
This setting specifies the 13-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is in the “ON” position. Refer to the Working with
Graphical Display Pages section for instructions on entering alphanumeric characters
from the keypad.
OFF TEXT
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: PB1 Off (or PB[X] On)
This setting specifies the 13-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is activated from the “ON” to the “OFF” position and the
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Latched”. This message is not displayed when the
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Self-reset” as the pushbutton operand status is implied to
be “OFF” upon its release. The length of the “OFF” message is configured with the
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY PROPERTIES/FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
The message programmed in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings will be
displayed as long as PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand is asserted, but not longer than the
time period specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. After the flash time has
expired, the default message or other active target message is displayed. The
instantaneous Reset of the flash message will be executed if any relay front panel button
is pressed or if any new target or message becomes active.
The PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT setting is linked to PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF operand and will be
displayed in conjunction with PUSHBTN 1 ID only if the pushbutton element is in
“Latched” mode.
HOLD PRESSED
Range: 0.0 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 0.1 s
This setting specifies the time required for a pushbutton to be pressed before it is
deemed active.
The timer is Reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that any pushbutton operation
will require the pushbutton to be pressed a minimum of 60 ms. This minimum time is
required prior to activating the pushbutton hold timer.
AUTORESET
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton Autoreset feature. The setting
is applicable only if the pushbutton is in “Latched” mode.
AUTORESET DELAY
Range: 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 1.0 s
This setting specifies the time delay for automatic Reset of the pushbutton when in the
“Latched” mode.
LOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting assigns a FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit pushbutton operation from
the front panel pushbuttons. This locking functionality is not applicable to pushbutton
autoreset.
DROPOUT TIME
Range: 0.0 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 0.0 s
This setting applies only to “Self-reset” mode and specifies the duration of the
pushbutton “active” status after the pushbutton has been released. The length of time
the operand remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
The setting is required to set the duration of the pushbutton operating pulse.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
0 msec
SETPOINT
SETPOINT
Latched Flash Message Time PB 1 ID Text:
SETPOINT
XXXXXXXXXX
` 0
AND
Disabled XXXXXXXXXX
Latched Latched/Self-Reset
OR
CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
Self-Reset
AND
Pushbutton 1 Lock
LATCH Pushbutton 1 OFF
AND
Off (Flexoperand)
RST
Figure 5-10: Pushbuttons Logic Diagram
TIMER
SETPOINT `
60 ms
Pushbutton 1 Hold 0
AND
PB t PKP
0
PB LED
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
IN-SERVICE
TIMER
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Pushbutton 1 ON 200 ms Pushbutton 1 ON
OR
0
AND
SETPOINT
`
OR
Auto-Reset Delay
SETPOINT
LCD MESSAGE
Autoreset Function
t PKP ENGAGE MESSAGE
AND
0
Enabled
SETPOINT SETPOINT
Disabled SETPOINT
Drop-Out Timer Flash Message Time PB 1 ID Text :
` XXXXXXXXXX
0 0
AND
AND
5–51
DEVICE
DEVICE CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
Tab Pushbuttons The Tab Pushbuttons provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on,
off) information. Twenty (20) Tab Pushbuttons are available for programming.
The digital state of the Tab Pushbuttons can be entered locally (by directly pressing the
front panel pushbutton) or through Modbus by specifying the correct COMMAND sequence.
Typical applications include breaker control, autorecloser blocking, and settings groups
changes. The Tab Pushbuttons are under the control level of password protection. Only
one pushbutton can be pressed at a time. If multiple pushbuttons are pressed
simultaneously, the button pressed first takes the priority.
The Tab Pushbutton settings can be accessed from Setpoints > Device > Front Panel >
Tab Pushbuttons > Tab PB1. The Tab Pushbutton control can be executed by navigating
to Status > Summary > Tab Pushbuttons. By default, the summary page is shown to
quickly glance at the active tab pushbuttons. The individual pages can then be accessed
from the summary page.Each Tab Pushbutton asserts its own OFF and ON FlexLogic
operands (for example, TAB PB 1 ON and TAB PB 1 OFF). These operands are available for
each pushbutton and can be used to program specific actions. Each pushbutton has an
associated “LED” indicator. By default, this indicator displays the present status of the
corresponding pushbutton ON state.
The activation and deactivation of Tab Pushbuttons is dependent on whether latched or
self-reset mode is programmed.
SELF-RESET MODE: In Self-reset mode, a Tab Pushbutton remains active for the time it is
pressed (the pulse duration) plus the Dropout time specified in the settings. The pushbutton
is deactivated in Self-reset mode when the dropout delay specified in the Dropout Time
setting expires. The pulse duration of the pushbutton must be at least 100ms to operate
the pushbutton.
LATCHED MODE: In Latched Mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by directly pressing
the associated tab pushbutton. The pushbutton maintains the set state until deactivated
by another press of the same button. The state of each pushbutton is stored in non-volatile
memory and maintained through the loss of control power.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Tab PBs > Tab PB1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
This setting selects the characteristic of the pushbutton. If set to “Disabled” the
pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both ON and OFF)
are de-asserted. If set to Self-reset the control logic is activated by the pulse issued when
the pushbutton is being physically pressed.
When in Self-Reset mode and activated locally, the pushbutton control logic asserts the
Tab PB [X] ON FlexLogic operand as long as the pushbutton is being physically pressed,
and after being released the deactivation of the operand is delayed by the Dropout Time
setting. The OFF operand is asserted when the pushbutton element is deactivated.
If set to Latched, the control logic alternates the state of the corresponding FlexLogic
operand between ON and OFF on each button press. When in Latched mode, the states
of the FlexLogic operands are stored in a non-volatile memory. Should the power supply
be lost, the correct state of the pushbutton is retained upon subsequent power-up of the
relay. When the pushbutton operand is in the ON state, the operand appears on the
target message until the pushbutton is pressed again to change it to the OFF state.
ID TEXT
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Tab PB 1 (or Tab PB[X])
This setting specifies the 13-character line of the user-programmable message and is
intended to provide the ID information of the pushbutton. This text is used to describe
the pushbutton in the FlexLogic operands.
LINE 1 TEXT
Range: 2 lines of alphanumeric characters
Default: [blank]
This setting specifies the text that is displayed on Line 1 of the button when in the
normal view.
LINE 2 TEXT
Range: 2 lines of alphanumeric characters
Default: [blank]
This setting specifies the text that is displayed on Line 2 of the button when in the
normal view.
LINE 1 SHORT TEXT
Range: 2 lines of alphanumeric characters
Default: [blank]
This setting specifies the text that is displayed on Line 1 of the button when in the
summary view. This is also the text that appears on the tabs when operating the
pushbuttons from the Single Line Diagram view.
LINE 2 SHORT TEXT
Range: 2 lines of alphanumeric characters
Default: [blank]
This setting specifies the text that is displayed on Line 2 of the button when in the
summary view.
BUTTON COLOR
Range: Black, Red, Yellow, Blue, Green, Teal, Purple, White
Default: Black
This setting specifies the background color of the Tab Pushbutton. If the button is
disabled, the button color by default is shown as grey.
TEXT COLOR
Range: Black, Red, Yellow, Blue, Green, Teal, Purple, White
Default: White
This setting specifies the text color of the Tab Pushbutton.
INDICATOR COLOR
Range: Black, Red, Yellow, Blue, Green, Teal, Purple, White
Default: Yellow
This setting specifies the color of the “LED” indicator for the Tab Pushbutton.
INDICATOR TRIGGER
Range: TAB PB 1 ON, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: TAB PB 1 ON
This setting assigns a FlexLogic operand to trigger the Indicator to change color from
the default color (white) to the selected color.
HOLD PRESSED
Range: 0.1 to 10.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 0.1 s
This setting specifies the time required for a pushbutton to be pressed before it is
deemed active.
The timer is Reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that any pushbutton operation
will require the pushbutton to be pressed a minimum of 100ms.
AUTORESET
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting enables the Tab Pushbutton Autoreset feature. The setting is applicable only
if the pushbutton is in “Latched” mode.
AUTORESET DELAY
Range: 0.2 to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 1.0 s
This setting specifies the time delay for automatic Reset of the pushbutton when in the
“Latched” mode.
LOCK
Range: Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting assigns a FlexLogic operand to inhibit pushbutton operation from the front
panel pushbuttons. This locking functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
DROPOUT TIME
Range: 0.0 s to 600.0 s in steps of 0.1 s
Default: 0.0 s
This setting applies only to “Self-reset” mode and specifies the duration of the
pushbutton “active” status after the pushbutton has been released. The length of time
the operand remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
The setting is required to set the duration of the pushbutton operating pulse.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
Annunciator Description
The graphical annunciator panel provides an emulation of a conventional physical
annunciator panel with backlit indicators each inscribed with a description of the alarm
condition that lights the indicator. The annunciator has 36 user-configurable
(programmable) indicators. The indicators can be arranged in pages of 3x3 or 2x2 grids.
Each indicator can have up to 3 lines of configurable text. When the indicators are not
active (i.e. a configured FlexOperand for the annunciator is not triggered), the background
is black and the foreground text color is grey. When the associated FlexOperand becomes
active, the background and the foreground turns brighter in color per the color
configuration. When disabled, the indicators are greyed out with no text.
Layout - If the grid layout is selected to be 3x3, the annunciator has 4 pages. If the grid
layout is 2x2, the annunciator has 9 pages. The numbering of the indicators is shown as
follows.
33 35
34 36
Navigation - The annunciator panel can be displayed in two ways. By default, the
annunciator panel is programmed as one of the homescreens. This means that when on
the home page, pressing the home button multiple times rotates through all the
homescreens. Alternatively, the annunciator can be accessed by navigating to
Status\Summary\Annunciator\Page1. Individual annunciator pages can also be
assigned as a homepage. If the auto navigation setting is enabled in the setup, the screen
automatically jumps from home to the annunciator page with the first active alarm. Pages
with active alarms will have a maroon flashing tab pushbutton label. If other pages have
active alarms, the “>>” button will show a flashing label.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Annunciator > Annunciator Setup
Reset Annunciator
Default: Off
Range: Off, any FlexLogic operand
This setting designates a FlexLogic operand that, when activated, acknowledges/resets
all annunciator windows in the graphical front panel. This setting is the same as that
defined under Setpoints > Device > Resetting > Reset Annunciator. Refer to the Resetting
section in this chapter for additional details.
The Reset Annunctr OP (OPRD) FlexLogic operand is activated by the two sources of
RESET command, operand source and manual source. Each individual source of a RESET
ANNUNCIATOR command also activates its individual operand Reset Annunctr OP
(OPRD) or Reset Annunctr OP (MNUL) to identify the source of the command. Both of
these operands generate an event in the event record when activated. The Reset
Annunciator setting selects the operand that activates the Reset Annunctr OP (OPRD)
operand. The RESET pushbutton in the front panel or the reset command from the
Enervista 8 Series Setup software activates the Reset Annunctr OP (MNUL) operand.
PAGE LAYOUT
Range: 3x3, 2x2
Default: 3x3
This setting selects the grid layout of the annunciator pages. The default 3x3 grid layout
provides 4 annunciator pages and 2x2 provides 9 pages.
AUTO NAVIGATION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
This setting when enabled, automatically navigates to the annunciator panel page from
where the indication was triggered. While in the annunciator panel, if no action is taken,
the screen returns back to the home page after the timeout setting.
FOCUSED NAVIGATION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
When this setting is enabled at the same time as the 'Auto Navigation' setting, the page
that has the active indicator will come into focus. The focus will change to the newest
indicator as soon as that becomes active. Target Messages and Default Screens both
have a lower priority than the 'Focused Navigation' setting of the Annunciator Panel.
Path:Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Annunciator > Indicator 1(36)
ALARM INPUT
Range: Off, any FlexLogic Operand
Default: Off
This setting specifies the input operand used to activate the corresponding indicator.
ALARM TYPE
Range: Off, Self-Reset, Latched
Default: Off
This setting specifies the alarm type. Self-Reset alarms track the state of the
corresponding input operand. Latched alarms can be reset using Reset pushbutton or
through Acknowledgement via graphical front panel.
The alarm type of each annunciator indicator may be configured as Off, Self-Reset, or
Latched. The default mode is Off. In this mode, the indicator is greyed out without any
text. In self-reset mode (Figure: Self-Reset Mode), the indicator’s inactive state is by
default in black background with dark grey color text. When the associated operand
becomes active (i.e. the assigned FlexOperand is triggered), the configured background
color and foreground text color appears. In latched mode (Figure: Latched), the
configured operand causes the background to flash when it becomes active. If the
alarm is then acknowledged or reset, the background stops flashing. If the operand
becomes inactive, the indicator returns to its default colors. The behavior of these
modes conforms to ISA-18.1-1979 (R2004) standard - A-4-5-6 (self-reset), and M-6
(latched).
Figure 5-11: Self-Reset Mode
State: Normal
Visual: OFF
Operand O FF
Operand ON
Reset PB to
Acknowledge
State: Abnormal
Visual: ON
State: Normal
Visual: OFF
Operand O N
State: Alarm
Operand O FF
Reset PB to
Reset PB to
Acknowledge
Acknowledge Visual: Fast-Flash
AND
AND
Operand OFF
Operand ON
Reset PB to
Acknowledge
AND
State: Abnormal Operand O N
Visual: ON
When any annunciator page is displayed with an alarm condition, the navigation keys
can be used to select an indicator. Once selected, the alarm condition can be
acknowledged by pressing the reset pushbutton or by pressing the enter key. A
confirmation message is displayed for acknowledging the alarm. Pressing the Reset or
Enter key again acknowledges the alarm and pressing the Escape button discards the
message. When the alarms are active under latched mode, a power loss retains the
previous state of the alarm as the alarm states are stored in non-volatile memory.
TEXT LINE 1 (2,3)
Range: 15 Alphanumeric Characters
Default: [blank]
These settings specify the displayed text on the corresponding line in the alarm
indicator. Three lines can be displayed with each line allowing up to 15 alphanumeric
characters.
TEXT COLOR
Range: Black, Red, Yellow, Blue, Green, Teal, Purple, White
Default: White
This setting specifies the color of the alarm indicator text.
BACK COLOR
Range: Black, Red, Yellow, Blue, Green, Teal, Purple, White
Default: Red
This setting specifies the color of the alarm indicator background. When the indicator
becomes active, the background changes color from the default Black to the
programmed alarm back color.
Display Properties Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the
Front Panel Display Properties setting.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Display Properties
COLOR SCHEME
Range: Green (open), Red (open)
Default: Green (open)
This setting defines the color scheme for the breaker status. If it is programmed Green
(open), the breaker open status is shown in the color green on the single line diagram
and on the device status.
The Active target Icon shown above, will be the only indication of active target
messages.
LANGUAGE
Range: English, German, Polish, Russian
Default: English
This setting selects the language used to display the settings, metering, status, and
targets. The range is dependent on the order code of the relay.
Default Screens The 8 Series relay provides the convenience of configuring and displaying up to three
default screens from a predefined list. Each type of screen to display can be selected, and
the display time programmed. The sequence of displaying the screens starts after the time
of inactivity programmed in the Message Timeout setpoint, when no PB has been pressed,
and no target message is present. Pressing a pushbutton, or the presence of a target
message inhibits the sequential display of default screens. The screen displays resume
only after the target messages are cleared, and no PB pressing is recorded for 30 seconds.
When configured the home screen is changed to the first screen defined by this feature.
Display timeouts also return to this first screen (i.e. default screen 1).
If the default screens feature is disabled and there are no home screens programmed, the
home page will show the Metering > Summary > Values screen after the message timeout
inactivity period.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Default Screen
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
This setpoint enables the feature. Displaying of the screen starts 30 s after setting the
feature to “Enabled”, providing no targets have been issued, nor a PB has been pressed.
DISPLAY TIME
Range: 5 to 900 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 10 s
The display time is the amount of time that each of the three screens are displayed
within the display sequence.
DEFAULT SCREEN 1(3)
Range: varieties of screens for selection
Default: SLD (for Default Screen 1 only), Off (for Default Screen 2/3 only)
This setpoint enables the user to input up to 3 default screens from a list of screens.
Home Screens The home screens allow the selection of a set of pages as home pages (max. 10. Multiple
home pages are configured and navigated to by pressing the home button repeatedly.
Navigate through all available home screens by repeatedly pressing the home button.
When returning to the home screen (either by pressing escape or directly pressing the
Home button) through the different menus, the last accessed home screen is shown.
Subsequent presses of the Home button navigates to the next programmed home screen
on the list.
While accessing the home screens, the tab pushbutton navigation labels show the root
menu – i.e. Targets, Status, Metering, Setpoints, and Records. The exceptions are the Tab
Pushbuttons screens which instead show pushbuttons in the navigation labels.
If the default screens are enabled, the first default screen is shown after 30 seconds plus
the inactivity period defined in Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Display Properties >
Message Timeout. If the default screens feature and screen saver are disabled, the screen
defaults to the Values screen after the inactivity period.
When the home screens are programmed and the default screens feature is enabled but
the screens are set to Off, the last accessed home screen is shown as the home page.
By Default, the first home screen is configured to show the first single line diagram.
When on any single line diagram page, if an object is selected, the home button will not
NOTE:
function. The selected object must first be de-selected by pressing the escape button to be
NOTE able to use the home button functionality again.
Path: Setpoints > Device > Front Panel > Home Screens
HOME SCREEN 1
Range: All available pages
Default: SLD1
HOME SCREEN 2
Range: All available pages
Default: Tab PB Summary
HOME SCREEN 3
Range: All available pages
Default: Annunciator Pg 1
HOME SCREEN 4
Range: All available pages
Default: Values
HOME SCREEN 5 to 10
Range: All available pages
Default: Off
Clear Records
The Clear Records command is accessible from the front panel and from the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software.
Path: Device > Clear Records
Records can be cleared either by assigning “On” or a FlexLogic operand to the appropriate
setting.
The Clear Records command is also available from Records > Clear Records, however there
FASTPATH:
the allowable settings are only “ON” and “OFF”. (FlexLogic operands cannot be used.)
Resetting
Some events can be programmed to latch the faceplate LED event indicators and target
message on the display. Depending on the application some auxiliary output relays can be
programmed to latch after the triggering event is cleared. Once set, the latching
mechanism holds all the latched indicators, messages, and auxiliary output relays in the
set state, after the initiating condition has cleared, until a RESET command is received to
return these latches (except the FlexLogic latches) to the reset state.
The RESET command can be sent from the faceplate Reset pushbutton, a remote device
via a communication channel, or any programmed FlexLogic operand. Executing the
RESET command from either source creates a general FlexLogic operand RESET OP. Each
individual source of a RESET command also creates its individual operand RESET OP (PB),
RESET (COMMS), and RESET OP (OPERAND) to identify the source of the command.
RESET INPUT 1(2,3):
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects an operand from the list of FlexLogic operands. The targets, LEDs,
and latched output relays reset upon assertion from any of the operands selected as
Reset Inputs.
Installation
Path:Setpoints > Device > Installation
DEVICE NAME
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
An alphanumeric name may be assigned to the device.
DEVICE IN SERVICE
Default: Not Ready
Range: Not Ready, Ready
The relay is defaulted to the “Not Ready” state when it leaves the factory. This
safeguards against the installation of a relay whose settings have not been entered.
When powered up successfully, the “IN SERVICE” LED becomes red. The relay in the “Not
Ready” state blocks signaling of any output relay. These conditions remain until the relay
is explicitly put in the “Ready” state.
SERVICE COMMAND
Range: 0 to 65535
Default: 0
See Password Recovery Procedure for details.
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
Range: Celsius, Fahrenheit
Default: Celsius
Selects engineering unit of temperature display.
VALIDATE CANBUS IO
Range: NO, YES
When the relay is booted the 8 Series relay enumerates the installed IO cards
automatically. When the relay is commissioned and the Validate CANBUS IO command
is set to Yes the current auto detect value is saved to non-volatile memory. This value is
then used to configure all display dependencies and used in self-test validation.
REMOTE IO DETECT VALUE
Range: Up to 6 alphanumeric characters
Shows the letter type of the Remote RTD card Board ID installed (e.g. GGGG).
CURRENT CUTOFF
Range: 0.000 to 1.000 p.u. in steps of 0.001 p.u.
Default: 0.020 p.u.
VOLTAGE CUTOFF
Range: 0.0 to 300.0 in steps of 0.1 V
Default: 1.0 V
Lower the Voltage Cutoff and Current Cutoff levels with care as the relay accepts lower
FASTPATH:
System
Figure 5-13: System Display Hierarchy
To measure and function properly, the following information must be entered on the
845 relay:
• Current Sensing: information related to phase and ground CT primary ratings
• Voltage Sensing: information related to Phase and Aux. VT connections, secondary
voltage, and VT ratios
• Power Sensing: information related to voltage and current banks polarity residing on
the same card
• Power System: information related to system frequency, tracking frequency, phase
rotation Transformer: information related to transformer losses, temperature rise over
ambient, winding resistance, type of transformer, capacity, winding voltage, phase
shifting, grounding, etc.
• Breakers: information related to detecting the status of breakers by assigning contact
inputs
• FlexCurves: information related to inverse time curves with user-programmable points
Current Sensing
The names and the configuration of the current banks below apply only to 845 orders for
the protection of either two-winding transformers with voltage, or three-winding
transformers.
Path:Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > CT Bank 1-J1
CT BANK NAME
Range: Any combination of 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
PHASE CT PRIMARY
Range: 1 A to 12000 A in steps of 1A
Default: 500 A
Enter the phase CT primary current for current sensing bank J1.
GROUND CT PRIMARY
Range: 1 A to 12000 A
Default: 500 A
Enter the rated Ground CT primary current for the ground current input for the selected
Current 1 bank.
Path:Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > Current Bank 2-K1
Path:Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > Current Bank 3-K2
The names and the configuration of the current banks below, applies only to 845 orders for
two-winding transformers without voltage.
Path:Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > CT Bank 1-K1
Path:Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > Current Bank 2-K2
Voltage Sensing
Traditional VT The Voltage Sensing menu provides the setup for all VTs (PTs) connected to the relay
voltage terminals.
Path:Setpoints > System > Voltage Sensing > Ph VT Bnk1-J2
PHASE VT BANK NAME
Range: Any combination of 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Ph VT Bnk 1-J2
Enter the name of the phase voltage from bank J2.
PHASE VT CONNECTION
Range: Wye, Delta, Single
Default: Wye
Select the type of phase VT connection to match the VTs (PTs) connected to the relay.
Pseudo Voltage / Single VT Voltage
In cases when the distribution feeder has only one VT/voltage source (to measure single
phase to neutral voltage or phase-to-phase voltage), 845 facilitates 3-phase power and
energy measurements derived from pseudo 3-phase voltages. The pseudo 3-phase
voltage are derived from any one VT source connected by considering balanced 3-phase
system (i.e. all three phase voltages and currents same in magnitude and placed 120
degrees apart with individual phases). Since, the pseudo 3-phase voltage calculation
relies on balanced power system, the calculation accuracies are influenced by system
unbalance conditions. In case of perfectly balanced system, the calculated pseudo
voltages are same as actual system voltages, however, the errors in 3-phase power and
energy calculation increases with system unbalance. The generated 3-phase voltages
from a single-phase reference input are only used for calculating the 3-phase metering
quantities.
PHASE VT SECONDARY
Range: 10.0 to 240.0 V in steps of 0.1 V
Default: 120.0 V
Select the output secondary voltage for phase VTs connected to the J2 bank.
PHASE VT RATIO
Range: 1.00 to 5000.00 in steps of 0.01
Default: 1.00
Select the phase VT ratio to match the ratio of the VTs connected to the J2 bank.
AUX. VT NAME
Range: Any combination of 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Ax VT Bnk1-J2
Enter the name of the auxiliary voltage from bank J2.
AUX. VT CONNECTION
Range: Van, Vbn, Vcn, Vab, Vbc, Vca, Vn
Default: Van
Select the voltage type corresponding to the one applied to the Aux VT relay terminals
from bank J2. Select Vn (neutral voltage), if the neutral voltage is applied to the relay
auxiliary VT.
AUX. VT SECONDARY
Range: 10.0 to 240.0 V in steps of 0.1 V
Default: 120.0 V
Select the output secondary voltage of the aux. VT connected to the aux. VT input from
bank J2.
AUX. VT RATIO
Range: 1.00 to 5000.00 in steps of 0.01
Default: 1.00
Select the aux. VT ratio to match the ratio of the VT connected to the aux. VT input from
bank J2.
The nominal PHASE VT SECONDARY and the AUX VT SECONDARY voltage settings are the
FASTPATH:
voltages across the phase VT terminals and the auxiliary VT terminals correspondingly
when nominal voltage is applied.
For example, on a system of 13.8kV nominal primary voltage, and a 14400:120 volt VT in a
Delta connection, the secondary voltage would be 115V, i.e. (13800/14400)*120. For a Wye
connection, the voltage value entered must be the phase to neutral voltage which would
be 115/√3 = 66.4 V.
On a 14.4 kV system with a Delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of
14400:120, the voltage value entered would be 120 V, i.e. 14400/120.
Power Sensing
The power computation in the 845 relay is performed using the voltage and current inputs
from the card inserted in slot J. In cases when the connected VTs and CTs have opposite
polarity, the power sensing menu provides for inverting the power measurement.
Path:Setpoints > System > Power Sensing > Power 1
3PH VT BANK INPUT
Range: Dependent upon the order code
Default: J2-3VT
This setpoint selects the 3-phase VT inputs used for Power (X) computation.
3PH CT BANK INPUT
Range: Dependent upon the order code
Default: J1-3CT
This setpoint selects the 3-phase CT inputs for Power (X) computation.
PHASE CT&VT POLARITY
Range: Same, Inverse
Default: Same
When “Inverse” is selected, this setpoint inverts (multiplies phase currents by “-1” ) the CT
polarity for the phase currents from CT bank J1, with respect to the phase voltages from
the VT bank J2.
The setpoint for inversion of the power metering will be useful to avoid the physical
NOTE:
inversion of the CT connections on the relay. As the power metering will affect the power
NOTE directional elements, the user must determine the correct forward and reverse direction of
the power, before setup.
Power System
Path:Setpoints > System > Power System
NOMINAL FREQUENCY
Range: 60 Hz, 50 Hz
Default: 60 Hz
The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY is used as a default to set the digital sampling
rate if the system frequency cannot be measured from available AC signals. This may
happen if the signals selected for frequency tracking are not present, or a valid
frequency is not detected. Before reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency
tracking algorithm holds the last valid frequency measurement for a safe period of time
while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay.
PHASE ROTATION
Range: ABC, ACB
Default: ABC
The selection of the PHASE ROTATION setting must match the power system phase
rotation. The phase sequence setting is required to properly calculate sequence
components and power parameters. Note that this setting informs the relay of the
actual system phase sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay labeled
as a, b, and c, must be connected to system phases A, B, and C for correct operation.
FREQUENCY TRACKING
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
Frequency measurement is accomplished by measuring the time between zero
crossings of the composite signal of three-phase bus voltages, line voltage or three-
phase currents. The signals are passed through a low pass filter to prevent false zero
crossings. Frequency tracking utilizes the measured frequency to set the sampling rate
for current and voltage which results in better accuracy for the Discrete Fourier
Transform (DFT) algorithm for off-nominal frequencies.
The main frequency tracking source uses three-phase voltages. The frequency tracking
is switched automatically to the alternative reference source, i.e., three-phase currents
signal, if the frequency detected from the three-phase voltage inputs is declared invalid.
The switching will not be performed if the frequency from the alternative reference
signal is detected invalid. Upon detecting valid frequency on the main source, the
tracking will be switched back to the main source. If a stable frequency signal is not
available from any source, then the tracking frequency defaults to the nominal system
frequency.
In cases when the 845 relay is ordered with phase voltage inputs, but voltages are not
FASTPATH:
available on the relay (no PTs, or voltage reads zero), the source for frequency tracking is
the CT bank from the same card, as the voltage bank. For 845 relay orders without VT
inputs, the source for frequency tracking is K1 - the first CT bank from the card residing in
K-slot. In this case automatic changing of the frequency source is not permitted
Transformer
INTRODUCTION
The percent (biased) differential protection is the main protection for power transformers
with regards to detecting all types of transformer internal fault. This protection is based on
Kirchoff’s law, where the sum of all currents flowing in and out of the protected equipment
equals zero. However, when applying this law to the overall differential protection, one
must keep in mind that the direct summation of the measured currents per-phase, does
not automatically result into zero differential current. This is because:
Transformer Setup
General Setup
Most of the setpoints from the transformer general setup are used for computation of the
hottest-spot winding temperature, aging factor, and accumulated loss of life.
Path: Setpoints > System > Transformer > Transformer Setup > see “General Setup”
REFERENCE WINDING
Range: Winding 1, Winding 2, Winding 3
Default: Winding 1
The reference winding (Wref) is the winding to which all other winding currents are
scaled. That is, the per-unit values of the differential current and the restraint current are
based on the nominal of the CT of the reference winding.
PHASE COMPENSATION
Range: Internal (software), External (with CTs)
Default: Internal (software)
Select the type of phase compensation to be performed by the relay. If set to Internal
(software), the transformer magnitude and phase shift compensations are performed
internally by the relay algorithm. If set to External (with CTs), the transformer phase shift
is externally compensated by the CT connections. The relay still performs magnitude
compensation when “External (with CTs)” option is selected.
When the phase compensation type External (with CTs) is selected, the relay does not
FASTPATH:
apply phase compensation internally as per the entered winding angles from the
transformer type selection. In this mode, the relay expects to measure already phase
compensated currents on its terminals. In this mode, the relay only performs magnitude
compensation.
Windings
Path: Setpoints > System > Transformer > Winding 1
Path: Setpoints > System > Transformer > Winding 2(3)
All transformer windings from 845 are associated with CT bank inputs. Depending on the
selected 845 order code, the following CT banks represent the winding currents:
1. 845 orders for two-winding transformers without voltage inputs:
– Winding 1-K1 CT bank
WINDING SETTINGS
RATED MVA
Range: 0.001 to 2000.000 MVA in steps of 0.001
Default: 5.000 MVA
Enter the self-cooled (100%) load rating for the power transformer.
NOMINAL PH-PH VOLTAGE
Range: 0.001 to 1000.000 KV in steps of 0.001
Default: 13.800 kV
Enter the nominal phase to phase voltage rating winding 1 of the transformer.
CONNECTION
Range: Wye, Delta, Zig-Zag
Default: Wye
Enter the winding connection.
ANGLE WITH RESPECT TO W1 (only in Winding 2 and Winding 3 menu)
Range: 0° , 30° Lag, 60° Lag, 90° Lag, 120° Lag, 150° Lag, 180° Lag, 210° Lag, 240° Lag, 270°
Lag, 300° Lag, 330° Lag
Default: 0°
Enter the angle by which the currents from Winding 2 (Winding 3) are lagging the
currents from Winding 1.
GROUNDING
Range: Not within zone, Within zone
Default: Not within zone
Select “Within Zone”, if there is a grounding path at the winding 1(2, 3) side of the
transformer such as grounded neutral, grounding transformer, or grounded corner of a
delta winding. Select “Not Within Zone”, if there is no grounding path for the winding in
the zone.
The Delta CT connection has the effect of removing the zero sequence components of
the phase currents. If there were a grounding bank on the Delta winding of the power
transformer within the zone of protection, a ground fault would result in differential (zero
sequence) current and false trips. In such case, it would be necessary to insert a zero
sequence current trap with the wye connected CTs on the Delta winding of the
transformer.
In general, zero sequence removal is necessary if zero sequence can flow into and out of
one transformer winding but not the other winding. Transformer windings that are
grounded inside zone protection allow zero sequence current flow in that winding, and
therefore it is from these windings that zero sequence removal is necessary.
WNDG RESISTANCE (3-Ph)
Range: 0.0001 to 100.0000 ohms in steps of 0.0001
Default: 10.0000 ohms
Enter the three-phase winding resistance from the transformer nameplate.
PHASE RELATIONSHIPS OF THREE-PHASE TRANSFORMERS
Power transformers that are built in accordance with ANSI and IEC standards are required
to identify winding terminals and phase relationships among the windings of the
transformer.
ANSI standard C.37.12.70 requires that the terminal labels include the characters 1, 2, 3 to
represent the names of the individual phases. The phase relationship among the windings
must be shown as a phasor diagram on the nameplate, with the winding terminals clearly
labeled. This standard specifically states that the phase relationships are established for a
condition where the source phase sequence of 1-2-3 is connected to transformer windings
labeled 1, 2, and 3 respectively.
IEC standard 60076-1 (1993) states that the terminal markings of the three phases follow
national practice. The phase relationship among the windings is shown as a specified
notation on the nameplate, and there may be a phasor diagram. In this standard the
arbitrary labeling of the windings is shown as I, II and III. This standard specifically states
that the phase relationships are established for a condition where a source phase
sequence of I-II-III is connected to transformer windings labeled I, II and III respectively.
Magnitude Compensation
The percent differential protection from the 845 relay uses the phase-phase voltage and
the CT primary setting of the Reference Winding (wref) (selected by the setpoint Reference
Winding under Transformer\General Setup), to perform magnitude compensation for
(bring to common base) the currents measured from the other windings.
To compute differential and restraint currents, the 845 relay uses Winding 1 phase-phase
voltage and the primary CT rating from the Signal input used for Winding 1. The 845 relay
computes magnitude compensation factors for Winding 2 and Winding 3 currents as
shown below:
VW1, VW2, VW3 - Phase-to-phase voltages (Setpoint) programmed for Winding 1, Winding 2,
and Winding 3
CTW1, CTW2, CTW3– Current transformer rated primary current (Setpoint) programmed in
Current Sensing menu and used as Signal Inputs to represent the currents from Winding 1,
Winding 2, and Winding 3.
Vmin – Minimum winding voltage
∆VTLC – Voltage difference between winding voltage at actual tap, and minimum voltage
(Setpoint)
Where CT[Wref], V[Wref] are the reference winding Phase-Phase Voltage (setpoint) and
Phase CT Primary (setpoint).
The equations above are used when the Tap Charger is not enabled (or the relay is prdered
NOTE:
The magnitude compensation factor for the reference winding currents is equal to 1.
NOTE:
NOTE
2. Tap Position Detection set to “Enabled”, and CT bank selected for TC Winding
Currents
The purpose of the tap changer installed on one of the transformer windings is to maintain
transformer output voltage within a certain bandwidth. To do this, the tap changer either
increases or decreases the turns of that winding i.e., changes its phase-phase voltage,
which in return leads to a different transformation ratio. When the transformation ratio is
changed, the nominal currents of the windings change as well, meaning that the
computation for CT mismatch based on the initially entered CT and ph-ph voltage per
winding, will be different, than the actual CT mismatch. This mismatch will appear as
differential current.
To compensate for the differential current, in cases of installed tap changer causing the
winding voltage to either go higher or lower than the nominal winding voltage entered in
the setpoints, the 845 provides dynamic CT mismatch compensation based on detection of
tap position.
The algorithm checks if the Tap Changer function is “Enabled”, and on which winding it is
installed. To determine the winding, the algorithm checks which winding has the same
selection of Signal input as the one selected for the tap changer.
If the Signal input selected for the OLTC (Onload Tap Changer) is the same as the one for
the reference winding, the magnitude compensation factors for each non-reference
winding will be computed using the following equation.
If the CT bank input is not the same as the one of the reference winding (TC installed on
non-reference winding), the computation of the compensation factor for that non-
reference winding is performed using equation below.
For the other non-reference winding without the tap changer, such as in case of a 3
winding transformer, the magnitude compensation factor is computed using the following
equation.
The maximum allowed magnitude compensation factor (and hence the maximum allowed
NOTE:
Phase Compensation Reference: The overall percent differential protection from the
845 relay uses either the Delta, or the Zig-Zag winding (depending on the transformer
setup) as a reference to perform phase shift compensation. If the transformer has only
“Wye” connected windings, the phase currents from the first Wye winding in the setup are
used as a reference.
The power system phase sequence must be set when describing the winding phase
relationships, since these relationships change, when the phase sequence changes. The
example below shows why this happens, using a transformer described in IEC
nomenclature as “Yd1”.
The Example Transformer figure shows the physical connections within the transformer
that produce a phase angle in the delta winding lagging the respective wye winding by
30°. The winding currents are also identified. Note that the total current out of the delta
winding is described by an equation. Now assume that a source, with a sequence of ABC, is
connected to transformer terminals ABC, respectively. The currents that would be present
for a balanced load are shown below.
Figure 5-16: Phasors for ABC Sequence
Note that the delta winding currents lag the wye winding currents by 30°, which is in
agreement with the transformer nameplate.
Now assume that a source, with a sequence of ACB is connected to transformer terminals
A, C, B respectively. The currents that would be present for a balanced load are shown in
the next figure: Phasors for ACB Sequence.
Figure 5-17: Phasors for ACB Sequence
h f
Note that the delta winding currents lead the wye winding currents by 30°, (which is a type
Yd11 in IEC nomenclature), which is in disagreement with the transformer nameplate. This
is because the physical connections and hence the equations used to calculate current for
the delta winding have not changed. The transformer nameplate phase relationship
information is only correct for a stated phase sequence.
It is suggested that for the ACB sequence the phase relationship can be returned to that
shown on the transformer nameplate by connecting source phases A, B and C to
transformer terminals A, C, and B respectively. This will restore the nameplate phase shifts
but will cause incorrect identification of phases B and C within the relay, and is therefore
not recommended.
All information presented in this manual is based on connecting the relay phase A, B and C
terminals to the power system phases A, B and C respectively. The transformer types and
phase relationships presented are for a system phase sequence of ABC, in accordance
with the standards for power transformers. Users with a system phase sequence of ACB
must determine the transformer type for this sequence.
The following diagram shows the internal connections of the Y/d30 transformer from our
example.
Figure 5-18: Wye/Delta (30° lag) Transformer
Under balanced conditions, the winding 2 phase currents lag the corresponding phase
currents of winding 1 by 30°. With CTs connected in a wye arrangement (polarity markings
pointing away from the transformer), even after magnitude compensation, the summation
of the currents from both transformer windings will not result in zero differential current,
because they will NOT be 180° out-of-phase.
Traditionally, this problem was solved by connecting the CTs from the wye side of the
transformer (winding 1) in a delta. This compensates for the phase angle lag introduced in
the delta side (winding 2).
The 845 performs the phase angle correction internally based on the setpoint “Angle With
Respect to W1” from the menu System > Transformer > Transformer Setup > see
“Winding 2”, and the same setpoint from the menu System > Transformer > Transformer
Setup > see “Winding 3” for three-winding transformer protection.
The angle of Winding 1 is always 0°, and this setpoint is omitted from the Winding 1 setup
NOTE:
menu.
NOTE
The 845 supports all standard two-, and three-winding transformer types, and a variety of
non-standard applications, where the selection of winding connection type and selected
lagging angle with respect to Winding 1 are not described in the table of standard
transformer types.
As shown in the menu for transformer windings setup, the 30° lag of the Delta winding
currents, will result in a 0° phase shift applied to Delta currents (Delta –phase reference),
and a 30° phase angle correction (phase shift) applied to the winding 1 currents (Wye
winding). These angle corrections are described in the table as Phase shift.
In general, zero sequence removal is necessary if zero sequence can flow into and out of
one transformer winding but not the other windings. Transformer windings that are
grounded inside the zone of protection allow zero sequence current flow in that winding,
and therefore it is from these windings that zero sequence removal is necessary.
The 845 performs this phase angle compensation and zero sequence removal
automatically, based on the settings entered for the transformer. All CTs are connected
Wye (polarity markings pointing away from the transformer). All currents are phase and
zero sequence compensated internally before the calculation of differential and restraint
quantities.
The phase reference winding (wf) is the winding which will have a phase shift of 0° applied
to it. The phase reference winding is chosen to be the delta or zigzag (non-wye) winding
with the lowest winding index, if one exists. For a transformer that has no delta or zigzag
windings, the first “wye” winding is chosen.
The phase compensation angle φcomp is the angle by which a winding current is shifted
with reference to the angle of the reference winding, and is calculated by the 845 for each
winding as follows
φcomp[w] = | φ[wf] – φ[w] | where Rotation = “ABC”
φcomp[w] = | φ[w] – φ[wf] | where Rotation = “ACB”
The following figure: Phase and Zero Sequence Compensation for Typical Values of φcomp,
shows the phase shift compensation equations of transformer winding currents, based on
typical phase compensation angles φcomp, and whether or not the zero sequence current
is removed:
where:
IA[w] = uncompensated winding ‘w’ phase A current
IAp[w] = phase and zero sequence compensated winding ‘w’ phase A current
Figure 5-20: Phase and Zero Sequence Compensation for Typical Values of φ comp
p
p I A > w @ = --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @ – --- I C > w @
IA > w @ = IA >w @
p p
IB > w @ = IB > w @ I B > w @ = --- I B > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I C > w @
p
IC > w @ = IC > w @ p
I C > w @ = --- I C > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @
ODJ p p
I A > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @
p p
I B > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – -------I A > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I A > w @
p p
I C > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @
ODJ p
p I A > w @ = – --- I C > w @ + --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @
IA > w @ = –IC > w @
p p
IB > w @ = – IA > w @ I B > w @ = – --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @ + --- I C > w @
p
IC > w @ = – IB > w @ p
I C > w @ = – --- I B > w @ + --- I A > w @ + --- I C > w @
ODJ p p
I A > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @
p p
I B > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @
p p
I C > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – -------I B > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I B > w @
ODJ p
p I A > w @ = --- I B > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I C > w @
IA > w @ = IB > w @
p p
IB > w @ = IC > w @ I B > w @ = --- I C > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @
p
IC > w @ = IA >w @ p
I C > w @ = --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @ – --- I C > w @
ODJ p p
I A > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – -------I A > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I A > w @
p p
I B > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @
p p
I C > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @
ODJ p
p I A > w @ = – --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @ + --- I C > w @
IA > w @ = – IA > w @
p p - -
IB > w @ = – IB > w @ I B > w @ = – I B > w @ + I A > w @ + --- I C > w @
-- --
p
IC > w @ = –IC > w @ p
I C > w @ = – --- I C > w @ + --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @
210° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – -------I B > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I B > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @
3 3 3 3
240° lag p 2 1 1
p I A > w @ = --- I C > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @
IA > w @ = IC > w @ 3 3 3
p p 2 1 1
IB > w @ = IA >w @ I B > w @ = --- I A > w @ – --- I B > w @ – --- I C > w @
3 3 3
p
IC > w @ = IB > w @ p 2 1 1
I C > w @ = --- I B > w @ – --- I A > w @ – --- I C > w @
3 3 3
270° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I B > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I C > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – -------I A > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I A > w @
3 3 3 3
300° lag p 2 1 1
p I A > w @ = – --- I B > w @ + --- I A > w @ + --- I C > w @
IA > w @ = – IB > w @ 3 3 3
p p 2 1 1
IB > w @ = –IC > w @ I B > w @ = – --- I C > w @ + --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @
3 3 3
p
IC > w @ = – IA > w @ p 2 1 1
I C > w @ = – --- I A > w @ + --- I B > w @ + --- I C > w @
3 3 3
330° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – -------I B > w @ I A > w @ = ------- I A > w @ – ------- I B > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @ I B > w @ = ------- I B > w @ – ------- I C > w @
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @ I C > w @ = ------- I C > w @ – ------- I A > w @
3 3 3 3
where: IAC[w] , IBC[w], and ICC[w] - magnitude, phase and zero sequence compensated
winding phase currents
M[w1]- magnitude compensation factor for winding 1 (see previous sections)
M[w2]- magnitude compensation factor for winding 2 (see previous sections)
M[w3] - magnitude compensation factor for winding 3 (see previous sections)
IAP[w] , IBP[w], and ICP[w]- phase and zero sequence compensated winding phase currents
(see earlier)
The magnitude compensation factor for the reference winding is 1.
EXAMPLE
Consider a typical Wye/Delta power transformer with the following data:
Since Winding 1 is always magnitude compensation reference, the currents from winding
1 , are scaled only to be presented in times Winding 1 CT.
MW1 = 1 , - magnitude compensation factor for winding 1 - REFERENCE
Winding 1 currents = (MW1*Iload(W1))/CTW1 = 104.5/500 = 0.209 x CTW1
To check that the measured currents from both windings will sum-up to zero after applying
magnitude compensation, one can perform the following simple calculations:
The non-reference Wye winding will be rotated by -30° degrees to be in-phase and match
the currents from the Delta winding.
Per figure: Two-winding transformer connections for phase compensation angle of 30 lag,
the relay will use the following phase and zero-sequence compensation equations:
Winding 2 (Delta):
IAp[w] = IA[w]
IBp[w] = IB[w]
ICp[w]= IC[w]
Restraint currents:
IrA= 0.209 x CT
IrB= 0.209 x CT
IrC= 0.209 x CT
Xfmer Status The 845 relay can be set to detect the status of the protected transformer when energized
Detection or de-energized. The detection of the transformer energized/de-energized status is set to
produce operands, which can be used for transformer monitoring applications, and to
trigger an LED (operand set by the factory to trigger LED “Transformer De-Energized”). The
transformer status is detected based on measured voltage, or breaker status, which can
be supervised by a current above the programmed minimum level.
Detection by breaker status
When the ‘b’ auxiliary contacts from all switching devices (which can be used to energize
the transformer) are assigned to the ALL BREAKERS OPEN setpoints, closed contacts
indicate de-energization. When Current Supervision is enabled, any current exceeding the
minimum energization current indicates energization.
Detection by voltage
When energization sensing by voltage is enabled, any voltage drops below the minimum
energization voltage indicates de-energization. However, if Current Supervision is enabled,
any of the winding currents that exceed the minimum energization current shows that the
transformer is being energized.
Current Supervision
The Current Supervision is set to support the decision for the Transformer Energized or De-
Energized status. If all winding currents drop below the minimum transformer magnetizing
current after transformer de-energization, this will be added to the decision from the
selected sensing method (Opened Breakers, or Voltage), and will indicate de-energization.
Any current exceeding the minimum energization current will indicate energization.
Path: Setpoints > System > Transformer > Xfmr Status Detection
SENSING BY BREAKERS OPEN
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This method of sensing indicates that when all transformer breakers are detected open,
the transformer must be de-energized. For a more secure detection, the breakers open
detection can be supervised by the detection of the minimum current, when the Current
Supervision setpoint is enabled.
ALL BREAKERS OPEN
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Select the FlexLogic operand from the list representing to assert a flag when all
transformer breakers are open. This can be “52b” contacts from the transformer
breakers wired in series before connected to the relay, or another FlexLogic operand
(Virtual Output) becoming high upon the open status of all breakers.
SENSING BY VOLTAGE
Range: Disabled, Ph VT Bank 1-J2, Ax VT Bank1-J2
Default: Disabled
Select Ph VT Bnk1-J2 to detect the transformer status if all three-phase VTs are
connected to the phase VT terminals on the relay. Select Ax VT Bnk1-J2 if only one
voltage input is available from the system, and it is connected to Vaux terminals of the
voltage bank J2. In order for the relay to detect the transformer status accurately, the
VTs must be placed within the differential zone of protection between the Breaker and
the winding. If the VTs are placed outside the zone of protection, the transformer status
will not be correct. Even when the breaker is open, the relay can show the Transformer
Energized status.
The transformer status detection will work even if only one voltage input is available from
NOTE:
the power system. In such cases, the voltage input must be connected to the appropriate
NOTE phase voltage terminals on the relay. Since the other two voltages per the logic diagram
will be zero, the transformer de-energized status will be detected when the magnitude of
the connected single voltage input is below the minimum voltage setting.
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.50 to 0.99 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 0.85 x VT
Select the minimum voltage level required for the energized/de-energized transformer
status. Note that during faults the voltage tends to decrease. If the voltage stays below
the minimum voltage for more than 50 ms, the transformer will show the transformer
de-energized status. This situation can be avoided if Current Supervision is set to
“Enabled”. In this case, even if all the voltages collapse below the minimum voltage level,
the transformer will still show energized, because during fault conditions at least one
phase will measure substantial current.
When Sensing by Voltage is set to Ph VT Bnk1-J1, the 845 relay calculates delta voltages,
FASTPATH:
and compares them against the specified minimum voltage threshold given in times VT.
If Wye is programmed for phase VT connection, the VT unit is obtained by multiplying the
programmed secondary voltage through the VT ratio and SQRT(3). If Delta is
programmed for phase VT connection, multiplication of SQRT(3) is not necessary.
When Sensing by Voltage is set to Ax VT Bnk1-J2, the minimum voltage threshold applies
to the voltage measured at the auxiliary voltage input from the J2 terminals..
CURRENT SUPERVISION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
Current supervision can be used to add another element into one or another sensing
mechanism for detecting the Transformer Energized, or Transformer De-Energized
status. When “Enabled” the relay scans all the winding currents and compares the
measurements against the programmed setpoint “Minimum Current” level.
MINIMUM CURRENT
Range: 0.020 to 0.500 x CT in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.050 x CT
Select the minimum current, below which the transformer is considered de-energized.
Current supervision alone cannot change the Transformer De-Energized status unless
all transfer breakers are open or the voltage drops below the Minimum Voltage level.
Note that if no load is connected to a transformer which has been energized, the current
transformers from the closed breaker will detect only the transformer magnetizing
current. In order to have Transformer energized status supervised by current, the level
of the minimum current must be below the transformer magnetizing current.
When Enabled, a current level (< Minimum Current) alone does not change the
Transformer De-Energized status unless all transformer breakers are open or voltage
drops below Minimum Voltage level. Moreover, when Current Supervision is enabled,
neither All Breakers Open nor a voltage less than the Minimum Voltage can change the
Transformer De-Energized status unless current falls below the Minimum Current level.
When Current Supervision is Disabled, transformer De-Energized status monitoring is
based on the All Breakers Open condition or voltage less than Minimum Voltage
condition.
CURRENT SUPERVISION
Disabled = 0, Enabled = 1
METERING SETPOINT
W1 Ib W1 Ib < Minimum
W1 Ic W1 Ic < Minimum
W2 Ia W2 Ia < Minimum
W2 Ib W2 Ib < Minimum
AND
W2 Ic W2 Ic < Minimum
AND
W3 Ia W3 Ia < Minimum
W3 Ib W3 Ib < Minimum
W3 Ic W3 Ic < Minimum
SETPOINT
SENSING BY BREAKERS
OPEN
Disabled = 0 Enabled =1
LED: DE-ENERGIZED
AND
SETPOINT
AND
ALL BREAKERS OPEN FlexLogic Operand
t PKP= 50ms
OR
SETPOINT
FlexLogic Operand
AND
FlexLogic Operand
SENSING BY VOLTAGE Not Configured
NOR
XFMR Energized
Disabled = 0, Enabled = 1
Ph VT Bnk1 -J2, Ax VT
Bnk1 -J2
Figure 5-23: Transformer Status Detection Logic Diagram
SETPOINT 894009A3.cdr
METERING
RUN
PHASE VOLTAGE (J2)
AND
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Vab V < Minimum Ph VT
Bnk1-J2
Vbc V < Minimum
AND
Thermal Inputs The 845 relay can be set to monitor the hottest-spot winding temperature, the aging
acceleration factor and the transformer insulation life. In order for the relay to perform the
correct calculations, the user needs to enter transformer data and program RTD inputs for
measuring ambient and top-oil temperatures. The following menu shows the selections for
ambient and top-oil temperatures.
Path: Setpoints > System > Transformer > Thermal Inputs
WINDING CURRENTS
Range: CT Bank1-J1, CT Bank 2 – K1, CT Bank 3 –K2
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
Select the bank representing the currents (loading) of the winding to which the thermal
elements are applied.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
Range: Monthly Average, RTD 1, RTD 2….RTD x
Default: Monthly Average
Select RTD input if the ambient temperature is to be measured directly. Select the
“Monthly Average” setting and enter an average temperature for every month of the
year, if direct ambient temperature measurement is not available.
The setpoints for average monthly temperatures will show on the screen only when the
NOTE:
“Monthly Average” setting is selected. In all other cases, these setpoints will be hidden.
NOTE
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE AVG - Jan to Dec
Range: -60°C to 60°C (-76°F to 140°F) in steps of 1°C
Default: Jan= -20, Feb= -20, Mar= -10, Apr= 10, May= 20, Jun= 30, Jul= 30, Aug= 30, Sep=
20, Oct= 10, Nov= 10, Dec= -10
TOP-OIL TEMPERATURE
Range: Computed, RTD 1, RTD 2….RTD x
Default: Computed
Select RTD input for direct measurement of top-oil temperature. If such input is not
available, select the setting “Computed”.
Refer to SETPOINTS/RTD Temperature, on how to select RTD, to be used for measuring
NOTE:
On-load Tap Changer This section contains the settings to configure the tap position input. The 845 relay offers
tap position detection by monitoring either a resistive input from the tap changer control
circuitry, a dcmA analog input, or by Binary Coded Decimal (BCD) inputs. Based on the
detected tap, the 845 relay dynamically corrects for CT ratio mismatch resulting from the
changes of the voltage ratio of the transformer. Thus, the percent differential function of
the device can be set for greater sensitivity. See Section: Windings> Magnitude
Compensation > item Device, System, Input and Output Setpoints2. LTC compensation set
to “Enabled”, for more details on the tap position input.
Tap detection using Resistive Input
A typical tap position input layout is shown in the figure: Tap position input. Minimum tap
position and minimum tap voltage correspond to the “TAP 1” label in the figure.
In this method of detection, the resistive output from the tap changer is connected to the
Ohms input on the relay. The maximum resistance supported by the Ohms input is 5.1kΩ.
The user defines the minimum and maximum tap, voltage increment per tap, and the
Ohms per tap.
Tap detection using dcmA analog input
In this method, the user selects Analog Input 1 dedicated for detection of DC milliamp
value corresponding to a tap position. To detect the tap, the relay measures the dcmA
current at the terminal of the Analog Input 1 and compares it to the corresponding dcmA
current computed for each tap.
Tap detection using BCD input
The Binary Coded Decimal (BCD) is another way of detecting tap position by using the
combination of six bits each driven by contact input. The user wires and selects the
contact input per bit number. Each combination of six bits corresponds to a certain tap
position. Refer to the following table: All BCD combinations supported by the relay:
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Transformer > Tap Changer
TAP POSITION DETECTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
TC WINDING CURRENTS
Range: None, J1, K1, K2
Default: None
Enter the CT bank associated with the winding with tap changer. Enter 'None' if the
transformer is not equipped with a tap changer. Enter 'None' if automatic magnitude
compensation based on tap position used for the differential protection is not needed.
The setting “None” can be selected in cases where either the transformer is not
equipped with Tap Changer, or it is equipped with Tap Changer, but it is not desired to
position voltage will be used for automatic magnitude mismatch compensation for the
NOTE winding represented by the same CT bank currents. Otherwise, if the setpoint TC Winding
Currents is set to “None”, the mismatch magnitude computation is not automatically
updated to include the new transformation ratio. In such cases, the relay may display
differential current, where this current will be higher for taps far away from the tap
representing the nominal winding voltage, and it will be lower for taps closer to the
nominal voltage tap. It is recommended to increase the minimum PKP setting of the
Percent Differential characteristic to be above the maximum differential current that can
be seen at either Maximum tap, or Minimum tap.
available for use in any other application. The Analog Input 1 is excluded from the list
of analog inputs, and its range is forced to 0.000 – 20.000 mA. The Tap changer
monitors the measured µA. When the total number of taps per the tap changer setup is
computed, the tap position is detected based on minimum tap corresponding to the
measured DCmA at MIN TAP, maximum tap corresponding to the measured DCmA at
MAX TAP, and the µA step obtained by dividing the total µA of DCmA at MIN TAP and
DCmA at MAX TAP by the total number of taps.
MIN TAP
Range: -19 to +35 in steps of 1
Default: -16
This setting defines the minimum tap from the tap changer. The 845 uses the setting to
signal when the minimum tap is reached.
NEUTRAL TAP
Range: -17 to +37 in steps of 1
Default: 0
This setting defines the neutral tap position. The 845 uses the setting to signal when the
neutral tap is reached.
MAX TAP
Range: 0 to +39 in steps of 1
Default: +16
This setting defines the maximum tap from the tap changer. The 845 uses this setting to
signal when the maximum tap is reached.
MIN TAP VOLTAGE
Range: 0.01 to 20000.00 kV in steps of 0.01 kV
Default: 61.00 kV
Enter the voltage at the minimum position
VOLTAGE INCREMENT PER TAP
Range: 0.01 to 20.00 kV in steps of 0.01 kV
Default: 0.50 kV
Enter the voltage increment per tap change.
Ohms at MIN TAP
Range: 0 to 5100 Ohms in steps of 1 Ohm
Default: 33 Ohms
Enter the resistance in Ohms corresponding to the minimum tap. This setting is used
only when Ohms input is selected as “Tap Detection Input”.
Ohms at MAX TAP
Range: 0 to 5100 Ohms in steps of 1 Ohm
Default: 1089 Ohms
Enter the resistance in Ohms corresponding to the maximum tap. This setting is used
only when Ohms input is selected as “Tap Detection Input”.
DCmA at MIN TAP
Range: 0.000 to 20.000 mA in steps of 0.001 mA
Default: 4.000 mA
Enter the DCmA current corresponding to the minimum tap. This setting is used only
when Analog In 1 is selected as “Tap Detection Input”.
DCmA at MAX TAP
Range: 0.000 to 20.000 mA in steps of 0.001 mA
Default: 18.000 mA
Enter the DCmA current corresponding to the maximum tap. This setting is used only
when Analog In 1 is selected as “Tap Detection Input”.
BCD BIT 1- 5 INPUT
Range: Off, Contact Input 1(X), Virtual Input 1(X), Remote Input 1(X)
Default: Off
The six BCD inputs require selection of contact inputs, virtual inputs, or remote inputs.
The tap position is detected by the state combination of high/low bits received from the
tap changer mechanism.
Figure 5-25: An example of BCD decoder connections to an IO_A card for up to 19 taps
MIN TAP BCD bit 6 Input BCD bit 5 Input BCD bit 4 Input BCD bit 3 Input BCD bit 2 Input BCD bit 1 Input TAP Position
+Tap 0 1 1 0 0 1 19
+Tap 0 1 1 0 1 0 invalid
+Tap 0 1 1 0 1 1 invalid
+Tap 0 1 1 1 0 0 invalid
+Tap 0 1 1 1 0 1 invalid
+Tap 0 1 1 1 1 0 invalid
+Tap 0 1 1 1 1 1 invalid
+Tap 1 0 0 0 0 0 20
+Tap 1 0 0 0 0 1 21
+Tap 1 0 0 0 1 0 22
+Tap 1 0 0 0 1 1 23
+Tap 1 0 0 1 0 0 24
+Tap 1 0 0 1 0 1 25
+Tap 1 0 0 1 1 0 26
+Tap 1 0 0 1 1 1 27
+Tap 1 0 1 0 0 0 28
+Tap 1 0 1 0 0 1 29
+Tap 1 0 1 0 1 0 invalid
+Tap 1 0 1 0 1 1 invalid
+Tap 1 0 1 1 0 0 invalid
+Tap 1 0 1 1 0 1 invalid
+Tap 1 0 1 1 1 0 invalid
+Tap 1 0 1 1 1 1 invalid
+Tap 1 1 0 0 0 0 30
+Tap 1 1 0 0 0 1 31
+Tap 1 1 0 0 1 0 32
+Tap 1 1 0 0 1 1 33
+Tap 1 1 0 1 0 0 34
+Tap 1 1 0 1 0 1 35
+Tap 1 1 0 1 1 0 36
+Tap 1 1 0 1 1 1 37
+Tap 1 1 1 0 0 0 38
+Tap 1 1 1 0 0 1 39
+Tap 1 1 1 0 1 0 invalid
+Tap 1 1 1 0 1 1 invalid
+Tap 1 1 1 1 0 0 invalid
+Tap 1 1 1 1 0 1 invalid
+Tap 1 1 1 1 1 0 invalid
+Tap 1 1 1 1 1 1 Invalid
…. …. … … … … … …
-Tap 0 0 0 0 0 1 +1
-Tap 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
-Tap 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
-Tap 1 0 0 0 0 1 -1
-Tap 1 0 0 0 1 0 -2
… … ... … … … … …
-Tap 1 1 1 0 0 1 -19
Breakers
The status of each winding breaker is detected on the 845 relay by monitoring the state/
states of either one, or preferably two contact inputs. It is highly recommended to monitor
the status of the breaker using both breaker auxiliary contacts 52a, and 52b. However
using only one of them is also acceptable.
The breaker connection/disconnection to/from the power system (racked-out by the
breaker racking mechanism, or isolated by the associated disconnect switches on a fixed
circuit breaker) is provided by monitoring the contact input “BKR CONNECTED”. If the
contact input selected under the “BKR CONNECTED” setpoint is asserted, the breaker is
considered connected to the primary system. When the breaker is determined
disconnected, the breaker state is shown to be neither open, nor closed. The trolley is
integrated with a circuit breaker (CB), which works as a Disconnect switch. CB Trolley
status is decided based on the contact input selected under the “CONNECTED” and “BKR
TROLLEY” setpoints.
NAME
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: BKRX
CONTACT INPUT 52a
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Selects the Contact Input connected to the Breaker auxiliary contact 52a.
CONTACT INPUT 52b
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Selects the Contact Input connected to the Breaker auxiliary contact 52b.
CONNECTED
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Select a contact input to show whether the breaker is connected (Racked-in, or
disconnect switches switched-on), or disconnected (racked-out, or disconnect switches
switched-off) from the system.
BKR TROLLEY
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Select a contact input to show whether the Breaker Trolley is connected or disconnected
from the system.
TRIP RELAY SELECT
Range: Off, Any Output Relay
Default: Relay 1
Any output relay from the list of available output relays can be programmed for breaker
tripping action. Please refer to the table from the section Output Relaysfor more detail on
output relay availability with respect to their assignment.
CLOSE RELAY SELECT
Range: Off, Relay X
Default: Relay 2
Any output relay from the list of available output relays can be programmed for breaker
closing action. Please refer to the table from the section Output Relaysfor more detail on
output relay availability with respect to their assignment.
Table 5-6: Breaker status depending on availability of contacts 52a and 52b
52a Contact Configured 52b Contact Configured Breaker Status
Open Closed
Yes Yes 52a contact open 52a contact closed
52b contact closed 52b contact open
Yes No 52a contact open 52a contact closed
No Yes 52b contact closed 52b contact open
No No Breaker Not Configured
Table 5-7: Breaker status with both contacts 52a and 52b configured
52a Contact Status 52b Contact Status Breaker Status
Off On BKR Opened
On Off BKR Closed
On On BKR Unknown State
Off Off BKR Unknown State
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETPOINT
BKR 1 Disconnected
BKR 1 Connected
OR
AND
BKR 1 Connected
Connected FlexLogic
operand status
SETPOINT
BKR 1 Trolley
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Off = 0
OR
AND
894207A2.cdr
TARGET MESSAGE
OR
(to Trip and Close output relays)
SETPOINT
AND
PB LED: BREAKER CLOSED
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
BKR 1 Closed
SETPOINT
52b CONTACT
AND
FlexLogic operand =1, Off = 0
OR
BKR 1 Opened
FlexLogic operand
(BKR 52b status)
LED: ALARM
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
30 ms
XOR
BKR 1 Unkwn State
AND
892740A3.cdr
Switches
The Single Line Diagram (SLD) from the 8 Series relays can be configured with up to 9
disconnect switches. The disconnect switch detection is performed by monitoring the
state/states of either one or preferably two contact inputs 89a and 89b. Monitoring the
status of the switch using both auxiliary contacts 89a, and 89b is recommended, however
using only one of them is also possible.When both contacts are programmed, the switch
can be monitored for state discrepancy, i.e. both auxiliary contacts OFF, or both auxiliary
contacts ON during operation. Discrepancy Alarm Delay can be programmed to reflect the
transition of the switch during operation from Closed to Opened, and Opened to Closed. If
no auxiliary contact discrepancy is detected after the time delay expires, the switch will be
in one of its normal states, i.e. Opened or Closed. However, if contact inputs discrepancy is
detected after the time delay expires, the relay will issue a “SW1(9) Discrepancy” target
message and illuminate the ALARM LED. The switch discrepancy condition can be reset by
the operand assigned under Reset Alarm setpoint, providing both contact inputs 89a and
89b show normal states on the relay.
Path: Setpoints > System > Switches > Switch 1(9)
NAME
Range: 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: SW 1
Assign a user-defined name to the disconnect switch. This name is used in the SLD, flash
messages related to disconnect switch 1, and the event recorder.
The selection of Output Relay for Open Relay Select and Close Relay Select has higher
CAUTION:
priority than other settings as follows: If an Output Relay is first set to "Operate" under
a protection element for example, and then this same Output Relay is selected under
either Open Relay Select or Close Relay Select, this Output Relay is automatically
reverted to "Do Not Operate" and hidden from the menu of the protection element.
Deselecting the Output Relay from Open Relay Select or Close Relay Select unhides the
output in the menu of the protection element showing the setting value "Do Not
Operate".
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
This setting disables or enables the disconnect switch operation events.
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-Reset, Latched
Default: Enabled
This setting disables or enables the disconnect switch operation Targets.
The logic for Switch configuration and the Open, and Close status is shown in the following
tables.
Table 5-8: Switch configuration with Open and Close status
Contact Input 89a Contact Input 89b Switch Status
setpoint programming setpoint programming
Open Closed
Yes Yes 89a contact open 89a contact closed
89b contact closed 89b contact open
Yes No 89a contact open 89a contact closed
No Yes 89b contact closed 89b contact open
No No Not Configured
Table 5-9: Switch status with both contacts 89a and 89b programmed
89a Contact Status 89b Contact Status Disconnect Switch Status
Off On SW[X] Opened
On Off SW[X] Closed
On On SW[X] Intermittent, SW[X]
Discrepancy
Off Off
OR
SETPOINT
89a CONTACT
FlexLogic operand =1, Off = 0
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
OR
SETPOINT
89b CONTACT
FlexLogic operand =1, Off = 0
AND
FlexLogic operand
(SW1 89a state)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
FlexLogic operand
(SW1 89b state)
89b CONTACT
t PKP Positive
Edge S
XOR
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
894193A1.cdr
OR
SETPOINT
RESET ALARM
FlexLogic operand, Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
5–107
SYSTEM
SW1 INTERMITTENT
SYSTEM CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
FlexCurves
The relay incorporates four programmable FlexCurves - FlexCurve A, B, C and D. The points
for these curves are defined in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software. User-defined curves
can be used for Time Overcurrent protection in the same way as IEEE, IAC, ANSI, and IEC
curves. Each of the four FlexCurves has 120-point settings for entering times to reset and
operate, 40 points for reset (from 0 to 0.98 times the Pickup value) and 80 for operate (from
1.03 to 20 times the Pickup). This data is converted into two continuous curves by linear
interpolation between data points.
Path: Setpoints > System > FlexCurves
Use the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software program to select, design or modify any of the
NOTE:
FlexCurves.
NOTE
The following table for FlexCurves A, B, C, and D details the 120 points as well as the
characteristic for each of them, and a blank cell to write the time value when the operation
(for I > Ipickup) or the reset (for I < Ipickup) is required.
RESET TIME ms RESET TIME ms OPERATE TIME OPERATE TIME OPERATE TIME OPERATE TIME
ms ms ms ms
0.00 0.68 1.03 2.9 4.9 10.5
0.05 0.70 1.05 3.0 5.0 11.0
0.10 0.72 1.1 3.1 5.1 11.5
0.15 0.74 1.2 3.2 5.2 12.0
0.20 0.76 1.3 3.3 5.3 12.5
0.25 0.78 1.4 3.4 5.4 13.0
0.30 0.80 1.5 3.5 5.5 13.5
0.35 0.82 1.6 3.6 5.6 14.0
0.40 0.84 1.7 3.7 5.7 14.5
0.45 0.86 1.8 3.8 5.8 15.0
0.48 0.88 1.9 3.9 5.9 15.5
0.50 0.90 2.0 4.0 6.0 16.0
0.52 0.91 2.1 4.1 6.5 16.5
0.54 0.92 2.2 4.2 7.0 17.0
0.56 0.93 2.3 4.3 7.5 17.5
0.58 0.94 2.4 4.4 8.0 18.0
0.60 0.95 2.5 4.5 8.5 18.5
0.62 0.96 2.6 4.6 9.0 19.0
0.64 0.97 2.7 4.7 9.5 19.5
0.66 0.98 2.8 4.8 10.0 20.0
The first two columns (40 points) correspond to the RESET curve. The other 4 columns, with
80 points in total, correspond to the OPERATE curve. The reset characteristic values are
between 0 and 0.98xPKP, and the operation values are between 1.03 and 20xPKP.
The final curve is created by means of a linear interpolation from the defined points. This is
a separate process for the RESET and the OPERATE curve.
The definition of these points is performed in a separate module from the relay, using a
configuration program included in EnerVista 8 Series Setup software, which incorporates a
graphical environment for viewing the curve, thus making it easy to create.
The relay using a given FlexCurve applies linear approximation for times lying between the
FASTPATH:
user-entered points. Therefore, special care must be taken when setting the points close to
a Pickup multiple of 1; that is, 0.97*Ipickup and 0.98*Ipickup should be set to a similar value
as 1.03*Ipickup. Otherwise, the thermal model may incorrectly estimate the TCU% level
resulting in undesired behavior.
Inputs
Figure 5-29: Inputs Display Hierarchy
Setpoints Device
System
Contact Inputs
Inputs
Data
VirtualCapture
Inputs
Outputs
Analog Inputs
Protection
Remote Inputs*
Control
FlexLogic
Testing
Contact Inputs
The 845 relay is equipped with a number of Contact Inputs, depending on the Order Code,
which can be used to provide a variety of functions such as for circuit breaker control,
external trips, blocking of protection elements, etc. Contact inputs accept wet and dry
input signals. A wet type contact input signal requires an external DC voltage source. A dry
type contact input signal uses an internal DC voltage source. Depending on the DC source
level, the voltage threshold (17V, 33V, 84V, 166V) can be selected. The Contact Inputs can
be located on the HV I/O and Arc Flash cards located on slots ‘B’ or ‘C’ or ‘F’ or ‘G’ or ‘H’ or
all.
The maximum load current that can be delivered by the relay +24 V wetting voltage supply
NOTE:
is 100 mA. When the internal +24 V supply is used, the current limitations of the 24V supply
NOTE must be considered.
The Contact Inputs are either open or closed with a programmable debounce time to
prevent false operation from induced voltage. The debounce time is adjustable per
manufacturer specifications.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of one
protection pass (1/8 cycle) as shown in the figure below. The DC input voltage is compared
to a user-settable threshold. A new Contact Input state must be maintained for a user-
configurable debounce time in order for the relay to validate the new contact state. In the
figure below, the debounce time is set at 2.5 ms; thus the 3rd sample in a row validates the
change of state (mark no. 2 in the diagram). Once validated (debounced), the new state will
be declared and a FlexLogic operand will be asserted at the time of a new protection pass.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when
logging the change of the Contact Input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 1 in the
diagram).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic equations and timers, are executed
eight times in a power system cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the
frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic operand reflecting the debounced state of
the contact is updated at the protection pass following the debounce (marked no. 2 on the
figure below). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all
protection and control functions, as well as FlexLogic equations, are fed with the updated
states of the Contact Inputs.
The FlexLogic operand response time to the Contact Input change is related to the
debounce time setting plus up to one protection pass (variable and depending on system
frequency if frequency tracking enabled). For example, 8 protection passes per cycle on a
60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a contact debounce time
setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic™ operand-assert time limits are: 4.2 + 0.0 = 4.2 ms and 4.2
+ 2.1 = 6.3 ms. The 4.2 ms is the minimum protection pass period that contains a debounce
time, 3.0 ms.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the Contact Input event is time-stamped
with 1 protection pass accuracy using the time of the first scan corresponding to the new
state (mark no. 1 below). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the DC voltage
across the Contact Input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently
validated using the debounce timer. The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same
procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks no.1 and 2 in the
figure below) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 3 and 4 below) transitions.
Figure 5-30: Contact Input Debouncing Mechanism and Time-stamping Sample Timing
Path: Setpoints > Inputs > Contact Inputs > CI Voltage Threshold
Depending on the order code, Voltage Threshold value can be configured for all the
Contact Inputs (Slot F/G/H with order code ‘A’ or ‘M’ or ‘F’) or for each group of Contact
Inputs (Slot F/G/H with order code ‘B’ or ‘K’ and Slot B/C with order code ‘C’).
As an example, the following section shows description of the settings for Slot F with order
code ‘A’, Slot G with order code ‘B’ and Slot B with order code ‘C’.
Contact input card type ‘A’ allocated at Slot F requires one Voltage Threshold configuration
for all the contact inputs. Contact input card type ‘B’ allocated at Slot G has two groups of
five contact inputs and therefore requires two Voltage Threshold settings. While Contact
input card type ‘C’ allocated at Slot B has three groups of five contact inputs, and therefore
requires three Voltage Threshold settings.
Each Voltage Threshold setting is distinct by the slot or terminal numbers. For example:
‘Voltage Threshold/Slot F’ specifies the threshold setting of all the contact inputs in Slot F
with order code ‘A’; while ‘Voltage Threshold/G13-G17’ specifies the threshold setting for
group of five contact inputs with terminals G13 to G17.
Upon start-up, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed
modules) which Contact Inputs are available, then displays settings for only these inputs.
VOLTAGE THRESHOLD /[X]
Range: 17, 33, 84, 166 VDC
Default: 17 VDC
The setting determines the minimum voltage required to detect a closed Contact Input.
The value is selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V
sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V sources and 166 for 250 V sources.
For internal wetting set the Voltage Threshold to 17V.
FASTPATH:
When thresholds above 17V are selected, the internal +24V is disabled.
FASTPATH:
Path: Setpoints > Inputs > Contact Inputs > Contact Input X
NAME
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: CI 1
An alphanumeric name may be assigned to a Contact Input for diagnostic, setting, and
event recording purposes. The CI X ON (Logic 1) FlexLogic operand corresponds to
Contact Input “X” being closed, while CI X OFF corresponds to Contact Input “X” being
open.
DEBOUNCE TIME
Range: 0.0 to 16.0 ms in steps of 0.5 ms
Default: 10.0 ms
The Debounce Time defines the time required for the contact to overcome ‘contact
bouncing’ conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers,
set it as a maximum contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some
margin to ensure proper operation.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
For example, to use Contact Input F1 as a status input from the breaker 52b contact, to
seal-in the trip relay and record it in the Event Records menu, make the following settings
changes:
CONTACT INPUT 1 NAME: "52b"
CONTACT INPUT 1 EVENTS: "Enabled"
The 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
FASTPATH:
Virtual Inputs
The 845 relay is equipped with 64 Virtual Inputs that can be individually programmed to
respond to input signals from the keypad or from communications protocols. This has the
following advantages over Contact Inputs only:
• The number of logic inputs can be increased without introducing additional hardware.
• Logic functions can be invoked from a remote location over a single communication
channel.
• The same logic function can be invoked both locally via contact input or front panel
keypad, and/or remotely via communications.
• Panel switches can be replaced entirely by virtual switches to save cost and wiring.
All Virtual Input operands are defaulted to “Off” (logic 0) unless the appropriate input signal
is received.
Path: Setpoints > Inputs > Virtual Inputs > Virtual Input
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
If this setting is set to “Disabled,” the input will be forced to OFF (logic 0) regardless of any
attempt to alter the input. If set to “Enabled,” the input operates as shown on the logic
diagram below, and generates output FlexLogic operands in response to received input
signals and the applied settings.
NAME
Range: Up to 13 Alphanumeric Characters
Default: VI 1
An alphanumeric name may be assigned to a Virtual Input for diagnostic, setting, and
event recording purposes.
TYPE
Range: Latched, Self-reset
Default: Latched
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x TYPE is “Self-
Reset,” when the input signal transits from OFF to ON the output operand will be set to
ON for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic equations, then return to OFF. If set to
“Latched,” the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the
most recent received input.
The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the
FASTPATH:
FlexLogic equations (i.e., a pulse of one protection pass). If the operand is to be used
anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic equation, it will likely have to be lengthened
in time. A FlexLogic timer with a delayed reset time can perform this function.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
Figure 5-31: Virtual Inputs Scheme Logic
SETPOINTS
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION :
Disabled=0
Enabled =1
AND
S
Virtual Input 1 to ON =1
LATCH
FlexLogic Operands
Reset-
Virtual Input 1 to OFF =0
OR
Dominant VI 1 ON
AND
R
SETPOINTS
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
AND
Latched
892705A1.cdr
Self-Reset
Remote Inputs
Remote inputs provide a means of exchanging digital state information between Ethernet-
networked devices supporting IEC 61850. Remote inputs that create FlexLogic operands at
the receiving relay are extracted from GOOSE messages originating in remote devices.
Remote input 1 must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a
specific remote device for local use. The programming is performed by the three settings
shown in the Virtual Inputs section.
Path: Setpoints > Inputs > Remote Inputs
NAME
Range: Up to 13 Alphanumeric Characters
Default: VI 1
An alphanumeric name may be assigned to a Remote Input for diagnostic, setting, and
event recording purposes.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
This setting enables event generation wheneverRemote Input Status is updated.
Analog Inputs
The 8 Series relay can monitor any external quantity from the DcmA transducers such as
vibration, field current, pressure, tap position etc., using ‘Analog Inputs’. Any one of the
standard transducer output ranges: 0 to 1 mA, 0 to 5 mA, 0 to 10mA, 0 to 20 mA, or 4 to 20
mA can be connected to the Analog Input terminals. Polarity of these inputs must be
observed for proper operation. The analog input circuitry is isolated as a group with the
analog output circuitry and the RTD circuitry, only one ground reference is used for the
three circuits. Transducers limit this isolation to ±36 V with respect to the 8 Series safety
ground.
Depending upon the order code, the 8 Series relay supports one optional DC analog card.
The analog card has 4 analog inputs and 7 analog outputs. For each element, when the
measured analog input quantity exceeds the Pickup level for longer than the associated
time delay, the relay can be configured to cause an alarm, or trip. The element will drop out
only when the user programmed Dropout ratio has been met.
The connected analog input is still read and displayed in METERING /ANALOG INPUTS if the
NOTE:
trip function or alarm function is set to “Disabled”, and the Analog Input is not Disabled.
NOTE
Path: Setpoints > Inputs > Analog Inputs > Analog Input 1(X)
Settings
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting disables the Analog Input function or enables it for any generic application
or any specific application i.e., Tap Position. Upon selecting a specific application its
value is also displayed in the Transformer metering menu.
In the Tap Changer Setup, DcmA input is selected as ‘Tap Detection Input’ and Analog Input
NOTE:
1 Function is set as ‘Tap Position’. All other settings for Analog Input 1 are hidden.
NOTE
NAME
Range: Any combination of 13 Characters
Default: Anlp 1
This setting allows the assignment of symbolic names to each analog input. The length
is limited to 13 characters.
UNITS
Range: Any combination of 6 Characters
Default: units
This setting allows the assignment of symbolic names to the engineering units. The
length is limited to 6 characters.
RANGE
Range: 0 to 1 mA, 0 to 5 mA, 0 to 10 mA, 0 to 20 mA, 4 to 20 mA
Default: 0 to 1 mA
This setting provides the selection for the analog input range.
MIN VALUE
Range: -500000 to 500000 units in steps of 1 unit
Default: 0
For the MINIMUM VALUE setpoint, enter the value which corresponds to the minimum
output value of the transducer. For example, if a temperature transducer which outputs
4 to 20 mA for temperatures 0 to 250°C is connected to the analog input, then enter “0”
for the MINIMUM VALUE. The relay then interprets 4 mA as representing 0°C.
Intermediate values between the minimum and maximum are scaled linearly.
MAX VALUE
Range: -500000 to 500000 units in steps of 1 unit
Default: 0
For the MAXIMUM VALUE setpoint, enter the value which corresponds to the maximum
output value of the transducer. For example, if a temperature transducer which outputs
4 to 20 mA for temperatures 0 to 250°C is connected to the analog input, then enter
“250” for the MAXIMUM VALUE. The relay then interprets 20 mA as representing 250°C.
Intermediate values between the minimum and maximum are scaled linearly.
TRIP FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Configurable
Default: Disabled
Selecting the Trip or Configurable setting enables the Trip function of the analog input. If
Disabled is selected, the main function still remains enabled and reads the meter value.
TRIP TYPE
Range: Over, Under
Default: Over
This setting determines if pickup occurs when the analog input is over or under the
programmed threshold.
TRIP PICKUP
Range: -500000 to 500000 units in steps of 1 unit
Default: 20
This setpoint provides the trip pickup level in the engineering units defined in the setting.
TRIP DROPOUT RATIO
Range: 2 to 20 in steps of 1%
Default: 5%
This setting represents the variation of pickup value, in percentage of pickup, at which
the element will effectively drop out. The drop out ratio is defined as follows:
• Drop Out = pickup – pickup * dropout ratio /100, when TRIP TYPE is Over
• Drop Out = pickup + pickup * dropout ratio /100, when TRIP TYPE is Under
For example, if the pickup level is 5000 µA, TRIP TYPE is set to “Over” and DROPOUT
RATIO set to “10%”, the actual dropout will be 4500 µA. Conversely, if the TRIP TYPE is
“Under” with the same dropout ratio, the actual dropout will be 5500 µA.
TRIP PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 600 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 2
This setpoint will operate if the trip pickup condition is maintained for a longer time than
the delay time set here.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
This setting enables or disables the events of the Analog Input function.
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-Reset, Latched
Default: Latched
The selection of the Self-Reset or Latched setting enables the targets of the Analog Input
function.
ALARM FUNCTION:
OR
Disabled=0
ALARM S
AND
OR
AND
LATCHED ALARM LATCH
RESET R
SETPOINT Command
BLOCK: SETPOINT
AND
Off=0 LED: TRIP
ALARM TYPE
Operate Output
CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
OVER
TRIP FUNCTION:
AND
Disabled=0 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Anlg Ip 1 ALARM PKP
AND
Trip SETPOINT
OR
Configurable ALARM PICKUP: SETPOINTS Anlg Ip 1 ALARM OP
RUN
VALUE < =
PKP
LED: PICKUP
Figure 5-32: Analog Input Threshold Logic Diagram
AND
SETPOINT SETPOINT SETPOINTS
TRIP TYPE TRIP PICKUP:
TRIP PICKUP DELAY: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Dropout Ratio
OVER TRIP DROPOUT DELAY: Anlg Ip 1 TRIP PKP
RUN
UNDER tPKP Anlg Ip 1TRIP OP
SETPOINT tRST
VALUE > = PKP
AND
FUNCTION: SETPOINT
RUN Output Relay
Disabled = 0 SETPOINT
Enabled = 1 VALUE < = PKP Do Not Operate, Operate
NAME
UNITS
RANGE
MIN VALUE
MAX VALUE
ANALOG INPUT
Measured Signal
894125A1.cdr
5–119
INPUTS
OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
Outputs
Figure 5-33: Outputs Display Hierarchy
Output Relays
The 845 Transformer Protection System relay is equipped with a number of
electromechanical output relays specified at the time of ordering. The card A I/O module
from slot F, for example, provides five output relays.
The 845 auxiliary relays, starting with Aux. Relay 1, can be energized from the menu of
each protection or control feature, or from their respective menus when assigning a
FlexLogic operand (trigger) under the setpoint "Aux Rly # Operate".
The auxiliary relays can be used for different applications. Any output relays can be
programmed for either tripping or closing a breaker. For each of the breakers, a pair of
auxiliary relays can be selected for tripping and closing. Depending on how an Aux. Relay is
assigned, one of the following output relay logic diagrams applies:
1. If the auxiliary output relay is programmed under the Breaker menu for breaker
tripping, the operation of the output follows the Trip logic diagram below.
2. If the auxiliary output relay is programmed under the Breaker menu for breaker
closing, the operation of the output follows the Close logic diagram.
3. If the auxiliary output is not programmed for tripping or closing a breaker, the
operation of the output follows the Auxiliary Relay Generic logic from logic diagram.
The Trip and Close auxiliary relays follow the respective Trip and Close logic, meaning they
will have fixed operating characteristics as they depend on breaker feedback for resetting.
The auxiliary relays selected for breaker tripping are also available for selection from the
menus of all protection elements. The auxiliary relays selected for breaker closing are
excluded from the list for selection from the menu of all elements. Refer to the Breaker
setup section on how to select an auxiliary relay for breaker trip and close.
The operation of output relays selected for breaker Trip and breaker Close are breaker-
controlled relays designed to be controlled by the state of the breaker as monitored by a
52a contact, 52b contact, or both.
If the selection for the Type setpoint is "Pulsed", the Trip and Close relay operation follows
the logic outlined below:
• The Trip and Close relays reset after breaker is detected in a state corresponding to
the command. When a command is sent to one of these special relays, it remains in
operation until the requested change of the breaker state is confirmed and the
initiating condition has Reset.
• If the command Resets without a change of breaker state, the output relay is Reset
after a default interval of 2 seconds.
• If neither of the breaker auxiliary contacts. 52a or 52b, is programmed to a logic input,
the Trip Relay Resets after a default interval of 100 ms after the initiating input Resets.
The Close Relay is Reset after 200 ms.
• The Seal-In Time setpoint is available only when the output relay is selected as
"Pulsed". In all other cases the Seal-In Time setpoint is hidden and deactivated. The
default setting for the seal-in time is 100 ms.
If the Type selected is "Latched", the output relay is energized by any Trip or Open
command and remains energized upon element dropout. Latched auxiliary outputs can be
reset with a reset command.If the type selected is "Self-Reset", the output relay is
energized when the corresponding element operates and it stays energized until the
element drops out.
output relays during Relay Not Ready state, or detection of Major Self-Test error.
NOTE
MAINTAINING AN UNINTERRUPTED PROCESS
The Output Relays are operational (can be closed/opened) while the 845 Transformer
Protection System is In-Service. If the relay goes into “Out-of-Service” mode, the status of
all previously energized output relays changes to de-energized. If an output relay was used
to maintain a running process, or to hold a motor contactor while energized, the process or
the motor contactor will be interrupted. To keep the process uninterrupted, the following
connection scheme can be applied:
Figure 5-34: Maintaining an uninterrupted process upon a relay Major Error
If the output relay is energized during the In-Service relay condition, the NO contact will be
closed, and the NC contact will be open. The process is running. If the relay goes into “Out-
of-Service” mode, the output relay will be de-energized, and the process will still be
running, as the NC contact will be closed. An external switch, or stop pushbutton must be
installed in series to the relay output contacts, so that one can stop the process if needed.
Auxiliary Relay Path:Setpoints > Outputs > Output Relays > Aux Relay 1
selected for breaker NAME
Trip Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Aux Relay 1
The setpoint is used to name the Trip relay by selecting up to 13 alphanumeric
characters.
SEAL-IN TIME (displayed only if Type=Pulsed)
Range: 0.00 to 9.99 s in steps of 0.01 s
Default: 0.10 s
This setting defines the time to be added to the Reset time of Relay 1 “Trip” output, thus
extending its pulse width. This is useful for those applications where the 52 contacts
reporting the breaker state are faster than the 52 contacts that are responsible for
interrupting the coil current.
BLOCK
Range: Disabled, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Disabled
This setting defines a Block to the Trip output relay. When the selected input is asserted,
the Trip output relay is blocked.
OPERATE
Range: Off, On, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setpoint provides a selection of any operand from the list of FlexLogic or
communications, which can be used to energize the Trip output relay.
When set to On, the output relay is constantly asserted (On=1).
When set to Off and no FlexLogic operand is selected, the output relay operates as set in
individual protection elements.
Setting OPERATE to On supersedes individual protection function settings.
NOTE:
NOTE TYPE
Range: Self-Reset, Latched, Pulsed
Default: Latched
This setting defines the sequence type of the Trip output relay. The functionality is
described in the Outputs > Output Relays > Trip and Close Relays section.
OPERATION
Range: Non-Failsafe, Failsafe
Default: Non-Failsafe
Failsafe operation causes the output relay to be energized when the Trip condition signal
is low and de-energized when the same signal is high. A failsafe relay also changes state
(if not already activated by an operand driving this output relay) when control power is
removed from the 845. Conversely a non-failsafe relay is de-energized in its normal non-
activated state and will not change state when control power is removed from the 845 (if
not already activated by a protection element).
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
When the setpoint Function in the protection element menu is set to "Trip", the output
NOTE:
relays selected under the Breaker menu for breaker tripping need to be re-selected from
NOTE the protection element menu. These output relays will not be operational even if selected
to operate from the protection element menu, if the function is set to "Alarm", "Latched
Alarm", or “Configurable”.
$WOHDVWRQH
FRQWDFWSURJUDPPHG
IURP%UHDNHU'HWHFWLRQ
CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
25
$1'
6(77,1* 6(732,17
2SHUDWH2XWSXW
5HOD\5HDG\ 5HOD\ ³75,3´
%/2&. 6($/,17,0(
$1'
$1'
2SHUDWHWKHVHOHFWHG
8SRQGURSRXWRIWKHWULSVLJQDODQGQR $X[5HOD\SURJUDPPHG
7KLVWLPHUVWDUWVRQWKHIDOOLQJHGJHRI EUHDNHURSHQVWDWXVGHWHFWHGWKLVWLPHU
DSXOVHDQGLVVXHVDSRVLWLYHSXOVH ZLOOVWDUWRQWKHUDLVLQJHGJHRIDSXOVH
IRU%.5WULS
XSRQWLPHH[SLU\ LVVXHGIURPHLWKHURIWKHWZRWLPHUVDQG
75,3
ZLOOSURGXFHSRVLWLYHSXOVHXSRQWLPH
25
H[SLU\
$1'
5HOD\5HDG\
23(5$7(
)/2SHUDQG2II
75,3
7ULSZLWKRXW
25
%.5/RFDO2SHQ FRQILJXUHG
EUHDNHUFRQWDFW )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
$X[5HOD\;21
25
5HOD\5HDG\
%.55HPRWHO2SHQ 5(6(7FRPPDQG
6(732,17
7ULSUHTXHVW
7<3(
)RURQO\
$1'
25
3XOVHG 1RWH5HOD\7ULSLVSURJUDPPHGE\WKHPDQXIDFWXUHU
23(1IURP7UDQVIHU6FKHPH 6HOI5HVHW IRUEUHDNHUWULSSLQJRQDQGVLQJOHEUHDNHU
/DWFKHG RSWLRQUHOD\V$GGLWLRQDORXWSXWUHOD\VFDQEHVHOHFWHG
WRRSHUDWHIURPWKHPHQXRIHDFKHOHPHQW
)RURQO\
(OHPHQWRSHUDWLRQZLWKVHOHFWLRQRI$X[
Figure 5-35: Relay 1 “TRIP” Selected for Breaker 1 logic diagram
5HOD\SURJUDPPHGIRU%.5WULSSLQJ $FGU
)RUDQGRQO\
75,3IURP$Q\(OHPHQWVHWWR³7ULS´ /('75,3
25
DUHXVHGE\WKHµ7ULS¶ORJLF
5(6(7FRPPDQG
$1'
RQO\1RWH:KHQ&RQWDFWRULV
VHOHFWHGDVD6ZLWFKLQJ'HYLFHDOO
WKHLQSXWVDVVRFLDWHGZLWK&RQWDFWRU
5–125
OUTPUTS
OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
Aux Relay selected for Path:Setpoints > Outputs > Output Relays
breaker Close
Path:Setpoints > Outputs > Output Relays > Aux Relay 2 (Close)
The output relays selected under the Breaker menu for breaker closing are excluded from
NOTE:
the list of outputs for selection under the menus of all elements providing such output relay
NOTE selection.
$WOHDVWRQH
FRQWDFWSURJUDPPHG
IURP%UHDNHU'HWHFWLRQ
7KLVWLPHUVWDUWVRQWKHIDOOLQJHGJH
RIDSXOVHDQGLVVXHVDSRVLWLYH
SXOVHXSRQWLPHH[SLU\
CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
25
%/2&.
$1'
6(732,17
2II
6($/,17,0(
$1'
$1'
2SHUDWHWKHVHOHFWHG
$X[5HOD\SURJUDPPHG
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' 7KLVWLPHUVWDUWVRQWKHIDOOLQJHGJH 8SRQGURSRXWRIWKHFORVHVLJQDODQGQR
IRU%.5FORVH
6(77,1* RIDSXOVHDQGLVVXHVDSRVLWLYH EUHDNHUFORVHVWDWXVGHWHFWHGWKLVWLPHU
%.50DQXDO&ORVH SXOVHXSRQWLPHH[SLU\ ZLOOVWDUWRQWKHUDLVLQJHGJHRIDSXOVH
5HOD\5HDG\ LVVXHGIURPHLWKHURIWKHWZRWLPHUVDQG
25
23(5$7(
PV ZLOOSURGXFHSRVLWLYHSXOVHXSRQWLPH 5HOD\5HDG\
H[SLU\ &/26(
)/2SHUDQG2II
$1'
%ORFN&ORVH
)URP7UDQVIHUVFKHPH
%.5/RFDO&ORVH
)RURQO\
25
&/26(
%.55HPRWHO&ORVH
25
&ORVHZLWKRXW
FRQILJXUHGFRQWDFW )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
)RURQO\
5(6(7FRPPDQG
$1'
$X[5HOD\;21
5HOD\5HDG\
&/26(IURP7UDQVIHU6FKHPH
Figure 5-36: “Close” Selected for Breaker 1 logic diagram
7ULS5HOD\
25
6(732,17
$1'
7<3(
&/26(IURP89UHVWRUDWLRQ 1RWH5HOD\&ORVH
3XOVHG
6HOI5HVHW LVVHWIRUEUHDNHUFORVH
&/26(IURP8)UHVWRUDWLRQ E\GHIDXOWIRUDQG
/DWFKHG
$FGU
UHOD\V
&/26(IURP895HDFWLYH3RZHUUHVWRUDWLRQ
&/26(IURP$XWRUHFORVH
$1'
$1'
&ORVHUHTXHVW
$XWRUHFORVH,Q3URJUHVV
%UHDNHU)DLOXUH
5–127
OUTPUTS
OUTPUTS CHAPTER 5: DEVICE, SYSTEM, INPUT AND OUTPUT SETPOINTS
Auxiliary Output The 845 relay is equipped with Auxiliary Output relays. The I/O cards, and the number of
Relays auxiliary output relays are defined at the time of relay ordering. Auxiliary Relays can be
energized directly from the menu of the protection or control feature or from their
respective menus by assigning a FlexLogic operand (trigger) under the setpoint “Aux Rly #
Operate”.
Changing the state of any of the Auxiliary Relays will be inhibited if the 845 relay is in “Not
Ready” mode.
NAME
Range: Up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Aux Rly #
The setpoint is used to name the auxiliary output relay by selecting up to 13
alphanumeric characters.
SEAL-IN TIME (displayed only if Type=Pulsed)
Range: 0.00 to 9.99 s in steps of 0.01 s
Default: 0.10 s
When type = Pulsed is selected, the setpoint “AUX RLY # SEAL-IN TIME” is displayed in the
menu for selection of the time interval for which the output relay will remain Energized.
The actual time, for which the output relay stays energized, starts from the time of
output first trigger, and ends when Output Seal-In Time expires. The Seal-In time applies
at the dropdown edge of the output relay. If during timing out of the Seal-In Time,
another pulse/pulses occur, the Seal-In Time will be reapplied to the last pulse, resulting
in prolonged time for which the output will stay energized before going to de-energized
mode.
BLOCK
Range: Disabled, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Disabled
This setting defines a block to the Auxiliary output relay. When the selected input is
asserted, the Aux relay is blocked.
OPERATE
Range: Off, On, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setpoint provides a selection of any operand from the list of FlexLogic or
communications, which can be used to energize the auxiliary output relay.
When set to On, the output relay is constantly asserted (On=1).
When set to Off and no FlexLogic operand is selected, the output relay operates as set in
individual protection elements.
Setting OPERATE to On supersedes individual protection function settings.
NOTE:
NOTE TYPE
Range: Self-Reset, Latched, Pulsed
Default: Pulsed
If Self-Reset is selected, the output relay is energized as long as the element is in
operating mode, and resets when the element drops out. If Latched is selected, the
output relay stays energized upon element dropout. The latched auxiliary outputs can
be reset by issuing a reset command. For Pulse selection, see SEAL-IN TIME (displayed
only if Type = Pulsed).
OPERATION
Range: Non-Failsafe, Failsafe
Default: Non-Failsafe
Failsafe operation causes the output relay to be energized when the operand assigned
to the OPERATE AUX RLY # setting is low and de-energized when the same operand is
high. A failsafe relay also changes state (if not already activated by an operand driving
this output relay) when control power is removed from the 845. Conversely, a non-
failsafe relay is de-energized in its normal non-activated state and will not change state
when control power is removed from the 845 (if not already activated by a protection
element).
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
Figure 5-37: Auxiliary Relays generic logic
$1'
5(6(7&RPPDQG
6(732,17 25
$1'
7<3(
/DWFKHG
6HOI5HVHW 2SHUDWH$X[2XWSXW5HOD\
$1'
25
3XOVHG
$1'
5HOD\
7KLVVHWSRLQWLVGLVSOD\HGRQO\ 5HDG\
XSRQ³3XOVHG´RXWSXWW\SHVHOHFWLRQ
6(732,17
23(5$7( 6(732,17
$1'
2II 6($/,17,0(
25
2SHUDWLRQIURP3URWHFWLRQ W
&RQWURORU0RQLWRULQJ(OHPHQWV )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$X[5HOD\;21
5HOD\5HDG\
6(77,1*
$1'
5HOD\5HDG\
%/2&.
$FGU
2II
Critical Failure Relay The 845 relay is equipped with one output relay (# 8 - “Critical Failure Relay”) for failsafe
#8 indication. The Critical Failure Relay is a Form-C contact with one NO and one NC contact
(no control power). There are no user-programmable setpoints associated with this output
relay. The logic for this relay is shown below.
Figure 5-38: Critical Failure Relay 8 Scheme
Message & Event Records (Force the Relay into ‘NOT READY’ state)
OR
.
.
.
Major Error xx 892702A2.cdr
Message & Event Records
Virtual Outputs
The 845 relay is equipped with 96 virtual outputs that may be assigned for use via
FlexLogic. Virtual outputs not assigned for use are set to OFF (Logic 0).
A name can be assigned to each virtual output. Any change of state to a virtual output can
be logged as an event if programmed to do so. Virtual outputs are resolved in each
protection pass via the evaluation of FlexLogic equations.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic and the trip relay is used to
signal events, the settings would be programmed as follows:
Virtual Output 1 NAME: Trip
Virtual Output 1 Events: Enabled
Path: Setpoints > Outputs > Virtual Outputs > Virtual Outputs 1 (32)
NAME
Range: up to 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: VO 1
An alphanumeric name may be assigned to a virtual output for diagnostic, setting, and
event recording purposes.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
Analog Outputs
Description
Depending on the order code, the 8 Series relay supports one optional DC analog card. The
Analog card has 4 analog inputs and 7 analog outputs. There are three Analog Output
channel scenarios for analog minimum and maximum output range: A, B, and C shown in
the figure below. Type A characteristics apply when the minimum range is 0 and the
maximum range is a positive (+ve) value. Type B characteristics apply when the minimum
and maximum ranges are definitely positive (+ve) values. Type C characteristics apply
when the minimum range is a negative (-ve) and the maximum range is a positive (+ve)
value. The following diagram illustrates these characteristics.
Figure 5-39: Analog Outputs Channel Characteristics
Path: Setpoints > Outputs > Analog Outputs > Analog Output 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
RANGE
Range: 0 to 1 mA, 0 to 5 mA, 0 to 10 mA, 0 to 20 mA, or 4 to 20 mA
Default: 0 to 1 mA
This setting provides the selection for the analog output range.
PARAMETER
Range: Off, any Flex Analog Parameter
Default: Off
This setting selects the measured parameter to control the Analog Output level.
MIN VALUE
Range: Populates per selection of the analog parameter
Default: 0
This setting defines the minimum value of the analog output quantity. It populates
based on the selection of the analog parameter.
MAX VALUE
Range: Populates per selection of the analog parameter
Default: 0
This setting defines the maximum value of the analog output quantity. It populates
based on the selection of the analog parameter.
Each channel can be programmed to represent a FlexAnalog parameter available in the
respective 8 Series relay. The range and steps is the same as the range of the
FlexAnalog.
Chapter 6: Protection
Protection
The 845 protection elements are organized in six (6) identical setpoint groups: Setpoint
Group 1 to Setpoint Group 6.
Figure 6-1: Protection Display Hierarchy
Percent Differential
System Current
Inputs Data
Voltage
Capture
Group 1
Outputs Power
Data Capture
Group 2
Protection Frequency
Group 3
Monitoring
Group 4
Control
Group 5
FlexLogic
Group 6
Testing
Each Setpoint Group has the same protection functions, depending on the relay order
code.
Transformer Elements
• OverallPercent Differential
• Transformer Overload
Current Elements
• Phase Time Overcurrent Protection (51P)
Percent Differential
The 845 relay provides one Overall Percent Differential element per setpoint group. The
setpoints from the protection menu define a dual slope, dual breakpoint differential/
restraint characteristic. The filtering and calculation of transformer differential and
restraint currents, and differential current 2nd and 5th harmonics are as shown in the
figure: ProtectionFiltering and calculation of differential and restraint currents.
The K2 CT bank is connected to Winding 1, which is the High-Voltage winding of the GSU
NOTE:
connected to the system. In contrast, the K1 CT bank is connected at the neutral side of
NOTE the generator, and must be configured as Winding 2 (K1).
The 845 continuously calculates per-phase differential and restraint currents, and
compares the ratio between the two values with a user pre-defined differential/restraint
characteristic. The purpose of the characteristic is to define the zone of differential
protection operation and the zone of no operation. The differential characteristic provides
setpoints for sensitivity, dependability, and security for all types of faults, and is
programmed by the user to reflect a variety of transformer differential protection
applications.
The differential current is calculated per-phase as a vector sum of the currents from all
windings after magnitude and angle compensation.
Eq. 1
* * &
Id I1comp I 2 comp I 3comp
The restraint current is calculated as a maximum of the same internally compensated
currents:
Eq. 2
* * &
Ir max( I1comp , I 2comp , I 3comp )
Refer to the Transformer Setup chapter for the winding currents magnitude and phase
NOTE:
d
differential
Operate
Block
Slope 2
Slope 1
Pickup
Break 1
Break 2
restraining r
The above figure shows the differential/restraint characteristic of the main transformer
percent differential protection.
The decision for operation or no operation is complemented by detection of CT saturation,
followed by currents directional check. The saturation flag (SAT) can only be initiated during
an external fault, providing the magnitude of any of the restraints is bigger than a
threshold average using the Break1 and Break 2 setting programmed in the menu. While
at the same time, the differential/restraint ratio is below a slope average calculated based
on Slope 1 and Slope 2 settings. The directional flag is not checked unless the SAT flag is
initiated. Normally during internal faults, the trajectory of the differential/restraint ratio
does not cross the average calculated breakpoint threshold, in which case the directional
flag is not checked. The directional flag is checked during external faults (SAT flag
triggered), where due to saturation, the differential/restraint trajectory is able to enter the
operating region. Usually the angle between the currents during external fault and CT
saturation remains bigger than 90 degrees, in which case the percent differential
protection does not operate. However, while in the operating region, the protection would
operate, on evolving faults (external to internal fault), as the directional flag would be high
(angle less than 90 degrees).
Minimum Pickup:This setpoint is expressed in xCT of Winding 1 (J1 CT bank for relays
ordered with voltage, or K1 CT bank for relays ordered without voltage inputs). The
minimum pickup defines the minimum differential current required for operation. The
pickup setting must be higher than the amount of differential current that is seen under
normal transformer loading conditions, and must be higher than the maximum differential
current that is seen during transformer tap changer operation, providing the tap changer
automatic differential current compensation is disabled, i.e. the setpoint TC Winding
Currents from Tap Changer setup set to “None”. If this setpoint is set to a current bank (J1,
K1, K2) representing any of the transformer winding currents, the Minimum Pickup can be
set to be more sensitive but not below the differential current caused by CT errors during
normal transformer loading.
For example, for a 20MVA, 25MVA, or 28MVA power transformer with a 138kV/4.16kV ratio,
and class C current transformers CT(w1) 200:5, and CT(w2) 3000:5, the CT errors and the
minimum pickup setting is calculated as follows:
Winding 1 (138kV) CT – reference. Magnitude factor: M(w1) = 1
Winding 2(4.16kV) CT – non reference. Magnitude factor: M(w2) = 4.16 *3000/138*200 =
0.4521
Based on emergency MVA rating:
Winding 1 rated current = 28MVA/(138kV*sqrt(3)) = 117 Amps
The accuracy of the Class C current transformer is defined in the IEEE standard C37.110 as
not exceeding 10% for symmetrical current magnitudes of up to 20 times the rating for a
standard burden resistance:
117Amps *10% = 11.7 Amps = > 11.7/200 = 0.0585 xCT(w1)
3890 Amps *10% = 389 Amps = > 389/3000*M(w2) = 389/3000*0.4521 =0.0585 xCT (w1)
In the worst case, the errors from the two CTs as expressed in xCT(w1) as a reference can
be summed:
Minimum Pickup = 0.0585 + 0.0585 = 0.117 (0.2xCT setting for Pickup is sufficient)
Slope 1:This setting defines the desired differential/restraint ratio for detecting internal
faults. The percent Slope 1 setting must be above the differential/restraint ratio during
external faults with non-significant fault current magnitude, but with long lasting DC
component, which is able to cause CT saturation.
The Slope 1 setting can be calculated based on the restraint current during emergency
loading of the transformer:
Restraint current Winding 1 = 117 Amps/200 = 0.585 xCT
Restraint current Winding 2(scaled) = 3890/3000*0.4521 = 0.585 xCT
Differential current = CT error = 0.117 xCT
Slope 1 = (0.117/0.585)*100 = 20%
Adding 5% margin, produces a Slope 1 setting of 25%
Slope 2: The Slope 2 setting ensures stability during heavy through fault conditions, where
CT saturation results in high differential current. Slope 2 must be set high enough to cope
with the worst case when the CTs from one winding saturate but the CTs from the other
winding do not saturate during external fault. In such case the ratio of the differential to
restraint current can be as high as 95 to 98%.
Break 1: Break 1 must be set to reflect the through current (restraint current) expressed in
times winding 1 CT (w1) below which CT saturation due to DC components and/or residual
magnetism is not expected. The latter may be as high as 80% of the nominal flux,
effectively reducing the CT capabilities by factor of 5.
Therefore, this setting must correspond to the end of the linear operation of the CT with the
worst characteristic, counting up to 80% remnant flux in the CT core. To calculate this
setting, CTs knee-point voltage and CT secondary burden are needed.
Break 2: Break 2 setting defines the beginning of Slope 2 used to provide stability during
heavy through fault conditions, where CT saturation results in high differential current.
Break 2 must be set to the through-fault current which causes the worst CT to saturate,
with saturation free time of at least half power cycle.
To define the degree of CT saturation, the IEEE CT saturation tool can be used:
For example, let the CT 3000:5 on winding 2 be the worst one which would saturate first
during external faults, and let the maximum external fault current be 25kA, with an X/R
ratio of 15. The CT voltage kneepoint from the saturation characteristic is 300 V, with
winding resistance of 0.5 Ohms, Burden resistance of 2.19 Ohms, and Burden reactance of
0.01 Ohms.
Logging this data into the CT sat tool, produces the following CT saturation waveform:
The waveform shows that during this external bolted fault with maximum fault current of
25 kA, the CT (3000:5) will saturate severely, and produce only a ¼ of a cycle saturation
free time. Break 2 must be set to a through fault current so that the CT (3000:5) produces at
least ½ cycle saturation free time. The solution is to change the fault current to 15000 kA.
The waveform now shows a bigger part of the first cycle before saturation.
The fault current of 15000 Amps would then be translated as 15000/3000 = 5 times
winding 2 CT. Bringing this to the same scale with respect to winding 1 CT reference , i.e.
multiplying by a magnitude of 0.4521, the Break 2 setting would be:
Break 2 = 5 *0.4521 = 2.21 xCT (w1)
Figure 6-4: Examples of differential/restraint trajectory during internal fault
Path:Setpoints > Protection > Group 1 (6) > Transformer > Percent Differential
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Configurable
Default: Disabled
The selection of the Trip, or Configurable setting enables the Percent Phase Differential
function. The trip output relays selected to trip each breaker will operate, if the Percent
Differential protection operates and these trip outputs are selected in the Percent
Differential menu as “Operate”.
PICKUP
Range: 0.05 to 1.00 x CT in steps of 0.01
Default: 0.20 x CT
This setting defines the minimum differential current required for operation. The setting
is selected based on the amount of differential current that might be seen under normal
conditions. This differential current is a result of the transformer magnetizing current, CT
inaccuracies, and transformer ratio that would change by the transformer on-load tap
changer. When the tap changer feature is set properly, the 845 compensates the
transformation ratio which impacts the differential protection automatically.
SLOPE 1
Range: 1 to 100% in steps of 1
Default: 25%
This setting is applicable for restraint currents (through currents) of zero to kneepoint 1,
and defines the ratio of differential/restraint currents, above which the element will
operate. This slope is set to ensure sensitivity on internal faults at normal transformer
loading. The value of slope 1 must be above the maximum differential currents which
may be seen for through currents with magnitudes less than break 1 setting. The
differential currents can be caused by winding CT inaccuracies, the constant
transformer magnetizing current, and the leakage current from in-zone grounding
transformers. Usually a margin of 2% to 5% is added to this setting.
BREAK 1
Range: 0.50 to 2.00 x CT in steps of 0.01 x CT
Default: 1.50 x CT
The setting for Break 1 defines the limit of linear operation of the magnitude reference
CT, accounting for up to 80% residual flux, that effectively reduces the capability of the
CT by a factor of 5. Break 1 must be set below the current that can cause CT saturation
due to DC components and/or residual magnetism. Very often the Break 1 setting is
based on the transformer winding 1 nominal current (100% transformer loading). In
such cases, one must check whether or not this setting complies with the above
recommendation regarding the CT linear performance. This breakpoint marks the end of
slope 1, where no CT saturation is expected for restraining (through) currents smaller
than that breakpoint.
BREAK 2
Range: 2.00 to 30.00 x CT in steps of 0.01 x CT
Default: 4.00 x CT
Break 2 must be set below the fault current that is most likely to saturate any of the
transformer CTs due to an AC component alone. The setting is expressed in times CT,
where the CT rating is the magnitude reference CT either user selected, or selected
automatically.
SLOPE 2
Range: 1% to 100% in steps of 1%
Default: 95%
The Slope 2 setting ensures stability during through fault conditions, resulting in CT
saturation and spurious high differential current. Slope 2 must be set high to cater for
the worst case scenario, where only CTs from one winding saturate, but the CTs from the
other winding(s) do not saturate. In such cases the differential/restraint ratio can go as
high as 95% to 98%.
Setting Slope 1 higher than Slope 2 must be avoided, as it is not practical, even though the
NOTE:
ranges for both slopes can allow for one to do so. Correct programming of the differential-
NOTE restraint characteristic is achieved when Slope 1 is used for sensitivity of operation during
internal fault in the range of 15% to 35%, and Slope 2 set usually from 80% to 98%, is used
to provide secure area for the diff./restr. trajectory during external faults and CT saturation.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 10.000 in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
This setting defines the pickup time delay of the percent differential element.
INRUSH INHIBIT
Range: Disabled, 2nd Harm Block
Default: 2nd Harm Block
This setting enables or disables the inrush inhibit function. None of the settings for inrush
inhibit are active, when the function is set to “Disabled”.
INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL
Range: 1.0% to 40.0% in steps of 0.1%
Default: 20.0%
This setting specifies the ratio of the 2nd harmonic differential current to the
fundamental frequency differential current for the selected mode of the 2nd harmonic
inhibit. The percent differential protection will be blocked from operation if the actual
ratio of the differential 2nd harmonic current to the fundamental frequency differential
current is above this threshold.
The 845 relay provides one instantaneous differential element per setpoint group.
The Instantaneous differential protection is not biased protection and operates similar to
the instantaneous overcurrent protection. Inputs to this protection are computed by the
relay per-phase differential currents. Operation occurs if any of the computed phase
differential current is above the instantaneous differential pickup setting. The
instantaneous differential protection is usually set to operate during high fault currents,
and if used, its pickup must be set according to the following criteria:
• The pickup setting (xCT) must be selected higher than the maximum inrush current
during transformer energization.
• The pickup setting must be set higher than the differential current caused CT
saturation during faults outside the zone of protection.
• The pickup setting must be selected lower than the maximum fault current during
internal faults.
INSTANTANEOUS DIFF FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
INST DIFF PICKUP
Range: 3.00 to 30.00 x CT in steps of 0.01 x CT
Default: 10.00 x CT
This setting defines the pickup level of the differential current required for operation.
INST DIFF BLOCK
Range: Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
INST DIFF OUTPUT RELAYS
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
The menu includes a list of available output relays to be set for operation or no operation
upon protection operation.
The output relays selected under the Breaker menu for breaker trip need to be reselected if
FASTPATH:
the Percent Differential function is set to “Trip”. These output relays will not be operational
even if selected to operate if the Percent Differential function is set to “Configurable”.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-Reset, Latched
Default: Latched
Figure 6-6: Percent and Instantaneous Differential Protection Logic Diagram
LED: TRIP
OR
AND
OR
LED: ALARM
AND
OR
OR
Set Dominant
AND
S
OR
LATCH
Command
SETPOINTS RESET R
INSTANTANEOUS DIFF
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
FlexLogic Operands
Trip
Alarm Instant Diff OP A
Latched Alarm OR SETPOINT
Instant Diff OP B
Configurable INST DIFF PICKUP:
Instant Diff OP C
RUN
SETPOINT |Iad| > Pickup
INST DIFF BLOCK:
AND
RUN
OR
Off = 0 |Ibd| > Pickup Instant Diff OP
RUN
|Icd| > Pickup
SETPOINT:
OUTPUT RELAY 1(X),
upon selection
LED: PICKUP
OR
SETPOINT Do Not Operate, Operate
OR
OR
Slope 1
Disabled = 0 FlexLogic Operands
Trip Break 1
OR
OR
Ia Restr ) >
Tpkp
AND
Phase B Diff current (Ib Diff ) FlexLogic Operands
r 0
Phase C Diff current (Ic Diff ) Percent Diff Sat A
OR
AND
Restraint Currents
Percent Diff Dir A
RUN
Phase A Rest current (Ia Restr ) d
Phase B Rest current (Ib Restr ) (Ib Diff / SETPOINT
Ib Restr) >
Phase C Rest current (Ic Restr ) Tpkp
AND
FlexLogic Operands
r 0 FlexLogic Operands
Percent Diff Sat B
OR
AND
Percent Diff Dir B
RUN
d Percent Diff OP
SETPOINT
(Ic Diff / Percent Diff OP A
Ic Restr ) > Tpkp
AND
FlexLogic Operands
Percent Diff OP B
r Percent Diff Sat C 0
OR
AND
Percent Diff Dir C Percent Diff OP C
Iad>(0.5 x PKP)
10s
OR
Disabled = 0
2nd Harm Block SETPOINT
OR
Pcnt Diff Blocked
Differential 2nd Harmonic INRUSH INHIBIT MODE
INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL
Ia Diff 2nd Harm
RUN
Ib Diff 2nd Harm Ia Diff 2nd Harm ≥LEVEL 2nd Harm Diff A
Ic Diff 2nd Harm RUN
Ib Diff 2nd Harm ≥LEVEL 2nd Harm Diff B
SETPOINT RUN
894021A1.CDR
Transformer Overload
The Transformer overload element may be used as an instantaneous element with no
intentional delay or as a definite time element. Each winding load current is compared
with the pickup setpoint to produce an alarm or trip condition. Alternatively, the overload
detection is available through the Over-temperature alarm input. An external transformer
over temperature detector can be connected to this input.
Setpoints
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Transformer > Overload
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
PICKUP
Range: 50 to 300 % in steps of 1 %
Default: 208 %
This setting identifies the level of transformer overload, where the pickup delay starts
timing. For a two winding transformer, the setting is expressed as a percentage of the
transformer base MVA rating, and is normally set at or above the maximum rated MVA
from the transformer nameplate. For a three winding transformer, the setting is
expressed as a percentage of the winding base MVA rating.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 60000 seconds in steps of 1 s
Default: 10 seconds
OVERTEMP INPUT
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Select Any FlexLogic operand that, when asserted, indicates the transformer cooling
system has failed or an over-temperature condition exists on the transformer.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAYS
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Latched
LED: TRIP
TRIP
AND
LED:
AND
SETPOINT
ALARM
FUNCTION
OR
Disabled
Trip
S
Alarm
LATCH
OR
Latched Alarm
R
Configurable
Set
Dominant
Command
SETPOINT RESET
SETPOINT PICKUP LED: PICKUP
BLOCK RUN
AND
Off = 0
W1 load >= PICKUP
SETPOINTS
Figure 6-7: Transformer Overload Logic Diagram
OUTPUT RELAYS
RUN
Do Not Operate, Operate
SETPOINT
W2 load 0
OR
FlexLogic Operands
Overload PKP
AND
W2 Overload PKP
FlexLogic operand status
FlexLogic Operands
W3 Overload PKP
894008A2.cdr
6–15
TRANSFORMER OVERLOAD
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Current Elements
Figure 6-8: Current Elements Display Hierarchy
Phase TOC
Transformer
Setpoints Device Phase IOC
Current
System Phase Directional OC
Data
Voltage
Capture
Inputs Neutral TOC
Group 1
Power
Outputs Neutral IOC
Group
Data 2
Capture
Frequency
Protection Neutral Directional OC
Group 3
Monitoring Ground TOC
Group 4
Control Ground IOC
Group 5
FlexLogic Ground Directional OC
Group 6
Testing Restricted Ground Fault
The relay has six setpoint groups. The programming of the time-current characteristics of
these elements is identical in all cases and is only covered in this section. The required
curve is established by programming a Pickup Current, Curve Shape, Curve Multiplier, and
Reset Time. The Curve Shape can be either a standard shape or a user-defined shape
programmed with the FlexCurve feature. Accurate coordination may require changing the
time overcurrent characteristics of particular elements under different conditions.
A time dial multiplier setting allows the selection of a multiple of the base curve shape
(where the time dial multiplier = 1) with the curve shape setting. Unlike the
electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional to the time
multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10
times the multiplier 1 or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an
instantaneous response to all current levels above Pickup.
Time Overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory
variable. When this variable indicates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a Time
Overcurrent element will operate. If less than 100% energy capacity is accumulated in this
variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the Pickup value,
the variable must be reduced. Two types of this resetting operation are available:
“Instantaneous” and “Timed”. The “Instantaneous” selection is intended for applications
with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy capacity directly to zero
when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” selection can be used where
the relay must coordinate with electromechanical relays. UR relays calculate operate time
corresponding to the values in the range of 1.03 to 20 multiples of the pickup current.
Above 20 multiples of the pickup current, UR relays clamp the operate time to the value at
multiple of 20, resulting in the flat part of the characteristics. Reset time is calculated in the
range of 0 to 0.97 multiples of the pickup current.
IEEE CURVES
The IEEE Time Overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE
C37.112-1996 curve classifications for extremely, very, and moderately inverse. The IEEE
curves are derived from the formula:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
tr = characteristic constant
Table 6-2: IEEE INVERSE TIME CURVE CONSTANTS
IEEE CURVE SHAPE A B P tr
IEEE Extremely Inverse 28.2 0.1217 2.000 29.1
IEEE Very Inverse 19.61 0.491 2.000 21.6
IEEE Moderately Inverse 0.0515 0.1140 0.02000 4.85
ANSI CURVES
The ANSI time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the ANSI
C37.90 curve classifications for extremely, very, and moderately inverse. The ANSI curves
are derived from the following formulae:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A to E = constants
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
tr = characteristic constant
Table 6-4: ANSI INVERSE TIME CURVE CONSTANTS
ANSI CURVE SHAPE A B C D E tr
ANSI Extremely Inverse 0.0399 0.2294 0.5000 3.0094 0.7222 5.67
ANSI Very Inverse 0.0615 0.7989 0.3400 -0.2840 4.0505 3.88
ANSI Normally Inverse 0.0274 2.2614 0.3000 -4.1899 9.1272 5.95
ANSI Moderately Inverse 0.1735 0.6791 0.8000 -0.0800 0.1271 1.08
IEC CURVES
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and
British standard BS142. These are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The
formula for these curves is:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
K, E = constants
tr = characteristic constant
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
Table 6-6: IEC (BS) INVERSE TIME CURVE CONSTANTS
IEC (BS) CURVE SHAPE K E tr
IEC Curve A (BS142) 0.140 0.020 9.7
IEC Curve B (BS142) 13.500 1.000 43.2
IEC Curve C (BS142) 80.000 2.000 58.2
IEC Short Inverse 0.050 0.040 0.500
IAC CURVES
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formula:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A to E = constants
tr = characteristic constant
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
Table 6-8: GE TYPE IAC INVERSE TIME CURVE CONSTANTS
IAC CURVE SHAPE A B C D E tr
IAC Extremely Inverse 0.0040 0.6379 0.6200 1.7872 0.2461 6.008
IAC Very Inverse 0.0900 0.7965 0.1000 -1.2885 7.9586 4.678
IAC Inverse 0.2078 0.8630 0.8000 -0.4180 0.1947 0.990
IAC Short Inverse 0.0428 0.0609 0.6200 -0.0010 0.0221 0.222
I2T CURVES
The curves for the I2t are derived from the formula:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
I4T CURVES
The curves for the I4t are derived from the formula:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
FLEXCURVES
The custom FlexCurves are described in detail in the FlexCurves section of this chapter. The
curve shapes for the FlexCurves are derived from the formulae:
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds),
TDM = Multiplier setting,
I = input current,
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting,
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
Where:
T = operate time (in seconds)
TDM = Multiplier setting
I = input current
Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is
“Timed”)
Percent of Load-To-Trip
The Percent of Load-to-Trip is calculated from the phase with the highest current reading.
It is the ratio of this current to the lowest pickup setting among the phase time and the
instantaneous overcurrent elements. If all of these elements are disabled, the value
displayed is “0”.
RESET
Range: Instantaneous, Timed
Default: Instantaneous
Selection of an Instantaneous or a Timed reset time is provided using this setting. If
Instantaneous reset is selected, the Phase TOC element will reset instantaneously
providing the current drops below 97-98% of the Phase TOC PKP level. If Timed reset is
selected, the time to reset is calculated based on the reset equation for the selected
inverse curve.
DIRECTION
Range: Disabled, Forward (Ph Dir OC 1 FWD), Reverse (Ph Dir OC 1 REV)
Default: Disabled
VOLTAGE RESTRAINT
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting enables or disables the Voltage Restraint function for the TOC element.
When set to “Enabled” this feature lowers the Pickup value of each individual Phase Time
Overcurrent element in a fixed relationship with its corresponding phase input voltage.
If cold load pickup, autoreclosing, or manual close blocking features are controlling the
protection, the Phase TOC Voltage Restraint does not work, even if “Enabled” is selected.
Voltage restraint is used to lower the current pickup level for TOC function in linear
proportion as shown in figure below. For example, if phase TOC PICKUP setting is set to
1.000 XCT, in case of system faults cause generator terminal voltage drops to 0.4 pu
(ratio of Phase-Phase Voltage/ VT Nominal Phase-phase voltage), the new pickup with
voltage restraint would be 1.000*0.4=0.400 xCT. During the fault condition when the
voltage drops, the overcurrent relay pickup also drops linearly and it should be verified
that for the limiting case the new voltage restraint relay pickup should be lower than
(around 50% of) the fault current. Refer IEEE C37.102-2006, Annex-A for more details.
Figure 6-9: Voltage Restraint characteristics for Phase TOC
Multiplier for Pickup Current
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Phase-Phase Voltage ÷ VT Nominal Phase-phase Voltage
892784A1.CDR
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
LED: TRIP
AND
CONFIGURABLE IN 845
TARGETS
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION:
S
AND
Default: Self-reset
Disabled
Trip LATCH
Alarm R
OR
Latched Alarm
Set
Configurable
Dominant
SETPOINTS
DIRECTION: Command
Disabled RESET
Forward
AND
Reverse
SETPOINTS FlexLogic Operands
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
OR
PICKUP:
AND
Phase TOC 1 OP:A
Ph A Reverse (from Phase
AND
Directional OC element) CURVE:
Phase TOC 1 OP:B
Ph B Reverse (from Phase Same Logic as for Phase A
AND
TDM: Phase TOC 1 OP:C
Directional OC element)
AND
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
OR
INPUT:
Phase A current (Ia)
CT Bank 1 – Phasor, Adjust PKP
Phase B current(Ib)
J1 RMS
Phase C current (Ic)
RUN Ic > PICKUP
SETPOINT LED: PICKUP
RUN
VOTAGE RESTRAINT:
OR
Calculate
Voltage
Disabled Restraint
AND
Multiplier Adjust PKP FlexLogic Operands
Enabled
Phase TOC 1 PKP
From Cold Load Pickup
TOC Pickup Raise
Phase TOC 1 PKP A
From Autoreclose
TOC Pickup Raise
OR
Phase TOC 1 PKP B
From Manual Close Blocking
Phase TOC 1 PKP C
TOC Pickup Raise
894149A1.CDR
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: Dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1 (dependent on order code)
This setting provides the selection for the current input bank. The default bank names
can be changed in: Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > [Name] > CT Bank Name.
INPUT
Range: Phasor, RMS
Default: Phasor
PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 1.000 x CT
DIRECTION
Range: Disabled, Forward (Ph Dir OC 1 FWD), Reverse (Ph Dir OC 1 REV)
Default: Disabled
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
CONFIGURABLE IN 845
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
FUNCTION:
OR
Disabled = 0
Trip
S
AND
Alarm
LATCH
OR
Latched Alarm
R
Configurable
Set
SETPOINTS Dominant
DIRECTION:
Disabled Command
SETPOINTS
Forward RESET
AND
Reverse PICKUP:
RUN
OR
AND
SETPOINTS
Ph A Reverse (from Phase
AND
Directional OC element) Ia > PICKUP PICKUP DELAY: SETPOINTS
OUTPUT RELAYS
DROPOUT DELAY:
Ph B Reverse (from Phase Same Logic as for Phase A
Do Not Operate, Operate
Directional OC element)
tPKP
RUN
AND
tRST
Same Logic as for Phase A
Ph C Reverse (from Phase
Directional OC element) Ib > PICKUP tPKP
OR
tRST
SETPOINTS tPKP FlexLogic Operands
BLOCK tRST
RUN Phase IOC 1 OP
AND
Off = 0
Phase IOC 1 OP A
Figure 6-11: Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent logic diagram
Ic > PICKUP
From Cold Load Pickup Phase IOC 1 OP B
OR
From Autoreclose Phase IOC 1 OP C
(per shot settings)
SIGNAL INPUT:
Phase A current (Ia) FlexLogic Operands
Phase B current(Ib) Phasor, RMS Phase IOC 1 PKP
CT Bank 1 - J1
Phase C current (Ic)
Phase IOC 1 PKP A
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group1(6) > Current > Phase Dir OC 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
This setting provides the selection for the current input bank. The default bank names
can be changed in: Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > [Name] > CT Bank Name.
ECA
Range: 0° to 359° in steps of 1°
Default: 30°
The setting is used to select the element characteristic angle, i.e. the angle by which the
polarizing voltage is shifted in the leading direction to achieve dependable operation.
POLARIZING V THRESHOLD
Range: 0.050 to 3.000 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Default: 0.700 x VT
The setting is used to establish the minimum level of voltage for which the phase angle
measurement is reliable. The setting is based on VT accuracy.
REV WHEN V MEM EXP
Range: No, Yes
Default: No
The setting is used to select the required operation upon expiration of voltage memory.
When set to "Yes" the directional element output value is forced to ‘Reverse’ when
voltage memory expires; when set to "No” the directional element is ‘Forward’ when
voltage memory expires.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
The Phase Directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a
FASTPATH:
following reverse fault, the element needs some time – in the order of 8 ms – to change the
directional signal. Some protection elements such as Instantaneous Overcurrent may
respond to reverse faults before the directional signal has changed. A coordination time of
at least 10 ms must therefore be added to all the instantaneous protection elements under
the supervision of the Phase Directional element. If current reversal is a concern, a longer
delay – in the order of 20 ms – is needed.
SETPOINT
FUNCTION:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Disabled = 0 Ph Dir OC REV
OR
Enabled = 1
AND
SETPOINT
BLOCK:
Off = 0
SETPOINT
To phase TOC & IOC
AND
SETPOINTS
FWD
ACTUAL VALUES SIGNAL INPUT: Vpol
SETPOINT
POLARIZING V TRESHOLD
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE C LOGIC SIMILAR TO PHASE A Ph Dir OC REV C
894156A2.cdr
6–31
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
RESET
Range: Instantaneous, Timed
Default: Instantaneous
The selection of an Instantaneous or a Timed reset time is provided for this setting. If the
Instantaneous reset is selected, the neutral TOC element will reset instantaneously
providing the current drops below 97-98% of the Neutral TOC PKP level, before the time
for operation is reached.
DIRECTION
Range: Disabled, Forward (Ntrl Dir OC 1 FWD), Reverse (Ntrl Dir OC 1 REV)
Default: Disabled
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
SETPOINTS
Operate Output Relay 1 (TRIP)
FUNCTION:
CONFIGURABLE IN 845
Disabled = 0
Trip AND LED: ALARM
Alarm
OR
Latched Alarm
OR
Configurable
S
AND
LATCH
R
SETPOINTS
Set
PICKUP: Command Dominant
CURVE: RESET
RESET:
SETPOINTS DIRECTION:
SETPOINTS
BLOCK: RUN In > PICKUP
AND
OUTPUT RELAYS
Off = 0
Do Not Operate, Operate
USED ONLY IN 845 /889
Adjust PKP
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
Calculated as a sum of SIGNAL
INPUT: INPUT: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
phase currents
LED: PICKUP Ntrl TOC 1 OP
Neutral current(In) CT Bank 1 – Phasor, RMS
Figure 6-13: Neutral Time Overcurrent Protection logic diagram
J1
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Ntrl TOC 1 PKP
From Cold Load Pickup
894035A3.cdr
From Autoreclose
(per shot settings)
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
SETPOINT
FUNCTION: CONFIGURABLE IN 845
Disabled = 0
AND
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
S
OR
LATCH
Set
Dominant
Command
RESET
Direction (from Neutral
Directional OC element) SETPOINTS
PICKUP: SETPOINTS
AND
BLOCK: OUTPUT RELAYS
Off = 0 3 * (|I_0| - K * |I_1|) > tPKP
PICKUP tRST Do Not Operate, Operate
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
From Autoreclose
(per shot settings) Ntrl IOC 1 OP
LED: PICKUP
SETPOINTS
Figure 6-14: Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent Protection logic diagram
SIGNAL INPUT
Neutral IOC source
USED ONLY IN
845/889
6–37
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Where:
V_0 = 1/3 * (Vag + Vbg + Vcg) = zero sequence voltage
I_0 = 1/3 * In = 1/3 * (Ia + Ib + Ic) = zero sequence current
ECA = element characteristic angle
In = neutral current
When POLARIZING VOLTAGE is set to “Measured VX,” one-third of this voltage is used in
place of V_0. The following figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional
unit of the element by showing the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator
characteristics for a phase A to ground fault, with:
ECA = 90° (element characteristic angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
FWD LA = 80° (forward limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation
REV LA = 80° (reverse limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation).
The element incorporates a current reversal logic: if the reverse direction is indicated for at
least 1.25 of a power system cycle, the prospective forward indication will be delayed by
1.5 of a power system cycle. The element is designed to emulate an electromechanical
directional device. Larger operating and polarizing signals will result in faster directional
discrimination bringing more security to element operation.
The forward-looking function is designed to be more secure as compared to the reverse-
looking function, and should therefore be used for the tripping direction. The reverse-
looking function is designed to be faster as compared to the forward-looking function and
should be used for the blocking direction. This allows better protection coordination.
The above bias should be taken into account when using the Neutral Directional
Overcurrent element to directionalize other protection elements.
For 845 relays ordered without voltage inputs, the polarizing signal for the Neutral
NOTE:
Directional OC element is the ground current (Ig) from the bank selected as Signal Input in
NOTE the element’s menu. In this case the setponts “Polarizing Mode”, and “Polarizing Voltage”
are not displayed.
-3V_0 line
REV LA FWD LA
line line
VAG
(reference)
LA LA
3I_0 line
ECA
ECA line
-ECA line
-3I_0 line LA
VCG LA
VBG
REV LA FWD LA
line line
3V_0 line
827805A1.CDR
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Current > Neutral Directional OC 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
This setting provides selection of the current input bank. The default bank names can be
changed in Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > [Name] > CT Bank Name.
POLARIZING MODE
Range: Voltage, Current, Dual
Default: Voltage
This setting selects the polarizing mode for the directional unit.
• If Voltage polarizing mode is selected, the element uses the zero-sequence voltage
angle for polarization. Select either the zero-sequence voltage V_0, calculated from
the phase voltages, or the zero-sequence voltage supplied externally as the auxiliary
voltage V_X.
The calculated V_0 can be used as polarizing voltage only if the voltage transformers
are connected in Wye. The auxiliary voltage can be used as the polarizing voltage if
the auxiliary voltage is connected to a zero-sequence voltage source (such as the
open delta connected secondary of VTs).
The zero-sequence (V_0) or auxiliary voltage (V_X), accordingly, must be greater than
0.02 x VT to be validated for use as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is invalid,
neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
• If Current polarizing mode is selected, the element uses the angle of the ground
current measured on the ground current input. The ground CT must be connected
between the ground and neutral point of an adequate source of ground current. The
ground current must be greater than 0.05 x CT to be validated as a polarizing signal. If
the polarizing signal is not valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
For a choice of current polarizing, it is recommended that the polarizing signal be
analyzed to ensure that a known direction is maintained irrespective of the fault
location. For example, if using an autotransformer neutral current as a polarizing
source, it should be ensured that a reversal of the ground current does not occur for a
high-side fault. The low-side system impedance should be assumed minimal when
checking for this condition. A similar situation arises for a wye/delta/wye transformer,
where current in one transformer winding neutral may reverse when faults on both
sides of the transformer are considered.
• If Dual polarizing mode is selected, the element performs both directional
comparisons as described above. A given direction is confirmed if either voltage or
current comparators indicate so. If a conflicting (simultaneous forward and reverse)
indication occurs, the forward direction overrides the reverse direction.
POLARIZING VOLTAGE
Range: Calculated V0, Measured VX
Default: Calculated V0
Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage" or "Dual"
polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-
sequence voltage calculated from the phase voltages ("Calculated V_0") or supplied
externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX")
SEQ RESTRAINT :
SETTING
RUN
NEUTRAL DIR OC
FUNCTION : 3( I_0 - K I _1) PICKUP
Disabled =0
Enabled =1 AND
SETTING
AND TO NEUTRAL TOC AND
IOC ELEMENTS
BLOCK : AND
Off =0 SETTINGS
NEUTRAL DIR OC FWD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
ECA:
AND Ntrl Dir OC FWD
NEUTRAL DIR OC FWD
LIMIT ANGLE :
SETTING AND
Ig 0.05xCT AND RUN
NEUTRAL DIR OC FWD
POLARIZING :
Voltage OR Current Polarization
Current OR
REV
Dual OR
NOTE:
1) CURRENT POLARIZING IS POSSIBLE ONLY IN RELAYS WITH TO NEUTRAL TOC AND
THE GROUND CURRENT INPUTS CONNECTED TO IOC ELEMENTS
AN ADEQUATE CURRENT POLARIZING SOURCE SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC REV
PICKUP:
2) POSITIVE SEQUENCE RESTRAINT IS NOT APPLIED WHEN
AND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_ 1 IS BELOW 0.8 x CT NEUTRAL DIR OC
Figure 6-16: Neutral Directional Overcurrent Protection logic diagram
RUN
3( I_0 - K I_1 ) PICKUP 892716A2.cdr
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
SETPOINTS
CONFIGURABLE IN 845
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
AND
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
S
AND
LATCH
R
SETPOINTS
Set
PICKUP: Command Dominant
CURVE: RESET
RESET:
SETPOINTS DIRECTION:
SETPOINTS
BLOCK: RUN Ig > PICKUP
AND
OUTPUT RELAYS
Off = 0
Do Not Operate, Operate
Ground current(Ig)
J1 RMS
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
USED ONLY IN 845/889 Ground TOC1 PKP
From Cold Load Pickup
894121A2.cdr
From Autoreclose
(per shot settings)
6–45
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
LED: TRIP
AND
SETPOINT
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
AND
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
OR
S
AND
LATCH
Set
Dominant
Command
RESET
Direction (from Ground
Directional OC element) SETPOINTS
BLOCK: SETPOINTS
RUN DROPOUT DELAY:
AND
Off = 0 RELAYS
OR
From Autoreclose FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
(per shot settings)
Ground IOC 1 OP
LED: PICKUP
From Manual Close
Blocking
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
850 Only Ground IOC 1 PKP
Figure 6-18: Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent Protection logic diagram
From Ground CT
894119A1.cdr
6–47
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Where:
V_0 = 1/3 * (Vag + Vbg + Vcg) = zero sequence voltage
When POLARIZING VOLTAGE is set to “Measured VX,” one-third of this voltage is used in
place of V_0. The following figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional
unit of the element by showing the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator
characteristics for a phase A to ground fault, with:
ECA = 90° (element characteristic angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
FWD LA = 80° (forward limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
REV LA = 80° (reverse limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation).
The element incorporates a current reversal logic: if the reverse direction is indicated for at
least 1.25 of a power system cycle, the prospective forward indication will be delayed by
1.5 of a power system cycle. The element is designed to emulate an electromechanical
directional device. Larger operating and polarizing signals will result in faster directional
discrimination bringing more security to element operation.
The forward-looking function is designed to be more secure as compared to the reverse-
looking function, and should therefore be used for the tripping direction. The reverse-
looking function is designed to be faster as compared to the forward-looking function and
should be used for the blocking direction. This allows better protection coordination.
The above bias should be taken into account when using the Ground Directional
Overcurrent element to directionalize other protection elements.
-3V_0 line
REV LA FWD LA
line line
VAG
(reference)
LA LA
Ig line
ECA
ECA line
-ECA line
-Ig line LA
VCG LA
VBG
REV LA FWD LA
line line
3V_0 line
827805X1.CDR
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Current > Ground Directional OC 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
This setting provides the selection for the current input bank. The default bank names
can be changed in: Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > [Name] > CT Bank Name.
POLARIZING VOLTAGE
Range: Calculated V0, Measured VX
Default: Calculated V0
Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage" or "Dual"
polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-
sequence voltage calculated from the phase voltages ("Calculated V_0") or supplied
externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX")
FORWARD ECA
Range: –90° to 90° in steps of 1°
Default: 75°
This setting defines the element characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction in
"Voltage" polarizing mode. "Current" polarizing mode uses a fixed ECA of 0°. The ECA in
the reverse direction is the angle set for the forward direction shifted by 180°.
FORWARD LIMIT ANGLE
Range: 40° to 90° in steps of 1°
Default: 90°
This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit angle for the
forward direction.
FORWARD PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.050 x CT
This setting defines the Pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
forward direction.
REVERSE LIMIT ANGLE
Range: 40° to 90° in steps of 1°
Default: 90°
This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit angle for the
reverse direction.
REVERSE PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.050 x CT
This setting defines the Pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the reverse
direction.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
Enabled =1 AND
SETPOINT
AND TO GROUND TOC AND
IOC ELEMENTS
BLOCK :
Off =0 SETPOINT
GROUND DIR OC FWD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
ECA:
AND Gnd Dir OC FWD
SETPOINT GROUND DIR OC FWD
LIMIT ANGLE :
SIGNAL INPUT :
GROUND DIR OC REV
Ground Current ( Ig)
LIMIT ANGLE :
CT Bank 1 – J1
RUN
FWD
SETPOINT AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
GROUND DIR OC REV
Figure 6-20: Ground Directional Overcurrent Protection logic diagram
RUN
Ig PICKUP 894158A1.cdr
6–51
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
The resultant primary current can be negligible for ground winding faults within 35% of the
distance from the neutral point since the fault voltage is not the system voltage, but rather
the result of the transformation ratio between the primary windings and the percentage of
shorted turns.
Application of Restricted Ground Fault protection extends the fault coverage towards the
neutral point for low-impedance grounded winding.
Figure 6-22: Restricted Ground Fault zone of protection
845 implementation of the Restricted Ground Fault protection is a low impedance current
differential scheme. The 845 calculates the magnitude of the ground differential current as
an absolute value from the vector summation of the computed residual current, and the
measured ground current, and applies a restraining current defined as the maximum
measured line current (Imax) to produce a percent slope value. The slope setting allows
determination of the sensitivity of the element based on the class and quality of the CTs
used.The figure below shows typical wiring between the winding and ground CTs and the
845 CT terminals, to assure correct performance of the protection.
Figure 6-23: Three CT wiring for the Restricted Ground Fault protection
The 845 RGF protection includes ground current supervision mechanism to provide more
security during external non-ground faults associated with CT saturation, that may result
into spurious neutral current, and may jeopardize the security of the RGF 1 protection.
When the GROUND CURRENT SUPERVISION setting is selected as “Enabled”, the algorithm
checks if the ground current measured by the relay satisfies the selected GROUND
CURRENT SUPERV LEVEL, before making operation decision. The ground current
supervision is not active if the GROUND CURRENT SUPERVISION is selected as “Disabled”.
The RGF 1 protection works without the supervision as well.
The settings of this function are applied to the ground and all three phase currents to
produce pickup and trip flags. The RGF 1 pickup flag is asserted, when the restrained
ground differential current is above the PKP value. The RGF 1 operate flag is asserted if the
element stays picked up for the time defined in RGF 1 PKP DELAY. The element drops from
Pickup without operation, if the calculated restrained ground differential current drops
below 97-98% of the Pickup value, before the time for operation is reached.The Restricted
Ground Fault function can be inhibited by a blocking input.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Current > RGF 1 (X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1 -J1
PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.300 x CT
This setting defines the minimum Pickup level of the ground differential current required
for operation. The Pickup value is expressed in times Phase CT (primary) rating.
SLOPE
Range: 0 to 100% in steps of 1%
Default: 50%
This setting defines the slope as the ratio between the ground differential current and
the maximum line current (ground restraining current) as a percentage. The RGF 1
element operates if the actual ground differential/restraint ratio is greater than the slope
and the ground differential current is greater than the RGF 1 Pickup setting.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.100 s
The RGF 1 Pickup Time Delay setting defines the time required for the RGF 1 element to
operate after it has picked up. This time delay overrides the spurious ground differential
current condition caused by CT saturation due to external non-ground faults, or during
transformer energization. Since RGF 1 protection is intended to detect small ground fault
currents, delayed clearance of such a fault is not a high concern. On the other hand
delayed RGF 1 operation due to a spurious ground differential current caused by an out-
of-zone fault can be used as a backup for downstream protections should they fail to
clear the fault.
GND CURR SUPERV
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
This setting enables or disables the ground current supervision of the RGF 1 function. If
set to “Disabled”, the RGF 1 function works without ground current supervision. The
ground current level is monitored if the setting is set to “Enabled”.
GND CURR SUPERV LEVEL
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.300 x CT
This setting defines the level of measured ground current above which operation of the
RGF 1 protection is allowed. The setting is presented as a times ground CT (primary)
rating. The measured ground current is compared to the setting only if the GROUND
CURRENT SUPERVISION is set to “Enabled”.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
Rg = 10 ohms
Phase CTs: 800:5
Ground CT: 300:5
Ifgnd (max) = 4.16kV/(10 ohms *v3) = 240A - maximum ground fault current
To detect a ground fault on the Wye winding at 15% distance from the neutral point, the
relay shall detect ground differential current of:
Igd = (15x240)/100 = 36 A/800 = 0.045 x CT – PKP setting for the RGF protection
The transformer loading is almost unaffected for ground faults close to the winding
neutral, so that the winding rated load can be used as a reference in defining the RGF 1
slope setting. The rated load for 4.16kV Wye winding is:
Irated = 5MVA/(4.16kV*v3) = 693 A
Slope setting, % = (36 A/693A)*100 = 5.1 %. Select 5% if the transformer is expected to run
most of the time at full load. If most of the time the transformer runs at lower than the
nominal loads, the slope setting can be set to higher value:
@ 70% load the slope setting would be: (36 / 485 A)*100 = 7%
@ 50% load the slope setting would be: (36 / 346 A)*100 = 10%
@ 30% load the slope setting would be: (36 / 208 A)*100 = 17%
The ground current supervision feature and/or the RGF 1 Pickup time delay can be used if
CT saturation due to heavy external fault, is a concern.
LED: TRIP
AND
Operate Output Relay 1 (TRIP)
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
RGF 1 S
AND
FUNCTION:
LATCH # 1
Disabled
Set-
Command Dominant
Trip
RESET R
Alarm
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
SETPOINTS
RGF 1
AND
BLOCK :
Off = 0
METERING
Currents SETPOINTS
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
SETPOINTS
I0 RGF 1 Do Not Operate , Operate
Ig PICKUP:
Igd RGF 1
SLOPE:
Source IA RUN SETPOINTS
Source IC 0
Igd >= I pickup RGF 1 PKP
Figure 6-24: Restricted Ground Fault Protection Logic Diagram
LED: PICKUP
Calculate 3Io
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
RGF 1 GND CURR
SUPERV LEVEL : RGF 1 Superv ON
AND
Ig > I Level
89$1.cdr
CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION CURRENT ELEMENTS
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED : TRIP
OR
Latched Alarm
OR
Configurable
S
AND
LATCH
R
SETPOINTS
Set
PICKUP: Command Dominant
CURVE : RESET
SETPOINTS DIRECTION :
SETPOINTS
BLOCK : RUN I_2 > PICKUP
AND
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
Off = 0
Do Not Operate, Operate
Adjust PKP
From Autoreclose
(per shot settings )
850 Only
6–59
CURRENT ELEMENTS
CURRENT ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
SETPOINT
FUNCTION: CONFIGURABLE IN 845
Disabled = 0
AND
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
S
OR
AND
LATCH
Set
Dominant
Command
RESET
Direction (from Neg Seq
Directional OC element) SETPOINTS
PICKUP: SETPOINTS
AND
BLOCK: OUTPUT RELAYS
Off = 0 (|I_2| – K * |I_1|)> tPKP tDP
PICKUP Do Not Operate, Operate
O
From Cold Load Pickup
OR
From Autoreclose
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
(per shot settings)
Neg Seq IOC 1 OP
From Manual Close
LED: PICKUP
Blocking
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
USED ONLY IN 850
Neg Seq IOC 1 PKP
Negative Sequence IOC SETPOINTS
Figure 6-26: Negative Sequence Instantaneous Overcurrent logic diagram
Voltage Elements
Setpoints Device
Percent Differential
System
Transformer
Undervoltage Curves
Inputs
Group 1 Current
Phase UV
Outputs
Group
Data 2
Capture Voltage
Data Capture
Auxiliary UV
Protection
Group 3 Power
Phase OV
Monitoring
Group 4 Frequency
Auxiliary OV
Control
Group 5
Neutral OV
FlexLogic
Group 6 Neg Seq OV
Testing
Volts per Hertz
Undervoltage Curves
The undervoltage elements can be programmed to have an inverse time delay
characteristic. The undervoltage delay setpoint defines a family of curves as shown below.
The operating time is given by:
T = D/(1 - V/Vpkp)
Where:
T = Operating Time
D = Undervoltage Pickup Time Delay setpoint (for D = 0.00 operates instantaneously)
V = Voltage as a fraction of the nominal VT Secondary Voltage
Vpkp = Undervoltage Pickup Level
The element resets instantaneously if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage. The
delay setting selects the minimum operating time of the phase undervoltage.
At 0% of Pickup, the operating time equals the Undervoltage Pickup Time Delay setpoint.
NOTE:
NOTE
If FlexCurves are selected, the operating time determined based on following equation:
T= Flexcurve (Vpkp / V)
FlexCurve reverses the ratio of voltages. The ratio of set pickup value to the measured
NOTE:
voltage.
NOTE
Example: For a Pickup set to 0.9 x VT, when the measured voltage is 0.82 x VT, the ratio
would be 0.9/0.8 = 1.1, therefore in the FlexCurve, the corresponding Trip time setting entry
is at 1.1 x PKP (not at 0.82 x PKP). On the other hand, when the measured voltage is 1 x VT,
the ratio is 0.9/1 = 0.9, therefore, in the FlexCurve, the corresponding Reset time entry is at
0.9 x PKP.
This element may be used to give a desired time delay operating characteristic versus the
applied voltage (phase to ground or phase to phase for wye VT connection, or phase to
phase for delta VT connection) or as a definite time element. For the inverse time setpoint,
the undervoltage delay setpoint defines a family of curves as described inUndervoltage
Curves.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Voltage Elements > Phase UV 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
MODE
Range: Phase to Ground, Phase to Phase
Default: Phase to Ground
This setting provides the selection of phase to ground and phase to phase voltages for a
Wye VT connection (phase to phase for delta connected VT connection).
Only Phase to Phase mode shall be selected when Delta/Single’ VT Connection Type and
FASTPATH:
PICKUP
Range: 0.00 to 1.50 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 1.00 x VT
This setting sets the Phase Undervoltage Pickup level specified per times VT.
For example, a Pickup setting of 0.80 x VT with a 13800:115 VT translates into 11.04kV (or
92V secondary). If the mode selection is phase to phase and the Setpoints/System
Setup/Voltage Sensing/Phase VT Connection selection is Wye, the previous example
translates to the phase to phase voltage value of 11.04kV x 1.732 = 19.12kV.
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.00 to 1.50 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 0.20 x VT
This setting sets the minimum operating voltage for the undervoltage Pickup level
specified per times VT.
For example, a PKP setting of 0.20 x VT with 13800:115 VT translates into 2.76kV (or 23V
secondary).
If the Mode setting selection is Phase to Phase and the Setpoints/System Setup/Voltage
Sensing/Phase VT Connection selection is Wye, the previous example translates to a
Phase to Phase voltage value of 2.76kV x 1.732 = 4.78kV.
PHASES FOR OPERATION
Range: Any One, Any Two, All Three
Default: Any One
This setting defines the number of voltages required for operation of the Phase UV
protection function.
UNDERVOLTAGE CURVES
Range: Definite Time, Inverse Time, FlexCurves A/B/C/D
Default: Definite Time
This setting provides the selection of definite time delay or time delay inverse
undervoltage curves, or FlexCurves. In the case of FlexCurves, the voltage ratio used is
reversed. Refer to the equation and note regarding FlexCurves in the previous section
Undervoltage Curves.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
If Inverse Time is selected as an Undervoltage Curve setpoint, the Pickup Delay value is
loaded to variable D in the curve formula. For more information, refer to the previous
section Undervoltage Curves.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
LATCH
Trip Command
Alarm R
RESET
OR
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
SETPOINTS
AND
Off = 0 OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
SETPOINTS
Do Not Operate, Operate
PICKUP:
AND
MINIMUM VOLTAGE:
ANY ONE
NAME( Ph VT Bnk1-J2
VA(VAB) > MINIMUM OPERATE: ANY TWO Phase UV1 OP:
OR
AND
ALL THREE }
VB(VBC) > MINIMUM Phase UV1 OP A:
ANY ONE
SETPOINTS RUN VC(VCA) PICKUP Phase UV1 OP B:
Figure 6-29: Phase Undervoltage Protection logic diagram
AND
OR
Phase-to-Ground Voltages–
Wye connection MODE: ALL THREE } Phase UV1 OP C:
Phase A voltage (VA)
Phase B voltage (VB)
Phase C voltage(VC)
Phase-to-Phase Voltages –
LED: PICKUP
Delta connection
Ph-Ph AB voltage (VAB)
Ph-Ph BC voltage (VBC) MODE: Phase to Ground,
Ph-Ph CA voltage (VCA) Phase to Phase (for wye Phase UV1 PKP:
connection)
Calculated Phase-to-Phase Phase to Phase (Delta VTs)
Phase UV1 PKP A:
Voltages – Wye connection
Ph-Ph AB voltage (VAB) Phase UV1 PKP B:
{
Ph-Ph BC voltage (VBC)
Ph-Ph CA voltage (VCA) Phase UV1 PKP C:
894046A3.cdr
6–67
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
If Inverse Time is selected as an Undervoltage Curve setpoint, the Pickup Delay value is
loaded to variable D in the curve formula. For more information, refer to Undervoltage
Curves.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
/('75,3
$1'
2SHUDWH2XWSXW5HOD\75,3
/('$/$50
6(732,17
/$7&+('$/$50
$1'
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
25
7ULS 6
$1'
$ODUP
25
/$7&+
/DWFKHG$ODUP
&RPPDQG
&RQILJXUDEOH 6(732,176
5(6(7 5
3,&.83
6(732,176
3,&.83'(/$<
%/2&.
$1'
81'(592/7$*(
2II &859(6 )OH[/RJLF2SHUDQGV
6(732,176 581 9[!3,&.83
$1'
0,1,08092/7$*( $X[8923
6(732,176
9[!0,1,080
6,*1$/,1387 6(732,176
'R1RW2SHUDWH2SHUDWH
RQO\
$X[LOLDU\YROWDJH9DX[ /('3,&.83
$FGU
$X[893.3
PICKUP
Range: 0.02 to 3.00 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 1.50 x VT
The setting sets the phase overvoltage pickup level to specified per times VT.
For example, a Pickup setting of 1.10 x VT with 13800:115 VT translates into 15.18kV. If
the mode selection is phase to phase and Setpoints > System Setup > Voltage Sensing >
Phase VT Connection selection is Wye, the previous example translates to the phase to
phase voltage value of 15.18kV x 1.732 = 26.29kV.
PHASES FOR OPERATION
Range: Any One, Any Two, All Three
Default: Any One
The setting defines the number of voltages required for operation of the Phase OV
protection function.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
LATCH
Trip Command
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
AND
Off = 0 OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
PICKUP: DROPOUT DELAY: SETPOINTS
Do Not Operate, Operate
RUN
t PKP
889 only VA(VAB) ! PICKUP t RST PHASES FOR
OPERATION:
SETPOINTS RUN FlexLogic Operands
t PKP
Figure 6-31: Phase Overvoltage logic diagram
{
Phase-to-Ground Voltages– ALL THREE }
Wye connection MODE: Phase OV 1 OP C:
Phase A voltage (VA)
Phase B voltage (VB)
Phase C voltage(VC)
Phase-to-Phase Voltages –
Delta connection
Ph-Ph AB voltage (VAB) LED: PICKUP
MODE: Phase to Ground,
Ph-Ph BC voltage (VBC) Phase to Phase (for wye
Ph-Ph CA voltage (VCA) connection)
Phase to Phase (Delta
Calculated Phase-to-Phase connection) Phase OV 1 PKP:
Voltages – Wye connection
Ph-Ph AB voltage (VAB) Phase OV 1 OP A:
Ph-Ph BC voltage (VBC)
{ Phase OV 1 OP B:
Ph-Ph CA voltage (VCA)
Phase OV 1 OP C:
894049A3.cdr
6–73
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
The element reset rate is a linear reset time from the threshold of trip.
Figure 6-32: Overvoltage Curves
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Voltage > Auxiliary OV
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
PICKUP
Range: 0.00 to 3.00 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 1.50 x VT
This setting sets the auxiliary overvoltage pickup level specified per times VT.
For example, a Pickup setting of 1.10 x VT with 13800:115 VT translates into 15.08kV (or
126.5V secondary).
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 - 6000.000s in steps of 0.001s
Default: 1.000s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
LATCH
Trip Command
Alarm R
RESET
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
BLOCK : PICKUP:
AND
Off = 0 FlexLogic Operands
Overvoltage Curves:
RUN
Vx ! PICKUP
Figure 6-33: Auxiliary Overvoltage Protection logic diagram
Aux OV OP:
889
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
SIGNAL INPUT: OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
PICK-UP DELAY: Do Not Operate, Operate
NAME( Ax VT Bnk1-J2
DROP-OUT DELAY:
LED: PICKUP
t PKP
t RST
Auxiliary voltage
894076A4.cdr
Displacement. When using the curve to determine the operating time of the Neutral
Displacement element, substitute the ratio of neutral voltage to Pickup level for the current
ratio shown on the horizontal axis of the curve plot.
Be aware that the Neutral Overvoltage feature should be applied with caution. It would
normally be applied to give line-to-ground fault coverage on high impedance grounded or
ungrounded systems, which are isolated. This constraint stems from the fact that a
measurement of 3V_0 cannot discriminate between a faulted circuit and an adjacent
healthy circuit. Use of a time delayed back-up or alarm mode allows other protections an
opportunity to isolate the faulted element first.
As indicated above, the relay has one Neutral Overvoltage element per protection group.
The settings of this function are applied to 3V_0 calculated from the three phase-to-
ground (wye connected VTs) voltage inputs to produce Pickup and Trip flags per 3V_0
calculated voltage. The Neutral OV Pickup flag is asserted when the calculated 3V_0
voltage is above the PKP value. The Neutral OV Trip flag is asserted if the element stays
picked up for the time defined by the selected inverse curve and the magnitude of the
3V_0 voltage. The element drops from Pickup without operation, if the calculated voltage
drops below 97 to 98% of the Pickup value before the time for operation is reached.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Voltage Elements > Neutral OV 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
PICKUP
Range: 0.02 to 3.00 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 0.30 x VT
CURVE
Range: Definite Time, FlexCurve A, FlexCurve B, FlexCurve C, FlexCurve D.
Default: Definite Time
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
The NEUTRAL OV 1 PICKUP DELAY setting applies only if the NEUTRAL OV 1 CURVE setting
is “Definite time”.
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
Trip LATCH
Command
Alarm R
RESET
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable SETPOINTS
PICK-UP DELAY:
AND
t PKP
3_Vo > PICKUP Neutral OV 1 OP:
Van > 0.85 x VT t RST
OR
Vbn > 0.85 x VT
SETPOINTS
Vcn > 0.85 x VT
OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
LED: PICKUP
Neutral OV 1 PKP:
Phase Voltages
SETPOINTS
894050A2.cdr
Phase A Voltage (Va) SIGNAL INPUT:
Phase B Voltage (Vb) 3_V0
Phase C Voltage (Vc)
Ph VT Bank 1-J2
6–79
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
internally changed to 1/sqrt(3) of the user setting, before being compared to the actual
negative sequence voltage.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 1.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
Trip LATCH
Command
Alarm R
RESET
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
SETPOINTS
AND
t PKP
Off = 0 V_2 > PICKUP Neg Seq OV 1 OP:
t RST
SETPOINTS
Phase Voltages SETPOINTS
OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
Phase A Voltage (Va) Signal Input
Do Not Operate, Operate
Phase B Voltage (Vb)
Phase C Voltage (Vc) Ph VT Bank 1 – J2
LED: PICKUP
Neg Seq OV 1 PKP:
850 Only
Figure 6-35: Negative Sequence Overvoltage Protection logic diagram
894051A2.cdr
6–81
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
VOLTAGE MODE
Range: Phase-ground, Phase-phase
Default: Phase-ground
If the Phase VT Connection is selected as “Wye”, then the Voltage Mode setting further
defines the operating quantity and per-unit value for this element. If the Voltage Mode is
set as “Phase-phase”, then the operating quantity for this element will be phase-to-
phase nominal voltage. Likewise, if the Voltage Mode is set to “Phase-ground”, then the
operating quantity for this element will be the phase-to-ground nominal voltage.
If the Phase VT Connection (set under Setpoint > System > Voltage Sensing) is selected as
“Delta”, then the phase-to-phase nominal voltage is used to define the per-unit value,
regardless of the Voltage Mode selection.
PICKUP
Range: 0.80 to 4.00 V/Hz in steps of 0.01
Default: 1.05 V/Hz
Enter the Volts per Hertz value (in V/Hz) above which the Volts per Hertz 1 element will
pickup.
CURVE
Range: Definite Time, Inverse A, Inverse B, Inverse C, FlexCurve A, FlexCurve B,
FlexCurve C, FlexCurve D
Default: Definite Time
Definite Time:
For the definite time curve, T(s) = TD multiplier. For example, setting the TD multiplier to
20 results in a time delay of 20 seconds to operate when above the Volts/Hz pickup
setting. Instantaneous operation can be obtained the same way by setting the TD
multiplier to “0”.
Inverse Curve A:
The curve for the Volts/Hertz Inverse Curve A shape is derived from the formula:
7'0 9
7 2
` ZKHQ ! 3LFNXS
ª§ 9 · º )
«¨ ) ¸ 3LFNXS» 1
¬© ¹ ¼
where: T = Operating Time
TDM= Time Delay Multiplier (delay in seconds)
V = fundamental RMS value of voltage (pu)
F = frequency of voltage signal (pu)
Pickup = volts-per-hertz pickup setpoint (pu)
The volts/hertz inverse A curves are shown below.
Inverse Curve B:
The curve for the Volts/Hertz Inverse Curve B shape is derived from the formula:
TDM V
T when ! Pickup
ª§ V · º F
«¨ ) ¸ Pickup» 1
¬© ¹ ¼
where: T = Operating Time
TDM = Time Delay Multiplier (delay in seconds)
V = fundamental RMS value of voltage (pu)
F = frequency of voltage signal (pu)
Pickup = volts-per-hertz pickup setpoint (pu)
The Volts/Hertz inverse B curves are shown below.
Inverse Curve C:
The curve for the Volts/Hertz Inverse Curve C shape is derived from the formula:
TDM V
T when ! Pickup
1/2 F
ª§ V · º
«¨ ) ¸ Pickup» 1
¬© ¹ ¼
where: T = Operating Time
TDM = Time Delay Multiplier (delay in seconds)
V = fundamental RMS value of voltage (pu)
F = frequency of voltage signal (pu)
Pickup = volts-per-hertz pickup setpoint (pu)
The Volts/Hertz Inverse C curves are shown below.
Figure 6-38: Volts-Per-Hertz Curves for Inverse Curve C
TD MULTIPLIER
Range: 0.05 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01
Default: 1.00
This setting provides a selection for the Time Dial Multiplier which modifies the operating
times for the selected inverse curve. When the curve is set to “Definite Time”, T(s) = TD
multiplier. For example, setting the TD multiplier to 20 results in a time delay of 20
seconds to operate when above the Volts/Hz pickup setting.
T RESET
Range: 0.00 to 6000.00 in steps of 0.01
Default: 1.00
Enter the time that the Volts per Hertz value must remain below the pickup level before
the element resets.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic Operand
Default: Off
The Volts per Hertz can be blocked by any asserted FlexLogic operand.
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
6(732,176
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
7ULS 6(732,176
$ODUP
25
9ROWDJH0RGH
/DWFKHG$ODUP
&RQILJXUDEOH 3LFNXS
/('75,3
5HVHW7LPH
6(732,17 581
$1'
%ORFN /(' $/$50
$1'
2II
25
Figure 6-39: Volts per Hertz logic diagram
6(732,17
6,*1$/,1387 6
$1'
W
/$7&+ 6(732,17
3K97
3KDVH9ROWDJH,QSXWVIURP3K97
%QN- &RPPDQG 5 5HOD\V
%QN-
$FWXDO9DOXHV 5(6(7 'R1RW2SHUDWH2SHUDWH
:<( 'HOWD
$X[97 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
9DQ 9DE
%QN- 9ROWV+]23
9EQ 9EF 0$; 9+]
9)
9FQ 9FD
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
-97)UHTXHQF\ 9ROWV+]3.3
$X[LOLDU\9ROWDJH,QSXWVIURP$X[
97%QN-
$FWXDO9DOXHV
9[ 9)
-9[)UHTXHQF\ $FGU
6–87
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
POWER ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Power Elements
Figure 6-40: Power Elements Display Hierarchy
Setpoints Device
System
Group 1 Transformer
Inputs
Group 2 Current
Outputs
Group 3 Data
Voltage
Capture
Protection
Power Directional Power
Group 4
Monitoring
Group 5 Frequency
Control
Group 6
FlexLogic
Testing
Where:
P and Q are active and reactive powers as measured per the metering convention
Ɵ is a sum of the element characteristic (DIR POWER 1 RCA) and calibration (DIR
POWER 1 CALIBRATION) angles
SMIN is the minimum operating power.
The element has two independent (as to the Pickup and Delay settings) stages for Alarm
and Trip, and they can be set separately to provide mixed power protection.
By making the characteristic angle adjustable and providing for both negative and positive
values of the minimum operating power, a variety of operating characteristics can be
achieved as presented in the figure below. For example, section (a) in the figure below
shows settings for reverse power, while section (b) shows settings for low forward power
applications.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Power > Directional Power 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
RCA
Range: 0 to 359° in steps of 1°
Default: 180°
This setting specifies the Relay Characteristic Angle (RCA) for the Directional Power
function. Application of this setting is threefold:
1. It allows the element to respond to active or reactive power in any direction (active
overpower/underpower, etc.).
2. Together with a precise calibration angle, it allows compensation for any CT and VT
angular errors to permit more sensitive settings.
3. It allows for required direction in situations when the voltage signal is taken from
behind a delta-wye connected power transformer and phase angle compensation is
required.
For example, the active overpower characteristic is achieved by setting DIR POWER 1
RCA to “0°,” reactive overpower by setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “90°,” active underpower
by setting DIR POWER 1 RCA to “180°,” and reactive underpower by setting DIR POWER 1
RCA to “270°”.
CALIBRATION
Range: 0 to 0.95° in steps of 0.05°
Default: 0°
This setting allows the Relay Characteristic Angle to change in steps of 0.05°. This may
be useful when a small difference in VT and CT angular errors is to be compensated to
permit more sensitive settings.
The setting virtually enables calibration of the Directional Power function in terms of the
angular error of applied VTs and CTs. The element responds to the sum of the DIR
POWER 1 RCA and DIR POWER 1 CALIBRATION settings.
STAGE 1 SMIN
Range: -3.000 to 3.000 x Rated Power in steps of 0.001 x Rated Power
Default: 0.100 x Rated Power
The setting specifies the minimum power as defined along the relay characteristic angle
(RCA) for the stage 1 of the element. The positive values imply a shift towards the
operate region along the RCA line; the negative values imply a shift towards the restrain
region along the RCA line. Refer to the Directional power sample applications figure for
details. Together with the RCA, this setting enables a wide range of operating
characteristics.
The setting applies to three-phase power and the rated power is as follows:
Rated Power = 3 x VTSecondary (phase-neutral) x VTRatio x CTPrimary(Wye-connected VT), or
Rated Power = (3)1/2x VTSecondary (phase-phase) x VTRatio x CTPrimary (Delta-connected VT)
For example:
A setting of 2% for a 200 MW machine is 0.02 × 200 MW = 4 MW. If 7.967 kV is a primary
VT phase-neutral voltage and 10 kA is a primary CT current, the source rated power is
239 MVA, and, SMIN must be set at 4 MW/239 MVA =0.0167 x Rated ≈ 0.017 x Rated. If
the reverse power application is considered, RCA = 180° and SMIN = 0.017 x Rated.
The element drops out if the magnitude of the positive-sequence current becomes
virtually zero, that is, it drops below the cutoff level.
STAGE 1 DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.500 s
The setting specifies a time delay for stage 1. For reverse power or low forward power
applications for a synchronous machine, stage 1 is typically applied for alarming and
stage 2 for tripping.
STAGE 2 SMIN
Range: -3.000 to 3.000 x Rated Power in steps of 0.001 x Rated Power
Default: 0.100 x Rated Power
The setting specifies the minimum power as defined along the relay characteristic angle
(RCA) for stage 2 of the element. The setting needs to be coordinated with the setting of
stage 1.
STAGE 2 DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 20.000 s
The setting specifies a time delay for stage 2. For reverse power or low forward power
applications for a synchronous machine, stage 1 is typically applied for alarming and
stage 2 for tripping.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
LED : ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
Disabled S
AND
Trip
LATCH
Alarm
OR
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINTS
SETPOINTS
RELAYS
Figure 6-43: Directional Power logic diagram
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
Do Not Operate , Operate
AND
DIR POWER 1
Off=0
RCA :
SETPOINTS
DIR POWER 1 FlexLogic Operands
CALIBRATION : DIR POWER 1
DIR POWER 1 STAGE 1 DELAY : DirPwr 1 OP
OR
SETPOINTS
DIR POWER 1
LED: PICKUP
STAGE 2 DELAY : DirPwr 1 PKP
OR
tPKP
DirPwr 1 Stg2 OP
100 ms
89$.cdr
6–93
POWER ELEMENTS
FREQUENCY ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Frequency Elements
Figure 6-44: Frequency Elements Display Hierarchy
Transformer
Setpoints Device
Current
System
Group 1
Data
Voltage
Capture
Inputs
Group 2
Underfrequency
Power
Outputs
Group 3 Overfrequency
Frequency
Protection
Group 4 Frequency Rate of Change
Monitoring
Group 5
Control
Group 6
FlexLogic
Testing
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Level 5
Underfrequency (81U)
The 845 can be used as the primary detecting relay in automatic load-shedding schemes
based on underfrequency. The need for such a relay arises if during a system disturbance,
an area becomes electrically isolated from the main system and suffers a generation
deficiency due to the loss of either transmission or generation facilities. If reserve
generation is not available in the area, conditions of low system frequency occur which
can lead to a complete collapse. The 845 relay provides four identical Underfrequency
(UNDERFREQ) elements per protection group, or a total of 24 elements, which can
automatically disconnect sufficient load to restore an acceptable balance between load
and generation. The Underfrequency element can be set as an instantaneous element
with no time delay or as a definite time delayed element. The Underfrequency element has
the programmable minimum operating thresholds to prevent undesired operation during
periods of light load or unavailable voltage. The input voltages are the three phase-to-
phase voltages from delta connected VTs (PTs), three phase-to-ground voltages from wye
connected VTs (PTs), or single phase auxiliary voltage. The input currents are the three
phase currents.
The Underfrequency Pickup flag is asserted when the measured frequency of the specified
source is below the PKP value and the voltage and current are above the MINIMUM levels.
The Underfrequency Trip flag is asserted if the element stays picked up for the time
defined by the Pickup time delay. The element drops from Pickup without operation if the
measured frequency rises above 0.03Hz of the Pickup value and stays dropped-out for the
defined time delay before the time for operation is reached.
The minimum operating voltage setting selects the minimum voltage below which the
element is blocked.
The minimum operating current setting selects the minimum current below which the
element is blocked. Operation during periods of light load are prevented.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Frequency > Underfrequency 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
PICKUP
Range: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Default: 59 Hz
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 2.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 2.000 s
VT INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: Ph VT Bnk1-J2
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.000 to 1.250 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Default: 0.700 x VT
The setting sets the minimum voltage for Underfrequency element operation specified
per times VT. The setpoint prevents incorrect operation before energization of the source
to the relay location, and during voltage dips.
If the 3-phase VT uses a delta connection and SIGNAL INPUT is set to Ph VT Bnk1-J2, the
FASTPATH:
positive sequence voltage is used as the supervision voltage. In such condition, the true
supervision level is internally changed to 1/sqrt(3) of the user setting since the base of VT
here is the phase-phase voltage.
CT INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
MINIMUM CURRENT
Range: 0.000 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.200 x CT
The setting sets the minimum value of current required on any phase to allow the
Underfrequency element to operate. The setpoint is used to prevent underfrequency
tripping during periods of light load, when this action would have an insignificant effect
on the system. A setting of zero is suspend current supervision.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
UNDERFREQ 1
FUNCTION :
Disabled
OR
S
AND
Trip
LATCH
Alarm
OR
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
AND
Underfreq1 OP
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
UNDERFREQ 1 UNDERFREQ 1
Figure 6-45: Underfrequency Protection logic diagram
AND
Do Not Operate , Operate
0<f• P
• ICKUP tDPO
SETPOINTS
LED: PICKUP
UNDERFREQ 1 SETPOINTS
VT INPUT : UNDERFREQ 1
Ph VT Bnk 1 – J2 MINIMUM VOLTAGE :
RUN
Underfreq 1 PKP
Positive -
892737A4.cdr
sequence V• M
• INIMUM
wye/delta
Composite
Vx FREQUENCY f
Overfrequency (81O)
The 845 relay providestwo identical Overfrequency (OVERFREQ) elements per protection
group, or a total of 12 elements.
A significant overfrequency condition, likely caused by a breaker opening and
disconnecting load from a particular generation location, can be detected and used to
quickly ramp the turbine speed back to normal. If this is not done, the over speed can lead
to a turbine trip, which would then subsequently require a turbine start up before restoring
the system. If the overfrequency turbine ramp down is successful, the system restoration
can be much quicker. The overfrequency monitoring feature of the relay can be used for
this purpose at a generating location.
The Overfrequency feature is inhibited from operating unless the magnitude of the positive
sequence or auxiliary voltage rises above a threshold. When the supply source is
energized, the overfrequency delay timer is allowed to start timing only when the threshold
is exceeded and the frequency is above the programmed Pickup level. In the same way,
when an overfrequency condition starts the overfrequency delay timer and the voltage
falls below the threshold before the timer has expired, the element resets without
operating.
The Overfrequency element may be set as an instantaneous element with no time delay,
or as a definite time delayed element. The Overfrequency element has a fixed minimum
operating threshold to prevent undesired operation during periods of unavailable voltage.
The input voltages are the three phase-to-phase voltages from delta connected VTs (PTs),
three phase-to-ground voltages from wye connected VTs (PTs), or single phase auxiliary
voltage.
The settings of this function are applied to each source to produce Pickup and Operate
flags. The Overfrequency Pickup flag is asserted when the measured frequency of the
specified source is above the PKP value and the voltage is above the threshold. The
Overfrequency Operate flag is asserted if the element stays picked up for the time defined
by the Pickup time delay. The element drops from Pickup without operation if the
measured frequency decreases below 0.03 Hz of the Pickup value and stays dropped out
for the defined time delay before the time for operation is reached.
The minimum operating voltage is set as a threshold below which the element is blocked.
Path: Setpoints > Protection > Group 1(6) > Frequency > Overfrequency 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: Ph VT Bnk1-J2
This setting provides selection of the frequency input.
PICKUP
Range: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Default: 60.5 Hz
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 2.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 2.000 s
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.000 to 1.250 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Default: 0.700 x VT
The setting sets the minimum voltage for Overfrequency element operation specified
per times VT.
If the 3-phase VT uses a delta connection and FREQUENCY INPUT is set to Ph VT Bnk1-J2,
NOTE:
the positive sequence voltage is used as the supervision voltage. In such condition, the true
NOTE supervision level is internally changed to 1/sqrt(3) of the user setting since the base of VT
here is the phase-phase voltage.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: TRIP
LED: ALARM
SETPOINTS
AND
Disabled S
AND
Trip
LATCH
Alarm
OR
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINTS
FlexLogic Operands
BLOCK :
Off=0 Overfreq1 OP
AND
Voltage Inputs
None
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
Figure 6-46: Overfrequency Protection logic diagram
SETPOINTS
OVERFREQ 1 OVERFREQ 1
OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP DELAY :
SIGNAL INPUT : SETPOINTS
MINIMUM OPERATING
WYE DELTA VOLTAGE : OVERFREQ 1 OVERFREQ 1
SETPOINTS
VA VAB PICKUP : DROPOUT DELAY :
RUN
Positive - OUTPUT RELAYS 3 ( X ):
VB VBC RUN tPKP
sequence V ≥MINIMUM Do Not Operate , Operate
VC VCA f ≥PICKUP tDPO
Composite
FREQUENCY f
Vx LED: PICKUP
6–99
FREQUENCY ELEMENTS
FREQUENCY ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
PICKUP
Range: 0.10 to 15.00 Hz/sec in steps of 0.01 Hz/sec
Default: 0.50 Hz/sec
The setting specifies an intended Pickup threshold.
For applications monitoring a decreasing trend, set TREND to “Decreasing” and specify
the Pickup threshold accordingly. The operating condition is: -df/dt > PKP.
For applications monitoring an increasing trend, set TREND to “Increasing” and specify
the pickup threshold accordingly. The operating condition is: df/dt > PKP.
For applications monitoring rate of change of frequency in any direction, set TREND to
“Bi-Directional” and specify the Pickup threshold accordingly. The operating condition
can be either of the above two conditions.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 2.000 s
This setting provides a definite Pickup time delay. Instantaneous operation is selected by
a Pickup time delay setting of 0.000 s.
MINIMUM FREQUENCY
Range: 20.00 to 80.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Default: 45.00 Hz
The setting defines the minimum frequency level required for operation of the element.
The setting may be used to effectively block the feature based on frequency. For
example, if the intent is to monitor an increasing trend but only if the frequency is
already above certain level, this setting is set to the required frequency level.
MAXIMUM FREQUENCY
Range: 20.00 to 80.00 Hz in steps of 0.01 Hz
Default: 65.00 Hz
The setting defines the maximum frequency level required for operation of the element.
The setting may be used to effectively block the feature based on frequency. For
example, if the intent is to monitor a decreasing trend but only if the frequency is already
below a certain level (such as for load shedding), this setting is set to the required
frequency level.
VT INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: Ph VT Bnk1-J2)
This setting provides selection of the frequency input.
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.000 to 1.250 x VT in steps of 0.001 x VT
Default: 0.700 x VT
The setting defines the minimum voltage level required for operation of the element. The
supervising function responds to the positive-sequence voltage. Overvoltage
supervision is used to prevent operation under specific system conditions such as faults.
If the 3-phase VT uses a delta connection and FREQUENCY INPUT is set to J2-3VT, the
FASTPATH:
positive sequence voltage is used as the supervision voltage. In such condition, the true
supervision level is internally changed to 1/sqrt(3) of the user setting since the base of VT
here is the phase-phase voltage.
CT INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank1-J1 or CT Bank1-K1, dependent on order code
This setting provides selection of the frequency input.
MINIMUM CURRENT
Range: 0.000 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.200 x CT
This setting defines the minimum current level required for operation of the element. The
supervising function responds to the positive-sequence current. Typical application
includes load shedding. Set the Pickup threshold to zero if no overcurrent supervision is
required. The setting of zero suspends the current supervision.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The element will be blocked when the selected operand is asserted.
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
Each relay can be selected to become either energized or de-energized when operated,
and to operate as latched, self-resetting or pulsed.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
The selection of the Enabled setting enables the events of the function.
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to
“Disabled,” no target message is issued upon operation of the element. When set to
“Self-Reset,” the target message and its LED indication follow the operate state of the
element, and self-reset once the operate element condition clears. When set to
“Latched,” the target message will remain visible after the element output returns to
logic 0 until a RESET command is received by the relay.
LED: TRIP
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
FREQ RATE
FUNCTION :
OR
Disabled S
AND
Trip
OR
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
SETPOINTS
Off=0 SETPOINTS
AND
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
FREQ RATE TREND :
Do Not Operate , Operate
SETPOINTS Decreasing
OR
FREQ RATE Increasing
Current Inputs MINIMUM CURRENT : Bi-directional
Phase A Current (IA) RUN FlexLogic Operands
Positive -
OR
Phase B Current (IB) I = MINIMUM SETPOINTS FreqRate1 OP
OR
sequence
Phase C Current (IC) SETPOINTS
FREQ RATE
Voltage Inputs FREQ RATE PICKUP : PICKUP DELAY :
None RUN tPKP
AND
FreqRate1 Dwn OP
AND
SETPOINTS
-df/dt = PICKUP 0
FREQ RATE SETPOINTS
FREQUENCY INPUT : SETPOINTS
FREQ RATE SETPOINTS
WYE DELTA MINIMUM VOLTAGE : FREQ RATE
FREQ RATE PICKUP : PICKUP DELAY :
VA VAB RUN
Positive - RUN tPKP
AND
VB VBC
sequence V = MINIMUM FreqRate1 Up OP
VC VCA df/dt = PICKUP 0
SETPOINTS
Figure 6-47: Frequency Rate-of-Change Protection logic diagram
Composite
FreqRate1 Up PKP
FREQ RATE
Vx
MIN FREQUENCY :
FREQ RATE FreqRate1 Dwn PKP
MAX FREQUENCY :
LED: PICKUP
RUN
FREQUENCY f f > MIN & f < MAX
89$1.cdr
FreqRate1 PKP
OR
6–103
FREQUENCY ELEMENTS
FREQUENCY ELEMENTS CHAPTER 6: PROTECTION
Chapter 7: Monitoring
Monitoring
Harmonic Derating
Transformer
Harmonic Derating
The presence of harmonic currents in transformers increases the I2R losses, stray losses in
the core, clamps and structural parts, and eddy current losses in the windings. Of these
losses, the eddy current losses are of most concern since they tend to be proportional to
the square of the load current and approximately proportional to the square of frequency
which, in turn can cause excessive winding loss and abnormal winding temperature rise in
transformers when harmonics are present.
The Harmonic Derating element makes use of the harmonic derating factor (HDF)
computed by the Series 8 relay, using the harmonic content of the current signals and the
transformer data (refer to IEEE C57.110-2008 for the computation method). Once the
derating factor falls below a set value, the relay operates accordingly. The derating factor
is used to evaluate the load capability of the installed transformer under the non-
sinusoidal load currents. Once harmonics are present, the derating factor will decrease
from the ideal value of one per unit, which means the load capability is reduced due to
harmonics.
The Load-Limit Reduced LED indicator is ON and an operand of ‘Load Limit Reduced’ is
asserted if the HDF of any winding is less than 0.96, regardless of whether the element is
disabled or enabled.
The following three settings are used in this element:
NOTE:
• Setpoints > System > Transformer > Transformer Setup > Load Loss at Rated Load
NOTE
• Setpoints > System > Transformer > Transformer Setup > Rated Wndg Temp Rise
• Setpoints > System > Transformer > Transformer Setup > Wndg Resistance (3-ph)
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Transformer > Harmonic Derating > W1(2,3) Harmonic
Derating
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
MINIMUM OPER CURRENT
Range: 0.03 to 1.00 x CT in steps of 0.01 x CT
Default: 0.10 x CT
This setting sets the minimum value for all three-phase currents to allow the Harmonic
Derating element to operate.
PICKUP
Range: 0.01 to 0.98 in steps of 0.01
Default: 0.90
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 60000 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 10 s
BLOCK
Range: Any flexoperand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
FUNCTION : S
AND
Disabled
LATCH
Alarm
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
OR
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINT
SETPOINT
BLOCK :
OUTPUT RELAY X
AND
Off=0 SETPOINT
Do Not Operate , Operate
MINIMUM OPER
CURRENT :
W1 Current Input RUN SETPOINT SETPOINT
Phase A Current (IA) IA • MINIMUM
• PICKUP : PICKUP DELAY : FlexLogic Operands
Figure 7-2: Harmonic Derating Logic diagram
AND
IC • MINIMUM
• W1 Harm Derat OP
Phase C Current (IC) W1_HDF • PICKUP
• 0 LED: PICKUP
W1 Current Harmonics
Phase A Harmonics Calculate Harmonic
Phase B Harmonics Derating Factor W1 Harm Derat PKP
(W1_HDF ) LED: LOAD-LIMIT
Phase C Harmonics
REDUCED
W2 Current Harmonics
Phase A Harmonics Calculate Harmonic W1_HDF < 0.96
Phase B Harmonics Derating Factor W2_HDF < 0.96 Load Limit Reduced
OR
W3 Current Harmonics
Phase A Harmonics Calculate Harmonic
Phase B Harmonics Derating Factor
Phase C Harmonics (W3_HDF )
894000A2.cdr
Thermal Elements
The 845 thermal elements include Hottest-spot temperature, Aging Factor, and Loss of Life
elements. The computation of these elements follows the IEEE standards C57.91-2011
“IEEE Guide for Loading Mineral-Oil-Immersed Transformers”, and C57.96-2013 “IEEE Guide
for Loading Dry-Type Distribution Transformers”. The computations are based on
transformer loading conditions, ambient temperature, and entered transformer data.
• Refer to SETPOINTS > SYSTEM > TRANSFORMER > GENERAL and enter the
transformer data used in the computation of Hottest-Spot winding temperature,
Aging Factor, and Transformer Loss of Life
• Refer to SETPOINTS > SYSTEM > TRANSFORMER > WINDING 1(2,3) and enter the
windings data used to compute the transformer loading
The transformer winding settings are used for calculation of the winding nominal current,
and the load loss at rated load. The ratio of the actual load to the rated load K is used in the
Hottest-spot temperature computation. If the load loss at rated load is not available from
the transformer’s test report, use the following formulae to calculate it.
PR=In(W)2*R, where In(W) is the winding rated current, and R is the three phase series
resistance.
• Refer to Setpoints > System > Transformer > Thermal Inputs menu, and select the
inputs for Ambient temperature and Top-Oil temperature. If no transducer is available
to measure Ambient temperature, select the “Monthly Average” setting, and enter the
approximate average temperature per month in the monthly calendar menu. If Top-
Oil temperature measurement is not available, select the setting “Computed”.
..\System\Transformer\Thermal Inputs ..\Setpoints\RTD Temperature\RTD 1
Setpoints Value Unit Setpoints Value Unit
Winding Currents CT Bank 1-J1 Function Disabled
Ambient Temperature Monthly Average Name RTD 1
January -20 °C Type 100 W Platinum
February -20 °C Trip Temperature 155 ºC
Trip Pickup Delay 2 s
March -20 °C
Trip Dropout Delay 0 s
April 7 °C
Trip Output Relay X Do Not Operate
May 15 °C Alarm Function Disabled
June 25 °C Alarm Temperature 130 ºC
July 30 °C Alarm Pickup Delay 2 s
August 30 °C Alarm Dropout Delay 0 s
September 20 °C Alarm Output Relay X Do Not Operate
October 17 °C Sensor Open None
November 14 °C Block Off
December 9 °C Events Enabled
Top-Oil Temperature Computed Targets Latched
<< Status Thermal Tap Chan RTD 1 RTD 2 RTD 3 RTD 4 >>
To change the temperature unit, i.e. Fahrenheit, Celsius go to Setpoints > Device > Front
NOTE:
Panelmenu.
NOTE
The inputs for Ambient Temperature and Top-Oil Temperature from Thermal Inputs menu
include selection of RTDs. The selected RTDs must be programmed, for the temperature to
be measured on the relay and be included in the calculation for hottest-spot winding
temperature.
AND
OR
AND
S
LATCH
Set-
Command
Dominant
RESET R
SETPOINTS
Function
Latched Alarm
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
Configurable
Pickup Pickup Delay
AND
RUN
SETPOINTS t pkp
Hottest -Spot OP
Block
Off = 0
t°C > PKP SETPOINT:
METERING OUTPUT RELAY 1(X),
excluding trip selected
Hottest -Spot t ° output relays
894005$1.cdr
Aging Factor The Aging Factor element detects the aging of the transformer in per unit normal
insulation aging. The element can be set for an alarm or trip, whenever the actual aging
factor (as computed by the relay) is bigger than the (defined as acceptable) setting of the
aging factor PKP for the specified time delay.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Transformer > Aging Factor
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
PICKUP
Range: 1.1 to 10.0 in steps of 0.1
Default: 2.0
Enter a setting for the aging factor, above which the element will operate. The setting
must be above the maximum permissible aging factor under emergency loading
conditions, and maximum ambient temperature.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 60000 min in steps of 1 min
Default: 10 min
This setting is used to select a pickup time delay that is used to delay the operation of
the protection.
OUTPUT RELAY 1 (X)
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
The menu includes a list of available output relays to be set for operation or no operation
upon protection operation.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The Neutral IOC is blocked when the selected operand is asserted.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
The selection of the Enabled setting enables the Events function.
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
The selection of the Self-reset or Latched settings enables the target messages of the
function.
Figure 7-4: Aging Factor Logic diagram
LED: ALARM
AND
OR
AND
LATCH
Set-
Command
Dominant
RESET R
SETPOINTS
Function
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Disabled
Alarm Aging Factor PKP
OR
Latched Alarm
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
Configurable
Pickup Pickup Delay
AND
RUN
SETPOINTS t pkp
Aging Factor OP
Block
Off = 0
FAA > PKP SETPOINT:
METERING OUTPUT RELAY 1(X),
excluding trip selected
Aging Factor (FAA ) output relays
894006$1.cdr
Loss of Xfmr Life The Loss of Life (LOL) element provides a mechanism for detecting the accumulated total
consumed transformer life. It can be set to issue an alarm or trip, when the actual
accumulated transformer loss of life is higher than what is specified by the user loss of life
pickup setpoint. For brand new installed transformers, the setting for “XFMR INITIAL LOSS”
is “0”, and for already installed transformers, the user must estimate the consumed
transformer life in hours, being in service.
Path: Setpoints > Grouped Elements > Setting Group 1(8) > Transformer > Loss of Xfmr Life
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
INITIAL XFMR LOL
Range: 1 to 500000 hours in steps of 1 hr
Default: 0 hours
Enter a setting for the consumed transformer life in hours. When the LOL element is
enabled, the loss of life computed by the relay is added to the initial loss of life in hours.
PICKUP
Range: 0 to 500000 hours in steps of 1 hr
Default: 200000 hours
Enter the expected life, in hours, required for operation of the element. This setting must
be above the total transformer life set as a reference based on nominal loading
conditions, and 30º C ambient temperature, as outlined in the IEEE standards.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The Neutral IOC is blocked when the selected operand is asserted.
OUTPUT RELAY 1(X)
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
The menu includes a list of available output relays to be set for operation or no operation
upon protection operation.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
The selection of the Enabled setting enables the Events function.
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
The selection of the Self-reset or Latched settings enables the target messages of the
function.
AND
OR
AND
S
LATCH
Set-
Command
Dominant
RESET R
SETPOINTS
Function
Disabled
Alarm
OR
Latched Alarm
SETPOINTS
Configurable
Pickup
AND
RUN
SETPOINTS FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Block
Xfmr Loss Life PKP
Off = 0
LOL > PKP Xfmr Loss Life OP
METERING
SETPOINT:
Xfmr Life Lost
OUTPUT RELAY 1(X),
excluding trip selected
output relays
894007$1.cdr
Max Tap setpoints Input from the Tap Changer setup menu are set to the minimum and
NOTE maximum available values from the range. This applies to any of the three methods used
for tap position detection – BCD, DCmA, and Ohms. To be able to successfully detect Tap
changer failure, the selected Ohms or DCmA at Tap Min must be bigger than the smallest
measured Ohms or DCmA values by a value corresponding to at least one tap step, and
the selected Ohms or DCmA values must be smaller than the highest Ohm or DCmA
measured value by a value corresponding to at least one tap step
If the Tap position is used for compensation of the differential current due to the new
transformation ratio and the tap position is detected below the Minimum, or above the
Maximum tap , the relay may show small differential current. If the percent differential
protection is set to a very sensitive pickup level, this differential current may cause
operation. To avoid such undesired operation, it is wise to de-sensitize the protection until
the tap position is detected back in the range between the minimum and maximum tap.
For this reason either operand TC at Min Tap, or TC at Max Tap from the Tap changer
Setup, or The Tap Changer Fail PKP can be used for setpoint group change, where the
Percent differential protection can be enabled with less sensitive settings.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Transformer > Tap Changer Failure
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
DELAY
Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01 s
Default: 5.00 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAYS
Range: Do Not Operate, Operate
Default: Do Not Operate
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Latched
AND
LED: ALARM
SETPOINT
FUNCTION
OR
Disabled
S
AND
Alarm
LATCH
OR
Latched Alarm
R
Configurable System/Transformer/ LED: PICKUP
Onload Tap Changer Set
Max Tap Position Command Dominant
RUN RESET
SETPOINTS
DELAY
BLOCK
AND
OUTPUT RELAYS
System/Transformer/
Off = 0 tPKP
Onload Tap Changer Do Not Operate, Operate
OR
0
Min Tap Position
ACTUAL VALUE
RUN
Metering/
Transformer/Tap FlexLogic Operands
TC Position < Min Tap
Changer Position Position Tap Ch Fail OP
TC Position
FlexLogic Operands
Tap Ch Fail PKP
894004$1.cdr
FA_1
COM
FA_1
NO
V
FA_1
OPT/V
52a
contact
Trip
Coil
DC -
FA_2
COM
FA_2
NO
V
FA_2
OPT/V
52b
contact
Close
Coil
DC -
FA_1
COM
External
FA_1 Jumper
NO
V
FA_1
OPT/V
52a
contact
Trip
Coil
DC -
FA_2
COM External
Jumper
FA_2
NO
V
FA_2
OPT/V
52b
contact
Close
Coil
DC -
Some applications require monitoring the Trip coil or/and Close coil continuously,
regardless of the breaker position (open or closed). This can be achieved by connecting a
suitable resistor (see the table Value of Resistor “R”) across the breaker auxiliary contact(s)
52a in the trip circuit (across 52b contact(s) for Close coil). With such connections, the
trickle current is maintained by the resistor. For these applications the setting for the
Bypass Breaker Status should be set to ENABLED.
FA_1 FA_1
COM External
COM External
Jumper Jumper
FA_1 FA_1
NO NO
V V
FA_1
FA_1
OPT/V
OPT/V
Bypass
52a R
resistor
contact
Bypass
52a R Trip
resistor
contact Coil
DC -
DC -
FA_2 FA_2
COM External COM External
Jumper Jumper
FA_2 FA_2
NO NO
V V
FA_2 FA_2
OPT/V OPT/V
Bypass
52b R
resistor
contact
Bypass
52b R
resistor
contact Close
Coil
Close
Coil
52b Bypass
contact R
resistor
DC -
DC -
By default when 845 relay is ordered for protection of two-winding transformer, the I/O
card from slot "F" is equipped with two form A, and three form C auxiliary relays, and seven
contact inputs. The form A auxiliary relays can be used for monitoring of the trip circuits for
each of the two transformer breakers. If desired, the 845 can be ordered with a second I/O
card on slot "G", which will provide two more form A aux relays for monitoring of the close
circuits for both transformer breakers. Please note, that the selected default auxiliary
relays for "Trip Output Select" of Breaker 1, and Breaker 2 are Aux Relay 1, and Aux Relay 2
respectively. Form A relays for closing of the breakers are not selected: Close Output Select
set to "Off". The assignment of Aux Relays for Trip Output Select, and Close Output Select
setpoints per breaker is up to the user.By default when 845 relay is ordered for protection
of three-winding transformer, there will be two I/O cards: one on slot "F", and another one
from the same type on slot "G". Please note, that the selected default auxiliary relays for
"Trip Output Select" of Breaker 1, Breaker 2, and Breaker 3 are Aux Relay 1, Aux Relay 2 and
Auxiliary Relay 9 respectively. Form A relays for closing the breakers are not selected: Close
Output Select set to "Off". The user can change the default aux relays, with any other aux
relays for Trip and Close per each breaker.
The menu for Trip or/and Close Coil Monitoring for any of the transformer breakers is
NOTE:
available only if a Form A auxiliary relay is selected for the Trip Output Select and/or Close
NOTE Output Select setpoints under Setpoints > System > Breakers > Breaker 1(X). The menu for
coil monitoring is not available if a normal Form C aux relay is selected.
Trip and Close Contacts must be considered unsafe to touch when the relay is
DANGER:
energized.
3)
NOTE: TCM menu for BKR1(2,3) displayed only if Aux LED: ALARM /
Rly form A selected underSetpoints/System/ LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
TCM
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled LATCH # 1
Setpoints/System/ Alarm Set-
Breakers/BKR1: Command Dominant
Latched Alarm
OR
RESET R
Trip Relay Select = Aux Rly
SETPOINT
TCM
PICK-UP DELAY: SETPOINTS
TCM
SETPOINT DROP-OUT DELAY: OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
TCM t PKP
Do Not Operate, Operate
t RST
AND
BLOCK :
Off = 0
FlexLogic Operand
SETPOINT
TCM
BYPASS BKR STATE:
Disabled = 0 FlexLogic Operand
OR
FlexLogic Operand
BKR1 Closed
AND
AUX RLY #
OPERATE
Figure 7-12: Trip Circuit Monitoring logic diagram for Breaker 1 (Breaker 2 and Breaker
7–17
TRIP AND CLOSE CIRCUIT MONITORING
TRIP AND CLOSE CIRCUIT MONITORING CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
NOTE: TCM menu for BKR1(2,3) displayed only if Aux LED: ALARM /
Rly form A selected under Setpoints/System/ LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
TCM
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled LATCH # 1
Setpoints/System/ Alarm Set-
Breakers/BKR1: Command Dominant
Latched Alarm
OR
RESET R
Close Relay Select= Aux Configurable
SETPOINT
CCM
PICK-UP DELAY: SETPOINTS
CCM
DROP-OUT DELAY: OUTPUT RELAYS 3 to 7
Figure 7-13: Close Circuit Monitoring Diagram
SETPOINT
CCM t PKP
Do Not Operate, Operate
t RST
AND
BLOCK :
Off = 0
FlexLogic Operand
SETPOINT
CCM
BYPASS BKR STATE:
Disabled = 0 FlexLogic Operand
OR
FlexLogic Operand
BKR1 Opened
AND
AUX RLY #
OPERATE
7–19
TRIP AND CLOSE CIRCUIT MONITORING
BREAKER ARCING CURRENT CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Breaker > BKR 1 Monitor > BKR 1 Arcing Current
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank1-J1
INITIATION
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand, digital input, virtual input or remote input
that initiates the Breaker Arcing Current scheme, typically the Trip signals from internal
protection functions.
DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.00 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.030 s
The setpoint provides a delay interval between the time the tripping sequence is initiated
and the time the breaker contacts are expected to part, starting the integration of the
measured current.
ALARM LEVEL
Range: 0 to 50000 kA2-c in steps of 1 kA2-c
Default: 1000 kA2-c
The setpoint specifies the threshold value (kA2-cycle) above which the output operand is
set.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAYS X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
BKR 1 ARCING S
FUNCTION :
AND
LATCH # 1
Disabled
Set-
Alarm Command Dominant
SETPOINTS RESET R
Latched Alarm
OR
BKR 1 ARCING
AND
Configurable
DELAY:
SETPOINTS t delay 100ms
OR
BKR 1 ARCING 0 0
BLOCK :
Off = 0
AND
SETPOINTS
BKR 1 ARCING
INITIATION :
SETPOINTS
Off = 0
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
RECORDS Do Not Operate, Operate
Figure 7-15: Breaker Arcing Current logic diagram
BKR 1 ARCING
CURRENTS
Add to accumulator
Total I² cycle
SETPOINTS
RUN
CT Bank current IA BKR 1 ARCING
IA² t Integrate IA² cycle ALARM LEVEL : FlexLogic Operands
CT Bank current IB RUN
CT Bank current IC IB² t Integrate IB² cycle Select highest value kA² cyc > Alarm Level BKR 1 Arc OP
COMMAND RUN
IC² t Integrate IC² cycle
CLEAR BKR 1 ARCING
CURRENT :
892743A2.cdr
YES = 1
NO = 0 Set all to 0
Breaker Health
The 845 relay provides breaker health information by monitoring and analyzing the
operation count, arcing energy of breaking current, arcing time, tripping time, closing time
and spring charging time if applicable. The breaker health status depends on many
factors, such as permissible operation number, magnitude of breaking current, mechanical
wear and contact wear.
The operation count is able to give direct information by comparing it with the permissible
operation number. The longer tripping time and closing time can provide an approximate
estimation of trip/close coils and mechanical wear. The increasing spring charging time
may imply developing problems in motor and spring mechanisms. Meanwhile, the increase
in arcing energy of the breaking current may reflect the possibility of contact wear. Longer
arcing time may suggest the loss of dielectric strength in the arc chamber. If the arcing
energy or any of the time intervals is above the related Pickup levels for the use-defined
times, the ALARM LED is lit.
The scheme is equipped with three incomplete sequence timers for Trip/Close time, arc
time and spring charge time respectively. So it automatically resets the related time
interval after the programmed delay.
A breaker operation function is also included, where breaker operation failure is caused by
either of the following conditions:
• The breaker does not respond to a Trip command within the programmed breaker
operation delay time.
• The breaker does not respond to a Close command within the programmed time.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Breaker 1 > Breaker Health
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
MODE
Range: Detection, Monitoring
Default: Detection
The Breaker Health has two running modes: detection and monitoring. Since the
monitored time intervals differ for different breaker types and manufacturers, the
detection mode can be used to help set the Pickup settings based on the historical true
values. The operation count, arcing energy of the breaking current, arcing time, tripping
time, closing time and spring charging time are measured and displayed in ‘Records/
Breaker Health,’ But the element does not pick up when in detection mode. Monitoring
mode is the normal mode, wherein measurements are analyzed and the element may
pick up accordingly.
PRESET TRIP COUNTER
Range: 0 to 100000 in steps of 1
Default: 0
This setting pre-sets the actual operation number when the relay is starting in service or
the record is cleared.
TRIP TRIGGER
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting assigns the trip initiation signal.
CLOSE TRIGGER
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting assigns the close initiation signal.
SPRING CHARGE STATUS
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setting selects the signal to show the status of Spring Charge. Normally, the contact
input connected to the auxiliary contact of the limit switch can be used.
TRIP TIME PICKUP
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.050 s
The setting sets the Pickup level of the Trip time. The Trip time interval is initiated by the
TRIP TRIGGER signal and stopped by the OPEN STATUS signal.
CLOSE TIME PICKUP
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.050 s
The setting sets the Pickup level of the Close time. The Close time interval is initiated by
the CLOSE TRIGGER signal and stopped by the CLOSE STATUS signal.
INCOMPLETE TRP/CLS TIME
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.100 s
The setting declares a breaker operation failure condition if the breaker does not
respond within this time delay. The setting should be greater than the Trip time PKP
value and Close time PKP value.
ARC TIME PICKUP
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.100 s
The setting sets the Pickup level of the Arc time. The Arc time is initiated by the OPEN
STATUS signal and stopped when the current samples in one cycle are less than 0.02 CT.
Then the Arc time is equal to the calculated time interval minus one cycle.
INCOMPLETE ARC TIME
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.300 s
The setting declares an Arc time failure condition if there are currents flowing through
the breaker after this time delay. This setting should be greater than the Arc time PKP
value.
SPRING CHARGE TIME PICKUP
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 15.000 s
This setting sets the Pickup level of the Spring Charge time. The Spring Charge time is
measured from the pulse duration of the SPRING CHARGE STATUS.
INCOMPLETE CHARGE TIME
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 45.000 s
The setting declares a Charge time failure condition if the spring charging process is not
finished after this time delay. The setting should be greater than the Charge time PKP
value.
current element is disabled, the ACR ENERGY is not calculated and this setting should not
be used. The ACR ENERGY used here is the individual value for each trip and not the
accumulated value recorded in the Breaker Arcing Current element.
ALARM COUNTER
Range: 1 to 100 in steps of 1
Default: 5
The setting sets the alarm counter level. One counter is used to accumulate the Pickup
data from all monitoring quantities. If the counter value is above the alarm counter level,
the LED is lit and one operand is asserted.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
/('$/$50
$1'
25
$1'
6
/$7&+
6HW
&RPPDQG
'RPLQDQW
5(6(7 5
6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG 6(732,176
$ODUP %.5+($/7+
25
,1 $/$50&2817(5 )OH[/RJLF2SHUDQGV
/DWFKHG$ODUP
581
&RQ¿JXUDEOH %.5+OWK3.3
&RXQWHU 5HDO&RXQWHU $ODUP
6(732,176 &RPPDQG
&/($5 5(6(7 6(732,176
$1'
%/2&.
2ᚎ $1' 2873875(/$<6
'R1RW2SHUDWH2SHUDWH
6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
02'(
25
'HWHFWLRQ
0RQLWRULQJ
6(732,176 6(732,176
%.5+($/7+ %.5+($/7+
$1'
75,375,**(5 75,37,0(3,&.83
2ᚎ 581
%.5+OWK7ULS3.3
WBWULS 3.3
25
%.52SHQHG 6723
$5&7,0(3,&.83
67$57 581
&XUUHQW,QSXWV 67$57 WBDUFB$ %.5$UF3.3$
6723 WBDUFB$ WBWULSF\F 3.3
3KDVH$&XUUHQWLD LD[&7IRURQHF\F
581
67$57 %.5$UF3.3%
67$57 WBDUFB% WBDUFB% WBWULSF\F 3.3
6723
3KDVH%&XUUHQWLE LE[&7IRURQHF\F 581
%.5$UF3.3&
67$57 WBDUFB& WBWULSF\F 3.3
67$57 WBDUFB&
6723
3KDVH&&XUUHQWLF LF[&7IRURQHF\F
6(732,176
$1' $1'
%.5+($/7+
25
,1&203/(7($5&
7,0(
581
WB,$7
$1' $1'
WB,$7
25
25
%.5$UF)DLO
WB,$7
$1' $1'
$1'
&RPPDQG
25
5(6(7
6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
25
,1&203/(7(753&/6
$1'
7,0(
581
25
%.5+OWK23)DLO
WB,7&7
25
25
6(732,176
$1'
%.5+($/7+
$1'
&/26(75,**(5
2ᚎ 6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
&/26(7,0(3,&.83
581
)OH[/RJLF2SHUDQGV 67$57 %.5+OWK&OV3.3
WBFORVH WBFORVH 3.3
%.5&ORVHG 6723
6(732,176
6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
%.5+($/7+
&+$5*(7,0(3,&.83
635,1*&+$5*(
67$786 581
%.5+OWK&KJ3.3
2ᚎ WBFKDUJH WBFKDUJH 3.3
6(732,176
%.5+($/7+
,1&203/(7(&+$5*(
7,0(
581
WB,&7
%.5&KDUJH)DLO
6(732,176
25
%.5+($/7+
$5&(1(5*<3,&.83
$UF(QHUJ\,QSXWV 581
%.5(QJ\3.3$
,$WF\FOH ,$W 3.3
581
%.5(QJ\3.3%
,%WF\FOH ,%W 3.3
581
%.5(QJ\3.3&
,&WF\FOH ,&W3.3
$FGU
Functions
Power Factor (55)
It is generally desirable for a system operator to maintain the Power Factor as close to
unity as possible to minimize both costs and voltage excursions. Since the Power Factor is
variable on common non-dedicated circuits, it is advantageous to compensate for low
(lagging) Power Factor values by connecting a capacitor bank to the circuit when required.
The relay allows two stages of capacitance switching for Power Factor compensation.
The relay calculates the average Power Factor in the three phases as follows:
Average Power Factor = Total 3-Phase Real Power / Total 3-Phase Apparent Power
When the measured Power Factor becomes more lagging or leading (depending on the
user setting) than the Switch-In level, the relay operates a user-selected output contact.
This output can be used to control a switching device which connects capacitance to the
circuit, or to signal an alarm to the system operator. After entering this state, when the
Power Factor becomes less lagging or leading than the Power Factor Switch-Out level for a
time greater than the set delay, the relay resets the output contact to the non-operated
state.
For delta-connected VTs, the Power Factor feature is inhibited from operating unless all
three voltages are above a threshold and one or more currents are above 0.002 x CT.
Power Factor element delay timers are only allowed to time when the voltage threshold is
exceeded on all phases and the Power Factor remains outside of the region between the
programmed Switch-In and Switch-Out levels. In the same way, when a Power Factor
condition starts the Power Factor delay timer, if all three phase voltages fall below the
threshold before the timer has timed-out, the element resets without operating. A loss of
voltage during any state returns the Power Factor element(s) to the Reset state.
For wye-connected VTs, the power factor value is calculated from the valid phase(s) with a
voltage that is above a user-selected threshold and a current that is above 0.002 x CT.
Power Factor element delay timers are only allowed to time when the supervision
conditions are met and the Power Factor remains outside of the region between the
programmed Switch-In and Switch-Out levels. In the same way, when a Power Factor
condition starts the Power Factor delay timer, if one or more valid phases no longer satisfy
the supervision conditions, the power factor will be re-calculated based on the still valid
phase(s). If the element is continuously asserted with the new power factor value, the timer
will continue timing, otherwise, the element will reset without operating.
The following figure illustrates the conventions established for use in 845 relays, where the
negative value means the lead power factor, and the positive value means the lag power
factor.
For example, the applications of Switch-In and Switch-Out levels are shown in the figures
below.
The settings of this function produces Switch-In, Switch-Out and Operate flags. The Power
Factor Switch-In flag is asserted when the absolute value of the calculated Power Factor is
below the Switch-In value, and supervision conditions are satisfied. The Power Factor
Operate flag in the Switch-In level is asserted if the element stays switched-in for the time
defined by the time delay. After the element drops from Switch-In, the Power Factor
Switch-Out flag is asserted when the Power Factor passes the Switch-Out value. The
Power Factor Operate flag in the Switch-Out level is asserted if the element stays switched
out for the time defined by the time delay.
The minimum operating voltage is set as a threshold below which the element is reset.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Power Factor 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
SWITCH-IN
Range: -0.01 to -0.99, 1, 0.99 to 0.01 (for 8 Series Enervista Setup software: 0.01 Lead, 0.02
Lead, …, 0.98 Lead, 0.99 Lead, 1, 0.99 Lag, 0.98 Lag, …, 0.02 Lag, 0.01 Lag)
Default: 0.08 Lag
The setting sets the Power Factor Switch-In level. The negative value is used to denote
the lead power factor, and the positive value is used for the lag power factor.
SWITCH-OUT
Range: -0.01 to -0.99, 1, 0.99 to 0.01 (for 8 Series Enervista Setup software: 0.01 Lead, 0.02
Lead, …, 0.98 Lead, 0.99 Lead, 1, 0.99 Lag, 0.98 Lag, …, 0.02 Lag, 0.01 Lag)
Default: 1.00
The setting sets the Power Factor Switch-Out level. The negative value is used to denote
the lead power factor, and the positive value is used for the lag power factor.
SWITCH-IN and SWITCH-OUT are mutually exclusive settings. See the application examples
FASTPATH:
above which show no common zone in which both SWITCH-IN and SWITCH-OUT are
asserted.
DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 50.000 s
The setting provides the definite Switch-In and Switch-Out time delay. Instantaneous
operation is selected by the time delay setting of 0.000 s.
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
Range: 0.00 to 1.25 x VT in steps of 0.01 x VT
Default: 0.30 x VT
The setting sets the minimum voltage for Power Factor element operation specified per
times VT.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
POWER FACTOR 1
OR
FUNCTION: S
AND
Disabled
LATCH
Alarm
OR
Set-
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable Power Factor of Three RESET R
Phases
(delta-connected VTs )
AND
Do Not Operate, Operate
SETPOINTS SETPOINTS
Voltage Inputs SETPOINT POWER FACTOR 1
POWER FACTOR 1
- delta connected SWITCH-IN:
POWER FACTOR 1 DELAY:
Figure 7-18: Power Factor logic diagram
AND
Current Inputs VCA ≥ MINIMUM POWER FACTOR 1 POWER FACTOR 1
AND
Phase A Current (IA) IA > 0.002 xCT SWITCH-OUT: DELAY:
OR
Phase B Current (IB) IB > 0.002 xCT RUN tDLY
OR
AND
Power 1 PF 1 Switch-Out OP
Phase C Current (IC) (System Setup \ IC > 0.002 xCT PF passing SWITCH-
OUT 0
Power Sensing) VA ≥ MINIMUM
Voltage Inputs PF 1 Switch-In
AND
- wye connected VB ≥ MINIMUM
VA VC ≥ MINIMUM LED: PICKUP
OR
VB
AND
OR
VC 850 Only
PF 1 Switch-Out
AND
S 894059A3.cdr
OR
LATCH
Reset-
Dominant
R
OR
Demand
Current Demand is measured on each phase, and on three phases for real, reactive, and
apparent power. Setpoints allow emulation of some common electrical utility demand
measuring techniques for statistical or control purposes.
The relay is not approved as, or intended to be, a revenue metering instrument. If used in a
FASTPATH:
peak load control system, the user must consider the accuracy rating and method of
measurement employed, and the source VTs and CTs, in comparison with the electrical
utility revenue metering system.
Current Demand The Current Demand for each phase is calculated individually, and the Demand for each
phase is monitored by comparison with a single Current Demand Pickup value. If the
Current Demand Pickup is equalled or exceeded by any phase, the relay can cause an
alarm or signal an output relay.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Demand > Current Demand 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Configurable
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
This setting provides the selection for the current input bank. The bank names can be
changed in: Setpoints > System > Current Sensing > [Name] > CT Bank Name.
MEASUREMENT TYPE
Range: Blk Interval, Exponential, Rolling Dmd
Default: Blk Interval
This setting sets the measurement method. Three methods can be applied.
THERMAL 90% RESPONSE TIME
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 15 min
This setpoint sets the time required for a steady state current to indicate 90% of the
actual value to approximately match the response of the relay to analog instruments.
The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Thermal Exponential”.
TIME INTERVAL
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 20 min
This setpoint sets the time period over which the current demand calculation is to be
performed. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Block Interval” or
“Rolling Demand”.
PICKUP
Range: 10 to 10000 A in steps of 1 A
Default: 1000 A
This setpoint sets the Current Demand Pickup level.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Disabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Disabled
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
FUNCTION : S
AND
Disabled LATCH
Alarm Set-
OR
Command
Latched Alarm Dominant
RESET R
Configurable
AND
Off =0
SETPOINTS
MEASUREMENT TYPE :
Figure 7-20: Current Demand logic diagram
THERMAL 90%
RESPONSE TIME :
SETPOINTS
SETPOINTS
TIME INTERVAL : PICKUP :
Current Inputs SIGNAL INPUT:
RUN SETPOINTS
Calculate Phase A
Phase A Current (IA) IA Demand • PICKUP
•
CURRENT DEMAND OUTPUT RELAYS
RUN
Calculate Phase B Do Not Operate , Operate
OR
LED: PICKUP
USED ONLY IN 845 and 850
FlexLogic Operands
894060A3.cdr
Current Dmd1 PKP
7–35
FUNCTIONS
Real Power Demand The Real Power Demand is monitored by comparing it to a Pickup value. If the Real Power
Demand Pickup is ever equalled or exceeded, the relay can be configured to cause an
alarm or signal an output relay.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Demand > Real Power Demand 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Configurable
MEASUREMENT TYPE
Range: Blk Interval, Exponential, Rolling Dmd
Default: Blk Interval
This setting sets the measurement method. Three methods can be applied.
THERMAL 90% RESPONSE TIME
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 15 min
This setpoint sets the time required for steady-state Real Power to indicate 90% of the
actual value to approximately match the response of the relay to analog instruments.
The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Thermal Exponential”.
TIME INTERVAL
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 20 min
This setpoint sets the time period over which the Real Power Demand calculation is to be
performed. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Block Interval” or
“Rolling Demand”.
PICKUP
Range: 0.1 to 300000.0 kW in steps of 0.1 kW
Default: 1000.0 kW
This setting sets the Real Power Demand Pickup level. The absolute value of real power
demand is used for the Pickup comparison.
RESET DEMAND
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Any FlexLogic operand can be used to reset the minimum and maximum real power
demand from the current value to zero. These values are reset to zero at the rising edge
of the set operand. After reset to zero, calculation of minimum and maximum real power
demand values continues until the next rising edge of the reset operand.
The Reset Demand operand doesn’t reset the current value of the demand used by the
Real Power Demand function.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAYS X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Disabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Disabled
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
AND
FUNCTION :
Disabled LATCH
Alarm Set-
OR
Command
Latched Alarm Dominant
RESET R
Configurable
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
AND
Off=0
SIGNAL INPUT :
Real Power Inputs TIME INTERVAL : REAL POWER PICKUP :
OUTPUT RELAYS (3-7):
RUN
Three -Phase Calculate : Do Not Operate , Operate
Power 1 Real Demand |P Demand | • PICKUP
•
Real Power (P)
Min Real Demand
Max Real Demand
Not available in 869 Reset Min & Max Real
Demand to 0
ACTUAL VALUES LED: PICKUP
SETPOINTS Pwr 1 Real Dmd
Pwr 1 Min Real Dmd
RESET DEMAND : FlexLogic Operands
Pwr 1 Max Real Dmd
Off=0
RealPwr Dmd PKP
Rising
894061A2.cdr Edge
7–37
FUNCTIONS
FUNCTIONS CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
Reactive Power The Reactive Power Demand is monitored by comparing to a Pickup value. If the Reactive
Power Demand Pickup is ever equalled or exceeded, the relay can be configured to cause
an alarm or signal an output relay.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Demand > Reactive Power Demand 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Configurable
MEASUREMENT TYPE
Range: Blk Interval, Exponential, Rolling Dmd
Default: Blk Interval
The setting sets the measurement method. Three methods can be applied.
THERMAL 90% RESPONSE TIME
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 15 min
The setpoint sets the time required for a steady state Reactive Power to indicate 90% of
the actual value to approximately match the response of the relay to analog
instruments. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Thermal Exponential”.
TIME INTERVAL
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 20 min
The setpoint sets the time period over which the Reactive Power Demand calculation is
to be performed. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Block Interval” or
“Rolling Demand”.
PICKUP
Range: 0.1 to 300000.0 kvar in steps of 0.1 kvar.
Default: 1000.0 kvar
Any FlexLogic operand can be used to reset the accumulated reactive power demand
from its current value to zero. The accumulated value resets at the rising edge of the set
operand. After reset to zero, the reactive power demand element continues calculating
the demand until the next rising edge of the reset operand.
RESET DEMAND
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Any FlexLogic operand can be used to reset the minimum and maximum reactive power
demand from its current value to zero. The minimum and maximum values reset at the
rising edge of the set operand. After reset to zero, calculation of minimum and maximum
reactive power demand values continues until the next rising edge of the reset operand.
The Reset Demand operand doesn't reset the current value of the demand used by the
Reactive Power Demand function.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Disabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Disabled
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
AND
FUNCTION :
Disabled LATCH
Alarm Set-
OR
Command
Latched Alarm Dominant
RESET R
Configurable
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
AND
Off=0
SETPOINTS
REACTIVE PWR DMD
MEASUREMENT TYPE :
REACTIVE PWR DMD
THERMAL 90% SETPOINTS
RESPONSE TIME : REACTIVE PWR DMD
SETPOINTS
Figure 7-22: Reactive Power Demand logic diagram
Apparent Power The Apparent Power Demand is monitored by comparing to a Pickup value. If the Apparent
Demand Power Demand Pickup is ever equalled or exceeded, the relay can be configured to cause
an alarm or signal an output relay.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Demand > Apparent Power Demand 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Configurable
MEASUREMENT TYPE
Range: Blk Interval, Exponential, Rolling Dmd
Default: Blk Interval
The setting sets the measurement method. Three methods can be applied.
THERMAL 90% RESPONSE TIME
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 15 min
The setpoint sets the time required for a steady state Apparent Power to indicate 90% of
the actual value to approximately match the response of the relay to analog
instruments. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Thermal Exponential”.
TIME INTERVAL
Range: 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30 min
Default: 20 min
The setpoint sets the time period over which the Apparent Power Demand calculation is
to be performed. The setpoint is visible only if MEASUREMENT TYPE is “Block Interval” or
“Rolling Demand”.
PICKUP
Range: 0.1 to 300000.0 kVA in steps of 0.1 kVA
Default: 1000.0 kVA
The setting sets the Apparent Power Demand Pickup level.
RESET DEMAND
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
Any FlexLogic operand can be used to reset the minimum and maximum apparent
power demand from its current value to zero. The minimum and maximum values reset
at the rising edge of the set operand. After reset to zero, calculation of minimum and
maximum apparent power demand values continues until the next rising edge of the
reset operand.
The Reset Demand operand doesn't reset the current value of the demand used by the
Apparent Power Demand function.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Disabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Disabled
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
OR
AND
FUNCTION :
Disabled LATCH
Alarm Set-
OR
Command
Latched Alarm Dominant
RESET R
Configurable
SETPOINTS
BLOCK :
AND
Off=0
SETPOINTS
APPARENT PWR DMD
MEASUREMENT TYPE :
Figure 7-23: Apparent Power Demand logic diagram
Pulsed Outputs
The 845 relay provides a Pulse Output element for four energy measurements. The
element can operate auxiliary relays after an adjustable energy increment for the
quantities of positive and negative MWatthours and positive and negative MVARhours.
Pulses occur at the end of each programmed energy increment. Upon power-up of the
relay, the Pulse Output function, if enabled, continues from where it was at the time of loss
of control power. For example, if control power is removed when the positive Watthours
stored at last pulse was 24.000 MWh, when control power is re-applied a pulse occurs at
34.000 MWh if the energy increment is set at 10.000 MWh.
1. The Auxiliary Output relay(s) used for this element must be set to “Self-Resetting”
FASTPATH:
under Aux Output relays. The pulses consist of a one second on-time and a one
second off-time. This feature is programmed such that no more than one pulse per
two seconds is required.
2. The 845 is not a revenue class meter and cannot be used for billing purposes.
Energy quantities are displayed in MWh and MVarh, with resolutions of 1 kWh and 1 kVarh
respectively.
Disabled
Enabled
SETPOINT
CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
STORING Wh AT PULSE
FlexLogic Operands
RUN
Pos Wthrs Pulse OP
MWhprev
SETPOINT
NEG WHS PULSE SETPOINTS
INCREMENT
ACTUAL VALUE
1s 1s OUTPUT RELAYS (X)
RUN
REAL ENERGY MWh >= MWhprev + Do Not Operate, Operate
POSITIVE Wh
NMWhP value
MWh
STORING Wh AT PULSE
ACTUAL VALUE
SETPOINT
REACTIVE ENERGY Power 1
POSITIVE VARh POS VARHS PULSE SETPOINTS
INCREMENT
1s 1s OUTPUT RELAYS (X)
MVARh RUN
Figure 7-24: Pulsed Outputs logic diagram
SETPOINT
NEG VARHS PULSE SETPOINTS
INCREMENT
1s 1s OUTPUT RELAYS (X)
RUN
MVARh <= MVARhprev - Do Not Operate, Operate
NMVARhP value
STORING VARh AT
PULSE
FlexLogic Operands
RUN
Neg Varh Pulse OP
MVARhprev
894064A2.cdr
7–45
FUNCTIONS
FUNCTIONS CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
Digital Counters
The 845 relay provides sixteen identical Digital Counters. A Digital Counter counts the
number of state transitions from logic 0 to logic 1.
The Digital Counters are numbered from 1 to 16. The counters are used to count
operations such as the Pickups of an element, the changes of state of an external contact
(e.g. breaker auxiliary switch), or the pulses from a watt-hour meter.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Functions > Digital Counters > Digital Counter 1 (16)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
NAME
Range: Any 13 alphanumeric characters
Default: Counter 1
UNITS
Range: Any 5 alphanumeric characters
Default: Units
Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure with respect to the digital transitions to be
counted. The units label will appear in the metering corresponding Actual Values Status
under RECORDS/DIGITAL COUNTERS.
PRE-SET
Range: -2147483648, 0, +2147483647
Default: 0
The setpoint sets the count to a required pre-set value before counting operations begin,
as in the case where a substitute relay is installed in place of an in-service relay, or while
the Counter is running.
COMPARE
Range: -2147483648, 0, +2147483647
Default: 0
The setpoint sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three
FlexLogic output operands are provided to indicate if the present value is ‘more than (HI)’,
‘equal to (EQL)’, or ‘less than (LO)’ the set value.
UP
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand for incrementing the Counter. If an enabled
UP input is received when the accumulated value is at the limit of +2147483647, the
counter rolls over to -2147483648 and shows the alarm ‘Digital Counter 1 at Limit’.
DOWN
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand for decrementing the Counter. If an enabled
DOWN input is received when the accumulated value is at the limit of +2147483647, the
counter rolls over to -2147483648 and shows the alarm ‘Digital Counter 1 at Limit’.
SET TO PRE-SET
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand used to set the counter to the pre-set value.
The counter is set at pre-set value in the following situations:
1. When the Counter is enabled and Digital Counter 1 Set to Pre-Set operand has value 1
(when the Counter is enabled and Digital Counter 1 Set to Pre-Set operand has value
0, the Counter will be set to 0).
2. When the Counter is running and Digital Counter 1 Set to Pre-Set operand changes
the state from 0 to 1 (Digital Counter 1 Set to Pre-Set changing from 1 to 0 while the
Counter is running has no effect on the count).
3. When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the Counter and Digital Counter 1
Set to Pre-Set operand has the value 1 (when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent
to the Counter and Digital Counter 1 Set to Pre-Set operand has the value 0, the
Counter will be set to 0).
RESET
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand for setting the count, either 0 or the pre-set
value depending on the state of the Counter 1 Set to Pre-set operand.
FREEZE/RESET
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand for freezing (capturing) the accumulating
count value into a separate register with the associated date and time of the operation
while resetting the count to either 0 or the pre-set value depending on the state of the
“Counter 1 Set to Pre-set” operand.
FREEZE/COUNT
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand for freezing (capturing) the accumulating
count value into a separate register with the associated date and time of the operation
while continuing counting. The present accumulated value and frozen (captured) value
with the associated date/time stamp are available as STATUS values. If control power is
interrupted, during the power-down operation, the accumulated and frozen (captured)
values are saved into non-volatile memory.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
HI OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EQL OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
LO OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
The counter accumulated value can be reset to zero either by asserting an operand
NOTE:
programmed under Reset from the counter menu, executing the clear Digital Counters
NOTE command under the Records/Clear menu, or by setting the function of the counter to
“Disabled”.
SETPOINTS
CNTR 1 HI
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
Do Not Operate, Operate
FlexLogic Operand
SETPOINT
DGTL CNTR 1 COUNTER 1 HI
FUNCTION:
Disabled
Enabled
SETPOINTS
CNTR 1 EQL
OUTPUT RELAY 3 (X)
AND
SETPOINT
SETPOINTS Do Not Operate, Operate
DGTL CNTR 1
BLOCK: DGTL CNTR 1 NAME:
OFF=0
DGTL CNTR 1 UNITS: FlexLogic Operand
AND
SETPOINT COUNTER 1 LIMIT
DGTL CNTR 1
RESET:
OFF=0
AND
RECORDS
SETPOINT
OR
COUNTER 1
DGTL CNTR 1 ACCUMULATION
FREEZE/RESET:
OFF=0 COUNTER 1 FROZEN 892751A1.cdr
COUNTER 1 FROZEN
SETPOINT STORE DATE AND TIME
OR
DATE AND TIME
DGTL CNTR 1
FREEZE/COUNT:
OFF=0
Harmonic Detection
The Harmonic detection 1(6) element monitors the selected 2nd to 5th harmonic or Total
Harmonics Distortion (THD), which is present in the phase currents. The relay provides six
identical Harmonic Detection elements.
In a distribution network, harmonic detection can be used to monitor spurious harmonics
from inverter based distributed energy resources, and take control actions such as
islanding DERs or turning on harmonic filters. During transformer energization or motor
starts, the inrush current present in phase currents can impact some sensitive elements,
such as negative sequence overcurrent. Therefore, the ratio of the second harmonic to the
fundamental magnitude per phase is monitored, while exceeding the settable pickup level,
an operand is asserted, which can be used to block such sensitive elements.
During startup or shutdown of generator connected transformers, or following a load
rejection, the transformer can experience an excessive ratio of volts to hertz, that is,
become overexcited. Similarly, the ratio of the fifth harmonic to the fundamental
magnitude can be monitored to detect the overexcitation condition.
The harmonics monitored in this element is calculated from the phase currents, unlike the
NOTE:
second or fifth harmonic differential current used in the transformer differential element.
NOTE
The harmonics are updated every protection pass. The THD is updated every three cycles,
NOTE:
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINT
OR
Disabled
LATCH
Alarm
Set-
OR
Latched Alarm Command
Dominant
Configurable RESET R
SETPOINT
BLOCK :
SETPOINT
AND
Off=0 SETPOINT SETPOINT
SETPOINT OUTPUT RELAYS 1(X):
MINIMUM OPER PHASES FOR
PICKUP : Do Not Operate , Operate
SETPOINT CURRENT : OPERATION :
INPUT : RUN RUN ANY ONE : At least one
Figure 7-26: Harmonic Detection logic diagram
7–51
HARMONIC DETECTION
RTD TEMPERATURE CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
RTD Temperature
RTD Wiring Diagram
Figure 7-27: RTD Wiring diagram
To enhance the accuracy of the RTD, ensure all 3 cables are of the same length and gauge.
NOTE:
In addition, the Compensation and Return wires must be connected on the RTD side and
NOTE not on the relay side.
RTD Inputs
The 845 has two methods of supporting RTD inputs. I/O cards installed in the relay can
supply up to 13 RTDs, as described below. An optional CANBUS-based RMIO unit can also
be installed, which can monitor up to 12 additional RTDs (referred to as RRTDs). The RMIO
unit supports 6, 9, or 12 RRTDs.
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external Resistance
Temperature Detectors (RTDs) and convert these signals into a digital format for use as
required. These channels are intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in common
use.
Depending on the order code (Advanced Monitoring option selected), the 845 relay is
packaged with one combo card consisting of one RTD input, one Ohms input, four DCmA
inputs and seven DCmA outputs. Additionally, the relay can be furnished with up to two
optional RTD cards, each of them having 6 RTD input channels. Only slots “B” and “C” can
accept the optional RTD cards.
If only one RTD card is ordered at the time the relay is ordered, this RTD card is always
NOTE:
shown in slot B. The order code selection does not allow for an RTD card in slot C, if no RTD
NOTE card is ordered in slot B.
An I/) card L ordered in Slot G will contain an additional RTD input on the card. It will be the
NOTE:
highest RTD number shown (i.e. if 1 additional RTD card is used, then the LVIO RTD will be
NOTE RTD #7).
An alphanumeric name is assigned to each channel; this name is included in the channel
actual values. It is also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features
designed to measure this type of parameter. Selecting the type of RTD connected to the
channel configures the channel. The conversion chart is shown in the RTD Temperature vs.
Resistance table.
Table 7-2: RTD Temperature vs. Resistance
TEMPERATURE RESISTANCE (IN OHMS)
°C °F 100 Ω PT 120 Ω NI 100 Ω NI 10 Ω CU
(IEC 60751)
–40 –40 84.27 92.76 77.30 7.49
–30 –22 88.22 99.41 82.84 7.88
–20 –4 92.16 106.15 88.45 8.26
–10 14 96.09 113.00 94.17 8.65
0 32 100.00 120.00 100.00 9.04
10 50 103.90 127.17 105.97 9.42
20 68 107.79 134.52 112.10 9.81
30 86 111.67 142.06 118.38 10.19
40 104 115.54 149.79 124.82 10.58
50 122 119.40 157.74 131.45 10.97
60 140 123.24 165.90 138.25 11.35
70 158 127.08 174.25 145.20 11.74
80 176 130.90 182.84 152.37 12.12
90 194 134.71 191.64 159.70 12.51
100 212 138.51 200.64 167.20 12.90
110 230 142.29 209.85 174.87 13.28
120 248 146.07 219.29 182.75 13.67
130 266 149.83 228.96 190.80 14.06
140 284 153.58 238.85 199.04 14.44
150 302 157.33 248.95 207.45 14.83
160 320 161.05 259.30 216.08 15.22
170 338 164.77 269.91 224.92 15.61
180 356 168.48 280.77 233.97 16.00
190 374 172.17 291.96 243.30 16.39
200 392 175.86 303.46 252.88 16.78
210 410 179.53 315.31 262.76 17.17
220 428 183.19 327.54 272.94 17.56
230 446 186.84 340.14 283.45 17.95
240 464 190.47 353.14 294.28 18.34
250 482 194.10 366.53 305.44 18.73
RTD type copper (Cu) is only available when order code option ‘S’ is chosen for Slot B or C.
NOTE:
The Alarm temperature is set slightly above the normal measured temperature for the
transformer top-oil, bottom-oil, or LTC oil. The Trip temperature is normally set at the
maximum permissible oil temperatures defined as dangerous for the transformer and the
transformer insulation.
This element also monitors the RTD broken connection and blocks the RTD trip and alarm
functions if the RTD connection is detected as Open or Shorted and generates RTD Open
and RTD Shorted FlexLogic operands. An RTD is detected as Open when the RTD
connection is either open or the temperature is greater than 250°C. An RTD is detected as
Shorted when the RTD connection is either shorted or the temperature is equal to less than
-40°C.
The RTD input is active regardless of whether or not, the RTD Trip, or/and RTD Alarm
NOTE:
SETPOINT
SETPOINT Trip Temperature SETPOINTS
Trip Pickup Delay LED: TRIP To all Output Relays
Type RUN selected to trip Xfmr
SETPOINT Trip Dropout Delay
tº • Trip
• Temperature t PKP (850: Feeder) breakers
Name Resistance- t RST
AND
RTD 1 Temperature
Convertion From other FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
RTD
SETPOINT for voting RTD 1 (Trip)OP
Alarm Temperature SETPOINTS RTD 1 (Trip)PKP
Alarm Pickup Delay
RUN
Alarm Dropout Delay
•
Tº • Alarm Temperature SETPOINT
tPKP tRST
Trip Output Relay X
Do Not Operate, Operate
SETPOINT
LED: Alarm
Trip Function
Disabled LED:
AND
Trip Pickup
OR
OR
Configurable
Figure 7-28: RTD Protection logic diagram
AND
AND
AND
OR
S
AND
LATCH
OR
SETPOINT RESET R
Block Command
RUN
Off=0 R ¡ 250°C
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OR
RTD 1 Alarm OP
RTD 1 Alarm PKP
RUN
AND
• SETPOINT
R • -40°C
Alarm Output Relay X
SETPOINT
Do Not Operate,Operate
Alarm Function
Disabled FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Alarm Setpoints/Device/Front RTD 1 Open
OR
Latched Alarm Panel/Display Properties RTD 1 Shorted
Temperature Display:
(Celsius, Fahrenheit) ACTUAL VALUES
RTD 1 Temperature
894118A3.cdr
RTD Trouble
When set to Alarm or Latched Alarm, this element monitors all the RTDs that are either
programmed as Alarm or Trip or Configurable and generates an alarm if any of the RTDs
are detected as Open or Shorted. Upon detection of an RTD Open or Shorted condition, the
element also asserts the RTD Trouble PKP and RTD Trouble OP and operates the assigned
output relay. Both RTDs and RRTDs can be monitored using this element.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > RTD Trouble
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm
Default: Disabled
ALARM OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Latched
Figure 7-29: RTD Trouble logic diagram
LED: Alarm
SETPOINT
AND
Alarm Function
OR
Disabled
Alarm
AND
OR
Latched Alarm S
LATCH
RTD Trouble OP
From RTD 1(X) Temperature
RRTD 1 Open
.. .. SETPOINT
. .
RRTD X Open Alarm Output Relay X
RRTD 1 Shorted Do Not Operate, Operate
.. ..
. .
RRTD X Shorted 894178A1.cdr
Loss of Communications
Introduction
This section covers the functionality of the 8 Series Loss of Communications element.
The 8 Series device monitors activity on an interface via the configured protocol for this
interface. The communications status is set for each protocol.
If communications is lost, the enabled interface will issue a “Loss of Comms” event and
operate a combination of output relays / states.
Path: Setpoints > Monitoring > Loss of Comms
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
INTERFACE
Range: Serial, Serial + Ethernet, Ethernet, All
Default: Serial
Only the protocols associated with the selected interface are shown in this screen as
options. For example, if “Ethernet” is selected, select the Ethernet protocols to monitor.
The Ethernet protocols selection is defined as EthernetProtocolBitmask bitmasks.
MODBUS
Range: Off, On
Default: Off
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 600 s in steps of 1
Default: 2 s
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Latched
/('75,3
2SHUDWH2XWSXW5HOD\75,3
$1 '
6(732,17
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
$1 '
&RQILJXUDEOH
6
$1'
/$7&+
6HW
'RPLQDQW
&RPPDQG
5(6(7
Figure 7-30: Loss of Communications logic diagram
6(732,176
%/2&. 6(732,176
581
$1 '
2II 2873875(/$<6
&RPPV6WDWXV
3,&.83'(/$< 'R1RW2SHUDWH2SHUDWH
,QDFWLYH
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
/RVVRI&RPPV23
/('3,&.83
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
/RVVRI&RPPV3.3
$FGU
7–59
LOSS OF COMMUNICATIONS
LOSS OF COMMUNICATIONS CHAPTER 7: MONITORING
Chapter 8: Control
Control
6HWSRLQW*URXS
/RFDO&RQWURO0RGH
'DWD&DSWXUH
%UHDNHU&RQWURO
'DWD&DSWXUH
6HWSRLQWV 'HYLFH
6ZLWFK&RQWURO
'DWD&DSWXUH
6\VWHP 'DWD&DSWXUH
3ROH'LVFRUGDQFH
,QSXWV 9LUWXDO,QSXW&RQWURO
2XWSXWV 7ULS%XV
%)6HWXS
3URWHFWLRQ %UHDNHU)DLOXUH
%),QLWLDWH
0RQLWRULQJ 6\QFKURFKHFN
&ROG/RDG3LFNXS $56HWXS
&RQWURO
$XWRUHFORVH
)OH[/RJLF $5,QLWLDWH
&76XSHUYLVLRQ
$56KRWWR
7HVWLQJ
$55DWH6XSHUYLVLRQ
$5&XUUHQW6XSHUYLVLRQ
$5=RQH&RRUGLQDWLRQ
Setpoints Device
Testing Synchrocheck
VT Fuse Failure
Setpoint Group
The 845 relay provides six setpoint groups. All setpoints contained under the protection
setpoints are reproduced in six groups, identified as Setpoint Groups 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6.
These multiple setpoints provide the capability for both automatic and manual switching
to protection settings for different operating situations. Automatic (adaptive) protection
setpoint adjustment is available to change settings when the power system configuration
is altered.
Automatic group selection can be initiated from the autoreclose, SETPOINT GROUPS and
by use of a SET GROUP x ACTIVE setpoint input. The group selection can be initiated by this
input from any FlexLogic operands, inputs, pushbuttons or communications.
Group 1 is the default for the "Active Group" and is used unless another group is requested
to become active. The active group can be selected with the ACTIVE SETPOINT GROUP
setpoint, by SET ACTIVE x GROUP input or inputs from autoreclose, SETPOINT GROUPS. If
there is a conflict in the selection of the active group, between a setpoint, inputs and inputs
from functions, the higher numbered group is made active. For example, if the inputs for
Group 2, 4, and 6 are all asserted the relay uses Group 6. If the logic input for Group 6 then
becomes de-asserted, the relay uses Group 4. Some application conditions require that the
relay does not change from the present active group. This prevention of a setpoint group
change can be applied by setting Change Inhibit inputs (1 to 16). If needed, typically this
change inhibit is done when any of the overcurrent (phase, neutral, ground, or negative
sequence), overvoltage, bus or line undervoltage, or underfrequency elements are picked-
up.
Path: Setpoints > Control > Setpoint Groups
ACTIVE SETPOINT GROUP
Range: 1,2,3,4,5,6
Default: 1
The Active Setpoint Group setting is used for manual selection of the Active Setpoint
Group by setting.
SET GROUP 2 (3,4,5,6) ACTIVE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand that initiates change of the Active Setpoint
Group.
GROUP CHANGE INHIBIT 1 (UP TO 16)
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand that inhibits change of the active setpoint
group.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
SETPOINT GR 1
GR 2
ACTIVE SETPOINT GROUP GR 3
SETPOINT GROUP1 GR 4
GR 5
GR 6 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
S. GROUP 1 ACTIVE
AND
AND
SETPOINT
OR
SET GROUP 2 ACTIVE
Off
SET GROUP 3 ACTIVE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
Off
SET GROUP 4 ACTIVE S. GROUP 2 ACTIVE
AND
Off
SET GROUP 5 ACTIVE
OR
OR
Off
SET GROUP 6 ACTIVE
AND
Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
S. GROUP 3 ACTIVE
AND
from AUTORECLOSE
AND
OR
Setpoint Group 2
OR
Setpoint Group 3
Setpoint Group 4
Setpoint Group 5
Setpoint Group 6 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
S. GROUP 4 ACTIVE
AND
OR
OR
Setpoint Group 2
Setpoint Group 3
Setpoint Group 4
AND
Setpoint Group 5
Setpoint Group 6 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
S. GROUP 5 ACTIVE
AND
Figure 8-3: Setpoint Groups logic diagram
OR
OR
OR
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR
FROM MANUAL CLOSE S. GROUP 6 ACTIVE
OR
AND
BLOCK
OR
Setpoint Group 2
Setpoint Group 3
Setpoint Group 4
OR
Setpoint Group 5
Setpoint Group 6
AND
TO PROTECTION SETPOINT
OR
GROUPS
AND
SETPOINT
CHANGE INHIBIT 1
OR
Off
CHANGE INHIBIT 2
AND
Off
CHANGE INHIBIT 3
Off
OR
... ...
CHANGE INHIBIT 16
OR
Off
AND
892700A1.CDR
CHAPTER 8: CONTROL
Navigation
The 8 Series front panel provides navigation pushbuttons (PBs) which highlight the
component (breaker or disconnect switch) from the single line diagram. As shown in
Navigation and SLD component selection, the navigation PBs (Up/Down or Up/Down/Left/
Right depending on relay front panel model), are used to browse through the SLD
components. These PBs are used for SLD navigation only. The navigation starts with
highlighting the first breaker, and then goes through all other components in sequence,
until the last one (breaker or switch). Only the breakers and switches included in the SLD
from the display will be browsed (navigated).
SLD component selection). A flash message “ BKR # Selected”, or “Sw # Selected” appears
on the screen to denote the selection. Once selected, the text from the first three tabs from
the display corresponding to the PBs 1, 2, and 3 changes to “Tag”, “Block”, and “Bypass”. At
this stage, the selected breaker or switch can be Opened or Closed using the programmed
PBs, and Tagged/Blocked/Bypassed using the SLD PBs.
For PBs supporting one breaker only, the Local Control Mode menu includes the setpoint
“Select Before Operate”, which can be set to either Enabled or Disabled. When it is set to
Disabled, tagging, blocking and block bypassing commands are disabled from both Local
and Remote control. In this mode the breaker can be controlled directly by the
programmed Open and Close PBs. The local control for the disconnect switches is
suspended. In this mode they can only be controlled remotely, i.e. using pre-programmed
contact inputs, virtual inputs, comms, or any selected FlexLogic operand for closing and
opening commands. The remote block and block bypass flags are also suspended. With
Select Before Operate set to Disabled the relay behaves similar to some other legacy
relays, where when in Local mode the breaker is directly controlled by pressing the Open
and Close PBs without additional confirmation, and when in Remote mode the breaker is
directly controlled by executing the remote open and close commands from the
configured setpoints.
When the “Select Before Operate” setpoint is set to Enabled, the navigation, the breaker or
switch selection, as well as the blocking, bypassing and tagging are operational when in
Local mode. When switched to Remote mode, the remote blocking and bypassing will be
operational as well.
The selected component from SLD will be deselected if either the time programmed in
FASTPATH:
setpoint “Bkr/Sw Select Timeout” expires, or the PB “ESCAPE” is pressed. The “HOME”
button will not de-select the selected object. To navigate to home page, the component
must be first de-selected on the SLD page.
The programmed PBs for breaker or switch Open and Close can be used only in local mode
when an active object is selected in the SLD. The selected device can be opened or closed
provided it is not blocked or tagged. If no operation is detected, the selection is removed,
and the selected PB must be pressed again to enable the selection. The local mode breaker
selection and operation is only active if the user has proper level security access.
OR
ENTER
PB “ENTER” Setpoint
AND
Bkr/Sw Select Timeout
Timer
5 min
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SLD Breaker Selection
BKR 1 Selected
BKR 2 Selected
BKR 3 Selected
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND BKR 1
AND
Local Mode ON
BKR 2
AND
BKR 3
AND
NOTE: The selection of Breakers and Switches is
available only to those of them configured and included in
SW 1 the SLD. Not used breakers and switches are skipped
AND
from the sequence during navigation.
SW 2
AND
MESSAGE
SW 3
OR
AND
AND
SW 4
AND
Navigation Pushbuttons SW 5
AND
SW 6
AND
SW 7
AND
SW 8
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SLD Switch Selection
SW 1 Selected
SW 2 Selected
SW 3 Selected
SW 4 Selected
SW 5 Selected
SW 6 Selected
SW 7 Selected
SW 8 Selected
894195A1.cdr
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
Non-Volatile Latch Block OFF
Reset-Dominant
PB “BLOCK” S
positive FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Block
one shot Latch Block ON
894197A1.cdr
AND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SBO Enabled
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND Bypass Block OFF
Non-Volatile Latch
Reset - Dominant
PB “BYPASS
S
BLOCK”
positive FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Byp Blk one shot Latch Bypass Block ON
894198A1.cdr
AND
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SBO Enabled
SETTING
TAGGING
Enabled = 1
S
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Latch Tag ON
PB “TAG”
894199A1.cdr
positive R
Tag
one shot
AND OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SBO Enabled
The pushbuttons, Tag, Block and Bypass Block are used for both breakers and switches
FASTPATH:
when selected in the SLD. Only one component at the time can be selected in the SLD.
Tagging, blocking, or bypassing block can be performed in Local Mode, and only when the
FASTPATH:
component (breaker or switch) is selected in the SLD. The applied action of tagging,
blocking or bypassing block is retained for this component after it’s been deselected. To
change the status of the applied action, the component need be reselected.
The Local Mode control allows programming of separate pair of PBs for Open and Close
FASTPATH:
commands to breakers and for Open and Close commands to switches. If desired, one pair
of pushbuttons can be programmed for Open and Close commands to both breakers and
switches.
6(732,17 /0
/RFDO0RGH )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
2II /RFDO0RGH21
6(77,1* /RFDO0RGH2))
$1'
6HOHFW%HIRUH2SHUDWH
'LVDEOHG (QDEOHG
IURP%NU6ZVHOHFWLRQORJLF )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
6%2(QDEOHG
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.56HOHFWHG
$1'
$1'
6(732,17
%UHDNHU/RFDO2SHQ
2II 3XVKEXWWRQ21
3%³/RFDO6WRS´
3%³%.5/RFDO2SHQ´ )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.5/RFDO2SHQ
IURP%UHDNHU&RQWUROORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON2SHQ
23(1
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' FRPPDQG
7R6HOHFWHG%.5
%.55HP%ON2SHQ%\ 6HWSRLQWV6\VWHP
%UHDNHUV%.5
7ULS2XWSXW
5HOD\5HDG\
IURP%UHDNHUVWDWXVGHWHFWLRQORJLF
25
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' %.57ULS5HOD\6HOHFW
$1'
%.52SHQHG
IURP7DJJLQJORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
7DJ21
IURP/RFDO%ORFNORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%ORFN21
)URP/RFDO%\SDVV%ORFNORJLF
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%\SDVV%ORFN21
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.5/RF%ON2SHQ
6(732,17
%UHDNHU/RFDO&ORVH )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
3%³%.5/RFDO&ORVH´
$1'
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.5/RFDO&ORVH
3%³/RFDO6WDUW´ 7R6HOHFWHG%.5
6HWSRLQWV6\VWHP &ORVH2XWSXW
%UHDNHUV%.5
IURP%UHDNHU&RQWUROORJLF
25
%.5&ORVH5HOD\6HOHFW
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.55HP%ON&ORVH
$1'
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON&OV%\
IURP%UHDNHUVWDWXVGHWHFWLRQORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.5&ORVHG
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.5/RF%ON&ORVH
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.5/RF%ON&OV%\
)URP³%.5&RQWURO´PHQX
7KHORJLFVKRZVWKHORFDO
6(732,17&21752/%.5&21752/&/26(
6<1&68391%.5 EUHDNHUFRQWUROIRU%UHDNHUZLWK
WKHVHWSRLQW³6HOHFW%HIRUH
)URP&ORVH6\QFKURFKHFN6XSHUYLVLRQ 2SHUDWH´SUHVHQWLQWKHPHQXRQO\
IRU%UHDNHU VHOHFWHGLQ%.5 &RQWURO
ZKHQWKHUHOD\LVRUGHUHGWR
PHQX
VXSSRUWPRUHWKDQRQHEUHDNHU
7KHSURJUDPPHGYDOXH´%\SDVVµ´6\QF&OV3HUPµRU´6\QF&OV3HUPµIRUWKHVHWSRLQW
´&ORVH6\QF6SYQ%.5µIURP%.5&RQWUROPHQXDSSOLHV
$FGU
SETPOINT LM
Local Mode FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off = 0 Local Mode ON
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Selected
SETPOINT
Switch1 Local Open
Off=0, Pushbutton # ON =1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Rem Blk Open FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
Tag ON T PKP
0 AND
from Local Block logic
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Block ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Bypass Block ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
SETPOINT
Switch Local Close FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Off=0, Pushbutton # ON =1 SW1 Local Close
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Close Cmd
from Switch Control logic
relay
SW1 Rem Blk Close Setpoints/System/ selected to
Setpoints/Control/ Switches/SW1: close SW1
AND
Relay ( Ready = 1)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND Switch Control/
SW1: OR SW 1: Close Relay
SW1 Rem Blk Cls By Select
SW 1 CLOSE SEAL -IN
T PKP
0 AND
from Disconnect Switch status detection logic
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
SW1 Closed
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
894202A1.cdr
setpoints appear in the menu only if the relay is ordered with Advanced SLD; and the
NOTE “Select Before Operate” setpoint is set to “Enabled”. In all other cases, these setpoints are
hidden and inactive.
LOCAL MODE
Range: Off, On, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: order code dependent (On or Pushbutton 5 OFF)
For the 10 PB faceplate 11-A
Range: Off, On, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Pushbutton 5 Off
The LOCAL MODE setting places the relay in local mode. The relay is in Remote mode, if
not forced into Local mode by this setpoint (i.e. LOCAL mode set to Disabled, or the
selected input de-asserted). When in Local Mode, both Breakers and Disconnect
switches can be controlled using the faceplate pushbuttons and SLD pushbuttons.
BKR /SW SELECT TIMEOUT
Range: 1 to 10 min in steps of 1 min
Default: 5 min
This setting specifies the available time for open/close commands, after a breaker or a
disconnect switch has been selected in the single line diagram.
BKR LOCAL CLOSE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Pushbutton 2 ON
This setpoint is active, when Local Mode is activated. The breaker (contactor)close
command can be initiated by the selected faceplate pushbutton.
BKR LOCAL CLOSE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Pushbutton 2 ON
This setpoint is active, when Local Mode is activated. The breaker (contactor)close
command can be initiated by the selected faceplate pushbutton.
SW LOCAL OPEN
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Pushbutton 1 ON
This setpoint is active, when Local Mode is activated. The switch open command can be
initiated by the programmed faceplate pushbutton. The setpoint appears in the Local
Control Mode menu only when advanced SLD is selected when ordering the relay.
SW LOCAL CLOSE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Pushbutton 2 ON
This setpoint is active, when Local Mode is activated. The switch close command can be
initiated by the programmed faceplate pushbutton. The setpoint appears in the Local
Control Mode menu only when advanced SLD is selected when ordering the relay.
TAGGING
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
When enabled, tagging control is enabled and the TAG key is displayed on the front
panel interface. When a breaker or a switch is tagged both the local and remote control
of the device is inhibited.
Tagging is applied only from the TAG key and is mostly used for maintenance purposes,
FASTPATH:
and in general when either the open or close control must be inhibited. The tagging cannot
be bypassed and can only be disabled (untagged) by pressing the TAG key again.
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
“Bypass Rem Blk Close” flags are inhibited, when the setpoint Select Before Operate
residing under Local Control Mode menu is set to Disabled. The breaker remote open and
close commands are operational.
The 845 relay provides control of up to three breakers, depending on the order code. An
FASTPATH:
is located on radial feeders, or the line is powered by one source only, the DEAD SOURCE
PERM setpoint from the Synchrocheck menu shall not be disabled.
The 845 relay has one three-phase voltage inputs, a single auxiliary voltage input, and one
FASTPATH:
EVENTS
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
IURP&RQWURO0RGHORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
/RFDO0RGH21
25
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
7DJ21
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
6%2(QDEOHG )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HPRWH2SHQ
IURP/RFDO&RQWURO0RGHORJLF 6(732,17
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' %.55HPRWH2SHQ
$1'
%UHDNHUV%.5 %.57ULS
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' 2XWSXW
%.57ULS5HOD\6HOHFW
%.5/RF%ON2SHQ%\
23(1
FRPPDQG
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.52SHQHG
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
$1'
%.55HPRWH2SHQ3HUP
6(732,17
%.55HP%ORFN2SHQ
$1'
2II
$1'
6(732,17
$1'
%.5%\SDV5HP%ON2SHQ
2II )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON2SHQ%\
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON2SHQ
7ULS2SHQ5HOD\
IURP/RFDO&RQWURO0RGHORJLF
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.5/RF%ON&ORVH
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HPRWH&ORVH
%.5/RF%ON&OV%\
6(732,17
%.55HPRWH&ORVH 6HWSRLQWV6\VWHP
IURP6ZLWFKGHWHFWLRQORJLF %UHDNHUV%.5
2II
$ 1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.5 &ORVH5HOD\
%.5&ORVHG 6HOHFW
&/26(
6(732,17 FRPPDQG 7R
6HOHFWHG
%.55HPRWH&ORVH
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' %.5
$1'
2II &ORVH
%.55HPRWH&ORVH3HUP
2XWSXW
$ 1'
6(732,17
%.55HP%ORFN&ORVH
$1'
2II
$1'
6(732,17
$1'
%.5%\SDV5HP%ON&OV
2II
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON&OV%\
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
%.55HP%ON&ORVH
$FGU
6(732,176
&/26(6<1&+52&+(&.
6391%.5
%\SDVV
25
6\QF&OV3HUP
$1 '
6\QF%.5&OV3HUP
)URP6\QFKURFKHFN
The switch “Remote Block Open”, “Remote Block Close”, “Bypass Remote Block Open” and
FASTPATH:
“Bypass Remote Block Close” flags are inhibited, when the setpoint Select Before Operate
residing under Local Control Mode menu is set to Disabled. The remote open and close
commands are still operational.
Path: Setpoints > Control > Switch Control > SW 1(X) Control
REMOTE OPEN
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting specifies an input which when asserted initiates the open command to the
switch. This setpoint is active only when the operand assigned for Local Mode is de-
asserted, or Local Mode is set to “Off”.
REMOTE CLOSE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
This setting specifies an input which when asserted initiates the close command to the
switch. This setpoint is active only when the operand assigned for Local Mode is de-
asserted, or Local Mode is set to “Off”.
OPEN SEAL-IN
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
This setting specifies the seal-in time of the open commands due to an operator initiated
manual or remote open command to the disconnect switch.
CLOSE SEAL-IN
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
This setting specifies the seal-in time of the open commands due to an operator initiated
manual or remote close command to the disconnect switch.
To maintain the close/open command for a certain time, do so by either using the seal-in
FASTPATH:
timers Open Seal-In and Close Seal-In, or the setpoint "Seal-in" from the output relays, or
FlexLogic.
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Local Mode ON
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Tag ON
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SBO Enabled
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Loc Blk Open
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Loc Blk Open By SW1 Remote Open
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
from Switch detection logic
SW1 Open Cmd
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Opened
OPEN to output
SETPOINT command relay
Setpoints/System/ selected to
AND
Off = 0
AND
SETPOINT
SW1 Bypas Rem Blk Open
AND
Off = 0
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Rem Blk Open
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Loc Blk Close
AND
SETPOINT
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SW1 Rem Blk Cls By
894192A1.cdr
Trip Bus
Output Relays configured for Recloser operation are under the Trip Close Logic. Setpoints
NOTE:
under Trip Bus are not applicable to the output relays set under Trip Close Logic.
NOTE
The 845 relay provides six identical Trip Bus elements. The Trip Bus element allows
aggregating outputs of protection, control elements, inputs without using FlexLogic and
assigning them in a simple and effective manner. Each Trip Bus can be assigned to trip,
alarm or the other logic actions. Simple trip conditioning such as latch, delay, and seal-in
delay are available.
Path: Setpoints > Control > Trip Bus 1(X)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Trip, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
INPUT 1 to 16
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
These settings select a FlexLogic operand to be assigned as an input to the Trip Bus.
LATCHING
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Disabled
The setting enables or disables latching of the Trip Bus output. This is typically used
when lockout is required or user acknowledgement of the relay response is required.
RESET
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The trip bus output is reset when the operand assigned to this setting is asserted.
PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.000 s
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
Default: Self-reset
The Any Trip operand must not be programmed as an input for the Trip Bus function.
NOTE:
NOTE
LED : TRIP
AND
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
TRIP BUS 1
FUNCTION :
OR
Disabled
Trip S
AND
Alarm LATCH
OR
Latched Alarm Command
SET-
Configurable R DOMINANT
RESET
SETPOINTS
TRIP BUS 1
Figure 8-12: Trip Bus logic diagram
BLOCK :
Off = 0
AND
SETPOINTS
SETPOINTS TRIP BUS 1
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP DELAY:
NON VOLATILE
INPUT 1: S TRIP BUS 1
Off = 0 DROPOUT DELAY: FlexLogic Operands
LATCH t PKP
SETPOINTS Trip Bus 1 OP
t DPO
TRIP BUS 1 SET-
DOMINANT
INPUT 2 : R
SETPOINTS
Off = 0
OR
OUTPUT RELAYS 3 (X)
...
Do Not Operate , Operate
...
SETPOINTS
TRIP BUS 1
INPUT 16 :
Off = 0 LED: PICKUP FlexLogic Operands
SETPOINTS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING:
Disabled = 0
892752A2.cdr
SETPOINTS
OR
TRIP BUS 1
RESET:
Disabled = 0
detectors provide a fast operating time for currents at small multiples of the Pickup value.
The overcurrent detectors are required to operate after the Breaker Failure delay interval
to eliminate the need for very fast resetting overcurrent detectors.
Outputs
The outputs from the schemes are:
• Re-trip of the protected breaker
• FlexLogic operand that reports on the operation of the portion of the scheme where
high-set or low-set current supervision is used
• FlexLogic operand that reports on the operation of the portion of the scheme where
52b status supervision is used only
• FlexLogic operand that initiates tripping required to clear the faulted zone. The
Breaker Failure output can be sealed-in for an adjustable period
• Target message indicating a failed breaker has been declared.
Setup
Path: Setpoints > Control > Breaker Failure > BF1(X) > BF1(X) Setup
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Retrip, Latched Alarm, Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
When the Retrip function is selected and Breaker Failure is initiated (with re-trip current
supervision), the output relay #1 “Trip” operates but the “ALARM” LED does not turn on.
SIGNAL INPUT
Range: dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bank 1-J1
USE SEAL-IN
Range: Yes, No
Default: Yes
If set to ‘Yes’, the element will only be initiated if current flowing through the breaker is
above the supervision pickup level.
PH RETRIP SUPERV PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 1.000 x CT
The setpoint specifies the phase current Retrip level, which when exceeded after Breaker
Failure initiation, will Retrip its own breaker. The setting is set to detect the lowest
expected fault current on the protected circuit.
NTRL RETRIP SUPERV PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 1.000 x CT
This setpoint specifies the neutral current Retrip level, which when exceeded after
Breaker Failure initiation, will Retrip its own breaker. The setting detects the lowest
expected fault current on the protected circuit. Neutral Retrip current supervision is used
to provide increased sensitivity.
interrupting rating can be significantly longer than the normal interrupting time.
T2 PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.120 s
The setting provides a delay for Timer 2 logic which is supervised with current
supervision and breaker status (52b indication). The timer is set to the expected opening
time of the circuit breaker, plus a safety margin intended to overcome the relay
measurement and timing errors, relay processing time, current supervision reset time,
and the time required for the breaker auxiliary contact to open.
T3 PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0.000 to 6000.000 s in steps of 0.001 s
Default: 0.120 s
The setting provides a delay for Timer 3 logic which is supervised with breaker status
only (52b indication). The timer is set to the expected opening time of the circuit breaker,
plus a safety margin intended to overcome the relay timing errors, and the time required
for the breaker auxiliary contact to open.
PHASE HIGHSET PICKUP
Range: 0.050 to 30.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 1.000 x CT
The setpoint specifies the phase current output supervision level. The setting detects the
lowest expected fault current on the protected circuit.
Initiate
Path: Setpoints > Control > Breaker Failure 1(X) > BF1(X) Initiate
EXTERNAL INITIATE
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand that initiates the Breaker Failure scheme;
typically the trip signals from external devices.
The trip signals from internal protection functions may be used with the help of FlexLogic,
FASTPATH:
but for easier setting the Breaker Failure function is provided with a BF1 INITIATE submenu.
INITIATE IN1(15)
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Ph TOC 1 OP
The setpoint selects the FlexLogic operand that initiates the Breaker Failure scheme;
typically the trip signals from internal protection functions.
The default setting includes the following protection functions:
FASTPATH:
Ph TOC 1 OP
Ph TOC 2 OP
Ph IOC 1 OP
Ph IOC 2 OP
Ntrl TOC 1 OP
Ntrl TOC 2 OP
Ntrl IOC 1 OP
Ntrl IOC 2 OP
GND TOC 1 OP
GND IOC 1 OP
/('$/$50
$1'
6(732,176 /$7&+('$/$50
%)
)81&7,21
25
'LVDEOHG 6
/$7&+
$ODUP $1'
25
5(6(7 5
5H WULS
/('75,3
&RQ¿JXUDEOH
6(732,176
%) 2SHUDWH2XWSXW
6(732,176 5HOD\75,3
5(75,33.3'(/$<
%) W 3.3
$1'
%/2&.
2ᚎ
$1'
6(732,176 RQO\
6HWSRLQWV6\VWHP
7ULS0RGH %UHDNHUV%.5
%.57ULS5HOD\
7KUHH3ROH 6HOHFW
6(732,176
6(732,176 %)3+5(75,3
683(593,&.83
25
5
$1'
%),1,7,$7( 6HWSRLQWV?6\VWHP?
%)175/5(75,3 2QO\
5HFORVHU?5HFORVHU
(;7(51$/,1,7,$7( 683(593,&.83 7ULS&ORVH/RJLF?
581 3ROH6HWXS
,1,7,$7(,1
25 3ROH7ULS5HOD\
,$!3,&.83 6HOHFW
581
,1,7,$7(,1 )OH[/RJLF2SHUDQG
,%!3,&.83
%)5HWULS
25
6(732,176
581
$1'
6(732,176
%)
%) ,&!3,&.83
3+$6(+,*+6(73,&.83
86(6($/,1 581
,1!3,&.83 %)
<(6 175/+,*+6(73,&.83
Figure 8-13: Breaker Failure logic diagram
12 581
,$!3,&.83
581
)OH[/RJLF2SHUDQGV
,%!3,&.83
%)+LJKVHW23
25
581
6(732,176 ,&!3,&.83 %)/RZVHW23
,$ 6,*1$/,1387 6(732,176
581
,% %)
73,&.83'(/$< ,1!3,&.83
,& &7%DQN
-
W 3.3 6(732,176 %)
,1
$1'
3+$6(/2:6(73,&.83
%)
86('21/<,1 %)
/2:6(7'(/$<
6(732,176 175//2:6(73,&.83
W /2:
25
6(732,176 581
%)
6(732,176
%) 73,&.83'(/$< ,$!3,&.83
6(732,176
683(59,6,21 %)
W 3.3 581
'523287'(/$< 2873875(/$<6
$1'
&XUUHQW
,%!3,&.83
E &XUUHQW 'R1RW2SHUDWH2SHUDWH
25
25
581 7 '32
E
,&!3,&.83
581
6(732,176 )OH[/RJLF2SHUDQGV
,1!3,&.83
%)
%)23
6(732,17 73,&.83'(/$<
%) W 3.3
%)E6XSHUY23
$1'
%5($.(5&/26('
2ᚎ
$FGU
1RWH75,302'(VHWWLQJRQO\DSSOLHVWR53ROH%UHDNHU)DLOXUH
The HS Ground PKP setting is not available if the order code is selected to have just one
NOTE:
sensitive ground current input on the J1-Bank (4-0B in the order code).
NOTE
LIGHT SENSOR 1(4)
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
BLOCK
Range: Off, Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
AND
CONFIGURABLE IN 845
LED: ALARM
AND
SETPOINTS
Function:
OR
Disabled = 0
Trip
ARC FLASH PROTECTION
AND
Alarm
LATCH
OR
Latched Alarm
R
Configurable RESET
Set Dominant
Command FlexLogic Operands
AF 1 HS Ph IOC PKP A
AND
RUN AF 1 HS GND IOC PKP
Iahs > PICKUP
EVENTS
SETPOINTS
Ibhs > PICKUP
TARGETS
OUTPUT RELAYS
OR
SETPOINTS Ichs > PICKUP
Do Not Operate, Operate
BLOCK
Off = 0
SETPOINTS
FlexLogic Operands
Default: Latched
Default: Enabled
HS Ground PKP
Arc Flash 1 S1 OP
SETPOINTS HS Phase Currents RUN
Arc Flash 1 S2 OP
SIGNAL INPUT: HS Phase A current (Iahs) Ighs > PICKUP
HS Phase B current(Ibhs) Arc Flash 1 S3 OP
AND
USED ONLY IN 845 & 889 FlexLogic Operands
Level for Sensor 1 20 ms
Arc Flash 1 OP
RUN
Light Sensor 2 Input > Factory 0 ms
PKP Level * Auto Calibration
AND
Level for Sensor 2 20 ms
OR
RUN
Light Sensor 1 Light Sensor 3 Input > Factory 0 ms
FlexLogic Operands
AND
PKP Level * Auto Calibration 20 ms
Light Sensor 2
Level for Sensor 3 AF 1 Light 1 PKP
Light Sensor 3
RUN 0 ms AF 1 Light 2 PKP
Light Sensor4
Light Sensor4 Input > Factory 20 ms AND
PKP Level * Auto Calibration AF 1 Light 3 PKP
Level for Sensor4
AF 1 Light 4 PKP
AF 1 HS Ground Current(Ighs)
SETPOINTS
Light Sensor 1 Enabled = 1
AND
FlexLogic Operands
Light Sensor 1 Trouble
SETPOINTS
Light Sensor 2 Trouble
This setting enables or disables the events of the Arc Flash function.
AND
Light Sensor 2 Enabled =1
Light Sensor 3 Trouble
AND
Light Sensor 3 Enabled = 1
FlexLogic Operands
SETPOINTS Light Sensor Trouble
OR
AND
Programmable LED:
TROUBLE
Synchrocheck (25)
The 845 relay provides one Synchrocheck element.
The synchronism check function is intended for supervising the paralleling of two parts of
a system which are to be joined by the closure of a circuit breaker. The Synchrocheck
elements are typically used at locations where the two parts of the system are
interconnected.
If a breaker can be a paralleling point between two generation sources, it is common
practice to automatically perform a check to ensure the sources are within allowable
voltage limits before permitting closing of the breaker. Synchrocheck provides this feature
by checking that the bus and line input voltages are within the programmed differentials of
voltage magnitude, phase angle position, and frequency. If this feature is enabled, the
check will be performed before either manual close or automatic reclose signals can
operate the Close Output Relay. The Synchrocheck programming can allow permitted
closing if either or both of the sources are de-energized.
Synchrocheck verifies that the voltages (BUS and LINE) on the two sides of the supervised
circuit breaker are within set limits of magnitude, angle and frequency difference. The time
during which the two voltages remain within the admissible angle difference is determined
by the setting of the phase angle difference ∆Φ (without angle compensation) and the
frequency difference ∆F (slip frequency). It can be defined as the time it would take the
voltage phasor, BUS or LINE, to traverse an angle equal to 2 × ∆Φ at a frequency equal to
the frequency difference ∆F. This time can be calculated by:
As a result the breaker closing time must be less than this computed time, to successfully
close and connect both energized sides.
If one or both sides of the synchronizing breaker are de-energized, the Synchrocheck
programming can allow for closing of the circuit breaker using undervoltage control to by-
pass the Synchrocheck measurements (dead source function).
The measured bus and line input voltage magnitudes, angles and frequencies, and
calculated differential values of angle magnitude and frequency are available as actual
values under Metering > Synchrocheck 1.
The Synchrocheck from the 845 relay works correctly if programmed with voltage inputs
NOTE:
from Phase and Aux VTs placed across the breaker on same side of the transformer
NOTE winding. The Synchrocheck will not work correctly if the Phase and Aux VTs are placed on
two different windings.
The selection of “Aux VT Connection” under Setpoints > System > Voltage Sensing
determines the voltage used for Synchrocheck as derived from the three-phase voltages
available on the relay. For example, if the Aux VT Connection is selected as Vab, and the
three-phase VTs are connected in “Wye”, the relay computes delta voltage Vab as well, and
uses it for Synchrocheck.
The Synchrocheck cannot be performed if the three-phase VTs are Delta connected,
IMPORTANT:
and the Wye single voltage input is selected under “Aux VT connection”. “Wye”
voltages cannot be calculated from Delta connected VTs.
If both Line and Bus sides are three-phase VTs, the VT types must match, i.e. either
both Line and Bus Volt inputs are Delta or both are Wye. If both sides are single-phase
Aux VT inputs, then both Aux VT connection types must match, i.e. if the Line side Aux
VT type is Vab, then the Bus side Aux VT type must be Vab. Aux VT connection “Vn” is
not a valid type for synchrocheck.
If the VT types on the Line and Bus side do not match, as specified above, the
CAUTION:
Sunchrocheck does not run even when the Function is set to Enabled.
selection check, to determine that the voltage magnitudes are not different by more
than 5%. This check depends only on the settings entered for phase and auxiliary VTs
under Setpoints > System > Voltage Sensing. If the difference between the selected
voltage inputs by calculation is bigger than 5%, the Synchrocheck will not work.
For example, the phase VT can be set to Wye connection with secondary voltage of
66.4V. The Aux. VT can be connected between phase A to B with the secondary voltage
set to 115V. Then, one of the Synchrocheck inputs can be set as the Wye connected
phase voltage bank, and the other input can be the Aux. VT with voltage Vab. Since the
difference between the computed Vab input and the Aux. VT setting is 0%, the
Synchrocheck will work. However, if this difference is bigger than 5%, the
Synchrocheck will not work.
source only, the DEAD SOURCE PERM setpoint shall not be disabled.
SETPOINT
AND
BLOCK :
Off = 0
SETPOINTS
MAX VOLT DIFFERENCE:
Transfer Initiate
Magnitude Vlv
LIVE LINE VOLTS MIN:
Frequency flv
Sync 1Dead Line
AND
SETPOINT TO:
Figure 8-15: Synchrocheck logic diagram
AND
Transfer Scheme
DEAD BUS VOLTS MAX:
OR
SETPOINT
AND
SETPOINT
OR
SETPOINTS
AND
Off = 0
8–35
SYNCHROCHECK (25)
VT FUSE FAILURE (VTFF) CHAPTER 8: CONTROL
therefore is not available with the Low Energy Analog (LEA) order code option.
NOTE
The VT Fuse Failure detector can be used to raise an alarm and/or block elements that
may operate incorrectly for a full or partial loss of AC potential caused by one or more
blown fuses. Some elements that might be blocked (via the BLOCK input) are voltage
restrained overcurrent, directional current, power functions. This loss can be caused by a
blown primary voltage transformer fuse (or fuses), or by voltage transformer secondary
circuit protection fuse failure.
There are two classes of fuse failure that may occur:
1. Class A: loss of one or two phases
2. Class B: loss of all three phases.
Different means of detection are required for each class. An indication of a Class A failure is
a significant level of negative sequence voltage, whereas an indication of a Class B failure
is the presence of positive sequence current and an insignificant amount of positive
sequence voltage. These noted indications of fuse failure could also be present when faults
are present on the system, so a means of detecting faults and inhibiting fuse failure
declarations during these events is provided.
Once the fuse failure condition is declared, it is sealed-in until the cause that generated it
disappears. An additional condition is introduced to inhibit a fuse failure declaration when
the monitored circuit is de-energized: positive sequence voltage and current are both
below threshold levels.
The settings of this function are applied to three-phase voltage input (supervised with
positive, negative and zero sequence current components) to produce an Operate flag.
Path: Setpoints > Control > VT Fuse Failure 1 (2)
FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Alarm, Latched Alarm, Configurable
Default: Disabled
CT INPUT
Range: Dependent upon the order code
Default: CT Bnk1-J1
OUTPUT RELAY X
For details see Common Setpoints.
EVENTS
Range: Enabled, Disabled
Default: Enabled
TARGETS
Range: Disabled, Self-reset, Latched
Default: Self-reset
LED: ALARM /
LATCHED ALARM
AND
OR
SETPOINT
S
AND
FUNCTION : LATCH # 1
Disabled Set -
Command Dominant
Alarm R
RESET
OR
Latched Alarm
Configurable
AND
S
OR
LATCH # 2
FAULT
AND
Dominant
COMPARATORS
AND
RUN SETPOINTS
V_2 V_2 > 0.10 p.u. S
OR
OR
V_1 Do Not Operate, Operate
Reset-
AND
AND
RUN R
I_1 > 0.075 p.u.
RUN TIMER
V_1 < 0.80 p.u.
2 cyc
AND
RUN 20 cyc
I_1 < 0.05 p.u.
AND
OR
FlexLogic Operands
AND
VT Fuse Fail 1 OP
VT Fuse 1 V Loss
AND
RUN
I_1 892734A2.cdr
|I_1| – |I_1'| > 0.04 p.u.
RUN
I_2
OR
8–37
VT FUSE FAILURE (VTFF)
Setpoints Device
System
Inputs
Outputs
Protection
Monitoring
Control
FlexLogic
Testing
Level 1 Level 2
This chapter describes the FlexLogic and Testing setpoints in detail. Flexlogic setpoints
provide access to the variable logic used with the relay. Testing setpoints include simulated
current and voltage inputs, and test operations for LEDs, input contacts, and output relays.
Factory setpoints, as seen in the HMI Main Setpoints Screen, are for GE internal use only.
These cannot be accessed by users.
Figure 9-3: Enervista 8 Series Setup software Setpoints Menu
The Protection Summary page, as seen in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software Setpoints
menu, is described in detail in Protection Summary.
The SLD Configurator, as seen in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software Setpoints menu, is
described in detail in SLD Configurator.
The Modbus User Map, as seen in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software Setpoints menu, is
described in detail in the 8 Series Communication Guidethat can be downloaded from http:/
/www.gegridsolutions.com/.
FlexLogic
To provide maximum flexibility, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed
and user-programmed parameters. Logic upon which individual features are designed is
fixed, and all other logic, from digital input signals through elements or combinations of
elements to digital outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic
through FlexLogic. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs, which then
uses FlexLogic to produce analog and digital outputs.
The major sub-systems of a generic 8 Series relay involved in this process are shown as
follows.
For information on the Logic Designer and Logic Monitor menu items, see Help >
NOTE:
User Manual > Logic Designer & Monitor in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software.
NOTE
Setpoints Device
System
Inputs
Outputs
Protection
Timers
Monitoring Non-Vol Latches
TM
Control FlexLogic Equation
Logic Designer
FlexLogic
Logic Monitor
Testing
FlexElements
The states of all digital signals used in the 845 are represented by flags (FlexLogic™
operands). A digital “1” is represented by a 'set' flag. Any external contact change-of-state
can be used to block an element from operating, as an input to a control feature in a
FlexLogic™ equation, or to operate an output relay. The state of the contact input can be
displayed locally or viewed remotely via the communications facilities provided. In a simple
scheme where a contact input is used to block an element is desired, this selection is made
within the menu of the element. This applies to other features that set flags: elements,
virtual inputs, remote inputs, schemes, and human operators.
When more complex logic than the one presented above is required, the FlexLogic tool
should be used. For example, if it is desired to block the operation of a Phase Time
Overcurrent element by the closed state of a contact input, and the operated state of a
Phase Undervoltage element, the two input states need be programmed in a FlexLogic
equation. This equation ANDs the two inputs to produce a virtual output which then must
be programmed within the menu of the Phase Time Overcurrent as a blocking input.
Virtual outputs can be created only by FlexLogic equations.
Traditionally, protective relay logic has been relatively limited. Any unusual applications
involving interlocks, blocking, or supervisory functions had to be hard-wired using contact
inputs and outputs. FlexLogic™ minimizes the requirement for auxiliary components and
wiring while making more complex schemes possible.
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs is field
programmable through the use of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use
of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is available internally and on the
communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic).
FlexLogic allows customization of the relay through a series of equations that consist of
operators and operands. The operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes and
outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers and latches (with set and reset inputs). A
system of sequential operations allows any combination of specified operands to be
assigned, as inputs to specified operators, to create an output. The final output of an
equation is a numbered register called a ‘Virtual Output’. Virtual Outputs can be used as an
input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a seal-
in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators.
Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0. Operators provide a defined function, such as an
AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of parameters to be used to
set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, i.e. flag set) or
0 (=OFF, i.e. flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least 4 times during every power
system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances; e.g. contact and
remote inputs. These types of operands are grouped together (for presentation purposes
only) on the faceplate display. The characteristics of the different types of operands are
listed in the table below.
Table 9-1: 845 FlexLogic Operands
ELEMENT OPERANDS EVENT DESCRIPTION
Aging Factor Aging Factor PKP The Aging factor element has picked up
Aging Factor OP The Aging factor element has operated
Analog Input Anlg lp Trip PKP Analog Input 1 trip has picked up
Anlg lp Trip OP Analog Input 1 trip has operated
Anlg lp Alarm PKP Analog Input 1 alarm has picked up
Anlg lp Alarm OP Analog Input 1 alarm has operated
Anlg lp 2 to 4 Similar to Analog Input 1 operands above
Annunciator Reset Annunctr OP (MNUL) Annunciator reset manually (pushbutton or PC software)
Reset Annunctr OP (OPRD) Annunciator reset by operand (set under
Setpoints\Device\Resetting\Reset Annunciator or Setpoints\Device\Front
Panel\Annunciator\Annunciator Setup\Reset Annunciator)
[X] - the element number. Note the operand name will change depending
on what is programmed.
Switch Control SW[X] Open Cmd Local or Remote Open command initiated to Switch [X]
SW[X] Close Cmd Local or Remote Close command initiated to Switch [X]
SW[X] Remote Open Remote Open command is initiated to Switch [X]
SW[X] Remote Close Remote Close command is initiated to Switch [X]
SW[X] Rem Blk Open The Open command to Switch [X] is blocked
SW[X] Rem Blk Close The Close command to Switch [X] is blocked
SW[X] Rem Blk Open Byp The block open signal for Switch [X] is bypassed
SW[X] Rem Blk Close Byp The block close signal for Switch [X] is bypassed
[X] - the element number.
Synchrocheck Sync1 OK Synchrocheck 1 permission is given
Sync1 Live Bus Synchrocheck 1 bus voltage is live
Sync1 Live Line Synchrocheck 1 line voltage is live
Sync1 Dead Bus Synchrocheck 1 bus voltage is dead
Sync1 Dead Line Synchrocheck 1 line voltage is dead
Sync1 Dead Src OK Synchrocheck 1 dead source permission is given
Sync1 Close Perm Synchrocheck 1 breaker closing permission is given
Tab Pushbuttons TAB PB [X] ON Tab Pushbutton [X] is ON
TAB PB [X] OFF Tab Pushbutton [X] is OFF
TAB PB [X] PRESS Tab Pushbutton [X] is Pressed Down
Tap Changer Setup TC at Min Tap ON Tap Changer has reached Minimum Tap
TC at Ntrl Tap ON Tap Changer has reached Neutral Tap
TC at Max Tap ON Tap Changer has reached Maximum Tap
TC at Min Tap OFF Tap Changer position is not at Minimum Tap
TC at Ntrl Tap OFF Tap Changer position is not at Neutral Tap
TC at Max Tap OFF Tap Changer position is not at Maximum Tap
Tap Changer Failure Tap Ch Fail PKP Tap Changer Fail has picked up
Tap Ch Fail OP Tap Changer Fail has operated
Tap Ch Fail Alarm PKP Tap Changer Failure Alarm has picked up
Tap Ch Fail Alarm OP Tap Changer Failure Alarm has operated
Targets Active Target At least one target is detected active
column, “Phase A” becomes “Voltage AB”, “Phase B” becomes “Voltage BC” and “Phase C”
NOTE becomes “Voltage CA”.
Some operands can be re-named. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker
control feature, the ID (identification) of contact inputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of
virtual outputs. If the default name or ID of any of these operands are changed, the
assigned name appears in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in the
FlexLogic Operands table above.
Table 9-2: 845 FlexLogic Operators
TYPE SYNTAX DESCRIPTION NOTES
Editor INSERT Insert a parameter in an
equation list.
DELETE Delete a parameter from
an equation list.
End END The first END
encountered signifies
the last entry in the list of
processed FlexLogic™
parameters.
One-shot POSITIVE ONE SHOT One shot that responds A ‘one shot’ refers to a
to a positive going edge. single input gate that
generates a pulse
NEGATIVE ONE One shot that responds response to an edge on
SHOT to a negative going the input. The output
edge. from a ‘one shot’ is True
DUAL ONE SHOT One shot that responds (positive) for only one
to both the positive and pass through the
negative going edges. FlexLogic equation. There
is a maximum of 64 ‘one
shots’.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated below, and the operators available in
FlexLogic are listed in the FlexLogic operators table.
Table 9-3: FlexLogic Gate Characteristics
GATES NUMBER OF INPUTS OUTPUT IS ‘1’ (= ON) IF...
NOT 1 input is ‘0’
OR 2 to 16 any input is ‘1’
AND 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘1’
NOR 2 to 16 all inputs are ‘0’
NAND 2 to 16 any input is ‘0’
XOR 2 only one input is ‘1’
FLEXLOGIC RULES
When forming a FlexLogic equation, the sequence in the linear array of parameters must
follow these general rules:
1. Operands must precede the operator which uses the operands as inputs.
2. Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a
Virtual Output if it is to be used as an input to two or more operators.
3. Assigning the output of an operator to a Virtual Output terminates the equation.
4. A timer operator (for example, "TIMER 1") or Virtual Output assignment (for example,
" = Virt Op 1") may only be used once. If this rule is broken, a syntax error will be
declared.
FLEXLOGIC EVALUATION
Each equation is evaluated in the order in which the parameters have been entered.
FlexLogic provides latches which by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set
state after the set input has been asserted. However, they are volatile; that is, they reset on
the re-application of control power.
When making changes to settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any
new setting value is entered, so all latches are automatically reset. If it is necessary to re-
initialize FlexLogic during testing, for example, it is suggested to power the unit down then
back up.
Timers
Path: Setpoints > FlexLogic > Timers
There are 32 identical FlexLogic timers available. These timers can be used as operators for
FlexLogic equations.
TIMER 1 TYPE
Range: Milliseconds, Seconds, Minutes
Default: Milliseconds
The setpoint is used to select the time measuring unit.
TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY
Range: 0 to 60000 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 0 s
The setpoint sets the time delay to Pickup. If a Pickup delay is not required, set this
function to "0”.
TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY
Range: 0 to 60000 s in steps of 1 s
Default: 0 s
The setpoint sets the time delay to Dropout. If a Dropout delay is not required, set this
function to "0”.
Non-volatile Latches
The purpose of a Non-volatile Latch is to provide a permanent logical flag that is stored
safely and does not reset when the relay reboots after being powered down. Typical
applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently blocking relay
functions such as Autorecloser, until a deliberate HMI action resets the latch.
Operation of the element is summarized in the following table:
Path: Settings > FlexLogic > Non-volatile Latches > Latch 1(16)
NV LATCH 1 FUNCTION
Range: Disabled, Enabled
Default: Disabled
The setpoint enables or disables the Non-volatile Latch function.
NV LATCH 1 TYPE
Range: Reset-Dominant, Set-Dominant
Default: Reset-Dominant
The setting characterizes NV LATCH 1 to be set- or reset-dominant.
NV LATCH 1 SET
Range: Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
If asserted, this specified FlexLogic operand ‘SET’ NV LATCH 1.
LATCH 1 RESET
Range: Any FlexLogic operand
Default: Off
If asserted, this specified FlexLogic operand ‘RESET’ NV LATCH 1.
FlexLogic Equation
Path: Setpoints > FlexLogic > FlexLogic Equation
The FlexLogic Equation screen (see following figure from EnerVista 8 Series Setup software)
is one of two options available to configure FlexLogic. The other option is Logic Designer.
Three new time stamp variables: Logic Design Last Saved, Logic Design Last Compiled and
FlexLogic Editor Last Saved, have been included in this screen. Look at the time stamps to
easily see which of the options: FlexLogic Editor or Logic Designer is currently being used.
There are 1024 FlexLogic entries available, numbered from 1 to 1024 (i.e. FlexLogic Entry X
– where X ranges from 1 to 1024) with default END entry settings. If a “Disabled” Element is
selected as a FlexLogic entry, the associated state flag is never set to 1.
Figure 9-5: FlexLogic Equation Editor Screen
Logic Design Last Saved, Logic Design Last Compiled, and FlexLogic Editor Last Saved:
Each of these three read-only variables holds the time stamp that represents the time that
the operation (of the respective variable) was performed.
1. When no Logic (New file creation) is present these timestamps are set to default text
representations.
2. Time stamps are displayed in the format ‘Mon DD YYYY HH:MM:SS’ [Jun 22 1981
14:20:00]
3. Each time a ‘Save’ operation is performed in the ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ screen, the
‘FlexLogic Editor Last Saved’ entry gets updated.
4. Based on the values present at each launch of the ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ screen,
internal validation prompts the relevant messages. These prompts must be followed
to ensure that the ‘FlexLogic’ configuration is synchronized with the ‘Logic Designer’.
These three variables are shown in color in the FlexLogic Equation Editor based on
timestamps. Color is used to indicate the change (non-synchronization if any) of
FlexLogic between the FlexLogic Editor and Logic Designer Screens.
File Conversion and Handling of Time Stamps: When File Conversion is applied the three
time stamps are processed (either carry forwarded, defaulted, updated with latest PC time)
based on the Source and Destination File versions and Order code supported.
The following cases depict the nature of the three time stamps after a file conversion.
Source Version Target Is FlexLogic Time Stamps
Version Change Detected? [LDLs, LDLc, FELs]**
>= 160 >= 160 YES [ 0^ , 0 , PCTime**]
>= 160 >=160 NO *Existing time stamps are copied to
the converted file
< 160 >= 160 YES [ 0 , 0 , PCTime]
< 160 (& > 120***) >= 160 NO [PCTime, PCTime, PCTime,]
In a typical scenario where both the FlexLogic Designer and FlexLogic Editor are used for
configuring FlexLogic, the updated time stamps appear as shown in the following figure.
Logic Designer: This entry can be used to initiate the launch of the ‘Logic Designer’ screen.
Once chosen, the existing ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ screen is set to Read-only and then
the ‘Logic Designer’ screen launch is initiated.If the user wants to re-visit the FlexLogic
Editor Screen, any existing read-only screen has to be closed first. Then, the screen has to
be re-opened. The FlexLogic Editor screen is now editable, again.
In order to maintain synchronization of FlexLogic, the following update rules are defined.
For example, when a user tries to open the ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ of a particular
device or file.
• If the ‘Logic Designer’ screen is open and in Edit mode, a message prompts to save
any changes. The ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ is not launched.
• If the ‘Logic Designer’ is open and in saved mode (no edits to save or compile), the
‘Logic Designer’ screen is closed and then the ‘FlexLogic Equation Editor’ launch is
initiated.
Viewing FlexLogic To verify that the FlexLogic equation(s) and its selected parameters produce the desired
Graphics logic, the expression can be viewed by converting the derived equation into a graphic
diagram. It is strongly recommended and helpful to view an equation as a graphic diagram
before it is saved to the 845 device in order to troubleshoot any possible error in the
equation.
To View the FlexLogic Graphic
Click on the View button at the top of the Type column in the FlexLogic Equation screen,
see previous figure. Provided the equation is entered correctly, this generates a graphical
representation of the expression previously entered. If any operator inputs are missing or
any FlexLogic rules have been violated, the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software displays a
message box indicating any problems in the equation when the view feature is attempted.
The expression is also listed to the left of the diagram to demonstrate how the diagram
was created. The End statement is added as parameter 5 (End of list).
Figure 9-6: FlexLogic Graphic Example
FlexElements
There are 8 identical FlexElements™. A FlexElement is a universal comparator, that can be
used to monitor any analog actual value measured or calculated by the relay, or a net
difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. Depending on how the
FlexElement is programmed, the effective operating signal could be either a signed signal
(“Signed” selected for Input Mode), or an absolute value (“Absolute” selected for Input
Mode).
SETTING
SETTINGS
FUNCTION: INPUT COMPARISON
MODE:
Enabled = 1
OPERATING MODE:
Disabled = 0
DIRECTION:
SETTING
PICKUP:
BLOCK:
AND HYSTERESIS:
Off = 0
RATE OF CHANGE TIME SETTINGS
UNIT (dt):
SETTINGS PICKUP DELAY:
RATE OF CHANGE TIME:
INPUT 1(+):
RUN DROPOUT DELAY:
Actual Value FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
+ tPKP
INPUT 2 (-): FE 1 OP
- tDPO
Actual Value
FE 1 PKP
ACTUAL VALUE
894017$1.CDR
FE 1 Op Signal
INPUT 1 (+)
Range: Off, any FlexAnalog signal
Default: Off
This setting specifies the first input (non-inverted) to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed
as the input if this setting is set to “Off”. For proper operation of the element at least one
input must be selected. Otherwise, the element will not assert its output operands.
INPUT 2 (-)
Range: Off, any FlexAnalog signal
Default: Off
This setting specifies the second input (inverted) to the FlexElement. Zero is assumed as
the input if this setting is set to “Off”. For proper operation of the element at least one
input must be selected. Otherwise, the element will not assert its output operands.
This input should be used to invert the signal if needed for convenience, or to make the
element respond to a differential signal such as for a top-bottom oil temperature
differential alarm.
A warning message is displayed and the element does not operate if the two input
signals are of different types, for example if one tries to use active power and phase
angle to build the effective operating signal.
PICKUP
Range: -30.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 pu
Default: 1.000
This setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the
element.
If the “Over” direction is set, the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the
PICKUP value.
If the “Under” direction is set, the element picks up when the operating signal falls below
the PICKUP value.
The HYSTERESIS setting controls the element drop out.
Notice that both the operating signal and the pickup threshold can be negative when
facilitating applications such as reverse power alarms.
The FlexElement can be programmed to work with all analog values measured or
computed by the relay. The PICKUP setting is entered in pu values using the following
definitions of the base units:
Table 9-4: Definitions of the Base Unit for the FLEXELEMENT
Measured or calculated analog Base Unit
value related to:
Voltage VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the Input
1(+) and input 2(-) inputs
Current IBASE= maximum nominal primary RMS value of the Input 1(+)
and input 2(-) inputs
Power PBASE= maximum value of VBASE * IBASE for the Input 1(+) and
input 2(-) inputs
Power Factor PFBASE= 1.00
Phase Angle DegBASE= 360 deg
Harmonic Content HBASE = 100% of nominal
THD THDBASE= 100%
Frequency fBASE= nominal frequency as entered under the SYSTEM
SETUP menu
Volt/Hz BASE = 1.00
HYSTERESIS
Range: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1%
Default: 3.0%
This setting defines the pickup – drop out relation of the element by specifying the width
of the hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown above in the
Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis setpoints figure.
RATE OF CHANGE TIME UNIT (dt)
Range: millisecond, second, minute
Default: milliseconds
This setting specifies the time base dt when programming the FlexElement as a rate of
change element.
The setting is applicable only if the Operating Mode is set to “Delta”.
RATE OF CHANGE TIME
Range: 40 to 65535 in steps of 1
Default: 40
This setting specifies the duration of the time interval for the rate of change mode of
operation.
The setting is applicable only if the Operating Mode is set to “Delta”.
EXAMPLES
13.8 kV power system:
• Phase VT Connection: Wye
• Phase VT Secondary: 66.4 V
• Phase VT Ratio: 120:1 (phase to neutral primary voltage = 120*66.4 = 7968 V)
• Aux VT Connection: Vab
• Aux VT Secondary: 115 V
• Aux VT Ratio: 120:1(phase-phase primary voltage = 13800V)
• Phase CTs Primary: 2000 A
• Ground CT Primary: 500 A
• Frequency: 60Hz
Detecting voltage difference:
The voltage difference between calculated phase-phase voltage derived from Wye
connected phase VTs, and the directly measured phase-phase voltage from auxiliary VT
can be monitored by programming a FlexElement.
FlexElement settings:
• Input 1(+): J2 Vab RMS
• Input 2 (-): J2 Vaux RMS (input from VT connected between phases A and B)
• Operating Mode: Absolute
• Input Comparison Mode: Level
• Direction: Over
The analog input J2 Vab is phase-phase voltage computed by the relay based on three-
phase Wye voltages. As per the Phase VT setup, the primary RMS nominal voltage for J2
Vab input is 66.4 V *120 = 7.968kV.
The analog input J2 Vaux is directly measured phase-phase voltage and its primary RMS
nominal voltage is 115V *120 = 13.8kV
VBASE = max (7.968kV, 13.8kV) = 13.8kV.
If we want to detect 2% voltage difference (2% @13.8kV = 276V) between the computed
phase to phase Vab voltage, and the measured Vaux voltage from a VT connected
between phases A and B, the pickup per-unit setting for the FlexElement can be set as
follows:
Pickup = 276V/13800V = 0.02 pu
If the voltage difference between the selected inputs becomes bigger than 276 Volts, the
FlexElement will pickup, and operate, which can be used to energize contact, or initiate
alarm, or trip.
Detecting current difference between Neutral and Ground currents:
In a balanced system, the computed neutral and the measured ground currents is 0 Amps.
However, during ground faults their values are not zero. More specifically if the phase and
ground CTs are located on the same transformer winding, such that the ground CT is
installed on the grounded neutral of the winding, their values supposed to be the same
during external fault, and would be different during internal fault. The FlexElement can be
used for detecting the differential signal between these quantities. For example the
following condition can be made:
IBASE = max (2000A, 500A) = 2000A
FlexElement settings:
• Input 1(+): J1
• InInput 2 (-): J1 Ig
• Operating Mode: Absolute
• Input Comparison Mode: Level
• Direction: Over
• Pickup = 200A/2000A: 0.1 pu
When no CT saturation conditions exist, if the difference between the neutral current and
the ground current becomes more than 200 Amps primary, this can be treated as an
indication of an internal ground fault, which should be cleared. With IBASE = max (2000A,
500A) = 2000A, the pickup can be set as follows: Pickup = 200A/2000A = 0.1 pu
Detecting Low 3-ph Apparent Power:
VBASE = 7.968kV
IBASE = 1000 A
PBASE = VBASE *IBASE = 7968 V *2000A = 15.936MVA
The FlexElement can be set to detect under-power conditions and produce alarm, or trip if
the apparent power is less than 500kVA. In this case the pickup setting for the FlexElement
can be computed as follows:
and have resolution of 0.01%. However for the minimum pickup setting of 0.001 pu, this
would mean percentage step of 0.1%.
damage the equipment. A FlexElement can be used for simple detection of V/Hz values,
and to issue an Alarm, or Trip, if detected above Pickup setting. Since the base unit for V/Hz
= 1.00, programming of the pickup setpoint is straight forward for the desired FlexElement
operation. For the example given here, a value of 1.200 pu has been selected.
• Input 1(+): Volts Per Hertz 1Input 2(-): OffOperating Mode: AbsoluteInput Comparison
Mode: LevelDirection: OverPickup: 1.200 puHysteresis: 8.3 %
Now, if the FlexElement is needed to drop down when the V/Hz ratio becomes equal to 1.1,
the hysteresis can be calculated as:1.2pu-1.1pu = 0.1 puHysteresis = (0.1*100)/1.2 = 8.3%
High Breaker Arcing current detection
High breaker arcing current can be detected by using a FlexElement during the opening of
a breaker. One or more FlexElements can be configured for detecting levels of maximum
arcing current during the tripping of a particular breaker, and give an indication for the
health of the breaker.
The base unit for the breaker arcing current is programmed in the relay as: BASE = 2000
kA2*cycle
• Input 1(+): Total Arcing Current
• Input 2(-): Off
• Operating Mode: Absolute
• Input Comparison Mode: Level
• Direction: Over
• Pickup: 2.500 pu
• Hysteresis: 0.0 %
To configure the pickup setpoint for a total arcing current of 5000kA2/cycle, the per-unit
pickup value can be calculated as follows:
Pickup = 5000kA2 *cycle/2000 kA2*cycle = 2.500 pu
Testing
Figure 9-8: Testing Display Hierarchy
Setpoints Device
System
Inputs
Outputs
Protection
Monitoring Setup
Simulation
Control Pre-Fault
Test LEDs
Fault
FlexLogic
Contact Inputs Post-Fault
Testing
Output Relays
Simulation
Path:Setpoints > Testing > Simulation
• Setup
• Pre-Fault
• Fault
• Post-Fault
The Simulation feature is provided for testing the functionality of the 8 Series in response
to programmed conditions, without the need of external AC voltage and current inputs.
First time users will find this to be a valuable training tool. System parameters such as
currents, voltages and phase angles are entered as setpoints. When placed in simulation
mode, the relay suspends reading actual AC inputs, generates samples to represent the
programmed phasors, and loads these samples into the memory to be processed by the
relay. Normal (pre-fault), fault and post-fault conditions can be simulated to exercise a
variety of relay features. There are three sets of input parameters used during simulation,
each provides a particular state of the system as follows.
Testing of Arc Flash functionality is not possible with the Simulation feature.
NOTE
Pre-Fault This state is intended to simulate the normal operating condition of a system by replacing
the normal input parameters with programmed pre-fault values. For proper simulation,
values entered here must be below the minimum trip setting of any protection feature.
Voltage magnitudes and angles are entered as Wye values only. The voltage setpoints are
not available if the corresponding VT Bank PHASE VT CONNECTION setpoint is Delta.
Voltages are set in secondary VT units.
The CT and VT Bank availability is dependent on the installed Order Code options.
Fault The Fault state is intended to simulate the faulted operating condition of a system by
replacing the normal input parameters with programmed fault values.
Voltage magnitudes and angles are entered as Wye values only. The voltage setpoints are
not available if the corresponding VT Bank PHASE VT CONNECTION setpoint is Delta.
Voltages are set in secondary VT units.
The CT and VT Bank availability is dependent on the installed Order Code options.
Path:Setpoints > Testing > Simulation > Fault
J2 Fault Van(Vbn,Vcn,Vx) Voltage:
Range: 0.00 to 300.00 V in steps of 0.01
Default: 0.00 V
J2 Fault Van(Vbn,Vcn,Vaux) Angle:
Range: -359.9° to 0.0° in steps of 0.1
Default: 0.0°
J1(K1,K2) Fault Phase la(lb,lc):
Range: 0.000 to 46.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.000 x CT
J1(K1,K2) Fault Phase lg:
Range:
For Ground CT: 0.000 to 46.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.000 x CT
J1(K1,K2) Fault la(lb,lc,lg) Angle:
Range: -359.9° to 0.0° in steps of 0.1
Default: 0.0°
Post-Fault The Post-fault state is intended to simulate a system that has tripped by replacing the
normal input parameters with programmed post-fault values.
Voltage magnitudes and angles are entered as Wye values only. The voltage setpoints are
not available if the corresponding VT Bank PHASE VT CONNECTION setpoint is Delta.
Voltages are set in secondary VT units.
The CT and VT Bank availability is dependent on the installed Order Code options.
Path:Setpoints > Testing > Simulation > Post-Fault
J2 Postfault Van(Vbn,Vcn,Vx) Voltage:
Range: 0.00 to 300.00 V in steps of 0.01
Default: 0.00 V
J2 Postfault Van(Vbn,Vcn,Vaux) Angle:
Range: -359.9° to 0.0° in steps of 0.1
Default: 0.0°
J1(K1,K2) Postfault Phase la(lb,lc):
Range: 0.000 to 46.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
Default: 0.000 x CT
J1(K1,K2) Postfault Phase lg:
Range:
For Ground CT: 0.000 to 46.000 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
For Sensitive Ground CT: 0.000 to 4.600 x CT in steps of 0.001 x CT
For CBCT: 0.000 to 15.000 A in steps of 0.001
Default: 0.000 x CT
J1(K1,K2) Postfault la(lb,lc,lg) Angle:
Range: -359.9° to 0.0° in steps of 0.1
Default: 0.0°
Test LEDs
The Test LEDs setting is used to program the state and color of each LED when in test
mode and Force LEDs is “Enabled”.
Test LEDs setpoints here (in test mode) will revert to default values at power-up.
NOTE:
NOTE
Contact Inputs
The Contact Inputs section is used to program the state of each contact input when in test
mode. The number of Contact Inputs available is dependent on the installed Order Code
options.
Contact Inputs setpoints here (in test) will revert to default values at power-up.
NOTE:
CI 1(X):
Range: Off, On
Default: Off
The item name displays the user configurable name for the contact input.
Output Relays
The Output Relays section is used to program the state of each output relay when the
device is in test mode and Force Relays is “Enabled”.
Select “Off” to force the output relay to the de-energized state, or select “On” to force the
output relay to the energized state.
The number of Output Relays available is dependent on the installed Order Code options.
Output Relays setpoints here (in test mode) will revert to default values at power-up.
NOTE:
Status
Summary
Configurable SLD
The status of each SLD screen is displayed under Status > Summary > Configurable SLDs
> SLD1(X).
Figure 10-2: Sample SLD
Path: Status > Summary > Configurable SLDs > SLD 1(X)
Once in the SLD screen, by default no breaker/switch is highlighted or selected. Pressing
the Up/Dn (or Up/Dn/Left/Right) navigation keys highlights BKR1 and navigates through
BKR1, 2, 3, etc. and then through Switch1, 2, 3, etc.
If the Up/Dn/Left/Right keys are used, the selection moves to the closest available breaker/
switch from the currently highlighted object. To select the breaker/switch, press the enter
key. Upon pressing the Enter key, the tab labels change to the programmable tab
pushbutton labels and a flash message for the breaker selected appears (Flash Message:
“BKR1 Selected”). Pressing Escape de-selects the breaker/switch and the tab pushbutton
labels.
Annunciator
The graphical annunciator panel emulates a physical annunciator panel. Indicators on the
graphical panel are backlit and have a description of the alarm condition that lights each
indicator. The annunciator panel status window shows the alarms that are active.
To reset an active alarm, first highlight the active alarm using the navigation keys, then
press the reset button to reset the highlighted alarm. If no indicator is selected, all alarms
on the page are reset by pushing the reset button.
Home\HMI\Annunciator\Page1
Setting Sync
Group 3 Check
Active Fail
AR Breaker 2
Cycle Failure
Active
Tab Pushbuttons
Navigation
There are two ways to navigate to the Tab Pushbutton control pages:
• Relay Home Screens
• Path: Status > Summary > Tab Pushbuttons (from relay)
Home Screens
By default, the Tab Pushbuttons summary page is programmed as one of the Home
Screens. Press the home button repeatedly to cycle through the programmed Home
Screens.
Tab pushbuttons can only be controlled physically through the front panel of the relay.
FASTPATH:
Only the tab pushbuttons that are not set to Disabled are shown in color; labels for the tab
pushbuttons are shown for both active and disabled pushbuttons if labels have been
configured. (Configure tab pushbuttons from Device > Front Panel > Tab PBs > Tab PB1(X).)
When the actual button is pressed, the button on the screen is highlighted in blue and the
PB [X] PRESS operand becomes active. Although a disabled pushbutton can be pressed, no
action is taken and its operands are not activated. Pressing ESCAPE returns the screen to
Tab Pushbutton summary page. The Short Text for each Tab Pushbutton is used on the
Summary Page.
Pressing >> shows the next set of tab pushbuttons. For example, when in the page with
pushbuttons 1 to 4, pressing >> will navigate to the screen with pushbuttons 5 to 8.
Press >> to cycle through all five pushbutton screens. To go from page 2 to page 1,
press >> 4 times to cycle through and navigate to page 1 with pushbuttons 1 to 4.
Alternatively, escape to the overall summary screen and navigate to any desired page of
pushbuttons.
Breakers
The status of the breaker/breakers is displayed individually. If the selected trip output relay
is Form A-type, the status of the breaker Trip and Close circuitry is also displayed here. The
screen includes the total accumulated arcing current information for the breaker as well.
Path:Status > Breaker > Breaker X Status
STATE
Range: Not Configured, Opened, Closed, Disconnected, State Unknown
The Unknown state is displayed upon discrepancy of the 52a and 52b contacts for more
than 30 milliseconds.
BKR TROLLEY STATE
Range: Not Configured, Opened, Closed, State Unknown
TRIP COIL
Range: Not Set, Fail, OK
The Trip Coil state is displayed when Form -A output relays are used, and Trip Coil
monitoring is enabled.
CLOSE COIL
Range: Not Set, Fail, OK
The Close coil state is displayed when Form -A output relays are used, and Close Coil
monitoring is enabled.
TOTAL ARCING CURRENT
Range: 0.00 to 42949672.95 kA2-cyc in steps of 0.01
The measure of arcing current from all three phases during breaker trips. Refer to the
Breaker Arcing Current element description (under Setpoints > Monitoring > Breaker) for
more details.
Information
Path: Status > Information > Relay Info
The Information pages display fixed device information. the pages are divided into three
sections: Main CPU, Comms CPU, and Hardware Versions.
Main CPU
The Information related to the Main CPU is displayed here.
Path: Status > Information > Relay Info > Main CPU
• Order Code: The installed Order Code
• Product Serial #: The relay serial number
• Hardware Revision: The hardware revision of the relay
• Firmware Version:The firmware version of the Main CPU
• Firmware Date: The Main CPU firmware build date in the format mm/dd/yyyy
• Firmware Time: The Main CPU firmware build time
• Boot 1/2 Version: The boot 1/2 code version of the Main CPU
• Boot 1/2 Date: The Main CPU boot 1/2 code build date in the format mm/dd/yyyy
• Boot 1/2 Time:The Main CPU boot 1/2 code build time
• MAC Address 1: The MAC address for copper Ethernet port 1
• Remote CANBUS RMIO: The commissioned value of the CANBUS IO is displayed here.
If the relay has never been commissioned then the value is None, i.e. default = None
and Range = 6 alphanumeric characters.
• NUM of RMIO RTDs: The number of remote RTDs detected
Comms CPU
The Information related to the Comms CPU is displayed here.
Path: Status > Information > Relay Info > Comms CPU
• Comms CPU fw Version:The firmware version of the Comms CPU
• Comms CPU Firmware Date:
The Comms CPU firmware build date in the format mm/dd/yyyy
• Comms CPU Firmware Time: The Comms CPU firmware build time
• Boot Version:The boot code version of the Comms CPU
• Boot Date:The Comms CPU boot code build date in the format mm/dd/yyyy
• Boot Time: The Comms CPU boot code build time
• MAC Address 1: The MAC address for Ethernet port 4
• MAC Address 2: The MAC address for Ethernet port 5
Hardware Versions
Path: Status > Information > Relay Info > Hardware Versions
The Information related to the relay hardware is displayed here.
Environment
The Information related to Environmental is displayed here.
The Temperature Display setpoint can be changed from Celcius to Fahrenheit under
NOTE:
Settings Audit
The Information related to settings changes and settings file history is displayed here.
Path: Status > Information > Settings Audit
• Last Setting Change:The date and time of the last setting change.
• File Modified:
• File Received:
• File Origin:
• File Name:
Switches
Path:Status > Switches
SWITCH 1(X)
Range: Not Configured, Opened, Closed, Intermittent, Discrepancy
Default: Not Configured
Arc Flash
Path: Status > Arc Flash > Arc Flash 1
The status value shows the state of the given Flex operand related to Arc Flash protection.
Light 1(4) PKP
Range: ON, OFF
HS Phase IOC PKP A/B/C
Range: ON, OFF
Contact Inputs
Path: Status > Contact Inputs
The status of the Contact Inputs is shown here (see device menu via the menu path). The
‘Off/On’ display indicates the logic state of the Contact Input.
Output Relays
Path: Status > Output Relays
The status of all output relays is shown here, see above. In the Parameter column, the
value indicates the label on the output terminal. The Value column indicates the present
ON or OFF state of the output relay.
Virtual Inputs
Path: Status > Virtual Inputs 1(X)
The state of all virtual inputs is shown here, see next figure. The value for each Virtual Input
is shown on the control panel graphically as a toggle switch in either the On (|) state or the
Off (O) state.
Figure 10-6: Status of Virtual Inputs, HMI
Virtual Outputs
Path: Status > Virtual Outputs
The state of all virtual outputs is shown here, see next figure. The value for each Virtual
Output is shown on the control panel graphically as a toggle switch in either the On (|) state
or the Off (O) state.
Figure 10-8: Status of Virtual Outputs, HMI
Flex State
Path: Status > Flex States
There are 256 Flex state bits available. The status value indicates the state of the given Flex
state bit.
Communications
GOOSE Rx and Tx
The 845 supports 16 GOOSE transmissions and 64 GOOSE receptions each with 64 items
per transmission or reception. Non-structured GOOSE is supported. Each item within the
GOOSE message can be a digital or analog value. Messages are launched within one scan
of a digital point status change or an analog exceeding its deadband.
The 845 server supports a subset of the server features described in part 7.2 of the
IEC61850 standard.
GOOSE MESSAGING
As indicated above, the 845 supports 16 GOOSE transmissions and 64 GOOSE receptions
with details shown in the table below:
Service Launch Speed* Support for Programmable # of Tx # of Rx Test Bit Number of items in Number of remote
time to live Support each transmission or inputs per relay
reception
Configurable Within 2 ms Time to live programmable 16 64 Y 64 Data Items per 32
GOOSE (1 CPU scan)* from 1000 to 60000 ms Data Set
* Launch speed is measured by comparing the time stamp in SOE of digital remote output
status change to the time stamp of message seen on the network by a computer who’s
clock is synchronized by an IRIG-B card to the same IRIG-B source as the 845 relay.
REMOTE INPUTS
Path:Status > Communications > Remote Inputs
The present state of the 32 remote inputs are shown here. The state displayed is the
remote point unless the remote device has been established to be “Offline” in which case
the value shown is the programmed default state for the remote input.
GGIO1 INDICATIONS
Path:Status > Communications > GGIO1 Indications
The present state of the 32 GGIO1 Indications are shown here. There are up to 32 GGIO
indications that can be used to map any FlexLogic operand into the IED 61850 information
model. Default value is Off.
GOOSE STATUS
Path:Status > Communications > GOOSE Status
GOOSE 1 to 64 Status
Range: OFF, ON
Default: OFF
This setting indicates GOOSE communications are being received. A GOOSE STATUS of
ON indicates successful receipt of the last GOOSE packet. A GOOSE STATUS of OFF
indicates the communications link has failed, with the speed this setting changes
determined by the Update Time setting configured under GOOSE Transmission.
GOOSE HEADER
Path:Status > Communications > GOOSE HDR Status
GOOSE 1 to 64 H.Status
Range: OFF, ON
Default: OFF
This setting validates the GOOSE packet structure. A GOOSE HEADER STATUS of ON
indicates that the structure of the last GOOSE packet was valid.
GOOSE ANALOG
Path:Status > Communications > GOOSE Analog AV
FLOAT 1 to 24
Range:
Default: 0.0
SINT32 1 to 8
Range:
Default: 0
ACTIVITY STATUS
The communication state for each enabled communication type is shown by its value. The
main CPU and Comms software sets/resets the active bits for all enabled communication
types. The communication state bits are not latched.
Path:Status > Communications > Activity Status
SERIAL MODBUS
Range: NONE, ACTIVE
Default: NONE
ETHERNET MODBUS
Range: NONE, ACTIVE
Default: NONE
CONNECTIONS
Path:Status > Communications > Connections
MMS TCP - Maximum
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
MMS TCP - Remaining
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
Modbus TCP - Maximum
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
Modbus TCP - Remaining
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
DNP TCP - Maximum
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
DNP TCP - Remaining
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
IEC - 104 - Maximum
Range: 0 to 99 in steps of 1
Default: 0
Device Status
The general status of system components is displayed here.
Path: Status > Device Status
RUNNING, SAVING CID to FLASH
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
CID HANDLING DONE
Range: YES, NO
Default: YES
SELF-TEST FAULT
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
MAINTENANCE
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
IN SERVICE
Range: YES, NO
Default: YES
PICKUP STATE
Range: YES, NO
Default: YES
BREAKER X CONNECTED
Range: YES, NO
Default: YES
BREAKER X CLOSED
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
BREAKER X TRIPPED
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
ALARM
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
TRIP
Range: YES, NO
Default: NO
ACTIVE GROUP
Range: SP Group 1-6 Active
Default: SP Group 1 Active
Clock Status
Path: Status > Clock
SYSTEM CLOCK
Range: MMM DD YY HH:MM:SS
The current date and time of the system clock is displayed here.
RTC SYNC SOURCE
Range: None, Port 4 PTP Clock, Port 5 PTP Clock, IRIG-B, SNTP Server 1, SNTP Server 2
The RTC Sync Source actual value is the time synchronizing source the relay is using at
present.
PTP Status
The present values of the PTP protocol are displayed here.
Path:Status > PTP
Grandmaster ID is the grandmaster Identity code being received from the present PTP
grandmaster, if any. When the relay is not using any PTP grandmaster, this actual value is
zero. The grandmaster Identity code is specified by PTP to be globally unique, so one can
always know which clock is grandmaster in a system with multiple grandmaster-capable
clocks.
RTC Accuracy is the estimated maximum time difference at present in the Real Time Clock
(RTC), considering the quality information imbedded in the received time signal, how long
the relay has had to lock to the time source, and in the case of time signal interruptions,
the length of the interruption. The value 999,999,999 indicates that the magnitude of the
estimated difference is one second or more, or that the difference cannot be estimated.
Port 4 (5) PTP State is the present state of the port’s PTP clock. The PTP clock state is:
• DISABLED
If the port’s function setting is Disabled
• NO SIGNAL
If enabled but no signal from an active master has been found and selected
• CALIBRATING
If an active master has been selected but lock is not at present established
• SYNCH’D (NO PDELAY)
If the port is synchronized, but the peer delay mechanism is non-operational
• SYNCHRONIZED
If the port is synchronized
HMI Display
The HMI Display menu option opens a virtual HMI DIsplay window within the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software. The virtual HMI display provides front panel access to the relay with
clickable buttons and realtime display of the front panel, including navigation and viewing
relay settings, screens, and LEDs.
Path:Status > HMI Display
The HMI Display functionality is not available with the Advanced Cybersecurity option.
NOTE:
NOTE
Metering
All phasors calculated by 8 Series relays and used for protection, control and metering
functions are rotating phasors, that maintain the correct phase angle relationships with
each other at all times.
For display and oscillography purposes, all phasor angles in a given relay are referred to an
AC input channel pre-selected as the phase A voltage. If there is no voltage input, the
phase A current is used for angle reference. The phase angle of the reference signal always
display zero degrees and all other phase angles are relative to this signal. If the preselected
reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angles in 8 Series relays are always presented as negative values in the lagging
direction as illustrated in the following.
Figure 11-1: Phase Angle Measurement 8 Series Convention
The relay measures all RMS (root mean square) currents and voltages, frequency, and all
auxiliary analog inputs. Other values like neutral current, phasor symmetrical components,
power factor, power (real, reactive, apparent), are derived. A majority of these quantities
are recalculated every protection pass and perform protection and monitoring functions.
Displayed metered quantities are updated approximately three (3) times a second for
readability. All phasors and symmetrical components are referenced to the A-N voltage
phasor for wye-connected VTs; to the A-B voltage phasor for delta-connected VTs; or to
the phase A current phasor when no voltage signals are present.
Figure 11-2: An example of the Metering\Summary submenu
All the measured values can be viewed on the front panel display or monitored by remote
devices through the communication system. An example of the HMI display showing
actual currents is shown here.
The measured values can also be displayed in the PC (EnerVista 8 Series) program. The
same example of actual currents displayed in the EnerVista 8 Series program is shown as
follows.
The complete list of actual values available in the Metering menu is covered in the
following sections.
Summary
Path: Metering > Summary
The Metering Summary menu consists of display screens, including a graphical
presentation of key phasor quantities.
Transformer
INTRODUCTION
The percent (biased) differential protection is the main protection for power transformers
with regards to detecting all types of transformer internal fault. This protection is based on
Kirchoff’s law, where the sum of all currents flowing in and out of the protected equipment
equals zero. However, when applying this law to the overall differential protection, one
must keep in mind that the direct summation of the measured currents per-phase, does
not automatically result into zero differential current. This is because:
1. The transformer voltage ratio defines different winding nominal currents
2. The winding CTs are not rated to the exact match of the winding nominal currents
3. Physically, the transformer windings are connected in Delta, Wye or Zig-Zag
configuration, and they introduce a phase shift.
For the correct performance of the overall percent differential protection, it is necessary to
correct the magnitude and phase relationships of the CT secondary currents for each
winding, in order to obtain near zero differential currents under normal transformer
operating conditions. Traditionally, the phase shift between the currents from the
transformer windings has been corrected by connecting the CTs from the Wye winding in
Delta connection, and the CTs from the Delta winding in Wye connection. In the past, the
magnitude correction has been accomplished using interposing CTs, or tapped relay
windings. This however is not required any more when installing the 845 relay.
The 845 relay simplifies the process by performing the magnitude and phase shift
compensations automatically (internally). Upon entering settings for the protected
transformer and winding CT ratings, the relay automatically calculates and applies the
correct magnitude scaling to the winding currents as well as applying the correct phase
shift in order to prepare the currents for summation. To perform the correct currents
compensation, all winding CTs need to be connected in Wye (polarity markings pointing
away from the transformer). When the Tap Changer detection feature is enabled on the
relay, the algorithm automatically compensates the currents for the differential
computation based on the new voltage ratio corresponding to the detected tap.
primary, from the CT Bank assigned as Signal Input for Winding 1, is the reference CT
(base CT) used for estimating the differential and restraint currents. The winding reference
is explained in the Transformer Setup section.
The phasors of differential and restraint currents are displayed in primary amperes.
The phasors of differential and restraint currents are displayed in primary amperes.
Windings
The harmonic derating factor for each of the windings shows the effect of non-sinusoidal
load currents on the power transformer’s rated full load current. The actual values
messages display the harmonic derating factor for windings 1 through 3.
The 845 displays winding load parameters as follows:
Path: Metering > Transformer > Windings
Winding 1 load (W1 Load (% of rated))
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Winding 1 average phase current (W1 Average Ph Current)
Range: 0.000 to 120000.000 A
Winding 1 harmonic derating factor (W1 Harm Derate Factor
Range: 0.00 to 1.00
Winding 2 load (W2 Load (% of rated))
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Winding 2 average phase current (W2 Average Ph Current)
Range: 0.000 to 120000.000 A
Winding 2 harmonic derating factor (W2 Harm Derate Factor)
Range: 0.00 to 1.00
Winding 3 load (W3 Load (% of rated))
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Winding 3 average phase current (W3 Average Ph Current)
Range: 0.000 to 120000.000 A
Winding 3 harmonic derating factor (W3 Harm Derate Factor)
Range: 0.00 to 1.00
For a two winding transformer the winding load and winding average phase current are
calculated as:
W(1/2) Load (% of rated) = √3 x Iavg(1/2) x Vrated(1/2) x 100% / Srated
Where:
Iavg = (Ia + Ib + Ic)/3 is the actual average phase current (W(1/2) Average Ph Current) for the
corresponding winding.
Ia , Ib , Ic are magnitudes of the corresponding actual phase currents of the winding.
Vratedis the rated phase to phase nameplate voltage for the corresponding winding.
Srated is the rated nameplate apparent power for the transformer.
For three winding transformer the winding load and winding average phase current are
calculated as:
W(1/2/3) Load (% of rated) = √3 x Iavg(1/2/3) x Vrated (1/2/3) x 100% / SWrated(1/2/3)
Where:
Iavg = (Ia + Ib + Ic)/3 is the actual average phase current (W(1/2/3) Average Ph Current) for
the corresponding winding.
Ia , Ib , Ic are magnitudes of the corresponding actual phase currents of the winding.
Vratedis the rated phase to phase nameplate voltage for the corresponding winding.
Srated is the rated nameplate apparent power for the transformer.
Thermal Elements
Path: Metering > Transformer > Thermal Elements
The calculation of all “Thermal Elements” actual values starts at the time the relay is first
powered up. Therefore, the Daily Rate Loss of Life starts accumulating in the next 24 hour
period. All records can be cleared either from the relay’s keypad, or from the EnerVista 8
Series Setup PC program using the Clear Loss of Life command from the menu Records/
Clear Records.
Tap Changer
Path: Metering > Transformer > Tap Changer
Tap Position
Range: -19 to 39 in steps of 1, Invalid, Not Set
Ohms In 1
Range: 0 to 5100 ohms in steps of 1
Winding Voltage
Range: 0.00 to 1200000.00 kV in steps of 0.01
Delta V Above Min Tap V
Range: 0.00 to 1200000.00 kV in steps of 0.01
Currents
The number of Currents supported is order code dependent.
NOTE:
NOTE
The CT bank names shown are set in the CT Bank Name setpoints under Setpoints >
NOTE:
This metered value is the ratio between the highest phase current injected for the
NOTE current bank, and the lowest pickup setting among all Phase Timed and Instantaneous
overcurrent elements. If all these elements are disabled, the value displayed is "0".
For example, if the lowest pickup is 0.5 xCT, and the highest injected phase current is 1 xCT,
the displayed value for load-to-trip is 200%.
Voltages
The number of Voltages supported is order code dependent.
NOTE:
NOTE
The VT bank names shown are set in the CT Bank Name setpoints under Setpoints >
NOTE:
Frequency
Path: Metering > Frequency 1 - J
Frequency (Current Input J1-CT)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Frequency Rate of Change (Current Input J1-CT)
Range: -20.00 to 20.00 Hz/s
Frequency (Phase Voltage Input J2-3VT)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Frequency Rate of Change (Phase Voltage Input J2-3VT)
Range: -20.00 to 20.00 Hz/s
Frequency (Auxiliary Voltage Input J2-Vx)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Frequency Rate of Change (Auxiliary Voltage Input J2-Vx)
Range: -20.00 to 20.00 Hz/s
Harmonic Magnitude
Path: Metering > Harmonic I Magnitude
J1 Phase A 2nd Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
J1 Phase B 2nd Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
J1 Phase C 2nd Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
J1 Phase A 5th Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
J1 Phase B 5th Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
J1 Phase C 5th Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
K1 Phase A 2nd Harm Mag
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 in steps of 0.001
Harmonics 1(Harmonics 4)
The number of Harmonics supported is order code dependent.
NOTE:
NOTE All values relate to phase currents measured on the input cards (J1, etc.).
Path: Metering > Harmonics 1 - J1
Phase A/B/C Total Harmonic Distortion (Phase A/B/C THD)
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Phase A/B/C Second Harmonic (Phase A/B/C 2)
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Phase A/B/C Third Harmonic (Phase A/B/C 3)
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
-
-
-
Phase A/B/C Twenty Fifth Harmonic (Phase A/B/C 25)
Range: 0.0 to 100.0 %
Harmonic Detection
The second, third, fourth, and fifth harmonics per phase are shown here. The harmonics
values are presented in percent relative to the fundamental magnitude.
Note that similar harmonic ratios and THD values are also displayed under the general
metering menus, “Harmonics 1 - J1”, etc., where all values are calculated every three
cycles. The THD values used in the Harmonic Detection element are the same for the
general metering, so they are not shown here again. The harmonic ratios in the Harmonic
Detection element are calculated and updated every protection pass.
Path: Metering > Harmonic Detection
Synchrocheck
Path: Metering > Synchrocheck
If a Synchrocheck function setting is "Disabled," the corresponding metering display is not
displayed.
Bus Voltage Magnitude (Bus Volts Magnitude)
Range: 0.00 to 600000.00 V
Bus Voltage Angle (Bus Volts Angle)
Range: 0.0 to 359.9°
Bus Voltage Frequency (Bus Volts Frequency)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Line Voltage Magnitude (Line Volts Magnitude)
Range: 0.00 to 600000.00 V
Line Voltage Angle (Line Volts Angle)
Range: 0.0 to 359.9°
Line Voltage Frequency (Line Volts Frequency)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Voltage Difference (Volts Difference)
Range: 0.00 to 600000.00 V
Voltage Angle Difference (Angle Difference)
Range: 0.0 to 359.9°
Voltage Frequency Difference (Frequency Difference)
Range: 2.000 to 90.000 Hz
Power
The following figure illustrates the convention used for measuring power and energy in the
8 Series devices.
Figure 11-4: Flow direction of signed values for watts and VARs
PER IEEE CONVENTIONS
Generator
Parameters as seen by
G the 8-series relays
Voltage +Q
VCG
Watts = Positive IC
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Vars = Positive
PF = Lag IA
VAG –P +P
Current IB IA
PF = Lag PF = Lead
8-SERIES IED
VBG
–Q
M LOAD –Θ1°
Inductive Resistive S=VI
Generator
G
VCG +Q
Voltage
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Positive IA
Vars = Negative IC
PF = Lag VAG –P +P
IA
Current
PF = Lag PF = Lead
IB
8-SERIES IED
VBG –Q
S=VI
LOAD
–Θ2°
Resistive
Inductive Resistive
M LOAD
VCG +Q
+Q
VCG
Voltage IB
PF = Lead PF = Lag
Watts = Positive IA
Vars = Negative VAG –P +P
PF = Lag
IA IC
Energy
Energy (X)
Path: Metering > Energy > Energy 1(X)
Reset Energy D/T
Range: MM/DD/YY HH:MM:SS
Positive Watt Hours (Pos WattHours)
Range: 0.000 MWh to 4294967.295 MWh
Negative Watt Hours (Neg WattHours)
Range: 0.000 MWh to 4294967.295 MWh
Positive Var Hours (Pos VarHours)
Range: 0.000 Mvarh to 4294967.295 Mvarh
Negative Var Hours (Neg VarHours)
Range: 0.000 Mvarh to 4294967.295 Mvarh
Energy Log
Path: Metering > Energy 1 > Energy Log
Pwr1 Last Event Pos WattHours
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 MWh in steps of 0.001 MWh
Default: 0.000 MWh
This is the logged value of Pos WattHours energy accumulated during the last event or
shift interval. The shift interval refers to the time between the last two reset commands,
where the reset command refers to the rising edge of the FlexLogic operand set under
setpoint Reset Event Energy (Path:Power Systems > Power Sensing). An application
example is the monitoring of the total energy accumulated at the end of an event or a
shift interval. An event/shift interval can be defined by the breaker status operand (open
or closed).
Pwr1 Last Event Neg WattHours
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 MWh in steps of 0.001 MWh
Default: 0.000 MWh
This value shows the logged value of Neg WattHours energy accumulated during the
last event or shift interval.
Pwr1 Last Event Pos VarHours
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 Mvarh in steps of 0.001 Mvarh
Default: 0.000 Mvarh
This value shows the logged value of Pos VarHours energy accumulated during the last
event or shift interval.
Pwr1 Last Event Neg VarHours
Range: 0.000 to 4294967.295 Mvarh in steps of 0.001 Mvarh
Default: 0.000 Mvarh
This value shows the logged value of Neg VarHours energy accumulated during the last
event or shift interval.
Records > Clear Records or by the Flexlogic operand programmed by the setpoint Energy
NOTE Log Data under Device > Clear Records. The Reset Energy Log D/T in either case is recorded
and displayed.
Power Factor
The power factor value input to the power factor element(s) is displayed here. Note that the
value may not be equal to the power factor value displayed under Metering > Power 1
since the supervision conditions are applied in the element.
Current Demand
The number of Current Demand supported is Order Code dependent.
NOTE:
NOTE The relay measures Current Demand on each phase, and three phase Demand for real,
reactive, and apparent power. These parameters can be monitored to reduce supplier
Demand penalties or for statistical metering purposes. Demand calculations are based on
the measurement type selected under Monitoring > Functions > Demand. For each
quantity, the relay displays the Demand over the most recent Demand time interval, the
maximum Demand since the last maximum Demand reset, and the time and date stamp
of this maximum Demand value. Maximum Demand quantities can be reset to zero at
Records > Clear Records > Max Current Demand.
Path: Metering > Current Demand 1(X)
Cur1 Reset Demand D/T MM/DD/YY 00:00:00
Cur1 Ph A/B/C Demand
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Cur1 Max Ph A/B/C Demand
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Cur1 D/T Ph A/B/C Demand MM/DD/YY HH:MM:SS
Current Demand K1
Path: Metering > Current Demand K1
Reset (K1 Reset Demand Date/Time) MM/DD/YY 00:00:00
Phase A Demand (K1 Ph A Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Phase B Demand (K1 Ph B Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Phase C Demand (K1 Ph C Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Current Demand K2
Path: Metering > Current Demand K2
Reset (K2 Reset Demand Date/Time) MM/DD/YY 00:00:00
Phase A Demand (K2 Ph A Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Phase B Demand (K2 Ph B Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Phase C Demand (K2 Ph C Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Maximum Phase A Demand (K2 Max Ph A Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Maximum Phase B Demand (K2 Max Ph B Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Maximum Phase C Demand (K2 Max Ph C Demand)
Range: 0.000 to 12000.000 A
Date/Time Phase A Demand (K2 Date/Time Ph A Demand) MM/DD/YY HH:MM:SS
Directional Power
Path: Metering > Directional Power
The effective operating quantities of the sensitive directional power elements are displayed
here. The display may be useful to calibrate the feature by compensating the angular
errors of the CTs and VTs with the use of the RCA and CALIBRATION settings.
Directional Power 1
Range: -214748364.8 kW to 214748364.7 kW
Default: 0.0 kW
...
Directional Power X
Range: -214748364.8 kW to 214748364.7 kW
Default: 0.0 kW
Arc Flash
Path: Metering > Arc Flash > Arc Flash 1
HS Phase Current A/B/C
Range: 0.00 to 120000.00 A in steps of 0.01
HS Ground Current
Range: 0.00 to 120000.00 A in steps of 0.01
Sensor 1(X) Light Level
Range: 0.00 to 300000.0 Lu in steps of 0.1
Sensor 1(X) Max Light Level
Range: 0.00 to 300000.0 Lu in steps of 0.1
RTDs
Path: Metering > RTDs
The Temperature can be displayed in Celsius or Fahrenheit. The selection is made in
NOTE:
RRTDs
Path: Metering > RRTDs
The Temperature can be displayed in Celsius or Fahrenheit. The selection is made in
NOTE:
RTD Maximums
Path: Metering > RTD Maximums
The Temperature can be displayed in Celsius or Fahrenheit. The selection is made in
NOTE:
Clear Records > RTD Maximums to “ON”. Executing this command loads -40°C (or -40°F) as
NOTE the initial Maximum RTD value.
RRTD Maximums
Path: Metering > RRTD Maximums
The Temperature can be displayed in Celsius or Fahrenheit. The selection is made in
NOTE:
Clear Records > RRTD Maximums to “ON”. Executing this command loads -40°C (or -40°F)
NOTE as the initial Maximum RRTD value.
Analog Inputs
Path: Metering > Analog Inputs
Analog Ip 1 (4)
Range: -500000 to 500000 units in steps of 1
FlexElements
Path: Metering > FlexElements
The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the definitions
of the base units in the Definitions of the Base Unit for the FLEXELEMENT table. This table is
in the Setpoints>FlexLogic>FlexElements section.
FlexElement Operating Signals:
FlexEI 1 Op Signal
FlexEI 2 Op Signal
FlexEI 3 Op Signal
FlexEI 4 Op Signal
FlexEI 5 Op Signal
FlexEI 6 Op Signal
FlexEI 7 Op Signal
FlexEI 8 Op Signal
Records
Events
The 845 has an event recorder which runs continuously. All event records are stored in
flash memory such that information is permanently retained. The events are displayed
from newest to oldest event. Each event has a header message containing a summary of
the event that occurred, and is assigned an event number equal to the number of events
that have occurred since the recorder was cleared. The event number is incremented for
each new event.
The Event Recorder captures contextual data associated with the last 1024 events listed in
chronological order from most recent to oldest. Events for a particular element are
captured, if the setpoint “Events” from its menu is selected to Enabled. By default, the
Events setpoint from all elements is set to Enabled.
Path: Records > Event Records
The events are cleared by pressing the pushbutton corresponding to the tab CLEAR, or
when issuing clear event records command from the general clear records menu.
Event Viewer
The Event Viewer within the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software provides a consolidated
view of up to 1024 events from a single 8 Series device or up to as many as ten connected
8 Series devices or event files (10 x 1024 events in total).
To open the Event Viewer for a connected device, follow these steps in the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software:
1. Establish communications with the relay.
2. Select the Setpoints > Records > Events menu item.
A small Events window opens displaying the following:
– Date/Time of Last Clear
– Events Since Last Clear
– Date/Time of Last Retrieval
In addition, the Event Viewer launches for a detailed view of up to 1024 of the most
recent events.
The Event Viewer window runs as a separate application, and can be moved outside of the
main EnerVista 8 Series Setup window and resized as needed.
If the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software is closed, the Event Viewer remains open but
offline (no further events are received from running devices, however event data is still
available).
The Event List includes all events in descending chronological order. For multiple sources, a
Source column showing the device name or file name is shown between the Date/Time
and the Event columns.
To add an additional connected 8 Series relay to the open Event Viewer, follow these steps
in the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software:
1. Establish communications with the relay.
2. Select the Setpoints > Records > Events menu item.
The Event Viewer adds up to 1024 of the most recent events to the open window,
labelled with the new device name in the Source column.
The Event column is only shown when Show Event Numbers is selected on the Data tab.
On the left side of the Event List a checkbox column with a toggle button at the top allows
selection of specific events. Only the selected events are saved or copied by the Save to
File and Copy to Clipboard options in the File tab.
Use the following keys to navigate quickly through the Event List:
• 'End' scrolls to the bottom of the Event List
• 'Home' scrolls to the top of the Event List
• 'Page Down' scrolls one page down in the Event List
• 'Page Up' scrolls one page up in the Event List
When the Event Viewer and the EnerVista 8 Series Setup software are both open, new
events from connected devices are added to the Event Viewer as they occur and
oscillography and fault report records are gradually retrieved from the device, in order of
oldest to newest (assuming oscillography records and fault report records are saved in a
common location).
Oscillography record events (such as 'Trans. Rec Trigger' shown above) have a symbol in
the Data column that includes a link to launch the oscillography record in the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software.
Fault report events (such as 'Fault Rpt Trig' shown above) can be opened in the same
manner by clicking the fault report symbol in the Data column.
FILE TAB
Use the File tab to open event files in the Event Viewer, save events to a file, or copy events
to the clipboard.
• Open File: opens a window to browse to an events file (of type .eev, .txt. or .evt) and
opens it in the existing Event Viewer window, or in a new Event Viewer window.
– Check In New Window to open the file in a new Event Viewer window.
• Save to File: saves the selected events to a file. Hidden (filtered) events are not saved.
– Select the events to save using the checkboxes on the left of the events list.
– Check Include Event Data to save full details of each event instead of just a
summary.
• Copy to Clipboard: copies the selected events to the clipboard. Hidden (filtered)
events are not copied.
– Select the events to copy using the checkboxes on the left of the events list.
– Check Include Event Data to copy full details of each event instead of just a
summary.
HOME TAB
Use the Home tab to select the events shown in the detailed view, measure time between
events, and view the current Event Viewer statistics.
By default, the Event Viewer opens displaying the Home tab with the last three events
selected. Details of these three events are displayed in the lower pane of the Event Viewer
window.
To select up to three events from the list displayed in the Event Viewer, follow these steps:
1. From the Home tab, choose which event to set by clicking button 1, 2, or 3 above the
Event Selector label.
2. Click an event from the list of displayed events.
The event changes color to match the selected button (blue for 1, green for 2, or red
for 3) and the event details display in the lower pane, highlighted in the same color.
The absolute times between the three selected events are displayed above the Delta
Times label.
The Statistics area in the Home tab includes the following information:
• Sources: the number of event sources (devices and files) currently available.
• Events: the number of events being managed by the Event Viewer.
• Filtered: the number of events shown after any active filters are applied. (Filters are
applied in the Data tab).
DATA TAB
Use the Data tab to filter the events shown in the Event Viewer.
• Show Event Numbers: toggles on and off the event number column in the list of
events. The event number can be useful for reconciling events between the Eevnt
Viewer and local HMI of an 845 device.
• Select Event Sources: provides a drop-down list of all available event sources (devices
and files). Uncheck a device or file to hide the associated events from the main list.
• Cause of Event Filter: provides an alphabetized list of all event names, allowing
different event types to be shown or hidden.
By default all events are shown.
Transient Records
Path: Records > Transients > Transient Records
Using the EnerVista 8 Series Setup select a record and then click the “Launch Viewer”
button to view the waveform.
Fault Reports
The latest fault reports can be displayed.
Path: Records > Fault Reports
NUMBER OF REPORTS
This value shows the number of reports since the last clear.
LAST TRIP DATE/TIME
Range: MM/DD/YY/ HH:MM:SS
This value is the date and time on which the last report was generated.
LAST CLEAR DATE/TIME
Range: MM/DD/YY/ HH:MM:SS
This value is the date and time on which the record was cleared.
FAULT REPORT X TIME
Range: MM/DD/YY/ HH:MM:SS
This value is the date and time on which the specified fault report was generated.
Data Logger
The 845 Data Logger record can be retrieved and seen from this window. It displays the
oldest and newest timestamps, and the total number of samples captured for all channels
programmed in Setpoints > Device > Data Logger menu.
Path: Records > Data Logger
Breakers Records
Breaker Arcing Current
Path: Records > Breakers Records > Breaker 1
ARCING CURRENT PHASE A
Range: 00.00 TO 42949672.95 kA2-cyc in steps of 0.01
ARCING CURRENT PHASE B
Range: 00.00 TO 42949672.95 kA2-cyc in steps of 0.01
ARCING CURRENT PHASE C
Range: 00.00 TO 42949672.95 Ka2-cyc in steps of 0.01
TOTAL ARCING CURRENT
Range: 00.00 TO 42949672.95 Ka2-cyc in steps of 0.01
Breaker Health
The menu displays the breaker monitoring values. The latest value, average of last five
values and average of values since last reset are recorded, calculated and displayed.
When the DETECTION mode is selected, the values displayed here can be used as the
reference for user settings. The values are saved into non-volatile memory to avoid the loss
of data during the power down period.
Path: Records > Breakers Records > Breaker Health
TOTAL BREAKER TRIPS
Range: 0 to 10000 in steps of 1
TRIPS SINCE LAST RESET
Range: 0 to 10000 in steps of 1
ALARM COUNTER
Range: 0 to 100 in steps of 1
LAST TRIP TIME
Range: 0 TO 4294967295 ms in steps 1
AVG. OF 5 TRIP TIME
Range: 0 TO 4294967295 ms in steps 1
AVG. OF TRIP TIME
Range: 0 TO 4294967295 ms in steps 1
LAST CLOSE TIME
Range: 0 TO 4294967295 ms in steps 1
Digital Counters
The present status of the sixteen Digital Counters is shown here. The status of each
Counter, with the user-defined Counter name, includes the accumulated and frozen
counts (the count units label also appears). Also included, is the date and time stamp for
the frozen count. The Counter microseconds frozen value refers to the microsecond
portion of the time stamp.
Path: Records > Digital Counter 1 (16)
COUNTER X ACCUMULATED
Range: -2147483648 to 2147483647 in steps of 1
COUNTER X FROZEN
Range: -2147483648 to 2147483647 in steps of 1
DATE/TIME FROZEN
Default: 01/01/70 00:00:00
Range: Date/Time Format (MM/DD/YY HH:MM:SS)
COUNTER X us FROZEN
Range: 0 to 999999 µs in steps of 1
Figure 12-1: Example of Digital States for the default BSG3 RMD profile
Path: Records > Remote Modbus Device > Device 1 > Analog Values
RMD-FLEXANALOG 1-64
Range: -2147483648 to 2147483647 in steps of 1
Default: 0
Up to 64 FlexAnalog operands can be shown here.
The value displayed is based on the Enumeration field defined in the Remote Modbus
Device Editor for each specific digital point.
The displayed text (see ‘Item Name’ field in EnerVista 8 Series Setup software) is the
FlexAnalog name defined in the Remote Modbus Device Editor ‘Label’ fieldfor each
Analog Point in the current profile. See Device > Communications > Remote Modbus
Device > Device 1.
The value displayed is based on the Data Type, Multiplier, Decimals, and Units fields
defined in the Remote Modbus Device Setpoint for each specific analog point.
Figure 12-2: Example for Analog Values of the default BSG3 RMD profile
Clear Records
The Clear Records command is accessible from the front panel and from the EnerVista 8
Series Setup software.
Path: Records > Clear Records
Records can be cleared by assigning “On” to the appropriate setting.
The Clear Records command is also available from Device > Clear Records, where the
FASTPATH:
Transformer M&D
The 845 Transformer Protection Relay and M&D (monitoring and diagnostics) devices are
connected and operated in client-server mode of operation. The contents from the M&D
device are organized as per the menu tree shown below under “Transformer M&D menu”.
Detailed information on the Transformer M&D menu tree contents (i.e., DGA Monitoring,
NOTE:
DGA Monitoring
The 845 relay provides configuration parameters to establish communication with DGA
devices on Modbus TCP/IP protocol. Four DGA devices are supported – Transfix, DGA 500,
Minitrans, and HM2. The 845 relay supports MODBUS TCP client protocol which acts as the
master or client to M&D devices.
The following configuration parameters are used for establishing the communication
between the 845 relay and DGA device.
IP ADDRESS
Range: standard IPv4 address
Default: 0.0.0.0
This setting specifies the IP address of the M&D DGA device that communicates with the
845 relay.
SLAVE ADDRESS
Range: 0 to 254
Default: 0
This setting is the slave ID field (unit ID) within the Modbus protocol. It is the ID of the
M&D device, and each M&D device in general has a unique ID.
PORT
Range: 0 to 10000
Default: 502
This setting is the standard port setting of the Modbus protocol. Port setting 502 is the
setting most often used for all Modbus based communications.
DEVICE TYPE
Range: None, Transfix, DGA 500, Minitrans, HM2
Default: None
This setting defines the type of M&D DGA device being used with the 845 relay on the
Modbus protocol. Supported device types include Transfix, DGA 500, Minitrans and HM2.
Device Data
The Device Data menu item provides the device ID and serial number of the DGA device
connected to the 845 relay.
Energization Records
The Transformer Energization record is generated by the 845 relay for every successful
transformer energization event. The energization record can only be retrieved using
EnerVista 8 Series Setup software. Six of the latest energization records are supported by
the 845 relay based on the FIFO concept.
Each energization record contains:
• Transient record data with 10 cycles of user configured energization winding source
voltage, and current waveform data of each phase sampled at 64 samples/cycle
• Computed energization parameters through data captured in the metering module
from the initial 10 cycles of captured raw data during an energization event and
downsampling this data to 64 samples/cycle.
• The latest available calculated, measured or monitored values for the selected
winding source after successful energization.
Models
Models consist of transformer operational data represented in a constructive manner
using electrical, thermal and DGA data. This section contains transformer models and DGA
models.
Transformer Models
Transformer models represent transformer operational electrical, thermal and DGA data
based on learned data in the form of a trend chart. Each trend chart consists of computed
or monitored parameter trends, classified based on relevancy as a group of 10
parameters.
The Data correlation model in this section is a customized trend chart where the user can
select the required parameter trends to display.
DGA Models
DGA models consist of the standard Duval Triangle and Gas Ratios model which is
computed based on the latest 50 DGA data samples. The Key Gas model is computed
based on the latest DGA data.
Maintenance
The following maintenance options are available through the EnerVista 8 Series
Setup software.
Path: Maintenance > Modbus Analyzer
The Modbus Analyzer is used to access data via the Modbus User map for testing,
troubleshooting and maintaining connected devices. See the 8 Series Protective Relay
Communications Guide for modbus memory map details.
Path:Maintenance > Update Firmware
Selecting Update Firmware loads new firmware into the flash memory. See Loading New
Relay Firmware in Chapter 3, Interfaces > Software Interface > Upgrading Relay Firmware.
Path: Maintenance > Environmental Awareness Health Report
Over the life of the 845 product remedial action can be required. The 845 has a module
which can record environmental data.
General Maintenance
The 845 requires minimal maintenance. As a microprocessor-based relay, its
characteristics do not change over time. The expected service life of a 845 is 20 years
when the environment and electrical conditions are within stated specifications.
While the 845 performs continual self-tests, it is recommended that maintenance be
scheduled with other system maintenance. This maintenance can involve in-service, out-
of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.
In-service Maintenance
1. Visual verification of the analog values integrity, such as voltage and current (in
comparison to other devices on the corresponding system).
2. Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages, and LED indications.
3. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, dust, or loose wires.
4. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.
Out-of-service Maintenance
1. Check wiring connections for firmness.
2. Analog values (currents, voltages, RTDs, analog inputs) injection test and metering
accuracy verification. Calibrated test equipment is required.
3. Protection elements setting verification (analog values injection or visual verification
of setting file entries against relay settings schedule).
4. Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change
of state forcing or as part of the system functional testing.
5. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, or dust.
6. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.
Appendix A
Appendix A
Warranty
For products shipped as of 1 October 2013, GE Digital Energy warrants most of its GE
manufactured products for 10 years. For warranty details including any limitations and
disclaimers, see the GE Digital Energy Terms and Conditions at https://
www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
For products shipped before 1 October 2013, the standard 24-month warranty applies.
Revision history
Major Updates
Table A-2: Major Updates for 845-AC
Chapter CHANGES
general minor corrections throughout.
cover Manual revision number from AB to AC
1 Order codes updated.
Typical wiring diagrams updated.
Details for ohms input (tap changer) added in Terminal Identification
2
section.
AC Analog table added for Slot K.
Auxiliary Relay Pulse Type changed so that it does not run Seal-In Timer
after Block is removed. Auxiliary logic diagram updated.
5
PseudoVoltage added.
LED "PICKUP" and FOCUSED NAVIGATION added to front panel settings.
6 UR operate time calculations added.
Breaker Control logic diagram updated.
Synchronous motor field breaker/contactor control logic diagram updated.
8
Added CBF initiation seal in and P Programmable timer for Retrip. Settings
and figures updated accordingly.
Latched Breaker Close relay dropped with corresponding breaker Trip Relay
10 ON for all breakers with any configured Close relay. Close and Trip logic
diagrams updated.
Communication Activity Status updated.
4 Added new Annunciator with Panel section to Setpoints > Device > Front
Panel > Annunciator
Added new Switches section (for disconnect switch setup) to Setpoints >
4
System > Switches
Revised Breaker logic diagram to 892740A2.cdr to update settings for
4
contact input 52a, 52b and remove the breaker disconnected dependencies
Revised Undercurrent logic diagram to 894205A1.cdr to add setting for
4
signal input
4 Added new Timed Undervoltage section to Setpoints > Protection > Voltage
Elements
Added new UV Reactive Power section to Setpoints > Protection > Voltage
4
Elements
Revised Neutral Overvoltage logic diagram to 894050A2.cdr to add setting
4
for signal input
Revised Negative Sequence OV logic diagram to 894051A2.cdr to add
4 setting for signal input
4 Added new Admittance section to Setpoints > Protection
Revised Power Factor logic diagram to 894059A3.cdr to add setting for
4
signal input
Revised Pulsed Outputs logic diagram to 894064A2.cdr to add setting for
4
signal input
4 Added new Local Control Mode section, see Setpoints > Control
4 Added new Breaker Control section, see Setpoints > Control
Added new Switch Control (for disconnect switch control) section to
4
Setpoints > Control > Switch Control
4 Added new Pole Discordance section to Setpoints > Control
4 Added new CT Supervision section to Setpoints > Control
4 Added new Ethernet Loopback test section to Setpoints > Testing